INDUSTRIAL and ENGINEERING CHEMISTRY
Transcription
INDUSTRIAL and ENGINEERING CHEMISTRY
INDUSTRIAL and ENGINEERING CHEMISTRY A N A L Y T IC A L E D ITIO N W A L T E R J . M U R P H Y , E D IT O R I S S U E D J A N U A R Y 25, 1944 Editorial Assistant: G . G l a d y s G o r d o n M anuscript Assistant: S t e l l a A n d e r s o n . / r-j - V \ i û ' j " T il, B. L. C l a r k e T . R. C u n n i n g h a m Advisory Board G. E . F . L u n d e l l M . G. M e l l o n V O L . 16, N O . 1 C O N S E C U T IV E N O . 2 M ake-up Assistant: C h a r l o t t e C . S a y r e - R. H . M ü l l e r II. H . W i l l a r d Ph E m u ls io n P o ly m e riz a tio n of S y n th e tic R u b b e r i n 10G r a m S y s t e m s ..................................... C harles F. Fryling 1 C o lo r o f A g u e o u s P o ta s s iu m D ic h ro m a te S o lu tio n s . R. E. Kitson with M. G . Mellon D e te r m in a tio n of T e tr a e th y lle a d in G a so lin e . . . . Harry G onick and J. J. Milano 4 G ra v im e tric D e te r m in a tio n of T u n g s t e n ...................... John H. Yoe and A. Letcher Jones Specific G ra v ity of B u t a d i e n e ...................................... . M. R. Dean an d T. W. Legatski 7 D ic h ro m a te D e te r m in a tio n o f Ir o n , U sin g S ilv er R e d u c t o r ......................J. L. H enry and R. W. G elbach 49 P h y sic a l M e th o d s of A n a ly sis of S y n th e tic a n d N a tu r a l R u b b e r ................................. R. Bowling Barnes, Van Zandt Williams, A. R. Davis, and Paul Gieseoke 9 50 E th y lb is - 2 ,4 -D in itro p h e n y la c e ta te , N ew p H I n d ic a t o r .................................. E. A. Fehnel and E. D. Amstutz 53 D e te r m in a tio n of R a te of C u re fo r N a tu r a l a n d S y n th e t ic R u b b e r ......................................................................... Leonard H. Cohan an d M artin Steinberg 15 D e te r m in a tio n of A lp h a ,P a ra - D irq e th y ls ty re n e in .P re s e n c e o f P a ra - M e th y ls ty r e n e , S ty r e n e , a n d P a ra - C y m e n e . . John H. Elliott and Evelyn V. Cook 20 D e te r m in a tio n of S o lu b le P e c tin a n d P e c tic A cid b y E l e c t r o d e p o s i t i o n ................................................................ Kenneth T. Williams and C larence M. Johnson P re c ise M e a s u r e m e n t of V o lu m e in T itr im e tr ic A n a ly s is .................................. . William M. Thornton, Jr. 45 23 P y c n o m e te r fo r V o la tile L iq u id s. C o n tro l of D iffu sio n a s A id in P re c is io n P y c n o m e try . . . . M. R. Lipkin, J, A. Davison, W. T. Harvey, and S. S. Kurtz, Jr. 55 A p p a ra tu s fo r M e a s u rin g G a s P e r m e a b ility of F ilm M a te ria ls of Low P e r m e a b ility . A. Cornwell Shum an 58 D e sig n of L a rg e -S iz e L a b o ra to ry E x tr a c tio n G lass A p p a r a t u s ........................................... Raymond Jonnard 61 A n a ly sis of P e tr o le u m O il-S o lu b le S o d iu m S u lfo n a te s b y A d s o r p t i o n .............................. John M. Koch 25 C o n tin u o u s L iq u id -L iq u id E x tr a c to r . . Irwin A. Pearl Q u a n tita tiv e D e te r m in a tio n of d -G a la c to s e b y S e le c tiv e F e r m e n ta t io n w ith S p e c ia l R e fe re n c e to P l a n t M u c ila g e s . Louis E. Wise and John W. A ppling M IC R O C H E M IS T R Y 62 28 D e te r m in a tio n of S m a ll A m o u n ts of A c ry lo n itrile i n A i r ......................G. W. Petersen and H. H. Radke 63 U se o f D is c r im in a n t F u n c tio n in C o m p a ris o n of P ro x im a te C o al A n a l y s e s ............................................... W . D. Baten and C. C. DeWitt 32 S p e c tr o p h o to m e tric D e te r m in a tio n o f Io d in e L ib e ra te d in O x id a tio n of C a rb o n M o n o x id e b y Io d in e P e n to x id e . B ernard Smaller an d J. F. Hall, Jr. 64 C o lo rim e tric A n a ly sis of X a n th o n e S p ra y R e sid u e s . C. C. Cassil and J. W. H ansen 35 P h e n o l S t u d i e s ........................................Wm. B. Deichmann 37 Y e a st M ic ro b io lo g ic a l M e th o d s fo r D e te r m in a tio n o f V i t a m i n s ........................ Lawrence Atkin, William L. Williams, Alfred S. Schultz, an d C harles N. Frey 67 P o la ro g ra p h ic D e te r m in a tio n o f C o p p e r, L e a d , a n d C a d m iu m i n H ig h - P u r ity Z in c A l l o y s ................. R. C. Hawkings and H. G . Thode 71 D e te r m in a tio n of P e c tin i n B io lo g ical M a te ria ls . Edwin F. Bryant, G ran t H. Palmer, and G . H. Joseph 74 S ta b ility of S ta n d a r d S o lu tio n s of C o p p e r P e r c h lo r a te a n d P o ta s s iu m I o d a t e .............................. Joseph J. Kolb 38 S e m ia u to m a tic P re s s u re C o n tro l in L o w -P re ssu re , L o w - T e m p e ra tu re L a b o ra to ry F r a c tio n a tio n . . . D. R. Douslin and W. S. Walls 40 T h e A m erican C hem ical Society assum es no resp o n sib ility for th e s ta te m e n ts an d opinions advanced b y c o n trib u to rs to its p u b lications. C op y rig h t 1944 b y A m erican C hem ical Society. 30,900 copies of th is issue p rin ted . P ublished b y th e A m erican C hem ical S o ciety a t E a s to n , P en tia. E d i to ria l Office: 1155 10th S tre e t, N . W ., W ash in g to n 6, D . C.; telephone, R epublic 5301; cable, Jiech em (W ash in g to n ). Business Office: A m erican C hem ical Society, 1155 16th S tree t, N . W .t W ashington 6, D . C . A d v e rtis ing Office: 332 W est 42nd S tre e t, New Y o rk 18, N. Y .; telep h o n e, B ry a n t 9-4430. E n te re d as second-class m a tte r a t th e P o st Office a t E a s to n , P e n n a ., u n d e r th e A ct of M arch 3, 1879, as 24 tim es a year— In d u stria l E d ition m o n th ly on th e 1st, A n aly tical E d itio n m o n th ly on th e lo th . A cceptance for m ailing a t special ra te of p o stag e p ro v id ed for in Section 1103, A ct of O c to b e r s , 1917, au th o rized Ju ly 13, 19 1 8 .i! . R em itta n ce s an d o rd ers for su b scrip tio n s an d for single copies, notices of changes of add ress an d new professional connections, and claim s for m issing n u m b ers should b e se n t to th e A m erican C hem ical Society, 1155 16th S treet, N . W ,, W ashin g to n 0, D . C . C hanges of ad d ress for th e In d u s tria l E d itio n m u st h e received on o r before th e 18th of th e preceding m o h th a n d for th e A n a lytical E d itio n n o t la te r th a n th e 3 0th of th e preceding m o n th . C laim s for missing num bers will n o t be allow ed (1) if received m ore th a n 60 d ays from d a te of issue (owing to th e h a za rd s of w artim e d elivery, no claim s van be honored from subscribers o utside of N o rth A m erica), (2) if loss w as d u e to failure of notice of change of address to be received before th e d a te s .specified in the preceding sentence, or (3) if th e reason for claim is “ m issing from files". A nnual su b sc rip tio n — In d u s tria l E d itio n a n d A n a lytical E d itio n sold only as a u n it, m em bers S3.00, nonm em bers S4.00. P o stag e to countries n o t in th e Pan-A m erican U nion S2.25; C an ad ian postage SO.75. Single copies— cu rre n t issues, In d u stria l E d itio n §0.75, A nalytical E d itio n S0.50; back num bers. In d u stria l E d itio n 30.80, A nalytical E d itio n prices on request; special ra te s to m em bers. T h e A m erican C hem ical S ociety also publishes Chemical and Engineering Newe, Chemical Abstracta, and Jo u rn a l o f the Am erican Chemical Society. R ates on req u est. A L U N D U M Laboratory W are has high heat transfer properties, is chem i ca lly inert and assures long service. C leaning is a sim ple process of wash ing and ign iting to constant weight. From your regular laboratory supply house you can obtain N orton tubes, cores and muffles for electric furnaces; crucibles and dishes for igniting, incinerating, melting,- dishes, cones, discs, thimbles, crucibles for filtering; combustion boats, pyrometer tubes and refractory cements. A Norton Laboratory W are catalog w ill be sent free upon request. NORTON C O M P A N Y , W o rc e ster 6, Mass E L .E G ff.R -IC FU RN ACE /FU SED January 15, 1944 ANALYTICAL With todays increased production demands taxing the m etallurgist, chemist, and physicist—the method used should facilitate obtaining informa tion concerning the submicroscopic structure of any sort of material in the shortest possible time. The G-E XRD Unit permits the registration of patterns with exposure times which are from three to thirty times faster than was previously possible. In routine diffraction studies of steel, four to eight hour tests were formerly necessary—with the G-E XRD Unit it is possible to conduct the same study ---------------- EDITION with a fifteen to thirty minute exposure. Corre sponding reductions in exposure times have materially speeded up the control of other metals. G-E X-Ray offers a complete line of diffraction cameras—each a precision instrument designed to meet the exacting standards required in analytical procedures. The XRD Unit, along with the cameras, offer a solution for many of the numerous problems encountered in the control and investigation of materials used in manufacturing processes. For complete information, write to Department NN41. GENERAL i f f ELECTRIC X R A Y CORPORATION 2012 JACKSON BLVD. C H I C A G O (12), ILL., U. S. A. 6 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING Vol. 16, No. 1 CHEMISTRY a c c u ra te m in u te s h o u r s . SPECTROGRAPH 'k The tim e tod ay is all im p o rta n t, p artic u larly th e tim e o f highly train ed technicians. T h a t is w hy m a n u fac tu rers th ro u g h o u t th e co u n try are u sin g th e A . R . L .D ie te rt L arg e G ra tin g S p e ctro g rap h in th e ir f| testin g lab o rato ries. T h e y h av e fo u n d th a t one tra in e d o p e ra to r an d th e S p ectro g rap h w ill do th e H The Spectrograph work t h a t fo rm erly re q u ired th e co m b in ed skill o f 1 2 illustrated includes op erato rs usin g th e w et m e th o d s o f a n aly sis. spark, D. C. Arc, N o t only is th e re a defin ite sav in g o f m a n -h o u rs, b u t th e and A . C. A rc , A . R . L .-C )ietert G ra tin g S p ectro g ra p h w ith its larg e linear source units. dispersion a n d exceptionally h ig h reso lu tio n is a n id eal in s tru m e n t fo r all types o f research a n d co n tro l analysis. A t th e p re s e n t tim e m a n u fa c tu re rs a re u sin g it to analyze iro n , steel, m agnesium , alum inum , b ronze, b rass, zinc, le a d —in fa c t, alm o st e v ery th in g . F o r com plete in fo rm atio n a b o u t th e A . R . L .-D ie te rt S p ectro g rap h w rite for o u r M o d ern A nalysis C atalo g u e N o . 128 to d a y . APPLIED RESEARCH LABORATORIES 4336 SAN FERN ANDO RD., GLENDALE, CALIF. HARR Y W D I E T E R T CO. 9330 ROSELAWN AVE., DETROIT, MICH. January 15, 1944 ANALYTICAL EDITION 7 B e g i n n i n g w it h P y r e x b r a n d L a b o r a to r y G la s s w a r e in 1 9 1 5 , C o r n in g R e s e a r c h h a s k e p t p a c e w it h t h e g r o w t h o f t h e m o d e r n la b o r a t o r y b y d e v e lo p in g n e w lin e s o f g la s s w a r e t o m e e t e a c h n e w la b o r a t o r y n e e d . T o d a y t h e r e a r e f iv e s e p a r a te lin e s m e e t in g e v e r y la b o r a t o r y r e q u ir e m e n t. 1. Pyrex brand Laboratory Glassware THE A L L - A R O U N D 3 . Pyrex brand Fritted Ware-FOR W ARE FOR A LL-A R O U N D S P E E D , R E T E N T IV IT Y A N D FREEDOM FROM CH EM ICA L R E A C T IO N USE F a b ric a te d fro m “ P y re x ” C h em ical G lass N o. 774— “ P y re x ” W a re com bines th e essen tial p ro p e rtie s o f ch em ical sta b ility , m ech a n ical stre n g th a n d h e a t resistance, scientifically balanced — th e standard glassw are fo r gen eral la b o ra to ry use. 2 . Pyrex brand Lifetime Red Low Actinic Glassware FO R L IG H T - S E N S IT IV E S U BSTA N C ES T liis colored glassw are affords hig h p ro te c tiv e v alu e. F a b ri c a te d from “ P y re x ” C hem ical G lass N o . 774, its l i f e t i m e b e d color is a n in te g ra l p a r t o f th e glass. M e ch an ical stre n g th , chem ical sta b ility a n d h e a t re sista n c e a re com b in ed w ith a b ility to r e ta r d d e te rio ra tio n fro m lig h t influence. T h e follow ing d a ta w ill serv e a s a guide to its efficiency: A p p ro x im ate p e rc e n t w av e le n g th tran sm issio n in A ng stro m u n its o f “ P y re x ” Low A ctinic W are 3000 4000 5000 6000 A n g stro m s 0 % A n g stro m s 1 % A n g stro m s 4 % A n g stro m s 12% G lass p a rtic le s a re fr itte d to form discs w hich a re sealed in to n o n -p o ro u s bodies— b o th o f “ P y re x ” C h em ical G lass N o . 774. W ith five p o ro sities a v ailab le— from u ltra fine to e x tra coarse— filtra tio n o f v a rio u s ty p e s o f p re c ip ita te s c a n be acco m p lished a t m ax im u m speed. D iscs a re m ech a n ically stro n g , th e rm a lly a n d ch em ically re s ista n t. 4 . Vycor brand Glassware FOR H IG H TEM PERATURE R E A C T IO N S , R A P ID A N A L Y S IS F a b ric a te d fro m 9 6 % Silica G lass N o. 790, th is w are possesses ex cep tio n al ch em ical sta b ility , h a s a h ig h so ften in g p o in t a n d ex trem ely low coefficient o f expansion. 5 . Corning brand Alkali-Resistant Glassware FOR B O R O N D ETER M IN A TIO NS A N D S IM ILA R A P P L IC A T IO N S D esigned specifically for use w h ere resistan ce to alk alies is im p o rta n t. F a b ric a te d from “ C o rn in g ” A lk a li-R e sista n t G lass N o. 728— su b sta n tia lly boron-free (ap p ro x . B 2 O 3 C o n te n t, 0 .0 6 % ). C O M P A R I S O N O F P R O P E R T I E S — (F or o th e r physical properties consult C atalog LP21 an d Supplem ents) N um ber and Type Coef, o f Expansion Annealing Softening Point Point Strain Point Specific Gravity Loss in Weight—-100 lbs. Steam Pressure 96 IJrs. (grams per sg. cm.) I^oss in Weight— Boiling 6 IJrs. in 5% N a O ll (grams per sg. cm.) Pyrex brand C hem ical Glass No. 774 0.0000032 560°C 820°C 510°C 2.23 0.0005 0.002 96% Silica Glass No. 790 0.0000008 910°C 1500°C 820°C 2.18 0.0001 0.0015 “ C orning” A lkali-R esistant Glass (B oron-Free) No. 728 0.0000063 620°C 870°C 585°C 2.60 0.0005 0.00004 PYREX BRAND (PYREX LABORATORY WARE P Y R E X ” and ‘‘V Y C O R " are registered trade-marks and indicate manufacture by m e a n s —— - Research- in Glass CORNING GLASS WORKS CO RN IN G, N. Y. I 8 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 Official U.S. Army Photograph H O W IS THE W A T E R ? Testing w ater supply is one of the jobs of the Army M edical Corps. The Army alw ays p lays safe with the health of the soldiers, who must be protected against contaminated w ater. In this ever-constant watchfulness over Army w ater supply, H ellige Sim plex Testers are helping in provid ing a quick and accurate means for securing true chlorine determinations. 3718 Northern Blvd. Lo n s Island City 1 New York January 15, 1944 ANALYTICAL EDITION 9 ÉXAX- a n d ASSURANCE throng) The Visible Guarantee o f In v is ib le Q u a lity INDUSTRIAL 10 AND ENGINEERING CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 the original building of O hio W esleyan University — founded in w a s the n am e of the cou rse in the first classroom instruction in chemistry at Ohio W esleyan University. The course began in 1845 and w a s housed in the old M ansion House — later nam ed Elliott Hall Edgar Hall now houses the modern fire proof chem ical laboratories w here Multiple Unit Organic Combustion Furnaces are used for instruction and research in organic chemistry. See your Laboratory Supply Dealer or send fo r Bulletin H D -135 A H E V I D U T Y E Ł E C T R IC COM P A N Y T «4 0 E m a rk LABORATORY FURNACES MULTIPLE UNIT ELECTRIC EXCLUSIVELY REG. U. S. RAT. OFF. iffe PÄS JBBMRMEB MILWAUKEE, WISCONSIN 1» -1 January 15, 1944 ANALYTICAL L in d b e r g L a b o r a to r y fu r n a c e s , h o t p la te s a n d c o n tro l, m o d e r n in d e sig n , a r e e n g in e e r e d a n d b u i l t to m e e t th e e x a c tin g e v e r y d a y r e q u i r e m e n ts o f y o u r la b o r a to r y . L in d b e r g C o m b u s tio n T u b e F u r n a c e —T e m p e r a tu r e s to 2500° F . F o r f a s t m o d e r n v o lu m e tr ic a s w e ll a s g r a v im e tr ic ty p e s o f d e te r m in a tio n s . E q u ip p e d w ith b u i l t - i n tr a n s f o r m e r , a ll n e c e s s a r y c o n tro l, G lo b a r e le m e n ts a n d t u b e a d a p to r s . L in d b e r g B o x F u r n a c e s —T e m p e r a tu r e s to 2000° F . E x p r e s s ly b u i l t f o r th e m a n y u s u a l la b o r a to r y jo b s, s u c h a s : a s h d e te r m in a tio n s , fu s io n s, e tc. E q u ip p e d w ith h e a v y , lo w v o lta g e , r o d ty p e e le m e n ts . B u ilt in tw o siz e s w ith c h a m b e rs 4 1/£>" x 10" x 4" a n d ‘7 % " x 14" x 5% ". L in d b e r g H o t P la t e s —T e m p e r a tu r e s to 900° F . T h e s e h o t p la te s , a v a ila b le in th r e e siz es, 10" x 12", 12" x 20" a n d 12" x 30", h a v e sp e c ia l c a s t m e ta l to p s . C o ile d n ic k e l- c h r o m iu m e le m e n ts a r e p la c e d to g iv e u n if o r m f a s t h e a tin g . T h e In d ic a tin g P y r o m e te r a n d I n p u t C o n tro l m o u n te d in th e s a m e c a s e p r o v id e th e la b o r a to r y w ith “s te p le s s ” te m p e r a t u r e s a n d e m b o d y th e fa m o u s L in d b e r g “p e r c e n t of c u r r e n t in p u t ” c o n tro l. EDITION 11 Box Type Furnaces Combustion Tube Furnace Hot Plates Lindberg Input Control and Pyrometer F o r com plete details and information get in touch with y o u r lab o ra to ry equipm ent dealer today. LINDBERG E N G IN E E R IN G COM PANY 2 4 5 0 W EST H U B B A R D STREET - C H IC A G O 1 2 , IL L IN O IS W ell-known Throughout the W orld as the Leaders in D eveloping and Manufacturing Industrial Heat Treating Equipment. 12 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING CHEMISTRY when you need chemicals b y the pound or carload ... come to us with confidence ★ A 32 page listing of industrial chemicals supplied by Harshaw is available to you in booklet form. Write for your free copy. HARSHAW CHEMICAL 1945 East 97th Street, Cleveland 6, Ohio B R A N C H E S I N P R I N C I P A L C IT IE S Vol. 16, No. 1 January 15, 1944 ANALYTICAL EDITION 13 booking F o r w a r W a r tim e a c h ie v e m e n ts in scien ce a re d e v e lo p in g a n e ra o f p ro g r e s s w h i c h c h a lle n g e s th e im a g in a t io n . A ll t h a t S p e n c e r is d o in g n o w — p r o A t th e w a r ’s e n d , S p e n c e r w ill be re a d y to se rv e sc ie n tific o p tic a l n e e d s o n a f a r b r o a d e r sc a le t h a n e v e r b e fo re . d u c in g m ic ro s c o p e s , p e ris c o p e s , te le sc o p e s, a ir c r a f t a n d a n ti - a i r c r a f t g u n s i g h ts , p ris m b in o c u la r s , a z im u th in s tr u m e n ts f o r d ir e c tin g a r t i l l e r y fire, ta n k s i g h ts , te le s c o p ic a lid a d e s fo r n a v i g a t i o n , p r o je c to r s f o r in s t r u c t i o n — w ill r e a p p e a c e tim e re w a r d s in a d v a n c e d Spencer k n o w le d g e , b e tt e r m a n u f a c tu r in g te c h S C I E N T IF I C IN S T R U M E N T D IV IS IO N O F n iq u e s , fin e r in s tr u m e n ts . AMERICAN -L L EN S C O M P A N Y B U FFA LO , NEW Y O R K OPTICAL COMPANY 14 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 B EC K M A N P H O T O E L E C T R IC QUARTZ S P E C T R O P H O T O M E T E R A self-contained, precision instrument with quartz prism, operating on an electronic circuit, for the rapid measurement of percentage transmission and density , W av e le n g th Scale; B, B u ilt-in E lectro n ic In d ic a tin g M eter: C , Slits w ith precision a d ju stm e n t; D , L ig h t Source; E , C o m p a rtm e n t for tw o P h o to tu b es; F , H older for fo u r 10 m m A b so rp tio n Cells; G, F ilte r Slide:; H , C o m p a rtm e n t fo r A b sorption Cells; J , P h o to tu b e Selector; an d K , Sw itch fo r checking d a rk c u rre n t QUARTZ SPECTROPHOTOMETER, Beckman Photoelectric. A self-contained unit with which a wide variety of research and control work can be conducted with convenience, speed and precision. Consisting of a quartz monochromator, with light source, holder for absorption cells, twin phototubes and built-in electronic meter for translating phototube currents into direct readings of percentage transmission and density. See Cary and Beckman, "A Quartz Photoelectric Spectrophotometer,” Journal of the Optical Society of America, Vol. 81, No. 11 {November, 1941), p. 682. M onochrom ator. Auto collim ating type, w ith 30° q uartz prism of selected crystal w hich provides high dispersion in th e ultra-violet. W avelength scale approx. 100 cm long, graduated from 200 m m u to 2000 mmu, readable to 0.1 m m u in th e ultra-violet and to 1.0 m m u in th e red, w ith a scale accuracy of 1 mmu. Optical p a rts rigidly m ounted in a massive h eat-treated iron block w ithin a dust-proof steel case. m arked “0.1” provides a ten-fold expansion of th e tra n s mission scale for m ore accurate readings on solutions below 10% transm ission. Slits. P rotected by quartz windows, w ith stra y light ef fects reduced to a minim um. Sim ultaneously and continu ously adjustable from 0.01 to 2.0 m m b y a precision m echa nism. Slits can not be dam aged by closing too far. F ull scale reading w ith nominal b and w idth less th a n 2 m m u over all b u t th e extrem e ends of th e spectrum . Sam ple H olders. A bsorption cells are accom m odated in a rem ovable holder w hich is inserted in a lig ht-tight com p a rtm en t and is operated from th e front of th e in strum ent by m eans of a sliding rod. Cells and holders arc available for 10, 20, 50 and 100 m m liquid lengths. Electronic Indicating M eter. A built-in potentiom eter and electronic amplifier m akes possible direct readings in percentage transm ission an d density. T he sw itch position 9101. Light Source. A stan d ard 32 c. p. 6-volt, tu n g sten lam p serves as a light source for th e range 320 to 1000 mmu. F or th e ultra-violet range below 320 m m u a sm all hydrogen discharge lam p is offered w ith power supply. P hototubes. Tw o phototubes are furnished in a com part m ent which adjoins th e cells. A sliding rod brings either tu b e into position and sim ultaneously switches th e electrical connections. Q u a rtz S p ectro p h o to m eter, B eck m an P h o to electric, M o d el D , ra n g e 320 to 1000 m illim icrons. C onsisting of m ono ch ro m ato r w ith q u a rtz prism an d tw o slits, b u ilt-in electronic m eter, 6-voLt tu n g ste n la m p in d e ta ch a b le housing, one each caesium -oxide a n d b luesensitive p h o to tu b es, an d holder w ith selected s e t of fo u r Corex glass ab so rp tio n cells fo r 10 m m liq u id le n g th . W ith d ry cells for op eratin g th e m e te r b u t w ith o u t 6 -v o lt sto rag e b a tte ry as req u ired for o p e ra tin g th e tu n g ste n lam p a n d electronic tu b e filam ents. O v erall dim ensions, 30 inches long X 9 inches high X 9>/i inches deep; shipping w eight, 110 lbs...........................................................764.00 9101-B. D itto , M o d el DUY, ran g e 220 to 1000 m illim icro n s, id en tical w ith above b u t w ith ultrav io let-sen sitiv e p h o to tu b e in place of th e bluesensitive tu b e and w ith th e ad d itio n of accessories for fa r u ltra v io le t consisting of one p a ir of F used Silica A bsorption C ells for 10 m m liquid length, H y drogen D ischarge L am p, housing for sam e, an d a pow er su p p ly u n it, 110 volts, 5 0 /6 0 cycles, for m a in ta in in g the discharge a t c o n sta n t in te n sity . Shipping w eight, 165 lb s.................................................................................................. 1052.00 Copy of 7-pp detailed description sent upon request. ARTHUR H. T H O M A S COMPANY R E T A IL — W H O LE SA LE — E X P O R T L A B O R A T O R Y A P P A R A T U S AND R E A G E N T S W E S T W A S H I N G T O N S Q U A R E , P H I L A D E L P H I A 5, U . S . A . Cable Address, “Balance,” Philadelphia IN D U STRIAL and EN G IN EER IN G CHEM ISTRY P U B L I S H E D BY THE A M E R I C A N CHEMICAL WALTER SOCIETY J. M U R P H Y , EDITOR Emulsion Polymerization of Synthetic Rubber in 10-Gram Systems A n Exp e rim e n tal T e c h n iq u e C H A R L E S F. F R Y L IN G , The B. F. G oodrich Com pany, A k ro n , O h io The experimental procedure consists of sealing the ingredients of a polymerization recipe into a test tube and rotating the tube at a constant temperature, following the course of the reaction by noting the decrease in volume of the system. The latex is removed for coagulation when the polymerization has proceeded as far as desired, and the y ie ld is determined by weighing the dried stabilized coagulum. C ontrol testing of raw m aterials. T h e particu lar properties essential for polym erization of all shipm ents of m aterials intended for large-scale production can be tested quickly. A good corre lation can be obtained between the experim ental results of this m ethod and behavior on a m anufacturing scale. D E V E L O P IN G practical recipes for th e m anufacture of INsynthetic rubber, it was desirable to investigate the effects on the polym erization process of a large v ariety of highly puri fied substances. Only sm all q u antities of m any m aterials were available. F urtherm ore, in order to obtain valid comparisons betw een experim ents conducted over a period of time, it was necessary to keep standardized sam ples of th e m ajor compo nents and to use them as econonomically as possible. These considerations led to the developm ent of a sm all-scale polym eri zation technique w hereby from 10 to 20 gram s of monomers could be employed. B y this m ethod an extraordinary am ount of valuable inform ation was obtainable. T his included: T he m ost serious lim itation to this technique is th a t m aterials cannot be added to or su b tracte d from th e system once poly m erization has started . [Balandina el al. described a sim ilar technique, th e details of which are n o t readily available to English-speaking investigators (I).] RECIPES FOR POLYM ERIZING SYNTHETIC RUBBER The developm ent of satisfactory polym erization recipes is one of the im p o rtan t objectives of synthetic ru b b er research. P a te n t literature contains m any examples of such. The following, from a U. S. p a te n t issued to W ollthan and Becker ([5), and recalculated to th e scale of this technique, is perhaps typical: 1. Yield 2. A polym erization reaction curve from which to estim ate length of induction period, if an y ; rate of polym erization a t any desired tim e; and over-all conversion a t any desired time 3. K ind of emulsion— i.e., w hether fluid, viscous, gelatinous, o r heterogeneous, a t any stage in the process 4. pH of emulsion a t end of process 5. Q ualitative observations on coagulation G. P roduction of a sam ple of sy nthetic rubber sufficiently large to determ ine solubility, milling characteristics, and cured properties by procedures described by G arvey (3) B u tad ien e S ty ren e Isohexyl m e rc a p tan W a te r Sodium oleate A m m onium p e rsu lfa te T e m p e ra tu re T im e Y ield T his small-scale technique has been employed for investigating polym erization of a large num ber of m onom ers an d comonomer m ixtures, for evaluating em ulsifying agents, for determ ining the effect of im purities in the reagents employed, for varying the comonomer ratio and the ratio of hydrocarbons to aqueous phase, an d for investigating behavior o f various initiators, inhibitors, an d other ingredients of th e polym erization recipe. I t proved to be especially advantageous in providing inform ation on the effect of some one ingredient over a range of concentrations. T h e influence of reaction tem perature was readily determ ined. In general, th e advantages of th e technique were particularly ap p a ren t in: 7 .5 gram s 2 .5 gram s 0 .0 5 g ram 1 8 .0 gram s 2 .0 gram s 0 .0 3 gram 30° C. “ S everal d a y s” “ E x c e lle n t” An understanding of th e function of each ingredient is essential In th e above example, the butadiene and styrene are th e mono mers, which, by copolymerizing, form syn th etic rubber. T he isohexyl m ercaptan is described as a substance exerting a “regu lating effect” —i.e., it possibly decreases th e branching charac teristics of th e resulting polym er. Sodium oleate is th e emulsify ing agent, an d th e am m onium persulfate acts as th e polym eriza tion initiator, also called th e “polym erization c ataly st” . T he possibilities of research on such a system are g reat and are increased by the fact th a t a v ariation introduced in an y one ingredient m ay require a concom itant change in some oth er in gredient. F o r example, su b stitu tin g an o th er substance for the in itiato r m ight require a change in th e ty p e of em ulsifying agent employed in order to get satisfactory results. Prelim inary surveys, where wide areas of investigation had to be covered in the sh o rtest possible tim e. T h e m ethod is am en able to sim ple labor-saving tricks, such as filling a large num ber of reaction tubes a t the sam e tim e w ith solutions of a given emul sifying agent. 1 2 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING GEN ERA L CONSIDERATIONS O N TECHNIQUE Polym erization, while a science, is also an a rt. T he w ay in which things are done— th a t is, th e niceties of experim ental tech nique em ployed—is of equal im portance to th e scientific aspects of the subject. Unless this view point is k ep t clearly in m ind, the investigator is frequently confronted by baffling failures. E m ul sion polym erization is particularly susceptible to the influence of traces of contam inants. T he equipm ent of a research laboratory m ay be covered w ith d u st which contains inhibitors o r accelera tors of polym erization, indeed, some substances, which under certain conditions inhibit polym erization, m ay under sightly dif ferent conditions a c t as catalysts. N evertheless, th e difficulties confronting the investigator can be avoided w ith a little care and forethought. W eighing Butadiene In general, solutions or other substances to be employed in polym erization experim ents should n o t be exposed to atm os pheric contam ination for longer periods than necessary. Glass stoppers afford adequate protection. T he contents of a flask m ay be tem porarily protected by covering the m outh w ith a sheet of clean dry tinfoil. Cork stoppers should be avoided; b u t if necessary, they can be covered w ith tinfoil. In no case should the alkaline contents of flasks come in con tact w ith tin foil. Glass bottles and flasks m ust be clean. In m ost cases tre a t m ent w ith chromic acid cleaning solutions, followed by rinsing w ith tap w ater and then distilled w ater, is adequate. R eaction tubes, however, require more effective cleaning. In one operation it is convenient to pour th e volatile contents of a D ew ar flask through a sh o rt length of rubber tubing. Al though rubber contains antioxidants, accelerators, and other chemicals, no trouble is experienced from th is source if th e rubber tubing is first extracted by boiling in several changes of acetone. T his can be done (on a steam plate) in a covered beaker if a sizable piece of dry ice is placed on th e w atch crystal, which thereby be comes a convenient reflux condenser. T h e extracted tubin g can be k ep t in a stoppered w ide-m outhed b o ttle for future use. C ertain monomers can be efficiently separated from powerful inhibitors added as stabilizers by d istillation through relatively simple equipm ent. T he practice of distilling monomers in the absence of an inhibitor should be avoided because of th e danger of explosions due to the accum ulation of peroxides in the distillation residue. I t has been custom ary in th e laboratory to prepare fresh sam ples of butadiene by condensation in clean glassware from a stream of gas taken from a large cylinder of hnuefied m aterial. H igher bofling monom ers are freshly prepared b y atm ospheric, vacuum , or steam distillation as required. All-glass distillation equipm ent is m ost satisfactory. T h e unstabilized monom ers can be k ept stoppered in a refrigerator a t —30° C. for several days w ithout detectable deterioration. Sometimes repetition of an operation is advisable. M etallic CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 polym erization vessels, no m a tte r how carefully cleaned, m ay be inhibited; merely em ptying and recharging are often sufficient to ensure a satisfacto ry reaction. T here is no su bstitu te for constant care and cleanliness on th e p a rt of th e investigator. A careful experim enter can easily a d ju s t th e w eight of sm all portions of certain m onom ers using a clean m edicine dropper, while a careless experim enter (perform ing th e sam e operation) can ruin a large num ber of experim ents by allowing th e m onom er to come in to contact w ith the ru b b er bulb of th e medicine dropper. EXPERIMENTAL PROCEDURE T he ingredients of a polym erization recipe are sealed into a test tube, which is ro ta te d a t a constant tem perature. T he course of the reaction is followed by noting th e decrease in volum e of th e system , and th e latex is rem oved for coagulation when th e poly m erization has proceeded as far as desired. T h e yield is deter m ined by w eighing th e dried, stabilized coagulum. Pyrex reaction tubes, 22 mm. in diam eter, approxim ately 55 ml. in capacity, to th e upper end of which are sealed 10-mm. d iam eter Pyrex tubes, m ay be obtained in gross lots from the Corning Glass Com pany, according to the following specifica tions: "G lass tubes, Pyrex, 22 mm. O.D. X 1.5 mm . walls (uni form), 215-mm. body to neck, 22-mm. tapered shoulder, 145mm. neck. 10-mm. neck X 1-mm. wall thickness” . These can be m ade by th e experim enter, b u t it has been found cheaper to purchase them . New tubes are cleaned by rinsing w ith distilled w ater and an hydrous c .p . sy nthetic m ethanol, in th a t order, and evacuating un til dry. E vacu atio n m ay be accomplished w ith a Cenco H yvac pum p connected in train through a d ry ice-acetone trap , which condenses the m ethanol and prevents diffusion of any vola tile in h ib ito r back into th e tube. A cetone-extracted rubber tubing is used to a tta c h the reaction tubes to the vacuum system . Old tubes, after being cleaned in a chrom ic acid b ath , are re paired b y sealing new necks of 10-mm. Pyrex tubing, 10 cm. long, to the shoulder of the tubes. T he open ends are fire-pol ished. T h e tubes are then subjected to the cleaning treatm en t recom mended by Suess, Pilch, and R udorfer (4). Clean con centrated n itric acid is poured into th e tubes and allowed to stan d from 16 to 24 hour's. If the tubes are reauired a t once, they are filled to th e shoulder w ith n itric acid and gently heated from 15 to 30 m inutes, then rinsed three tim es w ith tap w ater. One rinse should completely fill the tube to displace all th e fumes. A fter two additional rinses w ith distilled w ater, the tubes m ay be dried w it Ip synthetic m ethanol and evacuated. If desired, the m ethanol rinse and evacuation can be dispensed w ith by allowing the distilled w ater to drain from th e inverted tubes overnight. T h e d ry tubes are stoppered w ith No. 0 corks, which have been covered w ith fresh tinfoil, and th e tubes are kept in a clean place until used. Solids m ay be added to the reaction tubes in q u an tities as low as 0.5 mg. from small alum inum foil weighing scoops. If dupli- A d d in g Butadiene to Reaction Tube January IS, 1944 ANALYTICAL catc quantities are to be used throughout a series of experim ents, it is convenient to dissolve organic compounds in the less volatile comonomer and inorganic compounds in the aqueous solution of emulsifying agent. EDITION 3 visable to do th e sealing close to th e open end of the neck in an oxidizing atm osphere; otherwise a carbon m irror m ay form on the interior surface of th e tubing and prevent a tig h t seal. Oc casionally, if condensation is n o t complete, a slow blue flame tra v els from the heated glass down into th e reaction tube. I t has been impossible, however, to dem onstrate th a t th is brings about any variation in the ensuing polym erization. POLYM ERIZATION T h e sealed reaction tu b e is brought to reaction tem perature by immersion in w ater. T h e height of th e m eniscus is d eter mined and recorded, using a millim eter rule. T h e tu b e is then rotated a t a constant tem perature and readings of th e meniscus height are m ade periodically. I t is from these readings th a t re action curves such as Figure 1 can be plotted. If the polym erization is complete in less th a n 5 hours, a w ater therm o stat is required to prevent tem perature buildup. How ever, a therm ostatically controlled air cabinet, provided w ith shafts for ro tatin g the tubes, is more convenient. Rotation of Tubes in Constant-Temperature Cabinet ' T he solution of em ulsifying agent is generally prepared sepa rately and added to the reaction tubes from a pipet or a g raduated cylinder. Since slight v ariatio n s in th e ratio of m onom ers to aqueous phase have little effect, convenience generally d ictates the use of th e la tte r m ethod. T h e volum e of em ulsifying agent employed m ay vary from 10 to 30 ml. for 10 gram s of m onom ers. T he reaction tubes containing the em ulsifying agent and other ingredients are placed in a refrigerator, inclined a t an angle of 2° 8 ' from horizontal, and frozen a t —30° C. T his inclination m ay be obtained by placing a piece of 10-mm. glass tubing under th e necks of th e tubes. Unless chilled in th is position, th e tubes will crack when placed in a d ry ice-acetone bath. (The corkstoppered glass reaction tubes m ay be laid on a table a t the proper inclination and covered w ith d ry ice. However, any contam ination of the contents by carbon dioxide will alter the pH of th e soap solution and affect th e reaction ra te seriously.) If care is exercised, the aqueous phase can be frozen by direct im mersion of th e tubes in a d ry ice-acetone b ath , w ith frequent w ithdraw als and nearly horizontal rotations, so th a t th e aqueous phase freezes in contact w ith th e glass in th e form of a hollow cylinder. T he losses due to cracking of th e glass are high and th e operation is tim e consum ing; therefore th e m ethod of freezing first described is preferred in m ost cases. In the next step the frozen tubes are individually cooled further in a dry ice-acetone m ixture contained in a quart-size straig h t sided D ew ar flask. A rubber dam is fitted over th e tu b e and th e D ew ar flask, the neck of th e tube extending through a. hole in the dam. T his minim izes contam ination of the tu b e w ith es caping carbon dioxide, and holds it in a convenient vertical po sition. T he higher boiling comonomer is weighed to 0.1 gram in to a tared, clean m icrobeaker and poured into th e reaction tube. A b u ret is som etim es used for th is operation b u t contam ination by stopcock grease should be avoided. In either case th e opera tion m ust be performed in a rigorously clean manner. Freshly distilled butadiene is tem porarily contained in a pintsize D ew ar fitted w ith a two-hole extracted ru b b er stopper through w hich extend two sh o rt glass tubes arranged for con venient pouring. T he tem perature of th e butadiene is held a t —30° C. I t is weighed to 0.1 gram into a sm all silvered D ewar weighing flask using a torsion balance. T he small D ew ar is then attached to th e reaction tube by a sh o rt length of extracted rub b er tubing and th e butadiene is poured into th e reaction tube, allowing ab o u t 45 seconds for condensation of vapor before re moving the rubber tube. T h e weighing flask has a 10-mm. neck, and is 11.5 cm. from bottom to shoulder, 35 mm. in outside di am eter, 25 mm. in inside diam eter, and ab o u t 16 cm. in oyer-all length. Such flasks have been m ade in the lab oratory b u t it has been found more satisfactory to have them m ade by professional glass blowers. T h e reaction tube is scaled, using a hand blow torch. I t is ad Tl Figure 1. Polym erization Curve A reaction tube, prepared as described, using th e W ollthan and Becker recipe (5), will give an initial meniscus height of approxi m ately 110 mm . D u rin g the course of polym erization, it will drop 11 m m . Since the height can be read to 0.5 m m ., this pro cedure provides a simple m ethod of following th e reaction rate w ith an accuracy of a b o u t 5% . T able I shows for o th er recipes th a t th e drop in height of th e meniscus is directly proportional to th e yield of polym er, w ithin th e lim its of error of th e m ethod. If th e to ta l decrease of m eniscus height is m easured ju s t before opening th e tube, th e yield, as measured on th e d ry polymer, will Table I. Correlation between Percentage Polym erized and Fall of Meniscus for Three Polymerization Recipes F a ll of M eniscus Mm. ------------------ Y ie ld C alculated from m eniscus % 19 44 65 89 Series 1 3 .0 7 .0 10.4 14.1 Series II 3 .0 7 .0 10.9 14.4 M easured % 18 39 61 89 21 43 70 93 Series I I I 2 .0 4 .0 4 .5 5 .8 7 .6 7 .8 11.0 12.6 14.7 9 20 26 38 44 47 67 86 94 D ifference % + 1 + 5 + 4 19 45 70 93 _2 +2 0 13 26 29 37 49 50 70 81 94 + 4 4-6 ■ + 3 -1 4-5 4-3 4-3 —5 4 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 essary to break th e tip and direct the violently expelled foam into a large beaker. T he synthetic rubber latex m ust next be sta bilized by th e addition of an antioxidant. Two per cent of dis persed phenyl-beta-naphthylam ine has been found convenient and satisfactory. T he dispersion of the stabilizer can be ob tained by aqueous dilution of an alcoholic solution. The latex can be coagulated by any m ethod custom arily employed for breaking emulsions or coagulating n atu ral rubber latex. Follow ing coagulation, th e rubber is w ashed free of soap and electro lytes, using a B uchner filter and filter paper, and dried in air, preferably a t a low tem perature. T h e yield, accurate to ± 2 % , can be obtained by weighing to 0.1 gram. W ashing Coagulated Synthetic Rubber Samples give an accurate basis for calculating th e p artia l yields a t any given tim e during the process. R eaction curves p lotted using these figures will n o t be affected by errors due to v ariations in d iam eter of the individual tubes. The form ation of foam, w hich breaks w ith difficulty, frequently interferes w ith th e m easurem ent of meniscus height. In such a case the tubes can be centrifuged by swinging in a suitable tube on the end of a 90-cm. (3-foot) rope. [According to R eynolds (S) th e accuracy of this m ethod can be im proved by constriction of the tube a t the position where th e meniscus is read, together w ith high-speed centrifuging and redispersion of th e emulsion b y shak ing after the reading.) If a gel forms, or if there is m uch coagu lation during polym erization, the height of th e meniscus cannot be determ ined accurately. The end of the induction period, or the beginning of polym eri zation, is generally indicated by the appearance of a bluish opales cence, in addition to the change in height of th e meniscus. DETERMINATION OF YIELD Opening the reaction tubes presents no difficulty except when low partial conversions are under investigation. T hen it is nec SUMMARY M any m anufacturers of monomers, emulsifying agents, ini tiators, modifiers, and oth er ingredients going into polym eriza tion reactions find it necessary to have a reliable polym erization procedure for testing the quality of th eir products. T he proce dure presented, despite some shortcomings, has m any advan tages. M inim um am ounts of m aterial are required and large num bers of experim ents can be conducted in a relatively short time. A serious effort is m ade to point o u t some of the pitfalls which beset investigators of polym erization regardless of the type of technique employed. T h e best recom m endation for the procedure described is th a t it has been used to develop certmn types of syn th etic ru b b er w hich are now in commercial produc tion. LITERATURE CITED (1) Balandina, V ., et a l., Bull. acad. sci. U. R . S . S ., d a sse set. m ath. n ot., S er. chim ., 1936, 397-407. (2) G arvey, B . S ., J r ., I n d . E n g . C h e m ., 34, 1320-3 (1942). (3) R eyn old s, W . B ., personal com m unication. (4) Suess, P ilch, and Rudorfer, Z . ph ysik. Chem., A179, 361 -7 0 (1937). (5) W ollthan and Becker, U . S. P a ten t 2,281,613 (M ay 5, 1942). P resented of th e A before th e D ivision of R u b b e r C h em istry a t th e 105th M eeting C h e m i c a l S o c i e t y , D e tro it, M ich. m e r ic a n Determination of Tetraethyllead in Gasoline H A R R Y G O N I C K AN D J. J . M I L A N O , Shell O il Com pany, Incorporated, M arlinez, Calif. A method for the determination of tetraethyllead in gasoline is described in which the tetraethyllead Is decomposed with iodine and the lead subsequently titrated by a new acidimetric method em ploying 8-hydroxyqulnoline. The method is rapid and is ap plicable to all types of gasolines. T IL recently U Ndeterm ination th e m ost widely used m ethod for the of tetraethyllead in gasoline was the bromirration m ethod described by E dgar and C alingacrt (S) in which the tetraethyllead was decomposed by th e action of bromine. Although this m ethod was rapid and convenient for the determ ination of tetraethyllead in straig h t-ru n gasolines, difficulties were encountered w ith cracked gasolines owing to the rapid absorption of bromine by the olefins present, in com petition w ith the tetraethyllead. W ith gasolines of high olefiu content it was necessary to brom inate the gasoline completely7 to ensure complete decomposition of th e tetraethyllead. E ven so, low results were frequently7 obtained. M oreover, th e q u an tity of bromine required for complete brom ination of a gasoline of high olefin content was ra th e r large (frequently in excess of 200 gram s) and added substantially7 to th e cost of th e analysis. In addition, th e brom ination reaction was violent and was accom panied by th e evolution of corrosive vapors w hich caused considerable hazard to the operator. F or these reasons, the brom ination m ethod w as n o t suited to th e routine analysis of cracked fuels. More recently other m ethods have been devised in w hich the gasoline is treated w ith hydrochloric acid and th e load determ ined in the acid extracts. T h e best known of these is th e m ethod of C alingacrt and G am brill (3), recently adopted by th e American Society for T esting M aterials as a ten ta tiv e stan d ard (I). Al though this m ethod gives satisfactory results w7ith all types of gasolines, the over-all tim e required for a determ ination is some w h at lengthy7and specialized equipm ent is required. T he m ethod described in this paper was developed in an effort to reduce th e tim e required for the tetraeth y llead d eter m ination. B y th e proposed method, a single determ ination can be completed in one hour and for determ inations in q u an tity only7 a small fraction of th is tim e is required p er determ ination. The accuracy7 of the m ethod appears to be equal to previous m ethods and docs n o t appear to be affected by7 th e ty p e or composition of th e gasoline. More th a n three thousand sam ples of gasoline, January 15, 1944 ANALYTICAL representing all the principal brands and grades sold in th e western states, have been analyzed successfully. PRINCIPLE OF PROPOSED METHOD As in previous m ethods, the determ ination of the te tra e th y l lead divides itself into two distinct parts: (1) th e decom position of th e tetraethyllead to yield an inorganic lead salt, and (2) th e determ ination of the lead. EDITION rate, c .p ., crystals. H ydrochloric acid, C .P ., dilute solution; 1 to 1. Sodium chloride, c .p ., crystals. 8-H ydroxyquinoline, 0.065Ar in GO per cent isopropyl alcohol. S ta n d a rd sodium hydroxide, 0.0624AL S tandard hydrochloric acid, 0.0624Ar. (Standard 0.0624Y acid an d base were selected since these re agents are in general use in oil laboratories.) M ethyl red indicator; dissolve 1 gram in 600 ml. of alcohol and dilute to 1 liter w ith w ater. Phenol red indicator, 0.2 gram per liter of water. S e p a ra tio n op L ead . M easure exactly 100 ml. (corrected to G0° F.) of the gasoline to be tested into a 500-ml. Erlenm eyer flask. Add 50 ml. of th e iodine solution and allow to sta n d for a t least 5 minutes. Place the flask on a h o t plate under a h o t air stream and evaporate the gasoline to dryness. T he velocity of th e air stream and the tem perature of the h o t p late should be regulated so as to secure the maximum rate of evaporation w ithout sp a t tering or bumping. T he air stream effectively suppresses the tendency tow ard bum ping which is alm ost unavoidable w ithout its use. The evaporation ordinarily takes from 15 to 20 m inutes. Add 25 to 50 ml. of concentrated nitric acid (depending on the am ount of th e organic residue) and ro tate th e flask over a burner until dense fumes of iodine and nitrogen dioxide cease. Should any organic m a tte r adhere to th e walls of the flask continue rotating the flask until it is completely dislodged. Figure 1. Effect of Sodium Chloride on Neutralization Curve of Solutions Containing Lead Ions 0.137 gram of IPb(N03)j In 100 ml. of water. (1) No NaCI added, (2) 5 grams of NaCI added 1. Experim ents conducted in this lab oratory showed t h a t tetraethyllead is rapidly an d quantitativ ely decomposed by th e action of free iodine. U nsaturated hydrocarbons do n o t interfere, as they do n o t iodinate so rapidly as to compete w ith th e te tr a ethyllead reaction. T he gasoline is rem oved by evaporation under a h o t air stream , and an y organic m a tte r rem aining is subsequently oxidized w ith nitric acid and potassium chlorate. T he inorganic residue rem aining th en contains all th e lead in the form of inorganic salts including lead iodate, which is insoluble in w ater. T he lead salts so obtained are converted to th e more soluble chloride by treatm e n t w ith hydrochloric acid. 2. T he lead is determ ined b y an acidim étrie titra tio n m ethod ; it is therefore necessary to neutralize th e solution exactly before titra tin g the lead. T he neutralization of a solution containing lead salts ordinarily presents difficulties owing to th e hydrolysis of th e lead. T hese difficulties are obviated, however, b y the resence of sufficient chloride ions which effectively suppress the ydrolysis of the lead. T h e effect of sodium chloride on the neutralization of a lead solution is shown by th e curves in Figure 1. A fter th e solution has been neutralized, an exceas of 8-hydroxy quinoline is added. T his reagent reacts w ith th e lead ions to liberate an equivalent q u an tity of acid which is th e n titra te d w ith stan d ard alkali. T he reactions are assumed to be as follows : i... i ' Air in /e A E HOC„H,N = -OC»H„NH+ (1) P b+ + + 2 "O C dH jN H + = P b(O C ,H ,N H + )2 (2) Pb(O C tH jN H +)j + 2 0 H - = Pb(O C 8H ,N )2 + 211,0 (3) As indicated in E quation 1, 8-hydroxy quinoline is am photeric and goes over to th e ionic form. W hen 8-hydroxyquinoline re agent is added to a solution containing lead ions, lead 8-hydroxyquinolinium ions are formed according to E quation 2. These are quantitatively titra te d w ith stan d ard alkali to p H 7 according to E quation 3. O ther equilibrium reactions are undoubtedly involved, including reaction between lead 8-hydroxyquinolinium ions and excess reagent; however, the equations given indicate the essential result. DETAILS OF METHOD The h o t a ir-je t evaporator (Figure 2 ) is designed to direct a hot air stream into four Erlenm eyer flasks sim ul taneously during evaporations. A lthough th e design shown has proved very satisfactory in actual practice, o th er designs which will accomplish the same purpose m ay be used. R e a g e n ts . Iodine, sa tu ra te d solution in carbon tetrachloride (technical). N itric acid, c.r., concentrated. Potassium chlo A p p a ra tu s . Figure 2. H o t A lr - J e t Evaporator A ll interior metal parts must be heat-resistant To the actively boiling solution add crystals of potassium chlorate until th e organic m a tte r is com pletely destroyed. T he potassium chlorate should be added cautiously. T he solution should n o t be perm itted to evaporate to dryness while th ere is visible organic m a tte r present as indicated by a brow nish colora tion of the solution- otherwise spontaneous ignition will occur and cause losses of lead. Usually all organic m atter disappears after th e first 2 or 3 gram s of potassium chlorate have been added; however, one or tw o additional portions of 2 or 3 gram s each are added in order to complete th e oxidation. W ith practice, the oxidation of residues from cracked gasolines w ith potassium chlorate can be effected in 1 to 3 m inutes. E vaporate th e clear nitric acid solution to com plete dryness. Should the solution exhibit any darkening during the ev ap o ratio n , INDUSTRIAL Table I. AND ENGINEERING Determination of Tetraethyllead in Synthetic Gasoline Blends by the Proposed M ethod’’ Sam ples S0% cracked gasoline + 2 0% stra ig h t-ru n gasoline 100% s tra ig h t-ru n gasoline 50% cracked gasoline - f 50% iso p en tan c 50% cracked gasoline + 50% alcohol T e trae th y lle a d C o n te n t C alcu lated D eterm in ed M il/gallon 3 .0 7 3 .0 7 ,3 .0 6 ,3 .0 7 1.54 1 .5 4 ,1 .5 4 , 1 .56 0 .2 0 0 .1 9 ,0 .2 0 ,0 .1 9 3 .0 0 3 .0 0 ,3 .0 0 1.50 1 .5 1 ,1 .5 0 0 .3 0 0 .2 9 ,0 .2 9 1.54 1.54 1.54 1.55 ° T hese blends w ere m ade using eth y l fluid o b tain ed from th e E th y l Corp. add m ore potassium chlorate. The use of the hot air stream is n o t recommended during this operation, as the cooling effect of the air stream impedes the oxidation of possible traces of or ganic m atter. To ensure the complete destruction of organic m atter, heat the residue over a burner until it is completely fused. T he residue after fusion should be w hite (see note below on the use of potassium cldorate). Allow the flask to cool som ewhat, and add sufficient 1 to 1 hydrochloric acid to dissolve th e residue completely after 2 or 3 m inutes’ boiling. Usually 10 to 20 ml. of the dilute acid are sufficient. A fter complete solution is effected evaporate to dryness. Special care should be exercised tow ard th e end of the evaporation, as the potassium chloride formed has a tendency to spatter. Remove the rem aining acid as completely as possible by thoroughly heating th e flask while blowing a h o t air stream into it. D e te rm in a tio n o f L ead . Dissolve th e residue in the flask in 150 to 200 ml. of distilled w ater, add 2 or 3 drops of m ethyl red indicator, and exactly neutralize the solution w ith 0.0624;V sodium hydroxide to the alkaline (yellow-) end p o in t of the indicator. Usually there will be a sufficient concentration of chlorides as a result of the preceding operations to suppress the hydrolysis of the load. A deficiency of chlorides will render the n eutral point indefinite, in which case 5 to 10 gram s of sodium chloride should be added. A t th e neutral point one drop of 0.0624Ar acid should suffice to revert th e indicator color from a canary yellow to a definite pink. Occasionally the m ethyl red indicator will show a fading tendency, owing to remaining traces of oxidizing substances. T his fading ten d en cy is readily over come by the addition of a few milliliters of 0.1 N sodium thiosulfate solution. W here the q u an tity of lead present is approxim ately known, th e titratio n of the lead is carried o u t as follows: T o the neu tralized solution add a 2- to 3-ml. excess of the 8-hydroxyquino line reagent and a sim ilar excess of the stan d ard sodium hy droxide solution. Stopper th e flask and shake vigorously for a few seconds to break up th e precipitate and liberate any occluded substances. Add sufficient phenol red indicator (about 3 ml.) to produce a definite pink color and b ack -titrate the excess alkali w ith standard hydrochloric acid. T he hydrochloric acid should be added dropwise tow ard the end of the titratio n and th e end point taken on the yellow (acid) side of the indicator change. A gitate the flask when observing the end point and ignore any pink fluorescence which m ay appear after settling of the pre cipitate. I t is advisable to redeterm ine th e end point by adding a further excess of alkali and repeating th e b ack-titration w ith acid. M ake certain th a t there is a 2- to 3-ml. excess of th e 8hydroxyquinoline reagent over th e n et volume of alkali con sumed. W hen the approxim ate q u an tity of lead is n o t previously known, th e titratio n m ust be carried ou t stepwise in order to secure the correct excess (2 to 3 ml.) of the 8-hydroxyquinoline reagent. Add about 3 ml. of phenol red indicator to th e solution which has been previously neutralized to m ethyl red. Now add th e S-hydroxyquinoline in 3-ml. increm ents an d after each addi tion add an equal volume of 0.0624Ar sodium hydroxide. An excess of the S-hydroxyquinoline reagent is indicated when the addition of the alkali increm ent renders the solution alkaline (pink) to the phenol red indicator. A t th is point stopper the flask, shake vigorously for a few seconds, and b ack -titra te the excess alkali w ith standard acid to determ ine th e approxim ate consum ption of alkali. A djust th e volume of 8-hydroxyquinoline added, so th a t there is an excess of 2 to 3 ml. over the n et volume of alkali consumed (volume of stan d ard alkali m inus volume of standard acid). A larger excess of 8-hydroxyquinoline should be avoided, as this reagent exhibits a slight buffering effect which interferes w ith the end-point determ ination. R edeterm ine the CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 end point after the addition of a further 2 to 3 ml. of standard alkali by back-titration w ith stan d ard acid as already described. Two equivalents of titra ta b le acid are formed for each mole of lead. The solutions should be standardized against a known q u a n tity of lead, using the same titratio n procedure as in the analysis. P ure te st lead or lead n itrate m ay be used as a standard. T he result expressed in milliliters of tetraeth y llead per gallon of gasoline is obtained by m ultiplying th e PbO equivalent (ex pressed in gram s) of the n et volume of sodium hydroxide con sum ed b y 33.24. U se o f P o ta s s iu m C h lo r a te . In order to determ ine the explosion hazard attending th e use of potassium chlorate-nitric acid m ixtures for th e oxidation of organic residues, the effects of various conditions were investigated. I t was found th a t a mild explosion would sometimes occur in the vapor if th e liquid was not k ep t actively boiling during the oxidation process. In every case th e explosion was preceded by a dense accum ulation of greenish yellow vapors (probably a m ixture of chlorine and or ganic vapors). T he explosion hazard appeared to be completely elim inated by m aintaining th e solution in an actively boiling condition during the oxidation process, in which case th e accum u lation of greenish yellow fumes was prevented. By following this procedure more th an 3000 sam ples have been analyzed w ith o u t an explosion. In spite of this record it is suggested th a t a protective m ask be w orn by the operator during the oxidation. Table II. Comparison of A .S .T .M . and Proposed Methods Sam ples C om p e titiv e Q gasolines B ra n d B rand B rand B ra n d B ra n d I II III IV V T e tra e th y lle a d C o n te n t A .S .T .M . m ethod P roposed m ethod M l./aaU on 0 .2 6 0 .0 6 1.26 0 .3 7 0 .5 3 0 .2 6 0 .0 7 1.25 0 .3 8 0.5 3 1.35 1.78 1.92 1.87 1.58 2.01 1.06 1.35 1 .8 0 1 .9 3 ,1 .9 4 ,1 .9 3 1.87 1.57 2.01 1.08 3.0 4 3.0 5 2 . 9 7 ,2 .9 7 ,2 .9 7 3 .0 4 3 .0 6 3 . 0 0 ,3 .0 0 ,2 .9 9 C om p e titiv e E th y l gasolines B ra n d B ra n d B ra n d B ra n d B ra n d B rand B ra n d I II III IV V VI V II A viation gasolines B ra n d I B ra n d II B ra n d I I I ACCURACY OF THE METHOD A series of synthetic blends of tetraethyllead in cracked and straig h t-ru n gasolines was prepared to check th e accuracy of the m ethod. Blends were aLso prepared w ith th e addition of isopentane and alcohol and analyzed by th e described m ethod. T he results of these experim ents are shown in T able I. A comparison of results obtained by the proposed m ethod and by the A .S.T.M . m ethod (!) is shown in Table II. LITERATURE CITED (1) A m . Soc. T esting M aterials, D esignation D 526-41T . (2) Calingaert and G am brill, I n d . E n o . C h e m ., A n a l . E d ., 11, 324 (1939). (3) Edgar and Calingaert, Ib id ., 1, 221 (1929). American Society for Testing Materials Meetings T he 1944 Spring M eeting and C om m ittee W eek of A .S.T.M . is to be held in C incinnati, Ohio, a t th e N etherland Plaza from Feb ru ary 28 to M arch 3. T he 47th A nnual M eeting will be held in New York, N. Y., a t th e W aldorf-Astoria June 26 to 30, 1944. Specific G ravity of Butadiene M . R. D E A N A N D T. W . L E G A T S K I Phillips Petroleum Com pany, Research Department, Bartlesville, O k la . The specific gravities ( f/ 6 0 ° F.) of 1,3-butadiene of 9 9 .6 mole per cent purity were determined experimentally for the temperature range of — 1 7 .7 8 ° to 6 0 ° C. ( 0 ° to 1 4 0 ° F.), by means of a specially constructed steel pycnometer of approximately 4 5 0 0 -cc. capacity and capable of with standing the resultant vapor pressures without under going a permanent change in volume. The experimentally determined specific gravities were smoothed graphically and the experimental and smoothed values were compared to show the magnitude of the probable error in the smoothed data. The densities reported here were compared with densities found in the literature, and it was concluded that the final interpolated values determined in this work were probably correct to ± 0 .0 0 0 1 5 . The best value for the specific gravity ( 6 0 ° / 6 0 ° F.) of pure 1,3-butadiene was estimated to be 0 .6 2 7 4 ± 0 .0 0 0 1 5 . rren t in terest in 1,3-butadiene as a sy nthetic rubber T HrawE mcuaterial has created a need for m ore accurate and more com plete inform ation on the physical properties of this hydro carbon. L andolt and B ornstein {2) give a table of liquid densities for 1,3butadiene for the tem perature range —20° to 20° C. ( —4° to 6S° F.), Prevost (4) has reported a value a t 6.22° C. (21.2° F.), and Doss (1) lists a value a t 68° F . Because these d a ta cover a range of tem perature too sm all to m eet m ost requirem ents, it seemed advisable to check previous values an d extend th e tem perature range. T his paper reports experim entally determ ined liquid specific gravities for 1,3-butadiene for th e tem perature range -1 7 .7 8 ° to 20° C. (0° to 140° F .). METHOD T he procedure consisted essentially of com paring th e d eter m ined w eights of known volum es of b u tadiene under a num ber of tem perature conditions and under pressures approxim ately equal to the vapor pressures w ith th e w eights of identical volumes of w ater a t 15.56° C. (60° F .) and a t atm ospheric pressure. T his procedure has been employed previously b y th e w riters to arrive a t sim ilar d a ta for propane, iso- and n-butane, th e various b u ty l enes, and a num ber of commercial products falling in the classifi cation of liquefied petroleum gases (S). COM POSITION OF BUTADIENE USED T he 1,3-butadiene used in th e investigation was obtained from th e by-product butadiene p la n t of th e Phillips Petroleum Com pany and was representative of th e commercial p roduct of th e p lan t a t th e tim e of sam pling. T h e sam ple was inhibited against oxidation w ith 0.02 w eight per cent of phenvl-betanaphthylam ine. N o solvent for th e in h ib ito r w as used. T he q u a n tity of added inhibitor was calculated to increase th e specific g rav ity by no m ore th an 0.00005 and its presence in th e sam ple could, therefore, be ignored. T he com position of th e sam ple was ascertained by two different analytical techniques, b o th based upon th e well-known chemical reaction betw een maleic anhydride and 1,3-butadiene. Analyses by th e tw o techniques gave a p u rity of 99.6 mole per cent. T he im purities present were believed to consist of 1-butene and the high- and low-boiling 2-butenes. APPARATUS T he apparatus consisted of tw o steel pycnom eters of approxi m ately 4500-cc. capacity fitted w ith expansion cham bers to fa cilitate m easurem ents a t tem peratures below room tem perature. A constant-tem perature b ath, a centrifugal pum p for stirrin g th e b ath liquid, a torsion balance w ith calibrated w eights, and a calibrated mercury-in-glass therm om eter were also provided. T he details of one of the pycnom eter u n its are shown in Figure 1, where A is th e pycnom eter and B is th e expansion cham ber. C is a high-pressure stainless steel needle valve of such construc tion th a t when fully opened th e pressure of th e m aterial in the cham bers is held by a m etal-to-m etal seat instead of by valve packing, th u s reducing th e chance for errors due to leakage. Valve D is a brass body steel needle valve. B oth pycnom eter un its were tested before use w ith hydrogen gas a t 27-kg. (600 pounds) pressure to assure absolute freedom from leaks. T h e two units were used sim ultaneously for check determ inations. T he therm om eter used for the m easurem ent of b a th tem pera tures was graduated in 0.2° F . divisions. I t was checked before use against a B ureau of S tandards calibrated m ercury-in-glass therm om eter. T h e torsion balance w as checked before use for accuracy, sensi tiv ity , stab ility , and equality of length of balance arm s. I t was tested during use for reproducibility of w eights b y weighing an iron w eight of a b o u t 9 kg. (20 pounds) a t various tim es during th e day and on successive days. These tests indicated th a t a w eight in th e desired range— i.e., 7.7 to 8.6 kg. (17 to 19 pounds)— could be reproduced to 68 mg. (± 0.0015 pound). T h e set of brass w eights used were calibrated to 9 mg. (± 0.0002 pound). C a l ib r a tio n o f P y c n o m e te rs . A lter being carefully cleaned and dried, b o th internally and externally, th e tw o pycnom eter units were evacuated an d th e ta re w eights determ ined and checked b y repeated weighings to th e n earest 22 mg. (0.0005 pound). T h e volumes of th e pycnom eter cham bers were then ascertained for tem peratures of 4.44°, 15.56°, 26.67°, 37.78°, 48.89° and 60° C. (40°, 60°, 80°, 100°, 120°, and 140° F .), and w ith no internal pressure on the chambers, b y weighing th e w aterfilled cham bers a t th e various tem peratures and th en m aking cor rections for th e changing density of w ater. Freshly boiled dis tilled w ater was used. T h e effect of internal pressure on pyc nom eter cham ber volumes was ascertained for a tem perature condition of 15.56° C. (60° F .) and pressures of 0,14, an d 28 kg. p er sq. cm. (0, 200, and 400 pounds per square inch) gage, re spectively. T h e final results of the calibrations expressed in term s of volum e for various conditions of tem perature and in tern al pressure, were p lo tted to arrive a t a sm ooth relationship for use in th e subsequent experiments. I t is believed th a t the finally assigned volum es for the various conditions were know n to ± 0 .2 cc. for th e en tire tem perature range. MEASUREMENT OF DENSITIES The p y c n o m e t e r u n i t s w e r e evacuated to an absolute pressure of less th a n 1 mm. of m ercury. S u f f i c i e n t b u t a d i e n e was then charged in to th e units to fill A com pletely and B to half its capacity. Valve D was closed and C was left open. T he u n its were th en placed in a constant-tem perature b a th in such a m anner th a t cell A was to tally im mersed in th e b a th liquid, b u t w ith no p a rt of cell B immersed. H e a t was applied externally to B b y m eans of an electrically heated rem ovable jack e t to m aintain its tem perature, 6° to 9° C. (10° to 15° F .) higher th a n th e b ath tem perature. T h e tem perature of B was m easured by a therm ocouple on th e outside surface of th e cell a t a p o in t below th e liquid level in th e cell. In a prelim inary series of ob servations i t was determ ined th a t approxim ately one hour was re quired to bring th e tem perature of th e pycnom eter an d its charge of butadiene to th e b a th tem perature. T h e pycnom eters were consequently held in th e co n stan t tem perature b a th for 1.5 hours before being 8 INDUSTRIAL Tabic I. AND ENGINEERING Summary of Experimentally Determined Specific Gravities of 1,3-Butadiene T his W ork (99.6 M ole P e r C e n t 1,3-B utadicne) T e m p e ra P y cn o m eter tu re N o. Specific g ra v ity ° F. (i1/600 P .)° L ite ra tu re , Specific G ra v ity (t/6 0 ° F .)a 0.66671 0.66671 0 .6 6675 0 .6 6675 0 .6 6 5 9 (2)b 0.65414 0 .6 5 4 1 0 0 .6 6 4 0 (2)b 40 0.64097 0.64097 0 .6 4070 0.6 4065 0 .6 4 0 9 (£)& 60 0.6 2732 0.6 2725 0 .6 2 7 3 (2)b 20 21.2 0 .6 4 9 3 (4) 68 0.6 2 1 3 ( /) 80 0.61361 0.61371 100 0.59933 0 .5 9944 0.59944 0.59932 0.59937 0.59947 120 0 .5 8445 0 .5 8422 140 0.56920 0.56890 0.56850 0.56S70 <* Specific g ra v ity a t te m p e ra tu re t w ith reference to w a ter a t 60° F. &In te rp o la te d values. removed for weighing. D uring th a t tim e, th e b a th tem p era ture w as held constant to 0.06° C. (± 0 .1 ° F .). J u s t before rem oving a pycnom eter from th e b ath , C was closed. Im m e diately upon removal, th e outside surface was dried and B was evacuated. D was then closed, C was opened, and th e u n it was weighed. In those instances where th e b a th tem perature was be low th e dew point tem perature of th e room air, the tem perature of the pycnom eter was raised to above room tem peratures to avoid errors in weighing occasioned by condensation of m oisture on the surface. In such cases B served as a receiver for th e liquid butadiene displaced from A . RESULTS T he specific gravities of th e butadiene were subsequent^’ ar rived a t by dividing th e determ ined w eights of the butadiene contained in A a t the various tem peratures by th e w eight of th e sam e volume of w ater when a t 60° F . an d atm ospheric pres sure. T he value for the density of w ater a t 60° F. used in these calculations was tak en as 0.999017 gram p er cc. All experi m ental results are presented in T able I together w ith comparable d a ta from Doss (1), L andolt an d B ernstein (2), and Prevost (/,). An analysis of the m ethod used showed th a t errors in deter m ined gravities traceable to air buoyancy effects were of sm all m agnitude. T he buoyancy correction, calculated to be +0.00003, was n o t applied since it was too sm all in comparison w ith the experim ental error to be significant. W ithin the experi m ental error it has been concluded th a t th e determ ined specific gravity values can be accepted as equivalent to those taken in a vacuum . T he specific gravities presented in T able I were p lotted against tem perature, and, from a sm ooth curve draw n through th e points, th e specific gravity values for th e various interm ediate tem pera tures were determ ined. These sm oothed specific grav ity values are presented in Table II . Of th e tw enty-tw o different specific g rav ity m easurem ents m ade at. tem peratures of 48.89° C. (120° F.) an d below, only those m ade a t 4.44° and 26.67° C. (40° Table II. im pcratu rc ° F. 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 30 32 34 36 38 40 42 44 46 48 50 52 54 56 58 60 62 64 66 68 70 CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 Smoothed Specific G ravity V alues for Com m ercially Pure 1,3-Butadiene (09.6 molo p e r c en t 1,3-butadicnc) Specific T e m p e ra G ra v ity tu re (it/6 0 ° F .)a 0 F. 0.6668 0.6655 0.6643 0.6631 0 .6618 0.6606 0.6593 0.6580 0.6567 0.6554 0.6541 0.6529 0.6515 0.6502 0.6489 0.6476 0.6463 0 .6449 0 .6436 0.6423 0.6409 0.6396 0.6382 0.6369 0.6356 0.C342 0 .6328 0.6314 0 .6300 0.6286 0 .6 2 7 3 b 0.6259 0 .6245 0 .6232 0.6218 0.6205 72 74 76 78 80 82 84 86 88 90 92 94 96 9S 100 102 104 106 108 110 112 114 116 118 120 122 124 126 128 130 132 134 136 138 140 Specific G ra v ity (it/6 0 ° F.)' 0.6191 0.6177 0.6163 0.6149 0 .6135 0.6121 0.6106 0.6091 0.6077 0.6063 0.6049 0.6035 0.6021 0.6007 0.5993 0.5978 0.5963 0.5949 0 .5934 0.5919 0.5904 0.5S89 0.5874 0.5859 0.5844 0 .5828 0.5813 0.5798 0.5783 0.5767 0.5751 0.5736 0 .5720 0 .5704 0.5689 o Specific g ra v ity a t te m p e ra tu re t w ith reference to w a ter a t 60° F . & P robable Bpccific g ra v ity (6 0 °/6 0 ° F .) for p u re 1,3-butadiene, a rriv ed a t b y applying corrections for assum ed im p u ritie s, waa estim ated to be 0.027*1 * 0.00015. and 80° F.) in pycnom eter u n it 2 differed from the sm oothed value b y m ore th a n th e predicted probable am ount of 0.00018. I t was believed th a t th e 0.4 mole p er cent of im purities present in th e sam ple consisted of 1-butene and th e high- and low-boiling 2-butenes. B y m aking certain assum ptions, it was possible to predict the specific grav ity a t 60° F. of pure 1,3-butadiene. T hus, if it were assumed th a t th e three probable im purities were present in su bstantially equal proportions, th e com puted value of pure 1,3-butadiene would be higher th an the determ ined specific g rav ity of th e te st m aterial b y 0.00007. On adding th e buoy ancy correction of 0.00003 and sub tractin g th e correction of 0.00005 for th e am o u n t of inhib ito r present, th e final value rounded off to 0.6274 was obtained for th e specific grav ity (6 0 °/ 60° F.) of pure 1,3-butadiene. T h is was considered to be the m ost nearly correct value for pure 1,3-butadiene a t 60° F. ACKNOW LEDGMENT T h e w riters wish to acknowledge th e helpful suggestions m ade b y various m em bers of th e Phillips Petroleum C om pany R e search D e p artm en t in th e developm ent of th e experim ental m ethod and, in particular, th e assistance rendered b y L. R. F ru it on all experim ental m easurem ents. Acknowledgm ent is also m ade b o th to Phillips Petroleum C om pany an d to th e B. F . Goodrich C om pany for th e use of certain analytical techniques. LITERATURE CITED (1) D oss, “P hysical C on stan ts of th e Principal H ydrocarbons", 4 th ed., p. 47, T exas Co., 1943. (2) L andolt, H ans, and B ornstein, Richard, "Physikalisch-C hem ische T ab ellen ” , 2nd Supplem ent, P art 1, p. 207, B erlin, Julius Springer, 1931. (3) N atural G asoline A ssoc. Am erica, I n d . E n o . C h e m ., 34, 1240-3 (1942). (4) P revost, C ., Compt. Rend.., 186, 1209 (1928). Physical Methods of A n alysis of Synthetic and Natural Rubber R. B O W L IN G B A R N E S , V A N Z A N D T W IL L IA M S , A . R. D A V I S , a n d P A U L G IE S E C K E Stamford Research Laboratories, Am erican Cyanamid C o ., Stamford, Conn. In a compounded rubber stock, the ratio of natural to synthetic rub ber can be estimated approximately from a knowledge of the phos phorus content of the rubber hydrocarbon. A considerably more exact analysis can be carried out by means of infrared spectroscopic methods, which permit a determination of the type as well as the amount of rubber present. Complete details and comparative results of these two methods of analysis are given, as well as a simple pro cedure for separating the rubber hydrocarbon of a rubber stock from the carbon black and other com pounding ingredients. th e am o u n t present. In conjunction w ith th e la tte r analysis, a m ethod was devised for separating from com pounded rubber products a sam ple of rubber hydrocarbon free of pigm ent and filler. T he details of th e preparation and analysis of sam ples are given, together w ith a typical set of d a ta obtained in connection w ith the tire and tu b e studies. A lthough these m ethods m ay no t necessarily be successful in solving every type of ru b b er m ixture analysis encountered, th eir value in this p articu lar problem w arrants careful consideration in connection w ith sim ilar problems which m ay arise in th e future. PO R T S have been m ade th a t m ore th a n 3000 kinds of R Erubberlike synthetics have already been prepared. Obviously, DETERMINATION OF RATIO O F N A TU R A L TO SYNTHETIC RUBBER BY PHOSPHORUS CONTENT n o t all are of practical im portance, nor can they legitim ately be The m etabolic processes of plants bring about, w ithin th e vari referred to as “synthetic rubbers” , b u t a certain select group of ous p a rts of th e p lant, th e deposition of a g reat m any of the these, as well as still other new synthetics, will survive and prove m etals commonly found in th e soil. In con trast w ith this, the m eritorious. Uses will be found for these new synthetic rubbers m etals found in any sy nthetic p roduct are lim ited to those pur both alone and when blended w ith o th er synthetics or w ith n a t posely added an d those accidentally introduced by con tact w ith ural rubber. T he rubber chemists of th e future will therefore be the pieces of processing equipm ent. faced w ith the problem of analyzing such m ixtures. Because th e In order to determ ine w hether this difference m ight prove to be com ponents of these m ixtures are often complex and th eir deg valuable for analytical purposes, sam ples of n a tu ra l an d syn radation products are n o t well known, it will be difficult, by thetic rubbers were subjected to an u ltraviolet spectrochem ical conventional analytical m ethods, to establish th eir identities or analysis, using a large Iiilg er E - l spectrograph. T able I shows th e proportions in which they are present. th e results of such a com parative emission analysis. I t m ay be In anticipation of these difficulties, it was deemed advisable seen a t once th a t, whereas th e synthetics contain little or no to study th e applicability of various physical tools to this and phosphorus, th is elem ent is present in th e n atu ra l rubbers in other problem s of the rubber industry. In a previous publica readily detectable quantities. T his clue was followed up in tion (I) the authors called a tte n tio n to th e fact th a t infrared spectroscopy could be of value in differentiating between rubbers great detail and th e exact values for th e phosphorus contents and in analyzing rubber m ixtures, and pointed o u t th a t th e in were determ ined through th e use of an o th er spectrochem ical frared absorption spectra of th e v ari ous rubbers are unique and offer one m eans of attacking th e analytical Table I. Ultraviolet Spectrochemical A n a lysis of the Metal Content of Rubber problem outlined. However, in this Hydrocarbons prelim inary paper th e analytical possi S y n th e tic R u b b e r------ » ,----------------------- N a tu ra l R u b b e r----------------------- * bilities were merely noted w ith o u t any R eD oB una S Sm oked C repe T rea d C arcass claim ed m estic G erm an tre a d a tte m p t to reduce them to practice. sh e e t ru b b e r sto ck sto ck tires B una S B una S stock Shortly a fter th e completion of this -P e r C en t A sh (6 .3 ) (0 .2 7 ) (0 .1 7 ) (3 .6 ) (3 2 .5 ) (2 3 .2 ) (1 .4 9 ) (2 .1 1 ) prelim inary study, th e authors were 232 A lum inum 2222+ 24called upon by th e W ar Production A ntim o n y 2 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 2 B oard to analyze a series of captured B ariu m 23141+ 14141422B oron 21 1 + 141 + 14Germ an tires and inner tubes for the C adm ium 20 1 0 0 1 114Calcium 2 3 32 2242424A rm y Ordnance D epartm en t, an d to 22C hrom ium 1 1 0 14141.4determ ine, if possible, th e am ounts 22222C o p p er 1+ 141422 Iro n 2 2 2 2 22 and types of synthetic rubbers which 2 Lead 1 21 1414141433 M agnesium 332+ 24242+ had been blended w ith n atu ral rubber 2 1 M anganese 1 1 1 14141+ in the m anufacture of these tires. As 20 0 0 M oly b d en u m 0 0 0 0 2N ickel 1 0 1 14141414a result of this investigation, two 2 2 2 0 0 Pho sp h o ru s 142+ 24222 2 0 P o tassiu m 0 0 14satisfactory m ethods of analysis were 2 3 Silicon 2 2 2 242424developed. 32 2 2 2 2 Sodium 24242 1 S tro n tiu m 1 0 14141+ 1+ T he first, the determ ination of the 1 1 T in 1 1 1 1 1 142 2 1 T itan iu m 1 1 1 141+ phosphorus content, furnishes a sim 20 0 0 0 0 V anadium 0 0 2332 223 ple m ethod for m easuring the rela Zinc 24R an g es for q u a lita tiv e estim ates: tive am ounts of n atu ral and synthetic 2100 to 1.0 p.p .m . 3 » 100 to 1.0% rubbers present in an unknow n; the 10 to 0 .1 0 p.p.m . 3 10 to 0 .1 0 % 141 1 .0 to 0 .0 1 p.p.m . 2 4- 1 .0 to 0 .0 1 % second, the application of infrared 1 less th a n 0 .1 p.p .m . 2 « 0 .1 to 0 .0 0 1 % m etal n o t d etected spectroscopy, perm its determ ination 0 of both the type of each rubber and 9 10 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING tool, the visible light spectrophotom eter. T he details of the exact procedure followed are given below. T able I I gives the phosphorus contents of a v ariety of n atu ral and synthetic rubbers. These values show a considerable v aria tion for n atu ral rubbers of different origins, b u t all m ay be char acterized by high phosphorus (average 400 p.p.m .) -when com pared w ith typical synthetics (average 20 p.p.m .). T hus, an exact phosphorus determ ination should m ake possible a d eter m ination of the ratio of n atu ra l to syn th etic rubber in an unknow n sample. Tabic 1!. Phosphorus P .p .m . N a tu ra l ru b b e r Sm oked sh ee t A Sm oked sh ee t B Sm oked sh eet C S m oked sh e e t D Sm oked sh ee t E C repe P a le crepe R eclaim ed tu b e G u a y u le 690 380 320 500 400 490 350 390 200 P .p .m . S y n th e tic ru b b e r B u n a S (A m erican ; B u n a A (G erm an ; C o tto n tir e cord Viscose tir e cord 15 30 210 10 CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. I versus sy nthetic m aterials m ay arise in which this general m ethod m ight be of help.] Therefore, it is advisable th a t all cords, if present, be rem oved b y th e following procedure: A section of th e rubber (tire) is shredded in a two-roll mill, then mixed w ith w ater in a W aring Blendor. A fter 5 to 10 m inutes’ stirring, the cord can be partially separated by d écantation. T he rem aining cord is digested a t a b o u t 4° C. for 18 hours w ith an excess of cupram m onium solution [see Clibbens and Gaeke (5) and the com m ittee of th e A m e r i c a n C h e m i c a l S o c i e t y (4) for preparation of th is solution]. T h e m aterial is w ashed free of cupram m onium w ith w ater and then dried. If th e sam ple is a prepared rubber stock, all phosphate-containing plasticizers m ust be rem oved b y refluxing th e shredded rubber for 8 hours in a Soxhlet extractor w ith a solvent composed of 68% chloroform and 32% acetone. F o r m axim um photom etric accuracy, a w eight of rubber should be taken such th a t a phosphorus con ten t up to 0.080 mg. is contained. W ith syn th etic rubbers, a 1-gram sam ple is suit able, whereas, w ith n atu ra l rubber, approxim ately 0.1 gram is used. In order to ensure a rep resentative sam ple, a larger weight is tak en and subjected to the prelim inary preparation. The color value of a 1-gram eq uivalent is then m easured to furnish a rough idea of th e phosphorus content. W ith th is as a basis, a w eight of sam ple is chosen according to th e above criterion and is m easured accurately. Figure 1 was plotted in order to show th a t th e phosphorus could be determ ined accurately enough to allow th e content of tlxis elem ent to be used as a y ardstick and as a direct m easure of th e am ount of n atu ral rubb er present. (If th e origin of th e n a tu ral rubber is unknown, th e slope of this curve is n o t determ in able, and the m ethod is only roughly q u an titativ e. On th e other hand, if a sample of the n atu ra l rubber used in compounding is available for a phosphorus test, a m uch higher degree of accuracy m ay be expected.) In spite of the variation of the phosphorus content of n atu ral rubbers of different origin, a reasonable first guess a t a m ixture of unknow n constitution m ay be based upon th e following generalization: Figure 1. H igh pho sp h o ru s (300 to 450 p .p.m .) M edium phosphorus (100 to 250 p.p.m .) Low phosphorus (0 to 50 p.p.m .) n a tu ra l n a tu ra l 4- sy n th etic all sy n th etic As will be seen from T able IV, th e above m ethod provides a very simple approxim ate analysis. T he agreem ent between this an d the m ore exact infrared m ethod is indeed surprising. How ever, th e m ethod is alw ays open to th e u ncertainty th a t phos phorus m ay have been introduced in processing and n o t been elim inated in the sam pling procedure. A lthough any sensitive m ethod for determ ining th e phosphorus will be satisfactory, th e spectrochem ical procedure detailed below was found to be m ost suitable. T his colorimetric m ethod is based upon m any literature references of which Zinzadze (10) and Goodloe (6) are typical. An intense blue color is produced in solutions containing phosphorus b y reduction of phosphom olybdate, the intensity of th e color being directly proportional to th e phosphorus content of the solutions. In th is laboratory, th e color values or per cent transm issions were m easured on a General Electric recording spectrophotom eter. T he blue color which develops has a rath e r broad spectral w idth -which can be m eas ured satisfactorily by m eans of an y ordinary comparison color im eter, although the increased precision of th e m ore accurate photoelectric instrum ents is to be preferred. Figure 2 shows a series of transm ission curves for stan d ard phosphorus solutions. P r e p a r a t i o n o f S a m p l e . All glassware and reagents m u st be free of phosphorus and a suitable blank or control m u st be carried through the complete procedure. O ther possible sources of extraneous phosphorus are th e cord and plastieizer used in fabrication. [It is interesting in this connection to note (Table II ) th a t cotton, o r n atu ral, fibers are high in phosphorus, whereas sy nthetic fibers, rayons, etc., have a low content, th u s enabling a distinction to be m ade between these two types of fibers. U ndoubtedly o th er cases of n atu ral Phosphorus in Carcass Stock Com pounded with Natural Rubber and Buna S Formula oF Stock Rubber hydrocarbon 100 50 Zinc oxide Stearic acid 1 Pine tar 1.5 1.5 Agerite retln Sulfur 2.0 Altax 1.25 Preferably, the phosphorus values should be calculated to the w eight of ru b b er hydrocarbon, th e carbon, zinc oxide fillers, etc., having been rem oved previously. T his was n o t alw ays done in th e au th o rs’ work, a s th e carbon analysis w as done elsewhere; hence, the phosphorus con ten t of th e sam ples reported here was based on the entire ru b b er sample. A s h i n g o f S a m p l e . T he weighed sam ple of extracted rubber is ashed in a suitable crucible in a controlled furnace a t a tem perature n o t higher th an 600° C. u n til free of organic m aterial. T his m ust be done slowly enough to p rev en t th e m aterial from kindling. I t was n o t found necessary to add a phosphorus fixa tive in th e case of ru b b er m aterials, as no increased phosphorus values were obtained by adding zinc oxide to prevent th e vola tilization of phosphorus. A fter cooling, th e residue is dissolved by boiling in dilute sulfuric acid in a q u a n tity ju s t sufficient to dis solve th e soluble m aterials. Excess acid is to be avoided, since th e final acid ity is very im portant, b u t an excess of acid m ay be added an d la te r neutralized. A slight tu rb id ity w hich m ay be rem oved b y filtering rem ains in some cases as a result of the presence of a siliceous m aterial. T h e clear solution of th e ashes is transferred to a 50-ml. Pyrex volum etric flask an d th e volume is ad ju sted to a b o u t 40 ml. D e v e l o p m e n t o f C o l o r . A lthough m any procedures are de scribed in th e literatu re, th e following modification was used here. Standard Solidions. Solution I, am m onium m olybdate, 5.45 gram s [(N H 4)5M o j0 2(.4H20 ], dissolved b y w arm ing w ith w ater and m ade to 100 ml. Solution II , lOiV sulfuric acid (282 ml. of concentrated sulfuric acid diluted to 1000 ml.), checked b y titratio n . January 15, 1944 ANALYTICA L EDITION Solution I I I , stannous chloride. A stock solution of stannous chloride dehydrate is 40 gram s dissolved in concentrated h y drochloric acid (density 1.18) and m ade up to 100 ml. (stable for m onths). F o r use, it is diluted 200 tim es w ith distilled w ater (stable for one day). Analytical Procedure. To th e solution prepared according to instructions above, 2.5 ml. of Solution I and 5 ml. of Solution I I are added and mixed thoroughly, and 2 ml. of Solution I I I are added w ith constant swirling. T h e solution is m ade to volum e (50 ml.) and m ixed thoroughly. (T he final acidity of th e 50-ml. sam ple should be 1 N sulfuric acid. If excess acid is used in dis solving the ash, it m ay be neutralized a t th a t p o in t or th e am o u n t of Solution I I m ay be reduced to give th e final acidity stipulated.) A blank is carried through the sam e procedure to check for th e presence of phosphorus in the reagents. D e te r m in a tio n o f P h o sp h o ru s C o n te n t. T h e per cent transm ission of the solution in a 1-cm. thick cell a t 700 mu is m easured exactly 20 m inutes after adding Solution I I I . T he am ount of phosphorus in an unknow n m ay be determ ined from a calibration curve which shows th e per cent transm ission plotted as ordinates versus th e phosphorus con ten t of known stan d ard solutions as abscissas. T he calibration curve m ay be prepared from a scries of transm ission curves such as those of Figure 2. N o t e s o n P h o s p h o r u s A n a l y s i s . W hen a m olybdate is added to a solution containing orthophosphate according to th e m ethod described above, an insoluble phosphom olybdate is formed. However, because of th e high dilution, a p recipitate is n o t apparent. T h e addition of a reducing agent (stannous chlo ride) causes a reduction of th e phosphom olybdate and gives an intense blue color. U nder th e proper conditions, th e m olyb denum reagent necessary as an excess is n o t reduced. T he factors which affect th e color are: 1. T he acid concentration is very im p o rtan t. In th e presence of too m uch acid, a light color is produced. Conversely, if too little acid is used, the m olybdate reagent itself will be reduced, causing dark colors. In th e m ethod used, a 20% decrease in acidity results in a 10% increase in color intensity, while a 10% increase in acidity results in a 10% decrease in color intensity. Soluble silica also produces a blue color w ith th e above reagent if the silica concentration is high or th e acidity is insufficient to suppress th e ionization of th e silicic acid. T he acidity chosen as optim um in this investigation ( I N sulfuric acid) is such th a t silica up to 2000 p.p.m . does n o t interfere. 2. T he m olybdate concentration is th e n ex t m ost critical factor. An _increased m olybdate concentration results in a higher sen sitivity to phosphorus, b u t also an increased blank. A high blank reading is not desirable when low concentrations of phosphorus are present. A 50% increase in th e m olybdate con centration, as used above, results in approxim ately a 15% in crease in the color intensity. A 20% decrease in m olybdate con centration results in approxim ately a 10% decrease in color in tensity. 3. T he stannous chloride concentration is n o t very critical. A ± 5 0 % change in the am o u n t of stannous chloride influences the phosphorus result n o t m ore th an ± 5 % . 4. U nder the given conditions, th e color increases for 5 to 10 m inutes after the stannous chloride is added and bleaches slowly thereafter. I t is recom m ended therefore th a t th e color be m eas ured 20 m inutes after addition of th e stannous chloride. 5. T he following sources of interference have been considered, and m ethods of reduction or elim ination are recom m ended where necessary: Ferric ion up to 6 p.p.m . does no harm . F ifteen p arts per million slightly in h ib it color developm ent, while larger am ounts of ferric ion cause very rapid fading of the color. F errous ion causes no harm . A Jones rcductor w ith m etallic cadm ium gives best results for prevention of interference from ferric ion (7). T he presence of m ore th an 20 p.p.m . of titan iu m causes in terference by retarding the ra te of color developm ent. A rsenates give th e same color as phosphates and th e intensities are inversely proportional to the molecular weights. R eduction w ith sodium bisulfite elim inates th e influence of arsenates (20 mg. of arsenic pentoxide per 50 ml. m ay be taken care of b y re duction to arsenic trioxide). N itrates up to 100 p.p.m . have no effect; 200 p.p.m . reduce the color ab o u t 10%. Sulfates in large am ounts interfere, presum ably by depressing the ionization of the sulfuric acid. T arta ric and citric acids interfere above 20 p.p.m ., w ith in hibition of m axim um color. T h ey m ay be rem oved b y oxidation witli perm anganate. Aluminum an d m anganese in reasonable am ounts do n o t in terfere. Calcium an d m agnesium u p to 1000 p.p.m . have no effect. N ickel up to 1000 tim es th e phosphorus co n ten t does n o t in terfere except for its own color. 11 Trichloroacetic acid begins to interfere w ith the m axim um color developm ent a t concentrations above 4 % in th e final m ixture. Acetic acid shows practically no effect. H ydrochloric acid has a tendency to lessen color stab ility and retard s or inhibits m axim um coloration. DETERMINATION O F TYPES A N D AM OUNTS O F RUBBERS BY INFRARED SPECTROSCOPY R ecent publications (I, 8, 3, 8) have described in g reat detail the m ethods an d applications of infrared spectroscopy to the identification and analysis of m any ty p es of organic m aterials. I t is sufficient here to point o u t th e tw o salient characteristics of infrared absorption in order th a t th e basis for analysis can be understood. In the first place, th e infrared absorption spectrum (a p lot of per cent transm ission as ordinate versus frequency in cm .-1 ) of a m aterial is a unique characteristic of th e m aterial an d cannot be duplicated by an o th er compound. Some of th e absorption bands can be ascribed to particular atom ic groups w ithin the molecule while others, characteristic of th e molecule as a whole, are particularly useful for such studies as differentiating isomers. T hus it is to be expected th a t th e phenyl group in B una S would give rise to absorption bands which would n o t be present in n atu ral rubber, while conversely, th e m ethyl groups of n a tu ral rubber would cause a characteristic absorption which would not be observed in B una S. Moreover, it is to be expected th a t there will be fu rth er bands characteristic of th e molecule as a whole which will assist in th e differentiation. X IN ANGSTROMS Figure 2. Spectrophotometric Determination” of2Phosphorus Calibration of phoiphorui at reduced photphomolybdate Final toluUon 1N In sulfuric acid, MoOi 0.13 gram par 50.ml., SnCli.SHiO 0.006 gram par 50 ml. PhotNet T - lo g 7" —log T phorus —log T Blank % 94.5 73 58 34 12.5 0.024 0.137 0.237 0.469 0.903 0.024 0.024 0.024 0.024 0.113 0.213 0.445 0.879 M icro g ra m * M icrog ram Nona 8 15 30 60 0.0141 0.0142 0.0148 0.0146 12 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING In the second place, so long as no interm olecular action occurs, th e spectrum of a m ixture of rubbers will be simply th e spectra of th e pure com ponents combined in the proportion in which the m aterials them selves are present. Hence, it is to be expected th a t an unknow n m ixture can be analyzed by direct m easure m ent of th e strength of absorption bands unique to each compo n ent, or by comparison of th e absorption spectra of th e unknow n w ith those of a series of known prepared standards. 1800 1600 1400 1200 1000 800 FREQUENCY in cm : 1 Figure 3. CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 this series by a comparison of the absorption intensities 1500 cm.-1 , 917 cm.“ 1 ■orin „ and r,„r r . B y this m ethod, an unknow n such as 1380 cm. 1 83o cm. 1 J th a t shown in Figure 4 could be estim ated to be 85% n atu ral rubber, 15% B una S. All absorption spectra were tak en w ith sam ples sm eared on salt plates and a high resolution spectrom eter (2) was employed. T h e accuracy of th e m ethod is limited to 5 to 10% because of th e inability to m ake sm ear sam ples of 1800 1600 1400 1200 FREQUENCY in 1000 800 cm:' Infrared A bso rp tion Spectra of Rubber Hydrocarbons T he infrared absorption spectra of various common types of rubber are shown in Figure 3 (I). T he differences in these spec tra readily show th eir applicability in identifying an unknown rubber or in estim ating the content of a m ixture. In th e course of this investigation, only m ixtures of na tu ral ru b b er and B una S were encountered. A consideration of these tw o spectra in Figure 3 or Figure 4 shows several m ajo r points of difference— B una S has a strong arom atic ring frequency n ear 1500 cm.-1 and two strong bands a t 970 cm .-1 and 917 cm .-1 which are n o t present in th e n atu ral rubber. N atu ra l rubber, on th e other hand, shows a m ethyl band a t 1380 cm.-1 an d a strong band a t 835 cm .-1 which are n o t observed in B una S. T aking advantage of these differences, each unknow n sam ple was analyzed b y comparison of its spectrum w ith the spectra of a series of known m ixtures com pounded and treated in approxim ately th e same w ay as th e unknow n m aterials. T he m ethod is outlined roughly in Figure 4, showing the absorption spectra of n atu ral rubber, 50% n a tu ral and 50% B una S, pure B una S, an d an unknow n tire tread. I t can be seen from the 50-50 m ixture th a t the unique bands m en tioned above are all present w ith a stren g th proportional to the com ponent concentration. In the actual analysis, a g reat m any interm ediate stan d ard spectra were obtained. An unknow n w as m atched w ith one of constant thickness. G reater accuracy, if desired, could be ob tained by m aking per cent transm ission m easurem ents a t the chosen frequencies according to some of th e m ore involved analytical m ethods referred to above {2, 8, 8). In order to justify th e careful treatm en t, it would be necessary to stu d y th e un knowns and standards as solutions of known concentration in a suitable solvent which would tran sm it infrared radiation a t the analytical frequencies chosen. T his more careful trea tm en t would still require a prelim inary complete absorption spectrum of each unknown, in order to furnish a qualitativ e analysis for the various ru b b er m aterials which are present. S a m p le P r e p a r a t i o n . T h e m ethods described above are stan d ard procedures and are given in detail in th e references. Considerable time, however, had to be devoted to finding a m eans of converting a piece of tire stock to a sam ple whose infrared absorption spectrum could be m easured. All a tte m p ts to obtain th e spectra of th e tire stocks directly, either b y m icrotom ing a th in section o r by a sm ear from a solution of the stock m aterial, were unsuccessful. In order to o b tain a satisfactory spectrum , it is necessary to e x tract th e ru b b er hydrocarbon free of plasticizer, filler, etc. T h e m ethod finally devised was com pletely satis factory for th e au th o rs’ purpose and should be of g reat value in January 15, 1944 ANALYTICAL any situation whore it is desirable to separate filler and rubber w ithout destruction of the rubber hydrocarbon. Therefore, this separation by m eans of p-cym ene and xylene solution is com pletely described below. A fter this separation, the rubber is present as a solution in the hydrocarbon solvents. These solvents are rem oved by vacuum distillation until the rubber is a gum m y solid th a t will n o t flow a t room tem perature. T his gum is th en w ashed four or five tim es w ith h o t acetone to remove th e last traces of plastieizcr and solvent. In m ost cases the state of th e rubber is such th a t it can easily be sm eared on a rock salt plate. T he desired thickness is ob tained by scraping the film w ith a razor blade u n til th e 1450 cm .-1 C II band shows a transm ission of a b o u t 10%. I f th e ru b ber does n o t spread easily, it m ay be softened w ith a volatile solvent such as carbon tetrachloride. T h e film is th en dried in a vacuum oven to remove th e last traces of solvent. Finally, th e absorption spectrum of th e sam ple is obtained throughout th e spectral region of interest. EDITION showed clearing in a few m inutes an d could be filtered free of the carbon black a fte r stan d in g 10 m inutes. T his m ethod was fu rther altered slightly by using 250 cc. of n-hexane instead of 300 cc. of 70° B6. gasoline for diluting th e solution. Again th e carbon black separated easily. In order to determ ine w hether or n o t th e sam e dilution technique would work w ith xylene as th e solvent, a solution of th e sam e tread stock was m ade w ith 30 cc. of xylene plus a sm all am o u n t of thio-jS-naphthol, b u t on diluting w ith benzene and hexane, th e carbon black would n o t separate from th e solution. F u rth e r experim ents showed th a t th e combined use of pcymene and xylene gave th e m ost successful results and led to a satisfactory m ethod. M e t h o d I I (adopted for solution of ru b b er an d separation of pigm ents). Sheet th e sam ple to a thickness of approxim ately 0.375 cm. (0.15 inch) on a tig h t cold 15 X 30 cm. (6 X 12 inch) lab oratory mill. E x tra c t the plasticizer, etc., from 4 gram s of th e sheeted sam ple w ith a m ixture of 32% b y volum e of acetone and 68% by volum e of chloroform for a m inim um of 7 hours, or until the extracting liquid no longer shows color. T h is size of sam ple is sufficient to perm it rep eat analyses. Place 1.0 gram of the dried, extracted sam ple in a 400-cc. rub ber extraction flask w ith 25 cc. of p-cym ene and 5 cc. of xylene. H e a t on a steam b a th a t ab o u t 70° to 80° C. for 1 hour, then on a DISSOLVING RUBBER HyD RO CARBO N A N D SEPARATING IT FROM COM POUNDING INGREDIENTS I n the case of vulcanized n a tu ral rubber compositions, various solvent m ethods of determ ining th e am o u n t of ru b b er hydrocar bon have been used w ith some success. These m ethods, however, are som ew hat involved and time-consuming. E ven th e A.S.T.M . m ethod requires th a t the solution stan d overnight to allow the m ineral fillers and pigm ents to settle before filtration. I f the rubber composition contains highly dispersed, exceedingly fine pigm ents, such as carbon black, separation of th e pigm ents by filtration or centrifuging is usually impossible. Since m any present-day ru b b er products, p articularly tire tread compositions or compounds, contain large am ounts of carbon black, none of th e above-m entioned m ethods appeared prom ising for separation of th e rubber from the carbon black in suitable condition for infrared analysis. Accordingly, research on this question was initiated. Fearing th a t destruction o r decomposition of th e ru b b er hydro carbons m ight result from th e use of th e conventional high-boiling solvents used in the above separation m ethods, a num ber of lowboiling solvents were tried: ethylene dichloride, toluene plus piperidine, o-nitroanisole, D ispersing Oil N o. 10 (B arrett) plus xylene, and C ircolight Process Oil (Sun Oil Co.) plus xylene. These experim ents were unsuccessful. M ethod I. In the next attem p ts, which were som ew hat more successful, xylene plus a sm all am ount of thio-/3-naphthol boil ing under reflux was found to dissolve n a tu ra l or syn th etic tire tread stocks in 5 to 6 hours. T o accom plish this, 1 gram of chloro form -acetone-extracted tread stock was heated in 100 cc. of xylene plus 0.3 gram of thio-/3-naphthol a t 140° C., u n til solu tion was complete. However, this solution did n o t perm it easy separation of the carbon black unless a com bination of centrifuging and slight alcohol precipitation was used. (By adding alcohol to th e solu tion, a sm all am ount of rubber is p recipitated in order to drag dow n the carbon black during centrifuging. T here is some danger th a t this precipitation m ay be selective and thus change the composition of the residual rubber.) A sufficient separation of th e carbon black can be m ade in this m anner to perm it fairly satisfactory infrared analysis. In the case of carcass stocks con taining only zinc oxide as a filler, the pigm ent was easily separated b y settling or centrifuging. T h is m ethod w as n o t completely satisfactory, however, because of carbon black troubles and the difficulty of rem oving th e peptizer w ith o u t loss of th e rubber itself. T h e search for a b e tte r m eans of carbon black separation was therefore continued. T he cresol m ethod (9) was tried w ith some success, although there was considerable oxidation of th e rubber a t the high reflux and distillation tem perature required. T h e use of p-cym ene in place of the oresol w ith digestion a t ab ou t 160° to 170° C. gave a satisfactory solution in ab o u t 4 hours and caused no noticeable oxidation of th e rubber. On dilution w ith th e ben zene and 70° B6. rubber solvent gasoline, th e su p e rn a ta n t liquid 13 Figure 4. O u tline of Infrared A n a ly tica l M ethod Spectra of prepared standards and unknown sample 14 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING BSELKSa CORD CARGOES CORD A. STOCK Figure 5. First Step in Sam pling Procedure Labeled cross section of tire to be analyzed for rubber content Sm oked sheets Buna S Zinc oxide C arb o n black S tearic acid P in e ta r T herm oflex A N eozone D B ard o l S ulfur C ap ta x A lta i A gerite resin D 50. 50. 50. 1. 1 .5 2. ---------S tocks------A-912 ACKNOW LEDGM ENT In conclusion, th e authors would like to ex press th eir appreciation to th e several o th er m em bers of the staff of th is lab oratory who helped m aterially in th e establish m e n t of these analytical m ethods. Com position of Typical Rubber Stocks 87-1 Vol. 16, No. 1 cushion, breaker, and carcass stocks were re m oved from each tire, extracted, prepared for study, an d th en subjected to th e tw o an a lytical procedures. In T able IV, th e results obtained on a few typical G erm an tires an d inner tubes are p re sented. In view of th e spread in th e phos phorus contents of n atu ral rubbers from v ari ous sources (Table II), a m ean value of 400 p.p.m . was used in m aking th e analytical calculations from phosphorus determ inations. T he agreem ent betw een th e infrared an d the phosphorus m ethods is therefore all th e more gratifying. SPEAKER ł CUSHION STOCK Table III. CHEMISTRY A l-141 100. 5. 50. 2 .5 1 .5 1 .4 0 .6 3. 1 .2 100. 5. 50. Table IV . T ire N o. 5. 2. 1 .5 1 .2 5 1 .5 h o t plate under reflux a t 150° to 160° C. u n til th e ru b b er stock is com pletely dissolved. T hree to 4 hours are usually sufficient. Cool and dilute w ith 20 cc. of benzene an d then w ith 150 cc. of hexane. Allow th e carbon black an d oth er pigm ents to settle for a t least 10 m inutes, then decant th e clear su p e rn a ta n t liquid through a No. 1 filter paper. If desired, filtration m ay be done w ith suction, using an asbestos pad. W ash the flask, pigm ents, and filter w ith a m ixture of 5 cc. of benzene and 45 cc. of hexane. T he above treatm en t easily removes th e carbon black and o th er opaque compounding ingredients, giving a clear solution of th e ru b b er from which th e solvent m ay be rem oved b y vacuum distillation. In order to m ake valid comparisons between know n an d un known samples, m any m ixtures of n atu ral and B una S ru b b er in v arying proportions were com pounded according to th e typical m ethods of preparing tread, carcass, and tu b e stocks. T he ru b b er content of these known sam ples w as th en extracted according to th e final m ethod discussed above and was used for infrared com parison. T he compounding ingredients used in three such typical stan d ard s are given in T able I I I . T he infrared absorption spec tru m of th e 50-50 m ixture is shown in Figure 4. TYPICAL A N A LY T IC A L RESULTS O N A C TU A L TIRE A N D TUBE STOCKS T his entire project was initiated in order to provide a suitable m ethod for determ ining the composition of tires and tubes, w ith particular reference to the types an d relative am ounts of the various rubbers present. T he analytical m ethods which were evolved were applied successfully to a large num ber of samples. T he ty p e of inform ation obtained is well illu strated b y th e results shown below, which were selected a t random from th e samples examined. T h e tires, w hen received, were cross-sectioned, photographed, a n d labeled as shown in Figure 5, th u s ensuring a perm anent record of th e tires and a ready m eans of identifying th e various sam ples chosen. W herever possible, sam ples of th e tread, A n a ly sis of Captured German Tires P hosphorus N a tu ra l P .p .m . % In fra re d N a tu ra l Buna S % % T rea d S tocks FT 61 99 100 101 102 103 104 105 106 107 280 30 20 10 10 30 25 20 27 3 FT 61 99 100 101 102 103 104 105 106 107 340 340 380 430 130 190 230 200 305 190 FT 61« 99« 101« 102& 103& 104& 105* 106& 107 & 290 270 450 200 255 285 295 260 290 75 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 100 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 100 100 100 100 100 100 100 100 100 100 100 100 100 20 50 50 80 100 50 0 0 0 0 80 50 50 20 0 50 100 100 0 0 *75 75 85 100 100 100 *25 25 15 0 0 0 C arcass Stocks 100 100 100 100 25 50 60 50 80 50 C ushion an d T ubes 75 70 100 50 65 70 75 70 75 “ C ushion. b T ubes. LITERATURE CITED (1) Barnes, R . B ., Liddel, Urner, and W illiam s, V an Zandt, I n d . E n q . C h e m ., A n a l . E d ., 15, 8 3 - 9 0 (1 9 4 3 ). (2) Ibid., p p . 6 5 9 -7 0 9 . (3 ) B rattain , R . R ., R asm ussen, R . S., and C ravath, A . M ., J. A p p lied P h y s., 14, 4 1 8 - 2 8 (1 9 4 3 ). (4) Carver, E . K ., B ingham , E . C., Bradshaw , H ., and Venable, C . S., I n d . E n g . C h e m ., A n a l . E d ., 1, 4 9 -5 1 (1 9 2 9 ). (5) Clibbens, D . A ., and G aeke, Arthur, J . T extile In st., 19, 7 7 9 2 T (1 9 2 8 ). (6) Goodloe, Paul, I n d . E n g . C h e m ., A n a l . E d ., 9 , 5 2 7 - 9 (1 9 3 7 ). (7) K u ttn er, Theodore, and Cohen, H . R ., J . Biol. Chem., 75, 5 1 7 31 (1 9 2 7 ). (8) N ielsen, J . R ., and Sm ith, D . C ., I n d . E n g . C h e m ., A n a l . E d ,, 15, 6 0 9 -1 5 (1 9 4 3 ). (9) R oberts, J. B ., Jr., Rubber Chem. Tech., 14, 2 4 1 - 8 (1 9 4 1 ). (10) Z in z a d z e , C h ., I n d . E n g . C h e m ., A n a l . E d ., 7, 2 2 7 - 3 0 (1 9 3 5 ). Determination of Rate of Cure for Natural and Synthetic Rubber LEO N A R D H. C O H A N and M A R T IN S T E IN B E R G Continental Carbon Com pany, Research Laboratories, 6 1 3 0 W est 51st St., Chicago, III. The tensile strength at a given marked undercure divided b y the maximum tensile appears to be a convenient index of rate of cure. This index is called the tensile ratio. In comparing two stocks, the one having the higher tensile ratio is the faster curing. The proper undercure to use in calculating the tensile ratio has been found to be in the range of roughly 6 0 % of the maximum tensile, which for many stocks occurs at about one fourth the time to reach maximum tensile. The tensile ratio is very easy to determine, requires no special equip ment, and can be determined fairly accurately. In addition, it agrees well with generally accepted indexes of cure rate for typical natural rubber and G R -S formulations. H E m ethods th a t have been proposed for determ ining the ra te of cure of n atu ral ru b b er stocks include: T Tim e to reach some m aximum physical p roperty, such as te n sile strength, tensile product (12, 16), modulus a t a definite strain, aged tensile, or some prop erty of practical im portance for a given compound. T ests depending on tem p eratu re susceptibility like T-50 (5, 6, 7 ,1 1 ,1 4 ) or zero degree set (S). Chemical tests, such as determ ination of th e am ount of com bined sulfur (12). Special tests based on physical m easurem ents, such as tim e to reach the break in the m odulus a t a given strain vs. cure-tim e curve (4), tim e to reach th e cure giving “ reasonable snap w ith substantially unim paired te a r” (optim um hand te a r m ethod) (2), and tim e to reach m inim um reduced residual elongation (8). R a te of cure m ay be defined as th e tim e required to reach a given sta te of cure com pared to some stan d ard or control stock. Specifically, ra te o f cure referred to a given sta te of cure equals tim e to reach th a t sta te for the control divided by th e tim e for th e sam ple to reach th e sam e state. In th e previous example, if th e stan d ard stock reaches a sta te of cure of 0.94 based on re bound in 20 m inutes, th e ra te of cure of the sam ple tread stock would be 20/30 = 0.67, since th e sample stock required 30 m inutes to reach th e 0.94 state. O ptim um cure an d sta te of cure depend on th e physical prop erty used to determ ine curing characteristics. R ate of cure m ay depend in addition on th e state of cure a t which th e rate is m eas ured. From a practical view point th e basic physical property is th e useful life of a satisfactory commercial p roduct m ade from the com pound in question. If we th en tak e useful life as the physical pro p erty for determ ining sta te of cure and use a state of cure of 1.0 (optim um cure) a t which to measure ra te of cure, we arrive a t th e following definition of ra te of cure a t a given CONTINENTAL A A IN NATURAL RUBBER 3500 Of these m ethods, th e T-50 te s t and th e tim e to reach m axi m um tensile have been m ost widely accepted and have proved very useful, b u t leave som ething to be desired. T h e T-50 te s t requires special equipm ent n o t alw ays available in sm aller rubber laboratories, while the tim e to reach m axim um tensile, although obtainable from tensile d ata w hich in m ost cases would have to be determ ined anyhow in order to evaluate th e compound, is difficult to determ ine accurately, as th e tensile vs. cure-tim e curve usually has a flat m aximum . In GR-S th e need for a convenient index of ra te of cure is more urgent. T he T-50 te st is n o t applicable to GR-S compounds (9) and as a rule the tensile vs. cure-tim e curve has an even flatter m axim um th a n in rubber, so th a t th e accuracy of determ ining the tim e to reach m axim um tensile is even lower. I n considering the question of obtaining a satisfactory index of ra te of cure, it ■null be helpful to define th e term s “optim um cure” , and “sta te of cure” , “ra te of cure” . O ptim um cure for a given physical property m ay be defined as the tim e required to reach th e m axim um or optim um value for th a t p roperty— for example, th e optim um cure w ith respect to re bound would be th e cure tim e a t a specified cure tem perature to bring th e stock to its m aximum rebound. T h e p ro p erty m ost generally used is tensile stren g th and th e optim um cure for ten sile stren g th is often referred to sim ply as th e optim um cure. S tate of cure has been defined as th e position of th e cure in question in a series of cures (16). I t seems more precise to de fine sta te of cure w ith respect to a given physical property as th a t fraction of the m aximum value of th e property shown by th e cure in question (16). F o r example, if th e 30-m inute cure of a certain tread stock has a rebound of 47% and if th e m axi m um rebound for this tread stock is 50% , then th e sta te of cure of the 30-m inute cure w ith respect to rebound can be expressed as 47/50 = 0.94. I t m ay be useful in some instances to distinguish undercures from overcures; we m ay, therefore, indicate over cures by placing a negative sign before th e state of cure. Figure 1 I3 % ■■64 S 40 50 CURE TIME 60 70 (MIN. AT 3 0 7' f ) Figure 2 60 16 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 cure tem perature— rate of cure for an y stock is th e cure tim e required to reach m axim um useful life for a stan d ard control stock divided b y th e cure tim e required to reach m axim um useful life for th e sam ple stock. Table 1. Natural Rubber F o rm u la G um P p td . W h itin g Sm oked sheet Zinc oxide P ine ta r S tearic acid Sulfur M ercap to b en zo th iazple P re c ip ita te d w h itin g M edium th e rm a l (M T ) C o n tinex (S R F ) C o n tin e n tal AA (E P C ) C o n tin e n ta l D (M P C ) C o n tin e n ta l R-40 (CC) 100 7 .8 5 3 3 .3 2.8 1 100 7 .8 5 3 3 .3 2 .8 1 0 .7 4 3 0 .7 4 3 78 MT 100 7 .8 5 3 3 .3 2 .8 1 0 .7 4 3 C o n ti nex 100 7 .8 5 3 3 .3 2 .8 1 0 .7 4 3 W hile th e foregoing definition is precise, it is n o t very useful in actual labo rato ry work. Some index of ra te of cure is therefore desired which correlates closely w ith ra te of cure as defined above b u t can be determ ined conveniently and accurately. In th e absence of ________________ d a ta connecting any proposed index of ra te of cure w ith actu a l useful life tests it m ay be considered satisfac C o n ti C o n ti C o n ti to ry to shorv th a t th e proposed index n e n ta l n e n ta l n e n ta l D R-40 AA correlates closely w ith indexes of rate 100 100 100 of cure, th e usefulness of w'hich has 7 .8 5 7 .8 5 7 .8 5 3 3 3 already been established. 3 .3 2.81 3 .3 2.81 3 .3 2 .8 1 0.7 4 3 0 .7 4 3 0.7 4 3 50 50 50 50 50 C u re a t 280° F. Min. 0 8 15 30 60 90 180 180 280 300 390 390 T ensile a t break , l b ./ sq. in. 0 8 15 30 60 90 180 2 4 i6 ‘ 3580 3800 3490 2670 2450* 2400 2300 2175 2000 E lo n g atio n a t b reak , 0 8 15 30 60 90 180 8ÖÖ* 765 755 695 680 135 145 185 M odulus _ a t elongation, in. 400% lb ./sq . % B re ak in g set, 0 8 15 30 60 90 180 0 340 870 960 1100 900 780 300 720 1060 1250 1350 1320 900 1420 1920 2120 2200 2300 350 1070 1620 2100 2330 2675 250 720 1060 1430 2360 2630 180 370 770 1690 1800 2470 100 70 1620 2650 2700 2820 2550 2450 200 1950 2900 3200 3340 3200 2450 250 600 2400 3340 3750 3900 3750 370 750 2040 2660 3290 3880 3780 380 460 1200 2600 3300 3360 3170 975 900 6i0* 600 580 580 570 670* 600 585 550 550 750 600 600 550 540 450 450 860 775 600 600 600 565 530 975 800 650 640 630 570 535 1100 850 800 720 600 600 490 180 10 12 16 21 7 7 220 120 17 25 30 27 21 205 105 24 25 27 32 25 275 180 .... 7 10 10 5 0 1.5 17 12 17 15 i.7* 17 22 15 11 *35* 27 30 17 0 8 15 30 60 90 180 i7 0 ‘ 180 220 225 180 170 25 100 260 250 285 200 200 25 100 300 325 275 230 230 35 150 480 485 485 370 300 40 65 440 800 865 770 635 45 90 135 250 600 730 730 50 65 125 200 6S0 680 540 D u ro m c te r a t 25° C. 0 8 15 30 60 90 180 24 26 34 39 41 42 41 34 39 48 54 56 55 55 30 38 45 50 51 53 51 37 47 54 58 60 62 62 40 45 52 58 60 65 69 39 45 51 60 62 69 70 45 48 51 59 63 66 70 D u ro m c te r a t 100° C. 0 8 15 30 60 90 180 8 35 36 41 41 42 40 15 44 50 56 57 55 53 14 38 45 50 52 52 49 18 40 49 56 58 61 60 21 28 42 56 59 63 65 20 28 43 54 55 65 67 30 37 41 50 61 61 64 R ebound a t 25° C ., % , B ashore 0 8 15 30 60 90 180 46 49 51 57 60 58 56 35 39 42 52 55 53 53 46 51 52 55 58 59 58 43 38 42 48 47 47 45 31 31 30 33 37 36 34 30 32 33 34 32 32 32 23 23 0 8 15 30 60 90 180 28 54 63 70 75 68 65 27 58 65 69 71 68 67 28 60 62 73 75 77 74 26 48 53 63 60 61 60 23 33 43 48 52 50 47 23 34 40 48 46 46 47 *33* 48 48 41 0 8 15 30 60 90 180 2 3 .0 5 .0 - 1 .0 -1 S .0 -4 6 .5 -4 7 .5 -4 7 .8 2 2 .5 7 .0 0 .0 -1 2 .0 -2 4 .0 -2 7 .0 -2 7 .0 2 2 .5 1 1 .5 4 .5 -6 .5 -2 2 .8 -2 6 .5 -2 6 .5 2 1 .0 1 2 .5 5 .5 -6 .5 — 1 8 .0 -2 2 .0 - 2 5 .5 2 1 .0 18 .5 15.3 3 .0 -7 .2 - 1 0 .0 -1 5 .8 1 9 .8 2 0 .2 18.0 9 .5 3 .3 -0 .5 -3 .5 T e a r, lb ./in . R eb o u n d a t 100° C., % , B ashore T -50. ° C. 2 2 .0 *i 2 *5* 1 .5 -9 .3 -1 3 .7 -1 9 .0 *27* 34 32 28 23 25 TENSILE RATIO In order to determ ine which physi cal properties m ost closely fulfill th e above criteria for a useful index of ra te of cure, th e indexes suggested by previous investigators and other com binations of physical properties m entioned below were examined in n atu ral ru b b er and GR-S. T h e best index was found to be th e tensile ratio, which is defined as th e tensile strength a t a m arked undercure divided by th e m axim um tensile stren g th . T he undercure best suited for this purpose w’as found to be the cure giving a tensile stren g th of roughly 60% of th e maxim um tensile. F o r m any tread type stocks th e de sired cure is roughly one fourth the tim e to reach m aximum tensile. F or example, for a series of stocks of this ty p e which reach m axim um tensile in ab o u t 60 m inutes—say between 30 and 90 m inutes—the proper undercure for calculating th e tensile ratio wrould be a b o u t a 15-minute cure. A very definite objection to the use of th e tim e to reach some m axi m um p ro p erty such as maxim um tensile as an index of ra te of cure is th e inaccuracy involved in d eter m ining th is tim e when th e tensile vs. cure-tim e curve has a flat m aximum . T h e tensile ratio is, of course, not subject to th is difficulty, as the flatter th e m axim um in th e tensile vs. cure-tim e curve, th e easier it is to determ ine accurately th e value of th e m axim um tensile an d hence the tensile ratio. In Figures 1 and 2 the effect of the form of th e tensile m aximum on the accuracy of determ ining the tim e to reach m axim um tensile is illustrated. In both figures th e solid line gives th e tensile stren g th as determ ined from th e average of four identical stocks cured sim ultaneously a t the indicated cures. F rom the devia tions of th e individual stocks from th e average, th e probable error (0.67 tim es th e stan d ard deviation) a t each cure was calculated an d th e tw o broken lines correspond to th e average value m inus th e probable error and th e average plus th e probable error. January IS, 1944 ANALYTICAL T hus the two broken lines represent th e 50% confidence lim its for the tensile a t various cures. T he stock used for this purpose in Figure 1 was C ontinental AA in the n atu ral rubber form ulation given in Table I, while in Figure 2 C ontinental AA in th e GR-S form ula given in T able I I was used. F or th e possible tensile vs. cure-time curves th a t can be draw n w ithin th e broken lines, the maxima can be anyw here in th e shaded areas, so th a t th e time to reach maxim um tensile can vary from <miD. to G,». T h e ex trem e per cent variation is therefore, as shown on th e figures, 35% for the rubber stock and 64% for th e flatter G It-S curve. From the same figures the extrem e per cent variation for th e te n sile ratio can also be calculated as indicated on th e figures and is 10% for rubber an d 13% for G R-S. (These values are only approxim ate and illustrative. Since th e experim ental errors responsible for th e variation in th e individual curves are n o t en tirely independent, th e confidence limits for th e various calcula tions m ay be som ewhat different and the figures should n o t be considered as indicating a precise comparison of the accuracy of the tensile ratio and tim e to reach m axim um tensile.) DETERMINATION OF RATE OF CURE OF N A TU RA L RUBBER In order to determ ine how satisfactory an index of rate of cure was furnished by the tensile ratio, various pigm ents were milled in to a typical n atu ral rubber form ula, 26 volum es of pigm ent Figure 3 EDITION 17 per hundred volum es of ru b b er being used in all cases. In Table I th e formulas of th e stocks used an d th e experim ental test results are given. T he results include tests on uncured stock an d on a range of cures from 8 to 180 m inutes and perm it com parison of the tensile ratio and various indexes of ra te of cure which have been used or recom m ended for n atu ra l rubber. T he tim e to reach m axim um tensile, tensile p roduct (12, 16) (tensile m ultiplied by elongation), tear, and rebound were determ ined from th e d ata. Likewise the tim e to reach m inim um reduced residual elongation (breaking se t divided by tensile) (5), break in m odulus a t 400% ' elongation (4), and optim um cure as determ ined b y h and te a r (2) were determ ined. In addition to tab u latin g th e tim e to reach m axim um values th e tim e to reach various percentages (60, 70, 75, 80, 85, 90) of m axim um values w as determ ined for tensile strength and also for th e o th er physicals. We have defined sta te of cure as th e ratio of the p hysical property a t a given cure divided b y the m axim um value of th e physical property. I t was therefore th o u g ht of interest to see if th e state of cure for an y given cure, such as 15 m inutes, could offer a useful index of ra te of cure. F o r this purpose the ratioof tensile a t all undercures to m axim um tensile w as determ ined and sim ilar ratio s for tensile product, rebound, m odulus, a n d durom etcr. (In th e case of m odulus and durom eter the 180m inute cure was tak en as th e m axim um value.) Since th e re bound of th e uncured stock is appreciable, th e ratio of the in crease in rebound over uncured rebound a t all undercures to the increase in rebound over uncured rebound for the m axim um re bound was also calculated. Finally, it was thought, th e slope of th e curve for the various physical properties vs. cure tim e a t m arked undercures m ig h t furnish an index of cure. Therefore the difference in tensile for various undercures— e.g., tensile a t 15 m inutes m inus tensile a t 8 m inutes— divided by m axim um tensile was tab u la te d and sim ilar ratios for tensile product, tear, and rebound. Inasm uch as the T-50 test is probably th e m ost generally ac cepted index of rate of cure for n atu ra l rubber, th e indexes enum erated above were tested b y determ ining th eir correlation w ith T-50. T he tensile ratio w hich for this series of stocks was tak en as the tensile a t 15 m inutes divided by th e m axim um ten sile was found to give th e best correlation. T he results are sum m arized in Figures 3 and 4, w here the ten sile ratio an d oth er indexes of rate of cure are p lo tted against T-50 a t th e 60-m inute cure. T h e o th er indexes are those found to give th e closest correlation w ith T-50 or which have been pre viously suggested in th e literature. T he prediction indexes (P .I.) indicating th e degree of correla tion betw een th e various indexes of ra te of cure and T-50 are listed on th e figures. (Prediction index = 1 — \ / l — r 2, w here r is the coefficient of correlation calculated according to stan d ard statistical m ethods. P .I. is 0 for no correlation and 1 for perfect correlation. F o r six pairs of values as in the present instance r > 0.8 or P .I. > 0.4 shows significant correlation w ithin th e 95% confidence lim its.) T he prediction index of 0.84 for tensile ratio was th e highest found. Likewise the fact th a t tensile ratio, is the only function which can be fairly well approxim ated by a. single straig h t line confirms the indication given b y th e predic tion indexes. T he tensile ratio has been used in the authors’ labo rato ry as; an index of ra te of cure for various channel black stocks. I n at series of tw enty-seven experim ental blacks in th e sam e base for m ula used for the pigm ents in T able I the tensile ratio an d tim e to reach m axim um tensile were both m easured. T h e ra te o f cure as defined previously was then determ ined b y dividing th e tensile ratio of each experim ental stock by the tensile ra tio for the stan d ard control which was cured a t th e sam e tim e as th e experim ental sample. T h e sam e control was, of course, used th roughout th e series. Likewise, th e rate of cure was also esti m ated b y dividing the tim e to reach m axim um tensile of th e con trol b y th e tim e to reach m axim um tensile for the sam ple. The. INDUSTRIAL Table II. G um P p td . W h it ing 100 5 5 100 5 5 1.5 2 1 .5 2 MT 100 5 5 1 .5 o ÄND ENGINEERING CHEMISTRY G R -S C o n tinex HMF 100 5 5 100 5 5 1 .5 2 1 .5 2 C o n ti n e n ta l AA C o n ti ne n ta l D C o n ti n e n ta l R-40 100 5 5 100 5 5 100 5 5 1 .5 2 1 .5 2 1.5 2 78 50 Vol. 16, No. 1 prediction index indicating the corre lation between the ra te of cure de term ined in these two w ays was then found to be 0.24. Since for tw entyseven pairs of values a prediction index g reater th a n 0.08 shows a sig nificant correlation, there is a p p ar ently a definite relation between these two m ethods of determ ining ra te of cure. Of the two m ethods, tensile ratio can be d e t e r m i n e d m o r e precisely. 50 DETERMINATION O F RATE OF CURE IN GR-S 50 50 50 50 C u re a t 307« F . Min. <*s. 0 8 240* 240 240 240 240 250 90 210 320 400 410 420 220 580 850 1130 1130 1190 210 790 1270 1420 1450 1470 200 510 900 1230 1320 1480 260 360 800 1180 1260 1500 310 390 410 970 1100 1250 0 160 190 190 190 190 190 0 700 790 760 760 760 500 0 520 940 1130 1010 1010 840 40 650 1340 1630 1550 1460 1400 50 560 1880 2200 2200 2170 2100 100 300 1570 2380 2620 2590 2570 720* 950 2320 2550 2760 2600 80 500 740 1820 2360 2580 2570 460 315 400 300 315 340 225 300 590 560 550 550 545 455 275 880 805 665 625 590 520 415 685 590 520 390 385 350 410 600 550 450 415 395 385 490 640 625 575 465 450 425 550 675 660 600 490 490 430 550 600 660 650 550 540 480 12 10 4 6 4 5 5 15 10 9 6 5 5 4 17 7 4 5 4 4 4 15 10 9 5 4 2 2 32 22 17 12 5 5 5 37 16 19 15 5 5 5 31 29 26 20 15 14 10 20 70 90 90 85 80 80 20 115 135 100 100 110 85 i 55 225 185 155 150 150 20 125 265 225 220 175 170 30 50 230 325 285 265 270 10 33 36 35 35 35 35 15 42 44 44 45 43 43 14 28 35 41 42 42 43 15 33 43 49 51 52 51 16 33 44 51 52 55 54 21 38 45 55 59 58 60 23 37 45 54 58 58 61 33 41 47 57 61 61 66 8 32 35 35 34 34 35 11 44 44 44 43 41 41 6 33 36 41 41 41 40 9 33 42 48 51 54 52 11 33 44 50 51 53 51 11 29 40 50 56 55 57 14 29 42 51 55 56 59 23 35 44 50 58 57 62 43 53 51 52 53 53 52 28 39 40 40 39 40 38 33 44 47 48 46 46 46 20 38 40 43 43 42 41 28 38 41 42 43 42 42 25 30 31 34 35 33 32 23 28 30 31 31 30 31 19 22 25 25 26 26 26 15 30 60 90 180 26 56 57 58 60 59 58 33 4S 48 49 47 48 46 35 48 50 57 55 54 54 32 40 45 51 53 52 51 30 40 43 48 49 51 50 30 32 33 39 40 40 39 27 29 32 38 39 38 39 22 24 27 32 34 35 35 S 15 30 60 90 180 7 0 .5 8 4 .8 9 6 .9 9 8 .4 9 8 .8 9 S .0 8 9 .5 9 0 .6 4 3 .3 6 4 .0 7 S .4 8 6 .5 9 0 .0 7 0 .0 4 5 .5 6 5 .6 3 7 .5 6 6 .3 8 3 .2 3 2 .6 5 4 .2 7 2 .4 8 7 .4 8 9 .2 9 0 .4 15 30 60 90 ISO 0 8 15 30 60 90 ISO 0 8 15 30 60 90 180 0 8 15 30 60 90 180 0 8 15 30 60 90 180 0 8 15 30 60 90 180 0 8 15 30 60 90 180 0 8 15 30 60 90 180 0 8 9 5 .0 9 0 .8 7 2 .5 85! 6 *69 .*8 7 7 .6 iö ö ’ 200 320 380 380 290 *4 3 .6 5 9 .0 8 5 .2 8 9 .9 9 3 .9 55 145 180 265 280 315 305 3 1 .6 3 6 .2 50.1 7 0 .0 82 1 8 8 .0 As in th e case of n atu ra l rubber various pigm ents were studied in a typical form ulation, 26 volumes of pigm ent per 100 volumes of polym er being used as before. T h e form ula and te st results appear in Table II. Since T-50 does n o t show m uch v ariation w ith cure for GR-S, this te st was om itted. In place of the T-50 as a reference test w ith which o ther indexes could be compared, combined sulfur was determ ined by analysis. T h e sodium sulfite m ethod (1, 10) was used to determ ine free sulfur and th e combined sulfur cal culated by sub tractin g th e free sul fur from th e to ta l sulfur. T he com bined sulfur values for all cures are tabu lated in T able I I . I t is w orth noting th a t the figures for the faster curing stocks pass through a maxi mum. M oreover, if the slower curing channel black stocks were examined a t even longer cures th a n 180 m inutes, it is possible th a t the combined sulfur for these stocks too m ight pass through a maximum. T he reason for th is be havior is no t clear. T he sam e indexes of rate of cure studied in n atu ral ru b b er were d eter mined. In F igures 5 and 6 those indexes suggested by oth er investiga tors or found to correlate well with combined sulfur are p lotted against ° A n in te re stin g c o n tra s t a p p ea rs in the b eh av io r of elongation as a fu n c tio n of cure tim e for n a tu ra l ru b b e r and G R -S. In n a tu ra l ru b b e r, elongation is hig h e st in the uncured s ta te for all stocks an d decreases reg u larly as cure proceeds (T ab le I). In G R -S, how ever, elongation increases w ith cure reaching a m axim um for m oat stocks in th e vicin ity of th e 8 -m in u te cure. b In connection w ith com bined sulfur values for th e gum stock, w hich ap p ro ach al m o st 100% of th e original su lfu r, for a gum fo rm u la tio n differing from th e above stock on ly in th a t 10 p a rts of zinc oxide an d 0.75 p a r t of sulfur w ere used in ste ad of 5 of zinc oxide a n d 2 of Bulfur, th e m axim um com bined su lfu r w as less th a n 80% of the original su lfu r. T h e com bined su lfu r values for th is sto ck are: C u re, m in u tes C om bined sulfur, % 0 8 15 30 90 180 0 42 58 09 77 63 T h is behavior for G R -S is sim ilar to th a t observed b y T h o rn h ill a n d S m ith (13) for n a tu ra l ru b b e r. T h e y found th a t for higher su lfu r loading th e p e r c e n t of th e original sulfur com bined a t a given cure is higher. January 15, 1944 ANALYTICAL EDITION 19 Prediction indexes giving th e correlation of th e indexes of cure ra te w ith cure tem p eratu re are listed a t the to p of Figure 7. T he best correlation w ith cure tem perature is obtained w ith tensile ratio and combined sulfur. T im e to reach m axim um tensile also shows a significant correlation w ith cure tem p eratu re b u t does n o t correlate as closely as th e o th er tw o indexes. (For the eight stocks used in th is case a prediction index > 0.3 or a corre lation coefficient > 0.7 indicates a significant correlation w ithin 95% confidence limits.) DISCUSSION Studies w ith G R -I stocks also indicate th a t the tensile ratio is a useful index of cure for this synthetic. I t is planned to pre sent these results in a separate paper. I n dealing w ith certain special problem s th e tim e required to obtain a satisfactory index of ra te of cure m ay possibly be short ened. F o r example, in com paring a series of stocks all of winch have very sim ilar m axim um tensiles, th e tensile of th e proper undercure is approxim ately proportional to th e tensile ratio and can be used sim ilarly as an index of ra te of cure. A case of this so rt would occur in th e control testing of rubber channel blacks or other pigm ents. On th e o th er hand, although th e m axim um tensiles for different stocks in a series m ay be different, th e cure ra te m ay be sufficiently sim ilar so th a t th e tensile o f a fixed cure in th e m axim um tensile range, say th e 60-m inute cure, m ay be fairly close to th e m axim um tensile for all stocks. In th is event th e tensile ratio w ould be approxim ately equal to th e tensile a t 15 m in u tes/tensile a t 60 m inutes, w hich could th en be used as an index of ra te of cure an d would only require th e m aking of two cures. A possible example of th is ty p e m ight be a series of stocks containing different am ounts of petroleum -type softeners. T h e rate-of-cure results for b o th n atu ral ru b b er and GR-S indicate th a t th e tensile ratio is a satisfactory index of ra te of cure even in a series of stocks containing a widely different v ariety of pigm ents. However, it seems likely th a t th e g reatest usefulness for th e tensile ratio will occur in th e comparison of sim ilar pig m ents or oth er compounding ingredients such as carbon blacks, inorganic pigm ents, softeners, antioxidants, etc., in th e sam e test formula. T he above sh o rt cuts as well as tensile ratio itself are satisfac to ry indexes of ra te of cure only w ithin a set of stocks milled and cured side b y side, such as th e stocks in T ables I and II. In the comparison of stocks n o t m illed an d cured together a reference control is custom arily run a t th e sam e tim e as each stock. The 04 J (/) z a COMBINED SU LFU R AT IS’ CURE |% OF ORIGINAL SULFUR| Figure 5 Figure 6 th e combined sulfur a t th e 15-minute cure expressed as per cent of original sulfur. An index analogous to tensile ratio b u t utilizing tensile p roduct instead of tensile was also found to correlate w ith combined sulfur alm ost as well as tensile ratio b u t was n o t in cluded in th e graph. Prediction indexes listed on th e figures indicate the best correlation for tensile ratio, tim e to reach 85% of m axim um tensile, tim e to reach m axim um tensile, and tim e to reach break in m odulus. T h e highest value for the prediction index is obtained w ith tensile ratio. Since ra te of cure increases as tem p eratu re of cure is increased, a good te st of an index of ra te of cure is th e behavior of th e index a t different cure tem pera tures. In Figure 7, tensile ratio, combined sulfur a t th e 15-m inute cure, and tim e to reach m aximum tensile are plotted against cure tem perature. For these tests C ontinental AA in th e G R-S form ula given in T able I I was used. In addition to th e stocks cured a t various tem peratures, four duplicate stocks were cured a t 307° F . in order to give some indication of the reproducibility of these th ree m ethods. , , ,------ CONTINENTAL A A IN G R -S P. I. T E N SILE RATIO O ---------- — 0.73 COMBINED S U LFU R A — 0.69 TIME TO MAX. T E . X ------------ 0.36 TEN SILE RATIO TIME TO MAX. TE. (MIM) Tt&. AT Igr\ I MAX. TE J COMBINED SULFUR AT 15' 70 \SULFUftJ 60 310 CURE TEMP (°F) Figure 7 20 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING tensile ratio of the individual stocks divided by th e tensile ratio for th e corresponding control should th en be tak en as th e index of ra te of cure. ACKNOW LEDGMENT T he authors wish to th an k M iss B. C. M yerson and Miss M. Sohn for th eir assistance in obtaining th e experim ental d ata. LITERATURE CITED (1) A m . Soc. T estin g M aterials, C om m ittee D - l l , D 297-41T -16b, A .S .T .M . Standards on Rubber P roducts, p. 10 (1943). (2) Columbian Colloidal Carbons, IV, 26 (1943). (3) Fielding, J. I I ., I n d . E n g . C h e m ., A n a l . E d ., 12, 4 -9 (1940). (4) G arvey, B . S ., Jr., and Freese, J. A ., Jr., Sum m ary of U npub lished W ork, Offico of Rubber D irector M em orandum , p. 5 (Aug. 7, 1943). (5) G ibbons, W . A ., G erke, R . H ., and C uthbertson, G . R ., Proo. R ubber T ech . Conference, London, P a p er 36, pp. 8 81-7 (1938). CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 (6) G ibbons, W . A ., Gerke, R . H ., and T ingey, C h e m ., A n a l . E d ., 5, 279-83 (1933). H. C ., I n d . E n o . (7) H aslam , G . S., and K lam an, H . C ., Ibid., 9, 5 5 2 -8 (1937). ( 8 ) K u sov, A ., Kautschuk, 11, N o . 2, 2 4 -7 (1935); Rubber Chem. Tech., 8 , 548 -5 3 (1935). (9) N au gatu ck C hem ical, R eport N-40-1, B una S, p . 9 (Jan. 27, 1942). (10) O ldham , E . W ., Baker, L. M ., and Craytor, M . W ., I n d . E n o . C h e m ., A n a l . E d ., 8 , 4 1 -2 (1936). (11) R oberts, G . L., Proc. Rubber T ech . Conference, L ondon, P aper 54, p p . 5 06 -1 5 (1938). (12) S teven s, H . P ., In d ia Rubber J ., 52, 4 0 1 -3 (1916). (13) Thornhill, F. S ., and S m ith, W . R ., I n d . E n q . C h e m ., 34, 2 1 8 24 (1942) p . 222. (14) Villa, G. R „ I n d ia Rubber W orld, 101, N o . 2, 3 4 -8 (1939). (16) W hitby, G . S., " P lan tation Rubber and the T estin g of R ubber", p p . 320, 340, London, L ongm ans, G reen & C o., 1920. (16) W iegand, W . B ., I n d . E n g . C h e m ., 18, 1157-63 (1926). P before th e N ew Y ork G roup, D ivision of R u b b e r C h em istry , resented Am e r ic a n C h e m ic a l S o c ie t y . Determination of Alpha^ara-Dim ethylstyrene In the Presence of Para-M ethylstyrene, Styrene, and Para-Cymene J O H N H . E L L IO T T a n d E V E L Y N V . C O O K H ercules Experiment Station, H ercules Powder Com pany, W ilm ington, D el. a,p-Dim ethylstyrene can be determined in the presence of p-m ethylstyrene, styrene, and p-cym ene by two independent methods. The chemical method depends upon addition of hydrogen chloride or bromide to the styrenes with subsequent estimation of the tertiary halide formed by a,p-dimethylstyrene. The other method involves an analysis of the ultraviolet absorption curve of such mixtures. Results obtained by these independent methods are in good agreement. CHEM ICAL METHOD T he chemical m ethod of analysis depends upon th e following reaction. If th e addition of H X to a,p-dim ethylstyrene an d pm ethylstyrene follows M arkownikoff’s rule, where X is either Br or Cl, th e following compounds will be formed: X X C H .— ¿ — C H i E E D has recently arisen for a m ethod for th e determ ination of a-jp-dimethylstyrcne in th e presence of p-m ethylstyrene, styrene, an d p-cymene. Since no satisfactory procedures were available for th e analysis of such m ixtures, chemical m ethods, ultraviolet absorption, an d polarographic analysis were consid ered. Prelim inary experim ents on th e last, using th e technique of L aitincn an d W awzonek (I) were n o t prom ising an d this approach w as n o t studied further. I t w as found possible, however, to analyze such m ixtures by a chemical m ethod and also by m eans of ultraviolet absorption. B oth procedures were readily ad ap tab le to control use an d have been successfully applied to th e analysis of a large num ber of samples. H— CHj N In order to te st these m ethods it was first necessary to obtain pure sam ples of the various styrenes and p-cymene. T he a,pdim ethylstyrene and p-m ethylstyrene were synthesized and pu ri fied in this laboratory. A good grade of commercial styrene was vacuum -distilled several tim es before use. T he p-cymene was distilled through a 40-plate column packed w ith 0.23-cm. (’/«-inch) stainless steel helices a t 100-mm. pressure and a reflux ratio of approxim ately 60/1, a middle cu t being coEected and used in th is work. T he halogen in (1), formed from a,p-dim ethylstyrene, is a t tached to a te rtia ry carbon atom , while th a t in (2), formed from p-m ethylstyrene, is attach ed to a secondary carbon atom . The tertia ry halogen in (1) is m uch m ore readily hydrolyzed th a n the secondary in (2), and this fact offers a m eans of analytically de term ining <x,p-dimcthylstyrene in th e presence of p-m ethylstyrene a n d styrene. T here is no reaction of ILX w ith p-cymene. I t has been reported th a t hydrogen brom ide adds rapidly to styrene (2, 10), and th a t th e secondary brom ide formed by nor- Table I. C om po u n d p-C ym ene T he constants of these compounds are given in T able I. The brom ine num bers were run by a modification of th e m ethod of U hrig and Levin (3). T he refractive index results are in good agreem ent w ith the In ternational C ritical Tables values, th e tem perature being con sidered. T he sam ples of th e various styrenes were alw ays freshly vacuum-dlstiUed before being used. S tyrene p -M e th y l8ty re ne ci,p-Dim eth y latyrene Constants of Materials Used in Testing M ethods F o rm u la p -C H i.C iH « .C H (C H ,), C ,H ,.C H :C H t p -C H j. C«H i. C II :CH, p -C H 1 .CflH 4.C (C H ,):C H , r ’d ' 5 1.4913 1.5467 1.5421 1.5356 no (I.C .T .) 1.4947 (15° C.) 1.5467 (20° C .)° 1.5447 (1 6 .4 ° C.) 1.5344 (1 8 .7 ° C.) B rom ine N o. O b served T h e o ry <1 0 151 154 137 135 117 121 * V alue o t M oore, B u rk , a n d L an k elm a (7). 1 January 15, 1944 Table II. ANALYTICAL Determination of a,p-Dim ethylstyrene in Known Mixtures (U sing m eth o d inv o lv in g a d d itio n of H B r) W eig h t of a ,p -D im e th y lsty rc n e O th e r M ate rials P re se n t P re se n t R ecovered Grain Gram N one N one 0.2080 g ra m p -m e th y lsty re n e N one N one 0.1 m l. of benzene, 0.2 m l. of s ty re n e, 0.2 m l. of p -m e th y l sty re n e, 0.5 ml. of p-cym ene 0.2731 0.2131 0 .2 4 0 8 0.2 6 9 3 0 .2 4 1 4 0.4 1 4 7 0 .2 6 1 3 0.2 5 4 5 0.1 9 7 7 0.2 2 1 5 0.2 4 7 7 0 .2 2 4 5 0.3942 0.2 5 2 2 R ecovery % 9 3 .3 9 2 .8 9 1 .9 9 2 .0 9 4 .0 9 5 .2 9 6 .7 25.6% p -m e th y lsty re n e an d 48.8% p-cym ene 0 .0 8 5 4 0.1 0 0 6 0 .0 7 9 6 0 .0 9 2 6 9 4 .2 9 2 .0 m al addition m ay be hydrolyzed under relatively mild condi tions, indicating th a t th e conditions of hydrolysis of th e te rtiary halide m ust bo chosen so as to avoid interference from th e second ary halides present. B ased on these facts, th e following m eth ods have been developed, involving th e addition of IIX , rem oval of excess, followed by hydrolysis, and estim ation of th e tertiary halide formed from a,?j-dim ethylstyrene under conditions where there is no appreciable hydrolysis of th e secondary halide formed from p-m ethylstyrene and styrene. A sam ple weighing approxi m ately 0.5 to 1.0 gram is accurately weighed o u t into a 125-ml. Erlenm eyer flask containing 25 ml. of carbon tetrachloride. Gaseous hydrogen brom ide, generated by dropping brom ine onto naphthalene and purified by passing through several towers of naphthalene and finally one containing D rierite, is bubbled through the sample for 30 m inutes a t a rate of 3 to 4 bubbles per second. A t the end of this tim e th e addition tube is washed down w ith 10 ml. of carbon tetrachloride and a brisk stream of nitrogen is passed through the solution for 30 m inutes to remove unreacted hydrogen bromide. T he flask is then rem oved and chilled in an ice-salt b ath for 10 m inutes. T h irty milliliters of H y d r o g e n B ro m id e M e th o d . EDITION 21 previously chilled 90% alcohol are then added, th e flask is swirled for a few seconds, tw o drops of m ethyl red indicator are added, and the cold solution is rapidly titra te d w ith stan d ard O.liV alco holic potassium hydroxide to a b right yellow end point lasting for 10 seconds. T able II gives the results obtained by this m ethod on known samples. H y d r o g e n C h l o r i d e M e t h o d . T h e procedure is th e sam e as th a t used in th e hydrogen brom ide m ethod w ith th e following changes: Benzene instead of carbon tetrachloride is used as th e solvent. F o rty milliliters of 80% alcohol are used to effect hydrolysis of the te rtia iy halide. The titra tio n is performed a t room tem perature and th e sample titra te d with 0.1 A 'alcoholic potassium hydroxide to a 30-second bright yellow end point. H ydrogen chloride was generated by dropping concentrated hydrochloric acid into concentrated sul furic acid. T h e evolved gas was passed through a tow er filled w ith concentrated sulfuric acid before being passed into the solu tion being analyzed. T able I I I gives th e results obtained b y this m ethod on known samples. T he end points are considerably sharper th a n those given by th e hydrogen brom ide m ethod. Table III. Determination of a,p-Dim ethylstyrene in Known Mixtures (U sing m ethod involving a d d itio n of HC1) W eight of a ,p -D im e th y lsty re n e S ubstances P rese n t P rese n t R ecovered Gram Gram p-C ym cno S ty ren e p -M e th y lsty re n e a ,p -D im eth y lsty ren e a ,p -D im e th y lsty re n e plus 0.5 ml. each of p-cym ene, s ty rene, and p -m e th y lsty re n e N one N one N one 0 .2936 0.4739 0 .4116 0.3077 0.5693 0.4015 0.4052 N one N one N one 0.2740 0.4508 0.3903 0 .2940 0.5415 0 .3855 0 .3902 R ecovery % 93 '.h 9 5 .3 9 4 .7 95.5 * 9 5 .3 ° 9 6 .0 9 6 .2 a HC1 gas a dded for 1 ho u r in ste ad of 30 m inutes as in a ll o th e r cases. Table IV . Sam ple A B C D E F G H A n alyse s by H ydrogen Bromide and H ydrogen Chloride Methods H B r m ethod % 1 9 .6 ,2 0 .2 2 9 .2 ,2 9 .5 2 0 .2 ,1 9 .9 2 0 .5 ,2 0 .4 2 2 .6 ,2 2 .0 1 0 .6 ,1 0 .7 3 2 .8 ,3 2 .6 3 2 .9 ,3 2 .6 H C l m ethod % 1 9 .8 ,2 0 .6 2 8 .2 ,2 9 .3 2 0 .2 , 19.8 2 0 .6 ,2 0 .6 2 2 .6 , 2 3 .3 9 .5 , 9 .5 3 2 .2 ,3 2 .0 3 1 .8 ,3 2 .5 DISCUSSION OF RESULTS W AVELEN G TH IN M IL L IM IC R O N S Figure 1. Ultraviolet A bsorption Curves For a, p-dimethylstyren«,p-methylstyrene, styrene,end p-cymene In ethanol solutions An exam ination of Tables I I and I I I shows th a t som ew hat low recoveries (about 95% ) of a,p-dim ethylstyrene are obtained in every case. Therefore, to correct for th is a factor of 1.05 is used in calculating th e results. T his low recovery of a,p-dim ethylstyrcne is n o t raised by a longer tim e of addition of th e hydrogen halide. I t m ay be due to th e fact th a t a sm all fraction of the addition takes place contrary to M arkownikoff's rule. A con sideration of the results obtained by use of these m ethods in the analysis of over fifty sam ples of know n an d unknow n composition indicates th a t th e precision of th e m ethods is approxim ately =*=3 % of th e a,p-dim ethylstyrene present. Table IV shows the agreem ent betw een th e hydrogen brom ide an d hydrogen chloride m ethods in th e analysis of eight different sam ples of unknow n composition. T he agreem ent betw een th e results obtained b y th e tw o m eth ods is seen to be good. Since th e hydrogen chloride m ethod is som ew hat easier to use and th e end p o in t is sharper, it is recom mended for use. 22 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 ULTRAVIOLET ABSORPTION METHOD \ T he spectrophotom etric m ethod has been successfully applied to the q u an titativ e determ ination of compounds having charac teristic absorption bands in th e ultraviolet region of th e spec trum . Good examples of th is m ethod used in calculating two, three, and four constituents of a m ixture have been reported in th e literature (S-6 ). In m ixtures of pure styrene, «,p-dim ethylstyrene, p-m ethylstyrene, and p-cym ene it was found possible to determ ine th e am ount of each styrene present w ithin 2 % of th e know n value. T he absorption d a ta were obtained from m easurem ents made w ith a B eckm an quartz spectrophotom eter. T he solvent was ethanol in all cases. T he form ulas used in m aking the calulations use th e term specific a : , cl where a = absorption coefficient 70 = inten sity of radiation tran sm itted b y th e solvent I — intensity of radiation tran sm itted b y th e solution c = concentration of solute in gram s per 1000 ml. I = length in centim eters of solution thro u g h w hich the radiation passes T he sam ples of pure a,p-dim ethylstyrene, p-m ethylstyrene, styrene, and p-cym ene used to obtain th e specific absorption coefficients of th e pure compounds were th e sam e as those used in th e developm ent of th e chemical m ethod previously described. Per Cent Com position C om position of M ix tu re of P u re C om pounds M ix tu re C alculated from U ltra v io le t A b so rption D a ta % . 3 0 .8 4 2 .4 2 6 .0 E rro r % 1 .2 0 .4 0 1 <x,p-D im ethylstyrene p -M e th y lsty re n e S ty ren e K now n % 32 42 26 2 a ,p -D im eth y lsty ren e p -M e th y lsty re n e S ty ren e 5 5 90 6 .0 5 .3 8 8 .1 1 .0 0 .3 1 .9 3 « .p -D im e th y lsty re n e p -M e th y lsty re n e S ty ren e 5 90 5 3 .9 9 0 .3 5 .3 1.1 0 .3 0 .3 4 a .p -D im eth y lsty ren e p -M e th y lsty re n e S ty ren e p-C ym ene 25 26 25 24 2 4 .3 2 6 .3 2 5 .9 0 .7 0 .3 0 .9 5 or.p-D im ethylstyrene p -M e th y lsty re n e S ty ren e p-C ym ene 20 30 35 15 2 1 .9 2 9 .4 3 5 .8 1 .9 0 .6 0 .8 h logro y Specific a = Tabic V . Table V I . Samples of Unknown Composition a .p -D im e th y lsty re n e U ltra v io le t a b sorption m ethod C hem ical m ethod Sam ple T he values a t different wave lengths are shown in Figure 1. T he curve for styrene agrees very closely w ith previously pub lished d a ta concerning this com pound (5). % % 2 3 .0 .2 2 .9 2 0 . 0 . 2 0 .2 3 2 .5 , 3 2 .3 2 7 .3 ,2 7 .4 2 1 .7 ,2 2 .3 19.8, 2 0 .3 3 2 .8 , 3 2 .5 2 7 .8 ,2 7 .5 wave lengths there are sufficient differences in a of th e pure com pounds to perm it q u an titativ e calculations. I t is also evident th a t p-cym ene h as its absorption values below 280 m p and th ere fore does n o t appreciably affect absorption values above 280 mp, even though present in q u antities up to 70 or 80% . Q u an titativ e determ inations on three unknow ns require the selection of th ree suitable wave lengths in order to set up three sim ultaneous equations. A t a given wave length, components a, b, and c present in a solution in percentages of x, y, an d z, re spectively, will give a to ta l absorption value w hich can be repre sented by th e equation: M x + Figure 2. Ultraviolet Abso rp tion Curves For a, p-dlmcthylstyrcnc, p-mtUiyltlyrcn«. styrene end p-cymene In ethanol solutions (enlarged scale of spectral region ¡75 to 300 mp) T he styrenes have a strong absorption b and in th e spectral region 248 to 252 m p w ith less pronounced b u t y e t d istin c t bands in th e region to 300 mp. F o r th e th ree styrenes th e bands in th e region 248 to 252 mp are so sim ilar th a t no a tte m p t w as m ade to use them for q u an titativ e determ inations. A larger scale graph of the region 280 to 300 mp (Figure 2), shows th a t a t certain + = “ solution a ., a b , a e represent th e specific absorption coefficients for each of th e pure compounds a t th a t particu lar wave length. B y set tin g u p th ree equations a t different wave lengths, th e percent ages (x, y, and z) of each com ponent can be calculated. Since sim ultaneous equations w ith three or m ore unknowns are custom arily solved b y th e m ethod of determ inants, th e cri terion for th e selection of wave lengths is th a t th e determ inants in th e expressions for th e unknow n concentrations be as large as possible. Likewise, th e individual values of a should be large enough to be m easured w ith accuracy on th e spectrophotom eter. I n know n m ixtures of pure compounds, w ith or w ith o u t pcymene, it was found possible to calculate th e per cent composi tion by using th e absorption d a ta a t wave lengths 285, 291, and 295 m p (Table V). Values calculated from th e absorption d a ta differ from know n values by less th a n 2% . T h e presence of pcymene did n o t interfere w ith th e calculations. T he wave lengths 283, 287, an d 291 m p were found to give ju s t as accurate values as th e previously m entioned wave lengths. I t is th ere fore possible to use tw o sets of wave lengths to serve as checks on each other. F o u r sam ples of unknow n compositions were analyzed for a,p-dim ethylstyrene b y b o th th e chemical and ultraviolet ab sorption m ethods (Table V I). T he agreem ent betw een these independent m ethods is seen to be good. January 15, 1944 ANALYTICAL EDITION 23 ACKNOWLEDGMENTS (5) M iller, E . S., M ackinney, G ., and Zacheilo, F . P ., Ib id ., 10, 375 T he authors wish to express th eir th an k s for the assistance in running analyses given by Jordan P. Snyder and M iss M ary T hom as M ontgom ery. ( 6 ) M itchell, J . H., K ray bill, H . K ., and Zscheile, F . P ., I n d . E n g . LITERATURE CITED (1) Laitinen, H . A ., and W aw zonek, S., J . A m . Chem. Soc., 64, 1765 (1942). (2) M ayo, F . I t . , and W alling, C ., Chem. Rev., 2 7 , 351 (1940). (3) M iller, E . S ., J . A m . Chem. Soc., 57, 347 (1935). (4) M iller, E . S., P la n l P hysiol., 12, 667 (1937). (1 9 3 5 ). C h e m ., A n a l . E d ., 15, 1 (1 9 4 3 ). (7) M oore, B urk, and Lankeltna, J . A m . Chem. Soc., 63, 2 9 5 4 (1 9 4 1 ). (8) P estem er, M ., and W iligut, L., M onalsh., 6 6 , 1 19 (1 9 3 5 ). (9) Uhrig, K ., and L evin, H., I n d . E n g . C h e m ., A n a l . E d ., 13, 9 0 (1 9 4 1 ). (10) W alling, C ., K harasch, M . S., and M ayo, F . R ., J . A m . Chem. Soc., 61, 2 6 9 3 (1 9 3 9 ). before th e D ivision of A n a ly tic al a n d M icro C h em istry a t th e 100th M eeting of th e A m e r i c a n C h e m i c a l S o c i e t y , P ittsb u rg h , P enna. P r e s e n te d Determination of Soluble Pectin and Pectic A c id by Electrodeposition K E N N E T H T. W I L L I A M S A N D C L A R E N C E M . Western Regional Research Laboratory, A lb a n y , In a new approach to the determination of pectin, solutions of pectin or pectates are deashed by the use of ion-exchange resins. The pectin or pectic acid is electrolytically de posited at a platinum anode in a weighable form. The method requires less of the analyst's time and attention than does the calcium pectate method and, with partially purified solutions, gives results of the same order of accuracy. The method is especially applicable to amounts of pectin ranging between 5 and 50 mg. ST IG A T IO N S designed to develop new an d extended uses INforV Epectin have m ade desirable an analytical m ethod capable Since th e soluble pectinous m aterials are negatively charged colloids, it was decided to investigate th e possibility of collecting th e pectin on th e anode of a suitably arranged electrolysis system . Brown (2) unsuccessfully a ttem p ted to precip itate pectin electrolytically from aqueous solutions containing large am ounts of electrolytes. Griggs and Jo h n stin (5) observed flocculation of pectin a t th e anode on electrolysis w ith 110-volt d irect cur rent. T h e authors have found th a t pectin can be q u an titativ ely determ ined by electrodeposition, provided th e electrolyte con centration of th e solution is low. Ion-exchange resins can be used when it is necessary to rem ove th e electrolytes before electro deposition. APPARATUS of determ ining sm all am ounts of pectin. A pproxim ate estim a tions of pectin can be m ade b y p recipitation w ith 70 to 80 per A conventional electrolysis ap p a ra tu s supplied w ith 220-volt cent alcohol or 50 per cent acetone (1, 3, 8, 9). Alcohol and d irect current from a rectifier-transform er u n it was used. A m ercury cathode cell was constructed from a 250-ml. G riffin-type acetone of these strengths precipitate gums, some proteins, and beaker, in to th e side of which was fused a platinum wire (Figure calcium and potassium salts of some of th e organic acids as well 1). A mercury-filled side arm was added to provide flexibility as pectin. However, when d ilute solutions are used th e results in th e connection to th e negative binding post. Clean m ercury are likely to be low because of incom plete precipitation of the completely covering th e platinum wire in the vessel served as the cathode. T h e anode was a disk of 45-mesh p latinum gauze pectin and difficulties in handling sm all am ounts of th e precipi 6.25 cm. (2.5 inches) in diam eter, edged w ith 0.075-cm. (0.03-inch) ta te. T h e alcohol p recipitate is difficult to filter and wash p latinum wire to give rig idity and supported by a 15-cm. thoroughly. T his filtration m ay be im proved b y precipitation (6-inch) piece of 0.127-cm. (0.05-inch) p latin u m wire a t w ith acidified alcohol, b u t a fte r several w ashings enough acid tached to th e center (Figure 1). Sim ilar electrodes are availm ay rem ain w ith the pectin to cause charring when th e precipitate is dried. F ifty per cent acetone yields a precipitate which is m ore easily filtered and w ashed b u t affords little im prove m e n t in accuracy. T he pectic je ct to error acid. T h e calcium p ectate m ethod of E m m et and Carr6 (4), although tedious and tim econsuming, is probably th e m ost reliable of the m ethods in use a t th e present tim e, b u t is no t readily adaptable to very sm all am ounts of pectin because of the large num ber of m anipu lations required. I t has been used throughout this investigation for the analysis of stock solu tions for com parisons w ith the proposed m ethod. T h e proposed m ethod is th e resu lt of a n a t te m p t to devise an accurate m ethod w hich re quires less of the an aly st’s tim e and atten tio n and can be used to determ ine sm aller am ounts of pectin th an the m ethod of E m m et and Carr6. Figure 1. Electrolysis V essel, A n o d e and A n o d e s in H o ld er 24 INDUSTRIAL Table I. AND ENGINEERING CHEMISTRY A system of commercial ion-exchange resins has been used to rem ove electrolytes from pectin solutions in th is laboratory. (The use of exchange m aterials for th e rem oval of ash constitu ents from pectin solutions was first investigated in this laboratory by W. D . M aclay and co-workers who are in vestigating th e efficiencies of various comm ercial prod ucts for th is purpose.) T he I R 100 resin removes the cations b y exchange w ith hydrogen ion, while the IR 4 resin rem oves th e acids which would interfere, by conductance, w ith th e clectrodeposition of pectin. No pectin was lost during this process when th e conditions described below were fol lowed. T h e capacity and regeneration of these resins are described by th e m anu factu rer (7). Electrodeposition of Pectin from Solutions Containing V arious Percentages of A lc o h o l (25-m l. aliq u o ts of sto ck so lu tio n . T im e, 5 hours) A lcohol Content W eig h ts of D eposits M g. M g. M g. M g. % by volume 30 IT .2 1 8 .9 2 0 .6 40 50 60 2 1 .8 22.1 7 .9 7 .6 2 2 .2 8 .5 9 .2 7 .6 7 .1 Table II. T im e H r. 2 3 4 5 6 2 1 .9 5 .7 9 .8 R em arks S olutions becam e h o t. O ne of 4 d eposits d id n o t ad h ere to anode C o m p a ct deposits D eposits n o t co m p act B u lk y deposits Time Required for Electrodeposition of Pectin from 40 Per Cent A lc o h o l Solutions (25-m l. aliq u o ts of sto ck solution) W eights of D eposits A verage M g. M g. M g. M g. 1 9 .9 1 8 .9 2 0 .8 2 1 .8 2 1 .9 2 0 .4 2 0 .5 2 0 .3 22 .1 2 1 .7 1 9 .4 19 .6 2 0 .1 2 2 .2 2 2 .2 1 9 .0 2 0 .3 2 0 .1 2 1 .9 2 2 .1 1 9 .7 1 9 .8 2 0 .3 2 2 .0 2 2 .0 R em arks P recision P recision P recision Precision P recision poor poor fair good good able from platinum m anufacturers. T his electrode system has proved to be m uch m ore satisfactory th an one using either cylindrical or spiral electrodes, since th e m ercury cathode-disk anode system m akes it possible to have all th e solution under the influence of the field w ithout stirring. Ion-exchange resin columns were prepared from 24 X 190 mm. glass tubing constricted to a 6 -mm. o u tlet (Figure 2). T en gram s drained w eight of ion-exchange resin, supported on a glass wool m at, w as used in each tube. T h e cation-exchange column was m ounted so th a t the effluent dripped directly into th e acidabsorbing bed. ELECTRODEPOSITION O F PECTIN FROM LO W -A SH SOLUTIONS T h e following procedure w as found to give a firm deposit th a t adhered very well to the anode: An aliquot of th e aqueous solution containing approxim ately 5 to 50 mg. of pectin was placed in the electrolysis vessel and diluted to 0 8 ml. w ith distilled w ater, and 42 ml. of 95 p er cent ethyl alcohol were added w ith stirring. T o o btain q u an tita tiv e deposition in the sh o rtest tim e, th e alcohol concentration m ust be close to 40 per cent by volum e, as indicated in T able I. P re cipitation of th e pectin a t th is point indicates th a t the electrolyte content is too high an d th a t th e solution m u st be deashed. D uring th e electrolysis the vessel was immersed in a water-ice b a th to prevent an undue rise in th e tem perature of th e solution. T he anode was lowered into th e solution so th a t th e gauze was barely covered and 220-volt d irect cu rren t was applied. The cu rren t varied between 5 and 20 milliam peres, depending on the electrolyte con ten t and th e tem perature of the solution. N o stirring of any kind was employed during th e rim. Occasionally it was necessary to ad ju st th e anode level if the solution had expanded or contracted as a result of changes in tem perature. A t the end of 5 hours th e anode was w ithdraw n from th e vessel and im m ersed in 99 per cent eth y l alcohol for 3 m in u tes an d then in anhydrous ether for 3 m inutes. A very com pact deposit w as obtained, which was fu rth er de h y d rated by th e alcoliol-ether tre atm e n t to a v ery thin uniform film. T his alcohol-ethcr tre a tm e n t p erm itted complete drying in o n e h o u r a tl0 5 ° C. T he electrodes were cleaned by immersion in boiling w ater for a few m inutes, followed by rinsing in distilled w ater. If th e deposit w as pectic acid, th e addition of a little d ilute alkali aided in the solubilization. R em oval of the deposit by ignition in a flame w as avoided because of th e possible danger of changing th e electrode surface. T able I I shows the relation between the tim e of deposition and the weight of the deposit. RE M O V A L OF ELECTROLYTES FROM H IG H -A SH SOLUTIONS Pectin deposition from ex tracts of fru it was unsuccessful because the current was transferred b y th e electrolytes present. T he solution heated up and gas was evolved from b o th electrodes. N o deposit was obtained. Vol. 16, No. 1 Solutions containing 0.4 to 1 .0 m g. of pectin per ml. were deashed in th e follow ing m anner: T h e columns were rinsed w ith two 1 0 - to 15-ml. portions of th e solu Figure 2. Deashing System tion, w ith thorough drain Upper, cation exchange column, age betw een rinses. T he lower, add adsorbing column rinsings were discarded and th e m ain portion of th e solution w as deashed by percolation through the columns a t th e ra te of approxim ately 3 ml. per m inute. T he pectin concentration of th e solution w as unchanged by this trea tm e n t (Table II I ) . T h e pectin solutions trea ted in this m anner were low in ash, ranging from 0.5 to 4 mg. per 100 m l., and successful electrodepositions could be m ade from such solutions. T h e resin system has been used successfully on neu tral, acid, and alkaline aqueous ex tracts of pectin. Table III. Pectin Content of Solutions before and after Ion-Exchange Treatment Source of P e c tin B efore“ M g ./m l. A fte r“ M g ./m l. E x tra c t of whole g ra p e fru it 1 .0 3 1.03 E x tra c t of whole orange 0 .6 4 0 .6 4 E x tra c t of whole apple 0 .4 1 0 .4 0 H igh-ash com m ercial p e ctin 0 .3 5 0 .3 5 o A verago of th re e analyses b y m eth o d of E m m e t a n d C arré (4). Table IV . E x tra c t of W hole G ra p e fru it Electrodeposition of Pectin from A c id Extracts of W hole Fruit after Removal of Electrolytes“ A liquot of O riginal S olution M l. M g. —P e c tin D epositedM g. M g. M g. A verage Mg./rrd. 2 .5 14.2 14.1 14.1 5 .6 5 2 8 .4 5 .0 2 8 .1 2 8 .2 2 8 .0 5 .6 4 10.0 5 7 .8 5 7 .1 5 8 .3 5 7 .7 5 .7 7 O range 5 .0 13 .8 14.4 13.7 1 3 .8 2.7 8 10.0 2 9 .0 2 8 .9 2 8 .7 2 8 .5 2 .8 8 A pple 5 .0 10.9 11.1 11.1 11.1 2 .2 2 10.0 2 1 .4 21 .4 2 1 .8 2 2 .0 2 .1 7 2 5 .0 5 5 .2 5 4 .8 5 6 .7 5 6 .2 2 .2 3 a A verages of trip lica te analyses b y m e th o d of E m m e t and C arré (4) yielded 5.16 m g. of p e ctin p er m l. of g ra p e fru it e x tra c t, 2.57 mg. pe r ml. of orange e x tra c t, an d 1.99 m g. p e r ml. of apple e x tra c t. January IS, 1944 ANALYTICAL Table V . Electrodeposition of Pectic A c id from Extracts of W hole A p p le and Grapefruit after A ce to n e Purification, H yd ro lysis, and Removal of Electrolytes'* E x tra c t ot W hole A pple G ra p e fru it A liq u o t of O riginal S olution M l. 1 0 .0 2 0 .0 5 .0 1 0 .0 ------- P e c tin A cid D ep o sited ------ . M g. M g. M g. M g. 1 0 .7 2 2 .1 10 .6 2 1 .1 1 0 .6 2 2 .1 1 0 .4 2 1 .0 1 0 .7 2 2 .1 10.7 2 1 .5 1 0 .7 1 0 .7 2 1 .2 A verage M g ./m l. 1 .0 7 1 .10 2 .1 2 2 .1 2 a A verages of trip lica te analyses b y m e th o d of E m m e t a n d C arré (4) yielded 1.07 m g. of p eotie acid p er ml. of ap p le e x tra c t an d 2.13 mg. of pec tic acid p e r m l. of g ra p e fru it e x tra c t. A N A LY SE S OF EXTRACTS OF GRAPEFRUIT, O RA N G ES, A N D APPLES T h e flavedo was rem oved from oranges and grapefruit, leaving m ost of the albedo in tact. T h e apples were n o t peeled. T he following m odification of the extraction procedure of M yers and B aker (5) was used: , T he fru it was cu t up an d disintegrated in a W aring Blendor w ith the addition of sufficient w ater and hydrochloric acid to give a th in slurry of pH 1.7 to 2.0. T h e slu rry was th en heated in a w ater b a th a t 85° C. for 30 m inutes an d filtered through analytical grade Celite. T he residual pulp was extracted and filtered twice, m ore in th e sam e m anner. T h e clear extracts were com bined and diluted, if necessary, to a p ectin content of a p proxim ately 1 mg. per ml. A liquots of 100 ml. were tak en for analysis by th e calcium p ecta te m ethod of E m m et an d Carré. E lectrolytes were rem oved from o th er portions of th e solution 25 EDITION b y ion exchange and the pectin was determ ined by electro deposition and by th e calcium pectate m ethod (T able IV ). A nalyses b y th e proposed m ethod gave résulta from 9 to 13 per cent higher th a n those obtained b y the m ethod of E m m et and Carré. N one of th e extracts used in th is stu d y contained starch or dextrins, as indicated by th e absence of an y color form ation w ith iodine solution. I t is probable th a t such interference could be obviated, when necessary, b y am ylolytic tre atm en t prior to deashing. E lectrodepositions of pectic acid were also m ade from deashed aliquots of fru it extracts w hich h ad been subjected to th e sam e prelim inary acetone purification an d hydrolysis as used for calcium pectate determ ination. T hese results w ere in good agreem ent w ith those obtained by th e m ethod of E m m et and C arré (T able V). LITERATURE CITED (1) Assoc. Official Agr. C hem ., “Official and T e n ta tiv e M eth od s of A n alysis” , 5 th ed., p. 340 (1940). (2) B row n, J. C., A m . Vinegar In d ., 2, 14 (1923). (3) Carré, M . H ., and H ayn es, D ., Biochem. J ., 16, 60 (1922). (4) E m m et, A . M „ and Carré, M . H „ Ibid., 20, 6 (1926). (5) Griggs, M . A ., and Johnstin, R u th , I n d . E n o . C h e m ., 18, 623 (1926). ( 6 ) M yers, P . B ., and B aker, G. L., D el. Agr. E xp t. S ta., B ull. 160, T ech . N o . 10 (1929). (7) R esinou s P roducts and C hem ical Co., P hiladelphia, P enna., “T h e A m berlites” . ( 8 ) W ichm ann, H . J., J . Assoc. Official Agr. Chem., 6 , 34 (1922). (9) Ibid., 7, 107 (1923). A nalysis of Petroleum O il-So lu b le Sodium Sulfonates by Adsorption JO H N M. KO CH The A tlan tic Refining Co¡, Philadelphia, Penna. A n adsorption method for separating and estimating the components of oil-soap mixtures has been developed, which compares favorably with aqueous alcoh olic extrac tion analyses in accuracy and precision. It is rapid and convenient and entirely free from emulsion difficulties. H E m anufacture of medicinal w hite oil b y th e tre a tm e n t INofTpetroleum stocks w ith fum ing sulfuric acid, sulfonic acids are formed, some of which rem ain dissolved in th e oil layer after it is separated from the sulfuric acid sludge. U pon neutralizing th e “acid oil” layer w ith alkali, oil-soluble sodium sulfonates are produced. These “m ahogany soaps” are extracted w ith aqueous alcohol an d are fu rth er refined to produce commercially im por ta n t emulsifiers. Products of this ty p e are m arketed principally as a blend con sisting of approxim ately equal am ounts of oil and soap, contam inated w ith sm all am ounts of inorganic m atter. T o control the ratio of oil to soap in these m ixtures, it is necessary to estim ate a t least one of these com ponents. T his m ay be done by separating th e sulfonates from the hydrocarbons b y m eans of some physical process. D istillation is not suitable because of th e relatively high boiling points of th e hydrocarbons, coupled w ith th e unstable character of the sulfonates a t tem peratures in th e neighborhood of 130° C. Since neither of th e com ponents crystallizes readily from their m ixtures or from solutions of th eir blends, crystalliza tion cannot be used to separate them . Because of th e greater solubility of th e soaps in a water-alcohol mixed solvent, unsaponifiable m a tte r o r oil is usually extracted selectively w ith petroleum ether, from soap dissolved in 50 per cent aqueous alcohol solution. M ost of th e oil dissolves in the petroleum e th er an d th e aqueous alcohol retains in solution th e m ajo r portion of th e soap. B y a system atic process of m ultiple extractions, soap an d oil m ixtures can be sep arated com pletely if th e proper conditions are chosen. A rchibald an d B aldeschwieler (2) have described a m ethod of analyzing petroleum sul fonates b y th is ty p e of extraction. Since some of th e separations were found to be incom plete, a fte r em ploying th e standardized procedure, th e au th o rs have described a m ethod of correcting the oil fraction for th e soap contained in it. T h e large num ber of extractions an d m anipulations ordinarily required by th is m ethod are tim e-consum ing, an d severe em ul sion difficulties are encountered w ith some ty p es of sam ples. Selective adsorption can be used to separate m ixtures composed of m aterials having widely different adsorption characteristics, ju s t as selective solvent action is used to separate m aterials of different solubilities. T he adsorption process is often a d v a n ta geous because of its convenience, speed, and freedom from emulsion troubles. An adsorbent m u st be found which will adsorb sodium sulfonates, since oil is n o t easily adsorbed, and th e proper solvent an d displacing ag en t m u st be chosen. Simple adsorption, like simple extraction, is usually inadequate for sh arp sep aration of tw o com ponents. F ractio n atio n of some kind m u st be em ployed to th e b est advantage to achieve q u a n tita tiv e results. T h is p aper presents a new adsorption m ethod which has th e advantages of speed, convenience, an d freedom from emulsion troubles, and which has been found to be especially useful in th is lab oratory for p la n t control work. 26 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING PRELIMINARY EXPERIMENTS Percolation experim ents showed th a t sodium sulfonates could be selectively ad sorbed from n ap h th a solution, an d th a t th ey could, in tu rn , be com pletely displaced from th e adsorbent b y m ethanol. APPARATUS A N D M ATERIALS T he percolation apparatu s, shown in Figure 1, consisted of a 250-ml. separatory funnel, A, a 250-ml. extraction flask, B, and a percolation tube, C. T his tu b e had a 1.5-cm. inside diam eter and was 40 cm. long. _ A delivery tu b e 5 cm. long and 3 mm. in inside diam eter was sealed to the b ottom of th e percolator. In to it a glass wool plug was packed for th e purpose of supporting the adsorbent. J u s t before startin g the percolation, fresh A ttapulgus clay was packed into the percolator by tam ping successive 5-cm. sections of clay tig htly in place w ith a rod. T he clay was 30- to 60-mcsh size an d had been calcined a t 482° C. (900° F.). (Silica gel of 28- to 200-mesh, from th e D avison Chemical Corporation, and Fisher adsorption alum ina for chrom atographic analyses, were tried as sodium sulfonate adsorbents, b u t were found to be less, efficient th a n A ttapulgus clay. T he clay was supplied by th e A ttapulgus Clay Co., 260 South B road St., Philadelphia, Penna. A pproxim ately 35 gram s were used for an analysis.) T he volatility of th e petroleum n a p h th a solvent used in these experim ents was suffi ciently above th a t of the oil in th e sample, Figure 1. Per so th a t the solvent could be completely colation A p p a ratus separated from the oil by evaporation. N ap h th a of 30° to 80° C. (S6° to 176° F.) boiling range, distilled from a paraffinbase crude oil, and A.S.T.M . precipitation n a p h th a (J) of 50° to 130° C. (122° to 266° F .)’ boiling range, were found to be satisfactory. Vol. 16, No. 1 CHEMISTRY is less th a n 0.01 gram. Usually, 15 to 30 m inutes of heating are sufficient. Sim ilar tre a tm e n t is applied to th e soap fraction dissolved in m ethyl alcohol, except th a t a n oven k e p t a t 120° to 130° C. is used to save tim e. T h e w e i g h t s of oil and soap are reported as per cent of sam ple tak en . TEST OF THE METHOD Tw o tests were applied to th is m ethod. F o r th e first test, 40 grams of a refined petroleum sulfonate (sample A, T able II) were separated into an oil and a soap fraction b y th e m ethod of Archi bald an d Baldeschwieler (2). S ettling tim es of from 8 to_ 16 hours were perm itted for emulsions of n a p h th a and aqueous iso propyl alcohol to separate sharply into two layers. T h e oil frac tion, however, had a n ash co n ten t of 0.14 per cent; so it was filtered through A ttapulgus clay to produce a colorless oil which contained no ash, and was, therefore, free of soap. A series of m ixtures of th is oil and th e soap fraction w as prepared, and then analyzed by th e adsorption procedure. T able I contains these analyses and th e corresponding known blend values. Sample _5 consisted of th e extracted sulfonates themselves, w ith o u t th e addi tion of an y oil. In th e second test, a sim ilar series of know n m ixtures wTas pre pared b y blending oil and soap fractions which had been sepa rated from a group of sam ples by th e adsorption m ethod. T he adsorption analyses of these known m ixtures are also presented in T able I. These d a ta indicate th a t th e adsorption procedure gives ac curate analyses of oil-soap m ixtures of widely varying composi tion. As showm by th e analysis of sam ple 5, th e sodium sulfo nates obtained b y aqueous isopropyl alcohol extraction contained only approxim ately 0.3 per cent of oil. T he oil fractions obtained in these adsorption analyses were practically colorless an d free of soap, as indicated b y th e absence of ash following th eir ignition. PRECISION A N D COM PARISON WITH EXTRACTION METHOD A group of five refined soap sam ples was analyzed in duplicate to te st th e precision of th e adsorption procedure (Table II ). These d a ta , together w ith th e results shown in T able I indicate satisfactory reproducibility for m ost purposes. PROCEDURE A pproxim ately 2.0 gram s of sample are accurately weighed into extraction flask B , and dissolved in 25 ml. of petroleum n ap h th a. The solution is transferred to separatory funnel A, ■which is then stoppered. T he stem of the funnel is placed inside .th e open end of percolator C, so th a t it ju s t touches the clay, as shown in Figure 1. U pon opening th e stopcock the solution will percolate down through th e clay, and th e stoppered separatory -funnel will a c t as an autom atic feeding device. T h e percolate issuing from th e bottom of th e clay colum n is caught in th e tared extraction flask. As soon as th e last drop of solution has entered the percolator, th e stem and inside of the funnel are wrashed w ith petroleum n aphtha. These w ashings are charged to th e percolator. The top of the percolator is also w ashed clean of a n y rem n an ts of sample. T hen 100 ml. of n a p h th a are charged to th e separatory funnel and percolated through th e clay using th e same au to m atic feeding arrangem ent described for the solution. If the total n aphtha percolate is clear, it is set aside for evapora tion. If it is cloudy, indicating the presence of unadsorbed soap o r salts, th e combined percolate is ru n through a second percola to r packed with fresh clay. A 100-ml. n ap h th a wash is used as before. T he combined n ap h th a percolate in the tared extrac tion flask is very carefully evaporated on a steam b ath . Oil is prevented from creeping to the outside wall of th e flask by blow ing a gentle stream of a ir into th e flask during th e evaporation. While this operation is taking place, 100 ml. of absolute m ethyl alcohol are percolated through each of the clay colum ns used to adsorb the soaps. T he resulting percolates are collected in a tared extraction flask, and the solvent is evaporated from the soaps in the sam e m anner as was described for th e naphtha. W hen practically all of the n ap h th a has been evaporated from th e oil fraction on th e steam b ath , th e extraction flask is placed in a n oven and kept a t 100° to 105° C. for 15 m inutes, th e n cooled and weighed. T his process of heating in th e oven for 15-minute periods, followed by weighing, is repeated until th e loss in weight Table I. Sam ple N o. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 A n alyse s of Known Blends of W hite O il and Sodium Sulfonates by the A dso rp tion Procedure A ccording to B lend Soap Oil % % 8 0 .4 19.6 6 2 .4 3 7 .6 5 8 .7 4 1 .3 8 2 .5 17.5 100.0 0 .0 10.1 8 9 .9 8 0 .4 19.6 3 5 .0 6 5 .0 5 0 .0 5 0 .0 3 5 .0 6 5 .0 7 8 .7 2 1 .3 8 9 .4 10.6 C om position of S a m p le F o u n d b y A nalysis Soap Oil % % 8 0 .0 2 0 .0 3 8 .0 6 2 .2 5 9 .2 4 0 .9 8 2 .5 17.6 100.0 0 .3 8 9 .7 10.6 19.8 8 0 .1 3 4 .7 6 5 .0 4 9 .7 4 9 .9 6 4 .2 35.1 7 8 .2 2 1 .8 11.2 8 8 .7 ------- , D e v iatio n Soap Oil % % -0 .4 + 0 .4 -0 .2 + 0 .4 - 0 .4 + 0 .5 0 .0 + 0 .1 + 0 .3 0 .0 -0 .2 + 0 .5 + 0 .2 -0 .3 -0 .3 0 .0 -0 .3 -0 .1 + 0 .1 -0 .8 -0 .5 + 0 .5 -0 .7 + 0 .6 S am ples 1 to 5 w ere blended from com ponen ts p rep ared b y aqueouR isopropyl alcohol e x tractio n . S am ples 6 to 12 w ere blended from compon en ts p re p a re d b y A tta p u lg u s clay a d so rp tio n . Table II. Sam ple A Duplicate A dsorption A n alyse s of Refined Soaps C om position b y A nalysis Soap Oil % % 4 6 .4 5 3 .5 4 6 .5 5 3 .8 D e viation Soap Oil % % 0.1 0 .3 B 5 0 .6 4 9 .6 46 .2 4 6 .0 1.0 0 .2 C 5 0 .4 5 0 .8 4 7 .0 4 7 .3 0 .4 0 .3 D 5 1 .2 5 1 .3 4 9 .0 48.7 0.1 0 .3 4 9 .0 4 9 .8 5 0 .3 4 9 .3 0 .8 1.0 January 15, 1944 Table III. Sam ple F G H I J ANALYTICAL Comparison of A n alyse s of Refined Soaps b y the A dsorption and Extraction M ethods /----------- ---------------C om position b y A n aly sis— A d so rp tio n M eth o d E x tra c tio n M eth o d Soap Oil T o ta l Soap Oil T o ta l % % % % % % 5 6 .8 4 2 .7 9 9 .5 5 6 .6 4 3 .1 9 9 .7 6 0 .3 3 9 .1 9 9 .4 5 9 .8 3 9 .6 9 9 .4 5 5 .7 4 4 .4 100.1 5 4 .0 4 4 .8 9 8 .8 5 6 .6 2 4 .8 8 1 .4 5 8 .1 2 3 .4 8 1 .5 6 7 .4 3 2 .8 100.2 6 6 .6 3 3 .4 1 0 0 .0 Table IV . D e v iatio n Soap Oil % % + 0 .2 -0 .4 + 0 .5 -0 .5 + 1 .7 - 0 . 4 -1 .5 + 1 .4 + 0 .8 -0 .6 Resin-D isplacing Power of a Series of Trial Eluants T ria l E lu a n t W eig h t of M a te ria l D isplaced Grama A cetone E th y l a ce ta te D ie th y l e th e r C hloroform E th y len e dichloride N itro m eth a n e C arb o n te tra c h lo rid e C arb o n disulfide 1.4 9 0 0 .7 8 8 0 .7 8 6 0 .0 5 2 0 .6 1 2 0 .5 6 2 0 .1 3 6 0 .0 3 2 R atio of M ate rial D isplaced to R esin on C lay 1 .9 1.0 1. 0 0.8 0.8 0 .7 0. 2 EDITION 27 prepared clay column following th e m ethod described in th e a d sorption procedure. A fter th e clay w as w ashed w ith 100 ml. of petroleum naph th a, 150 ml. of a trial resin elu an t were percolated through th e colum n. T his percolate was collected separately, and th e w eight of m aterial displaced w as determ ined by the m ethod described for soaps. T he ratio of this w eight to 0.781 gram, th e am o u n t of resin in th e percolator charge, was calcu lated. Table IV contains th e d a ta obtained in th is m anner for a series of organic liquids. Im p u re solvents were percolated through an excess of A tta p u l gus clay to rem ove sm all am ounts of w ater and o th er easily adsorbed im purities. Acetone displaced practically all of th e resin and th e sulfonates. E th y l acetate and diethyl e th er displaced a q u a n tity of m aterial practically equal to th e w eight of resin adsorbed. Since th e dis placed m aterial contained negligible am ounts of ash, it was as sum ed to be resinous m atter. E th y l acetate an d diethyl ether were chosen as being th e best resin eluants of th e group tested. 0.0 MODIFIED ADSORPTION PROCEDURES F ive o th er refined soap sam ples were analyzed by b o th th e ex traction m ethod of A rchibald an d Baldescbwieler (2) and th e ad sorption procedure an d the results are compared in T able II I. Samples F and G were from th e same m anufacturer, b u t samples H , I, and J came from three different sources. Sample I was found to contain 18.6 per cent of m aterial which was volatile a t 130° C. T he agreem ent betw een th e tw o m ethods appears to be sa tis factory. T h ey are probably capable of giving equal accuracy and precision on sam ples of this type. SO A PS CONTAINING RESINS Soaps th a t are produced in th e course of medicinal w hite oil m anufacture, as described above, have been found to be p ra c ti cally free of resinous (oxygenated hydrocarbon) components. T here are some products on th e m arket, however, which do con tain resinous m aterials. These sam ples, containing resins in addition to sodium sulfonates an d oil, present a more difficult analytical problem for both th e extraction and th e adsorption m ethods, th a n th e sim pler case of soap an d oil m ixtures. W hereas th e extraction m ethod usually gives som ew hat high results for oil on these sam ples, th e adsorption m ethod gives high results for soap, due to th e adsorption of resins as well as sodium sulfonates on th e clay. Since there is a difference in m olecular stru ctu re and polarity betw een resin and sodium sulfonate molecules, there should also be an appreciable difference in th eir adsorption affinities. If all the sulfonate molecules in a given sam ple are more strongly ad sorbed by clay th a n all the resin molecules, th e la tte r can be se lectively displaced, by th e proper eluant, from a solid on which b oth com ponents are adsorbed. B y a series of tria l experiments, ethyl acetate was found to be a good resin eluant. Several pu b lications (S, 4, 5) have been helpful in choosing eluants. C H O O SIN G THE RESIN ELUANT A sam ple of soap, prepared by treatin g a very naphthenic pe troleum stock w ith concentrated sulfuric acid, followed by neu tralization w ith sodium hydroxide, was separated into its chief com ponents: oil, resins, and sulfonates. T his was done by ex tracting the soap from th e oily m a tte r (oil-resin m ixture) by the aqueous isopropyl alcohol extraction m ethod (2), and th en sepa rating th e resin from the oil by percolating a petroleum nap h th a solution of these com ponents through a column of A ttapulgus clay. T he oil-free resin was recovered from th e clay b y displac ing it w ith absolute m ethyl alcohol. A know n te s t m ixture consisting of 34.5 p er cent oil, 33.1 per cent resin, and 32.4 per cent soap was prepared and then dis solved in petroleum naphtha, an d 25 ml. of this solution, contain ing 2.359 gram s of th e test m ixture, were percolated through a To check these conclusions, and to te st a modified adsorption procedure for soaps of th is type, a group of m ixtures containing known am ounts of oil, resin, and sulfonates was analyzed. The procedure em ployed was th e sam e as th e one previously described, except th a t after th e 100-mi. petroleum n a p h th a wash was per colated through the clay, 100 ml. of th e resin elu an t were perco lated in th e sam e m anner. T h e m ethyl alcohol percolation fol lowed th a t of th e resin eluant. T he results of these analyses are shown in T able V. Table V . A n alyse s of Known Blends of O i l , Resin, and Sodium Sulfonates b y a M odified A dsorption Procedure Sam ple C om position of K now n N o. Oil R esin Soap 1 I 1 2 3 4- % % % % % % 3 4 .0 3 4 .6 3 4 .0 5 5 .0 4 9 .8 5 9 .2 3 3 .0 3 3 .0 3 3 .0 5 .0 1 5 .5 10.9 3 2 .4 3 2 .4 3 2 .4 4 0 .0 3 4 .7 2 9 .9 3 4 .0 3 4 .8 3 4 .2 5 7 .3 5 0 .5 6 0 .5 2 0 .4 3 2 .0 60 .3 5 .7 14.5 4 1 .3 3 3 .0 Table V I. Sam ple 1 2 3 4 5 6 C om position b y A nalysis Oil R esin Soap 11.1 8.8 3 8 .4 3 4 .5 2 9 .5 R esin E lu a n t C hloroform D ie th y l e th e r A cetone D ie th y l e th er E th y l a ce ta te D ie th y l e th e r Comparison of A n alyse s of Soaps Containing Resins by the Extraction and A dsorption M ethods E x tra c tio n M ethod Oily Soap m a tte r T o ta l % % % 9 .9 8 9 .7 9 9 .6 20.1 8 0 .3 100.4 3 0 .5 7 0 .5 101.0 37.1 6 3 .4 100.5 4 2 .9 5 7 .4 100.3 4 9 .8 5 1 .4 101.2 A d sorption M ethod O ily Soap m a tte r T o ta l % % % 9 .8 9 0 .0 9 9 .8 99.1 19.9 7 9 .2 9 9 .4 2 9 .7 6 9 .7 9 9 .9 3 6 .8 6 3.1 4 2 .5 5 7 .9 100.4 5 0 .2 4 9 .8 100.0 D e v iatio n Oily m a tte r Soap % -0 .1 -0 .2 -0 .8 -0 .3 -0 .4 + 0 .4 % + 0 .3 -1 .1 -0 .8 -0 .3 + 0 .5 -1 .6 D iethyl eth er and eth y l acetate were again found to be th e best resin eluants, an d th e modified adsorption procedure using either of these liquids gave analyses of satisfactory accuracy. In th e analysis of petroleum sulfonates containing resins, it is usually sufficient to determ ine th e sodium sulfonate con ten t and th e to ta l am o u n t of oily or inactive m a tte r in th e sam ple. T he aqueous isopropyl alcohol extraction m ethod (2) accomplishes this on sam ples of this type, b u t it is tim e-consum ing. T h e ad sorption m ethod can also be applied to obtain only th e soap and oily m a tte r in these sam ples by sim ply replacing th e petroleum n ap h th a, in th e original procedure, w ith a suitable resin eluant. T h e first percolate will then contain b o th th e oil and th e resins and th e m ethyl alcohol percolate will again contain th e sulfo nates. A series of soaps prepared from a very naphthenic stock, as described above, an d containing varying am ounts of oil and resins, was analyzed by th e isopropyl alcohol extraction m ethod (#) and 28 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING also by the modified adsorption m ethod. E th y l acetate was used as the solvent for th e oily m atter, and m ethyl alcohol as th e eluant for the sodium sulfonates. A comparison of th e analyses is given in T able V I. B oth m ethods gave essentially th e sam e analyses, b u t the adsorption procedure was more rapid an d convenient. A know n blend containing 49.8 per cent oil, 15.5 per cent resin (65.3 per cent oily m atter), and 34.7 per cent sulfonates was an a lyzed by the eth y l acetate-m eth y l alcohol adsorption procedure; 66.2 per cent oily m a tte r and 34.0 per cent soap was obtained. In the case of petroleum sulfonates which are n o t know n to be free of resins, it is therefore advisable to introduce an ethyl ace ta te percolation a t th e end of th e petroleum n a p h th a wash, and before the m ethyl alcohol percolation, to te s t for th e presence of resins. If th e ethyl acetate displaces m aterial which leaves practically no ash after ignition, th e presence of resins is indi cated, and one of the modified adsorption procedures described above should be adopted. CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 ous alcohol from caustic neutralized acid oil in th e m anufacture of medicinal w hite oil, it will be necessary to introduce an eth y l ace ta te percolation as a te s t for th e presence of resins. T h e adsorption procedure can be applied to crude oil-soluble sodium sulfonate products containing appreciable am ounts of w ater and inorganic salts, after first rem oving these components. T his rem oval can be accomplished very conveniently in th e d eter m ination of salt and w ater by th e usual m ethods. F or salt, a precipitation-type m ethod such as A .S.T.M . M ethod D91-40 (I) m ay be used, and for w ater a modified D ean and S tark m ethod is very convenient. A dsorption m ethods should find applications in grease and as p h alt analyses, and in th e separation of m ixtures containing or ganic salts or acids an d hydrocarbons. ACKNOWLEDGMENT T he au th o r wishes to express his appreciation to S. W . Ferris, W . K . Griesinger, and C. E . H eadington for advice an d assistance in th e preparation of th is paper. DISCUSSION T he chief advantages of th e adsorption procedure are freedom from em ulsion difficulties, rapid convenient physical operations, and sharp separations of oil and sodium sulfonate com ponents. Experience in this laboratory has dem onstrated th a t a given adsorption procedure m ay fail to give correct analyses on differ e n t types of sam ples. T he procedure used will depend upon th e adsorption characteristics of th e com ponents in th e refined oilsoluble sodium soap. Unless th e pro d u ct to be analyzed is known to consist entirely of oil and sodium sulfonates, as is nor mally the case, th e m ahogany soaps which are ex tracted b y aque LITERATURE CITED (1) Am . Soc. T estin g M aterials, C om m ittee D -2, R ep ort 1941, M ethod D 91-10, p. 236. (2) Archibald, F . M ., and Baldcschwieler, E . L., I n d . E n o . C h e m ., A n a l . E d ., 13, 6 08 (1 9 4 1 ). (3) Strain, H . H ., "Chrom atographic Adsorption A n alysis” , N ew York, Interscience Publishers, 1942. (4) Strain, H . H ., I n d . E n o . C h e m ., A n a l . E d ., 14, 245 (1942). (5) Zechm eister, L., and C holnoky, L ., “P rinciples and P ractice of Chrom atography” , N ew York, John W iley & Sons, 1941. Quantitative Determination of c/-Galactose by Selective Fermentation W ith S P ecial Reference to Plant M ucilages L O U I S E. W IS E a n d J O H N W . A P P L I N G The Institute of Paper Chemistry, A p p le to n , W is. A simple method has been developed which permits the determination of small amounts of d-galactose in the presence of mannose, glucose, fructose, xylose, arabinose, and glucuronic acid with an accuracy of 9 2 to 9 8 per ce n t ft depends on differential fermentations with two yeasts, Saccharomyces carlsbergensis (N .R .R .L . N o . 3 79) which ferments galactose, and S. bayanus (N .R .R .L . N o . 9 6 6 ) which leaves galactose unfermented. The yeasts have little action on xylose, arabinose, or glucuronic acid, and these C E N T L Y , interest in th e determ ination of galactose has R Ebeen revived because of th e newer technological applications of certain m annogalactan mucilages. T he estim ation of d-galac tose, w hich th u s assum es a new im portance, has alw ays presented difficulties, especially when o th er carbohydrates were present in q u an tity . T he v an der Ila a r modification of th e K ent-T ollensC reydt m ethod (4), w hich depends on th e oxidation of galactose to m ucic acid, is not q u an titativ e. O nly when rigorous precau tions are taken, and when relatively large am ounts of galactose are present, does the procedure give fairly accurate results (/.)). E ver since the earlier investigations of ICluyver (7 ), th e quan tita tiv e estim ation of d-galactose by ferm entation w ith certain yeasts has interested chem ists and microbiologists. K luyver compounds do not interfere with the determination. Reduc ing values of galactose, mannose, and d-glucurone were determined using the M unson-W alker method of analysis. The fermentation techniques were successfully applied to the hydrolysis products of lactose and to certain plant mucilages. The possible application of the method to galactose in the presence of galacturonic acid is being studied with a view toward its use in the analysis of other natural products. found th a t galactose was ferm ented by tw o varieties of Saccharomyces cerevisiae and by a “m ilk sugar y e a st". He also showed th a t Schizosaccharomyces pombe, Torula monosa, an d T. daltila did n o t ferm ent galactose. On th e basis of these differ ences, he proposed a proxim ate m ethod for th e microbiological determ ination of galactose in th e presence of o th er sugars. Among those who used (and modified) K lu y v er’s procedures were Schm idt, Trcfz, an d Schnegg (11), ITopkins, Peterson, an d F red (6), Sherrard and Blanco (IS ), K u rth an d R itte r (9), K u rth (8), S co tt an d W est (12), H arding, N icholson, and G ra n t (5), and, very recently, M enzinsky (10). T he last au th o r showed th a t the strain of Saccharomyces cerevisiae which he used in galactose fer m entation required preconditioning by culturing th e y east on a January 15, 1944 ANALYTICAL galactose-containing m edium . W ith o u t such p retre a tm en t th e y east was unable to utilize galactose. Besides th e yeasts m entioned above, th e following are known to ferm ent galactose: Saccharomyces pastorianus (S), S . m arxianus (3, 6), and S . fragilis {10). O ther yeasts know n to ferm ent th e common hexoses other th a n galactose are S . produdivus (3), S . apiculatus (3), and “Honey B ” yeast (3). These lists are n o t exhaustive. K luyver used the evolution of carbon dioxide as a m easure of ferm entable sugars. L a te r investigators (3, 8) showed th a t a q u an titativ e m easure of the reducing value simplified th e analysis of ferm ented sugar solutions. N otw ithstanding th e extensive w ork on th e selective fermen ta tio n of galactose, the results of relatively few experim ents w ith pure sugar m ixtures have been published an d no a tte m p t has been m ade to determ ine w hether th e m ethods could be applied in th e presence of uronic acids. T h e lim itations and general appli cability of th e ferm entation m ethods are, therefore, indeterm inate. T he presen t stu d y shows th e usefulness of th e microbiological m ethod. EXPERIMENTAL T he objects of the presen t investigation were to examine, more critically th a n heretofore, th e application of differential fermen tatio n s to know n sugar m ixtures, noting th eir lim itations, and to develop a proxim ate biochem ical m ethod for th e determ ina tion of galactose in the hydrolyzates obtained from mucilages and hemicelluloses. Several strain s of S. cerevisiae, cultured in th e laboratories of T he In s titu te of P ap er C hem istry, h ad been shown to ferm ent galactose q u an titativ ely in 1937 b y K u rth (3). In 1942, how ever, q ualitative experim ents w ith these sam e strain s showed Figure 1 EDITION 29 th a t none ferm ented 1 p er cent galactose solutions completely w ithin 190 hours. I t is evident th a t strain s of S . cerevisiae m ay lose th eir potency as galactose ferm enters w ith tim e, unless spe cial precautions are tak en to recondition them . Torula datlila appeared a t first to give fairly prom ising results as a nonferm enter of galactose. A bout 92 to 95 p er cent of the galactose (in a 1 per cent solution), when treated w ith Torula datlila, could be recovered a fte r 2 days a t 30° C., b u t only about 80 per cent rem ained a fte r a 5-day ferm entation period. W hen ever th e concentrations of galactose dropped to 0.1 p er cent, the sugar was rapidly destroyed. T he use of these organisms was discontinued in favor of tw o in teresting yeasts obtained from L. J . W ickerham , N o rth ern R e gional R esearch L aboratory, Peoria, 111. These were Saccharo myces carlsbergensis var. mandshuricus, N .R .R .L . N o. 379 (origi nally obtained from C harles N . F rey of th e Fleischm ann L abora tories in 1940), a highly ferm entative strain acting on dextrose, galactose, and some of th e common disaccharides, and S . bayanus, N .R .R .L . No. 966 (also originally obtained from F rey in 1940), which was known to ferm ent dextrose, sucrose, and m altose, b u t which, qualitativ ely a t least, had no effect on galactose. N either yeast had (during th e p ast three years) been k e p t on galactose media. These organism s proved entirely satisfactory. N either had more th a n a slight effect on arabinose, xylose, an d glucuronic acid. No. 379 ferm ented d-glucose, m annose, fructose, and galactose alm ost q u an titativ ely w ithin 48 hours. N o. 966 fer m ented the first three readily w ithin th e sam e tim e period and showed no action w hatsoever on galactose. These differences led to th e developm ent of a satisfactory proxim ate m ethod based on differential ferm entations, in which th e M unson-W alker reduc tion m ethod (3) was used w ith o u t m odification. In aliquot portions, ta k en from ferm entation m ixtures, 20 to 125 mg. of galactose could be determ ined w ith an accuracy of 92 to 98 per cent, even when o th er sugars were present originally in g reat ex cess. T he yeasts were m aintained in good condition by m onthly transfers on glucose ag ar (Bacto-D extrose agar, dehydrated). T hey have shown no decrease in potency over a period of 8 m onths. A gar sla n t cultures, 2 to 7 days old, were used for the preparation of th e suspensions required in inoculating th e sugar solutions. T he following procedure w as th e sam e for either yeast. A bout 2 ml. of sterile w ater were pipetted into th e tube con taining th e agar slan t culture, and th e surface grow th was re moved gently oy m eans of th e pipet, which also served to stir the suspension briskly. F o r each b o ttle slant of glucose agar re quired, 0.5 ml. of th e suspension was rem oved and spread over th e surface by tilting th e b o ttle back and forth. Eight-ounce, narrow -m outh, square, flint glass bottles w ith molded screw caps were used as containers for sterile w ater, y east suspensions, and b o ttle slants. Thereupon, th e slants were incubated for about 48 hours a t 30° C. One b ottle slan t easily furnished enough inoculum for four subsequent sugar analyses, because a dense grow th of y east cells coated th e agar surface a t th e end of th e 48-hour period. A bout 10 ml. of sterile w ater were added to th e b o ttle slant, and th e b ottle was tilted back and forth to loosen th e growth. A bout 5 ml. of th e dense y east suspension were p ip etted into a sterile dilution bottle, and 20 to 30 ml. of sterile w ater were added. T he exact am ount of w ater depended upon the tu rb id ity shown b y a Ceneo-Sheard-Sanford photelom eter. Suspensions whose readings fell w ithin th e range of 10 to 16 on this instrum ent, when distilled w ater gave a reading of 90, subsequently ferm ented sugar m ixtures satisfactorily. If the initial photelom eter reading fell below 10, more w ater was added and thoroughly mixed w ith th e suspension. W henever th e photelom eter reading exceeded 16, more y east suspension w as added. In practice it was found b e tte r to w ork w ith too dense th a n w ith too light a suspension. T h e density range listed above was shown b y p late counts to approxim ate 35,(KK>,000 cells p er ml. T h is density also corre sponded roughly to th a t of barium sulfate suspension prepared by mixing 5 ml. of a stock solution of 10 gram s of barium chloride di h y d rate p er liter of w ater w ith 55 ml. of 1 p er cent sulfuric acid and allowing th e m ixture to sta n d a t least a week in a sealed con- INDUSTRIAL 30 Table I. ENGINEERING A c tio n of Yeasts on Pentoses after a 6 -D a y Incubation Period Pentoses P rese n t in A liq u o t M g. 12.5 12.5 12.5 12.5 12.5 12.5 AND (xylose) (xylose) (xylose) (arabinose) (arabinose) (arabinose) T re a tm e n t C o n tro l O rganism O rganism C o n tro l O rganism O rganism CuaO O b tain ed in M unson-W alker D e term in a tio n s Mg. 2 6 .3 2 0 .8 2 2 .3 2 8 .6 2 6 .7 2 6 .7 379 966 379 966 tainer. I t was found expedient to use 25 ml. of sugar solutions in th e ferm entations and to carry o u t all experim ents in 125-ml. Erlenm eyer flasks. T he to tal reducing sugar in such solutions never exceeded 2 per cent, and the galactose concentration was ordinarily k ept w ithin th e range of 40 to 250 mg. per 25 ml. To the sugar solution were added 15 ml. of a filtered y east extract. (Red S ta r starch-free yeast cake was mixed w ith sufficient dis tilled w ater to yield a 10 per cent suspension. T his was heated for 1 hour in an Arnold sterilizer a t about 100° C. and subse quently for 20 m inutes a t 15 pounds’ pressure (a t 121° C.). T he cooled suspension was filtered several tim es through fluted filter paper using Cellite to clarify the solution. O rdinarily the y east extract formed a slightly turbid solution. T his was dis pensed in 80-ml. portions into Erlenm eyer flasks, w hich were plugged w ith cotton and heated a t 15 pounds’ pressure for 20 m inutes. T he cooled flasks of sterile y east extract can be stored for m onths w ithout change in a refrigerator.] T h e sugar and y east extract m ixtures, w hich showed a p H of a bout 5 to 6 (alkacid paper), were then sterilized a t 15 pounds’ pressure for 15 m inutes, cooled to about 30° C., inoculated under aseptic conditions w ith 10 ml. of the appropriate y east suspen sion, and incubated a t 30° C. for a minim um of 48 hours. Tlie ferm entations were always run concom itantly in pairs, under identical conditions, one flask being inoculated w ith organ ism 966 and the other w ith organism 379. T hree or four times during the incubation period, the flask was ro tate d gently to bring the bottom yeasts into intim ate con tact w ith the sugar solution. A t the end of the fennentatio n period, each solution was diluted to 100 ml. w ith distilled w ater, thoroughly mixed, and filtered through tw o No. 50 W hatm an filter papers. Twenty-five to 50ml. aliquot portions of the clear, pale yellow filtrates were tak en for analysis by th e usual M unson-W alker technique. (C are m ust be tak en to digest th e asbestos used in Gooch crucibles thoroughly w ith h o t Fehling solution, an d w ith concentrated n itric acid. T o prevent la te r clogging of Gooch crucibles, such treatm en ts should be continued u n til asbestos filter pads perm it the rapid filtration of h o t Fehling solution containing th e filtered y east extract referred to above.) T h e w eight of cuprous oxide resulting from the ferm entation w ith organism 379 was subtracted from th a t obtained by th e use of organism 966. T he galactose equivalent was calculated by the use of the galactose-cuprous oxide graph (Figure 1) draw n from d a ta obtained experim entally with pure galactose. (The mannose values given in Figure 1 were obtained from pure dknannose; the glucose values were taken from M unson and W alker’s tables.) T he effects of S . carlsbergensis an d S . bayanus on sm all am ounts of xylose an d arabinose were shown to be relatively unim portant, even a fter a n incubation period of 144 hours instead of th e usual 48-hour period. T his is indicated in T able I (and T able II). Inasm uch as the n e t reducing values in all differential galactose determ inations were obtained b y su b tractin g th e w eight of cu prous oxide found a fter ferm entation w ith organism 379 from th a t found after a ferm entation w ith organism 966, th e over-all error resulting from th e presence of pentoses is negligible. F u r therm ore, th e au th o rs’ q u an tita tiv e ferm entation periods seldom exceeded 2 days, w hich presum ably would resu lt in a lessened action on th e pentoses. Because glucuronic acid m ay be a m inor com ponent of hemicellulose hydrolysis, the effect of d-glucurone in th e galactose analysis w as determ ined. Figure 2 shows th e reducing values in milligrams of cuprous oxide p lotted ag ain st th e weights of glucurone (m elting point 174-5° C.) tak e n for analysis. Over a fairly wide range, this curve is practically coincident w ith th a t of glucose. T he action of organisms 379 and 966 on glucurone % CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 was found to be very slight an d th eir over-all effect in differential ferm entations of galactose was alm ost negligible. T his is indi cated in th e la st row of T able II. O rientating experim ents were also carried o u t w ith purified galacturonic acid, which rem ains v irtually u n attack ed by either organism, even when only sm all am ounts of th e acid are present in th e usual ferm entation m ixture. T he reducing value (M unson-W alker) of 12.5 mg. of galacturonic acid was shown to be 23.0 mg. of cuprous oxide; when neutralized, sterilized, inocu lated, and incubated in th e usual m anner, 20.7 mg. and 20.2 mg. of cuprous oxide were obtained w ith organisms 379 and 966. H ere again th e “ error” is cancelled. T he value an d lim itations of th e selective differential fermen tatio n s in th e determ ination of galactose are clearly shown in T able II . T h e first and last columns of th is tab le should be com pared. Invariably, in th e higher concentrations, galactose shows a slight b u t persistent residual reduction a fte r ferm entation w ith organism 379. W hether this is due to very sm all am ounts of un ferm ented galactose or (w hat is m ore probable) to th e slight re ducing pow er of th e products of th e ferm entation is n o t known. T he error is never very appreciable, b u t it accounts for th e fact th a t galactose recoveries are usually som ew hat low. Organism 966 is w ith o u t effect on galactose. Fisure 2 In order to determ ine w hether galactose could be satisfactorily determ ined in th e hydrolyzate of a disaccharide, pure lactose was heated w ith 2 per cent sulfuric acid a t th e boiling po in t for 2.75 hours. T he solutions wrere nearly neutralized w ith solid sodium carbonate (pH a b o u t 5, alkacid te s t paper). A liquot portions representing, in each ease, 125 mg. of lactose (hydrate) were sub- January 15, 1944 Table II. 1 G alactose T ak en M g. 125 125 125 150 (F erm en ted 72 hrs.) ANALYTICAL EDITION Galactose Determination A lo n e and in Mixtures of Pure Sugars 2 O th e r C om pon en ts M o. N one N one N one N one 3 CusO O b tain ed a fte r F e rm e n ta tio n w ith N o. 966 Mg. 24 7 .0 25 0 .1 2 4 7 .3 29 2 .6 N one N one M annose 125 M an n o se 125 6 2 .5 45 25 20 M annose M annose M annose M annose 62.5 80 100 230 N one Negligible <1 126.6 9 1 .2 4 9 .5 37 .1 4° C ujO O btained a fte r F e rm e n ta tio n w ith N o. 379 M g. 2 .6 5 .7 4 .5 6 .0 N one Negligible <1 1 .7 1 .6 0 .5 N one 5 G alactose N et R ecovered W eight of (C alcd. from C ujO , 5, b y U se of 3 -4 Figure 1) Mo. 24 4 .4 24 4 .4 24 2 .8 286.6 N one N one M o. 123.5 123.5 123.0 146.5 N one N one 124.9 8 9 .6 49 3 7.1 61 .5 4 2 .5 2 3 .5 18.5 40 ( M annose 40 ■<G lucose 40 ( X ylosc 5 88 8 .8 (due to xylose) 7 9 .2 3 7 .5 40 ( M annose 20 <G lucose 20 ( X ylose 45 173 9 2 .0 6 (due to xylose) 8 1 .0 3 8 .5 1 .6 4 9 .6 31 by control experim ents w ith pure sugar solutions th a t had been tre a te d w ith 2 p er cent sulfuric acid for 6 hours. One h undred m illigram s of m annose yielded 217 mg. of cuprous oxide be fore an d 2 1 0 mg. of cuprous oxide a fte r acid treatm en t. T he m annose reversion p ro d u c ts,' however, h ad no effect on th e galactose d eter m ination. T he acid -treated m annose ferm ented com pletely w ith o u t reducing value. G alactose appeared to be unaffected by th e action of 2 per cent sulfuric acid; 1 0 0 mg. of galactose yielded 200.5 mg. of cuprous oxide before an d 201.0 mg. of cuprous oxide after acid treatm en t. T able I I I gives th e yields of galactose (cal culated as galactan on th e oven-dry, ash-free basis) of several endosperm mucilages, some of which have d istin ct technological interest. DISCUSSION Assuming a m odicum of microbiological con trol, th e relative sim plicity of th e differential ferm entation m ethod for galactose has obvious f F ru c to se 3 0 .0 30 6 0 .5 N one 6 0 .5 2 9 .0 \ M annose 7 5 .5 advantages over th e older m ucic acid procedure. 3 7 .5 G lucurone 12.6 101 .5 5 2 5 .7 5 c 7 5 .8 3 6 .0 I t requires less m aterial for analysis, less a tte n (duo to glucurono) tion on th e p a rt of the analyst, and is less subject « U nless otherw ise s ta te d , figure in colum n 4 rep resen ts e rro r d u e to in com plete fe rm e n ta to fluctuations w ith slight variations in technique. tio n of galactose o r to presence of sm all a m o u n ts of red u cin g su b sta n c es a m ong galactose fe rm e n ta tio n p ro d u c ts. I t also appears to be more accurate. b R ecovered (using A llih n ’s fa c to r), 40.7 m g. of xyloBe. S . carlsbergensis (organism N .R .R .L . N o. 379) c R ecovered, 13 mg. of gluourone. _____ requires no reconditioning to galactose, such as th a t required by certain strain s of S . cerevisiae. Organism N .R .R .L . N o. 379 ferm ents jected to differential ferm entation. T h e galactose values found galactose readily, despite th e fa c t th a t th is sugar has n o t been were 62.5 and 62.5 mg. ( o 126.5 and 126.6 mg. of cuprous oxide); used as a n u trie n t in its culture. In th e a u th o rs’ brief experience, th e calculated value is 62.5 mg. of galactose. S . carlsbergensis does n o t lose its potency on transfer. I t was as T he effect of fructose on th e galactose determ ination is neg active in ferm enting galactose after 8 m onths of culture as it was ligible. Fructose, when present in large am ount, shows a per on receipt from Peoria. S . bayanus, although a powerful hexose sistent reducing value a fter ferm entation w ith eith er organism. ferm enter, leaves galactose practically untouched. T h is differ Inasm uch as these copper values were practically identical for ence in behavior should m ake for a n ideal com bination of m icro b oth N o. 379 and No. 966, th e errors cancelled each other. In organisms. On th e oth er hand, th e galactose ferm entation by a set of ferm entations w ith fructose alone, 250 mg. of this sugar N o. 379 leads to products w hich have a slight reducing value (as yielded 7.1 mg. of cuprous oxide a fter ferm entation w ith No. 966, shown in T able II ). A lthough v ery slight, th e error th u s caused an d 6.9 mg. of cuprous oxide a fte r tre atm e n t w ith No. 379. m u st be tak en into account. T he reduction is also su b ject to Acid hydrolyzates of polysaccharides (such as gums or hemim inor fluctuations. In general, it leads to galactose values th a t celluloses) are ordinarily neutralized w ith purified barium car are slightly low. bonate. To avoid the introduction of barium ion, which m ay or T he usefulness of the m ethod in its application to certain gums m ay n o t be deleterious to yeasts, sodium carbonate w as used in and mucilages is m anifest. In the case of th e endosperm muci lowering th e acidity of th e sugar solutions. T hese were never lages, independent determ inations of m annose (7), coupled with rendered alkaline. Alkacid te st paper showed th a t th e p H was th e figures given in T able I I I , account for 94 to 97 p er cent of a b o u t 5 to 6 , w hich experience had shown to be satisfactory for th e to ta l hydrolyzates. T he possible application of th e galactose y east ferm entations. R elatively large am ounts of sodium sul fate had practically no effect on eith er th e ra te of ferm entation of m ethod to th e hydrolysis products of pectins, in w hich galacthe sugar or on the results of th e M unson-W alker determ ination. turonic acid residues predom inate, is under investigation. How25 ( F ru cto se 25.0 \ M annose 62.5 5 1 .2 T he above analytical m ethod was applied to a series of m annogalactan mucilages isolated from the endosperm s of various seeds b y extraction w ith hot w ater, filtration, and precipitation w ith ethanol. T he dried mucilages were hydrolyzed by boiling for about 6 hours w ith 25 ml. of 2 per cent sulfuric acid. T he solutions were cooled, brought to a p H of 5 to 6 writh solid sodium car bonate, and subjected to the differential ferm enta tion w ithout rem oving the solution from th e 125-ml. flask. T h e analyses were made as usual on 25- or 50-ml. filtered aliquots tak en from th e ferm enta tion m ixtures th a t had been diluted to 1 0 0 ml. T he sugar yields found in such hydrolyses should be considered m inim al values. Significant am ounts of m annose were lost on hydrolysis, b u t galactose appeared to be largely unaffected. T his was shown 2 3 .8 Table III. Galactan Content of Plant M ucilages M ucilage G a lac ta n , % M ucilage G a lac ta n , % G uar 1 (Cyam opsis tetragonalobus) 3 7 .8 ,3 8 .2 ° 3 7 .4 ,3 7 .6 ° A rab o g alactan (from W . L archw ood) 7 9 . 4 , 7 9 .5 » 80.1 P alo v erd e (C ercidium torrcyanum ) 2 1 .3 ,2 1 .9 « T a ra (Cacsalpinia spinosa) 2 6 .2 , 26 .4 « 1 8 .2 ,1 8 .9 ° H uizache ( C aesalpinia cacaloca) 2 7 . 7 , 27.3» 2 6 .2 ,2 6 .8 ° 2 5 .4 ,2 5 .6 ° Sophora japonica G uar 2 3 3 .8 , 3 4 .4 ° L ocust b ean (Ceratonia ailiqua) 2 0 .0 19.9 H oney lo cu st (Gleditsia Iriacanthos) 2 6 .0 2 5 .9 F la m e tre e (D elonix regia) K e n tu ck y coffee bean ( Gymnocladus dioica) 15.6 ° D u p lic a te d ete rm in a tio n s on aliq u o ts fro m sam e fe rm e n ta tio n a re given on sam e line. 32 INDUSTRIAL ANÖ ENGINEERING ever, a few prelim inary experim ents indicate th a t galacturonic acid is affected b u t little by either organism. ACKNOW LEDGM ENT G rateful acknow ledgm ent is m ade to L. J. W iekcrham of the N orthern R egional R esearch L ab o rato ry for his cooperation in supplying the organisms, and to E d a N ihlen of T he In s titu te of P aper C hem istry for draw ing Figures 1 and 2 of th e text. LITERATURE CITED (1) Anderson, Ernest, U n iversity of Arizona, unpublished data. (2) A ssoe. Official Agr, Chem ., Official and T en ta tiv e M eth od s of A nalyses, 5th ed., p. 500, 1940. (3) Fisher, E ., and Thierfelder, H ., B er., 27, 2031 (1894). (4) H aar, A. W . v a n der, “A nleitung zum N achw eis, zur T rennung und B estim m u ng der M onosaccharide und A ldehydsaüren” , p. 123, Berlin, Gebrüder Borntraeger, 1920. CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 (5) H arding, V . J., N ich olson , T . F ., and G rant, G . A ., J . B iol. Chcrn., 99, 625 (1933). ( 6) H opkins, E . W ., Peterson, W . H ., and Fred, E . B ., J . A m . Chem. Soc., 5 2 ,3 6 5 9 (1 9 3 0 ). (7) K luyver, A . J., dissertation, “B iochem ische Suikerbcpalingen", T echnische H oogeschool, D elft, 1914. ( 8 ) Ivurth, E . F ., unpublished data, T he In stitu te of Paper C hem istry. (9) K urth, E , F ., and R itter, G . J., J . A m . Chem. Soc., 56, 2720 (1934). (10) M enzinsky, G ., Svensk P apperslidn ., 45, 421 (1942). (11) Schm idt, E ., Trefz, F ., and Schnegg, II., B er., 59, 2635 (1926). (12) S eott, M ., and W est, E . S., Proc. Soc. E xptl. B iol. M ed., 34, 52 (1936). (13) Sherrard, E . C ., and B lanco, G . W ., I n d . E n g . Chem ., 15, 611 (1923). (14) W ise, L . E ., and P eterson, F . C ., Ibid., 22, 362 (1930). P resented th e A before th e D ivision of S ugar C h em istry a t th e 106th M eeting of C h e m i c a l S o c i e t y , P ittsb u rg h , P enna. m e r ic a n Use of the Discriminant Function in the Comparison of Proximate Coal Analyses W . D. B A T E N A N D C. C . D e W IT T M ichigan State C o llege , East Lansing, M ich. Comparing a number of analyses of a material from one source with analyses of similar material from another source has heretofore presented a very real problem. The present paper applies statistical methods to the comparison of proximate analyses and B.t.u. per pound of coal from two mines. This statistical analysis b y random sampling shows the probability that two coals come from the same source. The discriminant function developed b y Fisher is used. By means of this function a comparison may be obtained between analytical data based on material from one source and data on similar material from a different source. In addition, the order of significance of the several analytical constituents in a single series of samples may be deter mined. The method Is capable of general application. cance betw een th e constituents of w hich th e compounds are formed. T h e com pound for the first m ine is: X = &1X1 + hx? - f 63X3 + biXt where Xi, Xj, x 3, an d x t represent, respectively, B .t.u ., per cent of volatile m aterial, p er cent of fixed carbon, an d p er cent of ash, and 61, 62, b3>an d 6, are constants to be found. T h e variables xi, X2, Xz, and xt m ay be correlated. T h e com pound for th e second m ine is X ' = b & l + 62X3 + ¡13X3 + b tx i where x j, x^, x'3, and xi represent, respectively, th e above sim ilar m easurem ents; th e coefficients are th e sam e as in com pound X . T he difference betw een th e m eans of th e above two comptmnds m ade up of th e four m easurem ents is E R (8), in 1936, developed th e discrim in an t function for FIStheH com parison of m ultiple m easurem ents obtained in taxo nomic problems. Since th en three papers (3, 4 , 5) have appeared which, m ake use of F isher’s technique. T h e present paper is concerned w ith th e application of th e discrim inant function to th e differentiation of two series of proxim ate coal analyses and th e B .t.u. per pound of coal. E ach series of an alytical d a ta is from a different mine. E ach series consists of 100 sam ples of coal. T h e proxim ate analysis, covering the volatile m a tte r, fixed carbon, per cent of ash, as well as th e B .t.u. per pound of coal, is used in m aking the comparison of th e coal from these mines. T he sam ples were taken from cars of coal sent to th is college over a period of several years, an d th e analyses are reported on sam ples dried a t 105° C. T h e analytical d ata, while accurate, indicate th a t th e m ethods of sam pling m ay be questioned. T h e value of the present approach is, however, n o t in th e d a ta reported b u t in th e application of statistical procedures to comparison of sim ilar chemical data. T h e discrim inant function enables one to o btain a numerical com parison of th e coals by th e use of tw o linear compounds or equations in w hich th e effects, in th e present instance, of all four o f these m easurem ents are combined. F u rth er, th e application of th is fimction to these analytical d a ta perm its a te st for signifi I) — 61'h -f- b^di T b$d3 T btdt (1 ) w here d 1 — x l — x ', d , = x a — x 3, d3 = x 3 — x 3, and = x^ — x i, and x t , x,2, x3, an d x 4 represent th e arithm etic m eans of the respective m easurem ents m ade of th e coal from th e first m ine an d x ', x ', x ', and x i represent th e m eans of sim ilar m easure m en ts m ade on th e coal from th e second m ine. Table I. Measurements of B.t.u., Per Cent of V o la tile M aterial, Per Cent of Fixed Carbon, and Per Cent of A s h for M ines A and B B.t.u., XI 13,000 13,700 12,800 12,300 14,100 13,900 Av. 13,110 ----- Mine A--------Vola tile Fixed matter. carbon, Xt Per cent ash, xt Xi 25.7 25.0 23.0 22.8 33.5 04.3 64.2 60.2 59.9 60.2 7 .9 S .4 10.0 12.9 5.9 2 7 !3 28.33 59.4 61.16 8^3 8.71 ------Mine B--------Per Vola tile Fixed cent ash. B.t.u., matter, carbon, < < 13,600 33.0 59.6 0 .5 14,300 36.9 6.2 56.3 35.5 12.9 13,000 50.9 34.9 14,000 58.7 5 .8 13,700 30.1 59.3 10.0 13,800 13,596 35.2 34.00 5Ü 8 56.28 9 .2 8.65 January 15, 1944 ANALYTICAL EDITION 33 T able I contains a few m easurem ents from m ines A and B, taken a t random from the sets of observations. T h e m eans of th e 1 0 0 m easurem ents on each of four properties are given in th e last line of th a t table. (C) 6, - 0 . 04927762 + (D) - 6 , - 0.0040536, - L et (A ) - S = 6 Js,i + b%$i2 + &3S33 + 6 Js„ -f- 2 &1&2S12 + 26,6,Si, + (J?) - (C) (B ) 0.0894186, - — 0 .0 0 9 7 5 8 & 2 + 0.0410916, = -0 .0 0 0 2 3 6 0.0060316, + 0.0107826, = 0.000000 0 .0 0 8 7 7 3 6 , + 0 .0 0 0 8 8 5 6 , = -0 .0 0 0 0 3 3 0.0623106, - 0.097644&3 + 0.0364816, = 0.000282 26 , 6,S i, + 2626,32, + 26261.521 + 26363831 (C) + (D) where 100 s<i = Y k =1 _ ~ *»)(*/.» - _ 100 x i) + Y (A) where k is the variable of sum m ation. 1 and j — 1 is _ 100 (*<■* ~ x i ) ( x f.k ~ x 'i) k= 1 T he value of s,,- when i = 100 (*>•* ~ x *)*+ Y sii = Y k=1 - O. O 5 3 3 3 O62 + 0.0833876, - 0.0303096, = -0 .0 0 0 2 3 6 D ividing eacli equation by th e absolute value of th e coef ficient of 62 in it gives: (*!•* “ I >')2 k= 1 -6 2 + 0.8990576, + 0.0906956, = -0 .0 0 3 3 8 2 (F) 62 - 1.5670686, + 0.5854766, = (G) - 6 2 + 1.5636046, - 0.5683296, = (F ) + (F) - 0.6680116, + 0.6761716, (F) + (G) - 0.0034646, + 0.017146, 0.004526 -0 .0 0 4 4 2 5 = 0.001143 = 0.000101 In our case th is q u a n tity is (using values in T able I) found as follows: D ividing each equation b y th e absolute value of th e coefficient of 6 , in it gives: s„ = (13,000 - 13,110)* + (13,700 - 13,110)* + . . . + (13,900 13,110)* + (13,600 - 13,596)* + (14,300 - 13,596)* + . . . + (13,800 - 13,596)* = 20,110,000 + 17,718,400 = 37,828,400 (H) - 6 , + 1.0122156, = 0.001711 (7) - 6 , + 4.9500586, = 0.029157 (if) - (7) -3 .9 3 7 8 4 3 6 , = -0 .0 2 7 4 4 6 ; 6 , = 0.006970 T he value of % where i = 2 and j = 3 is _ 100 «23 = Y - _ Xl)(.X3.k — Xi) + k =1 100 Y (X^ k - x D ( x i.k - x i) k= 1 B y using the values in T able I th is is s., = (25.7 - 28.33) (64.3 - 61.16) + (25.0 - 28.33) (64.2 61.16) + . . . + (27.3 - 28.33) (5 9 .4 - 61.16) + (33.0 34.00) (59.6 - 5 6 .2 8 ) + (36 .9 - 3 4 . 0 0 ) (56.3 - 5 6 . 2 8 ) + . . . + (35.2 - 34.00) (54.8 - 56.28) = - 645.82 - 373.49 = -1 ,0 1 9 .3 1 T he q u an tity S is equal to th e sum of squares w ithin com pounds. B y maximizing th e q u a n tity D 2/ S th e following equations arise. These equations are actually proportionalities, b u t for the _purpose urpose of evaluating constants 61, 6 2, 63, and 64 th ey m ay be used. S1161 + «1262 + 81363 + sh&i = di = di «1261 + S2262 + S2363 + 82161 «1361 + S2362 + 83363 + S3464 = d i «1461 + S2462 + S3463 + S4464 = <f< From these equations th e values of th e &’s, of in com pound X , can be found. T he solution tions gives, of all linear compounds in Xi, X2, x3, compound, X , which m ost clearly discrim inates th e other. These equations a re : From (77) From (7) 6, 6, = 0.005344 = 0.005345; 6 , = 0.005345 (average) From (F ) From (F) From (G) 62 6: 62 = 0.008820 = 0.008821 = 0.008821; 62 = 0.008821 (average) From From From From 6, 6, 61 6, = = = = (A) (B) (C) (D) 0.000007 0.000007 0.000007 0.000007; 6 , = 0.000007 (average) Therefore 6, = 0.000007, 6 , = 0.008821, 6 , = 0.005345, 6 , = 0.006970 T his m ethod of solving sim ultaneous equations is easy to follow and easy to explain to th e average com puter. The linear com pound which enables one to detect th e greatest difference betw een th e mines in relation to these four m easure m ents is X = 0.000007xi + 0.008821xj + 0.005345x, + 0.006970x, T he m ean com pound pertaining to mine A is X th e coefficients of these equa and x,, th e one one mine from 37.828.400.006, + 123,906.0062 + 20,685.206, 140,927.0064.= 486.00 123.906.006,+ 1,614.8762 - 1 ,0 1 9 .3 1 6 ,- 571.2164 = 5 .6 7 20.685.006, - 1,019.3162 + 1,849.626, - 849.976, = - 4 . 8 8 -1 4 0 ,927.006, - 571.216, - 849.976, + 1,519.426, = - 0 . 0 6 T here are several ways of solving these equations. One way (2), using the com puting machines, is as follows: D ividing each equation by the absolute value of th e coefficient of 6 , in it gives: = 0.000007xi + 0.00S821X2 + 0.005345x, + 0.006970x, = 0.000007 (13,100) + 0.008821 (28.33) + 0.005345 (61.16) + 0.006970 (8.71) or X = 0.7293 T he m ean com pound pertaining to mine B is X ' = 0.000007(13,596) + 0.008821 (34.00) + 0.005345 (56.28) + 0.006970 (8.65) = 0.7562 T he difference D betw een these two m eans is 0.7562 — 0.7293 = 0.0269. T his can be found directly from E q uation 1 as follows: D = 0.000007 (486) + 0.008821 (5.67) + 0.005345 ( - 4 . 8 8 ) + 0.006970 ( - 0 . 0 6 ) D = 0.003402 + 0.050015 - 0.026083 0.000418 = 0.0269 (2) as before. (A) 6, + 0.00327562 + 0.0005476, - 0.0037256, = 0.000013 (B) 6, + 0.0130336, - 0.0082266, - 0.0046106, = 0.000046 T h e question arises as to w hether or n o t th e m eans of these compounds are statistically significantly different. T able II contains an analysis of variance of these compounds and enables 34 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING one to te s t for a significant difference betw een these two means. T he tw o asterisks in th e la st colum n indicate th a t these com pounds are highly significantly different. T his m eans th a t the probability of getting by chance such a large value of D is less th an 0.01. T his is found from a table of F values (I, 7). T he odds in favor of getting by chance such a large difference between the compounds pertaining to th e two m ines are less th a n 1 to 99. T his indicates th a t the coal from m ine A is definitely different from the coai from m ine B, as far as these four m easurem ents are concerned. B y exam ining th e four term s in E q u atio n 2 one can determ ine which characteristic of th e coal (B .t.u., per cent of volatile m aterial, per cent of fixed carbon, or per cent of ash) is m ost im p o rtan t for differentiating th e two coals, which is of n ext im portance, etc. T h e second term , 0.050015, in th is equation is greater th a n th e absolute value of each of th e o th er term s; hence th e per cent of volatile m aterial is th e m o s t im p o rtan t factor, in th is casé, for determ ining w hether or n o t the coal from one m ine is different from th e coal from th e o th er m ine. T h e absolute value of the th ird term in th is equation, 0.026083, is second in size; hence the per cent of fixed carbon is next in im portance for revealing a difference between th e coal from th e two m ines. T he factor B .t.u. is th ird in im portance for differentiating these two coals. P er cent of ash is of th e least im portance for these mines. T he order of im portance of these factors m ay change for other coals. T able I I I gives th e ranks of im portance of these charac teristics when various com binations are used to calculate the com pounds. T able I I I gives th e ranks of th e ch aracteristics of th e coals for various, com binations of the sets of m easurem ents. In column 2 it is seen th a t per cen t of fixed carbon is th e m ost im p o rtan t characteristic for differentiating one m ine from th e oth er as far as per cent of volatile m aterial, per cen t of fixed carbon, and per cent of ash are concerned. CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 Table IV . A rithm etic A verages of B.t.u., Per Cent of V o la tile M aterial, Per Cent of Fixed Carbon, and Per Cent of A s h Measurements from M ines C and D M ines B .t.u . P e r C en t of V olatile M a tte r P e r C en t of Fixed C arb o n P e r C en t of Ash C D 13,700 13,205 3 5 .0 9 2 9 .9 9 57 .1 8 59.81 6 .5 6 8 .7 2 495 5 .1 0 -2 .6 3 -2 .1 6 D ifference Table V . A verages of B.t.u., Per Cent of V o la tile M aterial, Per Cent of Fixed Carbon, and Per Cent of A s h for M ines E and F M inea E F D ifference B .t.u . P e r C e n t of V olatile M a tte r P e r C e n t of Fixed C arbon P e r C en t of Ash 14,012 12,134 1,878 3 4 .1 5 35 .7 8 -1 .6 3 60.31 4 8 .1 4 12.17 4 .2 1 13.25 -9 .0 4 m ost im p o rtan t, per cent of fixed carbon is second, per cent of volatile m aterial is third, and per cent of ash is la st in im portance in testing w hether or n o t th e m ines differ as fa r as a com pound of these four sets of m easurem ents is concerned. T able V contains averages of m easurem ents pertaining to B .t.u., volatile m aterial, fixed carbon, and per cent of ash for m ines E an d F. T h e difference betw een th e m eans of the two discrim inant func tions pertaining to th e m ines is D = 0.000083 (1878) - 0.001356 ( - 1 . 6 3 ) + 0.006124 (12.17) + 0.009580 ( - 9 . 0 4 ) = 0.155874 + 0.002210 + 0.074529 - 0.086603 = 0.146010 In th is case B .t.u. is first, per cent of ash is second, per cent of fixed carbon is th ird , and per cent of volatile m aterial is fo urth in im portance for differentiating betw een th e coal from these mines. DISCUSSION Table II. Source of V ariatio n A n a ly sis of V ariance of the Compounds D egrees of Freed o m T o ta l B etw een com pound m ean s W ith in Table 111. 199 4 195 Sum of S quares M ean S q u are 50D* - 0.0362 D - 0.0269 0.00905** 0.00014 Rank of Characteristics for V arious Compounds Pertaining to Coals A and B C om pound Com posed of B .t.u. V olatile m a tte r Fixed carbo n P e r c e n t ash P e r cen t of v o latile B ,t.u . m a tte r P e r cen t of v o latile P e r c en t of fixed m a tte r B .t.u . carb o n P e r c en t P e r cen t P e r cen t of v o latile of fixed carbon m a tte r of ash 2 3 2 1 1 2 1 3 P e r cen t of carb o n P e r c en t of ash P e r cent of v o latile m a tte r P e r cent of fixed carbon Ï 2 2 1 T able IV contains th e m eans of m easurem ents pertaining to B .t.u., volatile m aterial, fixed carbon, an d per cent of ash for two other mines, C and D . T he discrim inant function pertain ing to these m ines for th e value D is I) = 0.000020 (495) - 0.006S60 (5.10) 0.001559 ( - 2 . 6 3 ) - 0.000468 ( - 2.16) or D = 0.00990 - 0.00350 + 0.00410 + 0.00101 D = 0.01151 An analysis of variance table (not given) shows th a t the two coals are significantly different. T h e characteristic B .t.u. is T he discrim inant function enables one to te st for a statistical difference betw een two linear compounds m ade up of several variables or m easurem ents. I t has m any advantages because it furnishes one m easurem ent pertaining to a com bination of several measurem ents. In the present instance th e statistical analysis of th e d ata shows a difference betw een th e coal from th e two mines. I t m ay be useful in th e future to compare an alytical d a ta from other mines. Such an effort would involve the selection of a standard coal, an d it seems ap p aren t th a t o th er analytical d ata, such as per cent of sulfur, per cent of m oisture, and the fusing tem perature of the ash, should be included in th e m ore accurate statistical comparison. CONCLUSION Fisher’s discrim inant function has been applied to the dif ferentiation of analytical d a ta obtained from one hundred coal sam ples tak en from each of two m ines. T h e intercom parison of the relative significance of the elem ents of th e analytical d ata relating to coal has been accom plished. T h e probability th a t two coals corrfe from the sam e source b y random sam pling is given. LITERATURE CITED ( 1 ) B aten , W . D ., “ E lem entary M ath em atical S ta tistics” , pp. 2 4 9 62, N ew York, John W iley & Sons, 1938. (2) B aten, W . D ., J . A gr. Research, 61, 237—10 (1940). (3) Brier, G . W ., S ch ott, R . G ., and Sim m ons, V. L., P roc. A m . Soc. A n im a l Production, 1, 153-60 (1940). (4) Cox, G . M ., and M artin, W . P ., Iow a Stale College J . S ci., 11, N o. 3, 323-31 (1937). (5) D ay, B . D ., Sandom ire, M . M ., J . A m . S lat. Assoc., 37, 4 6 1 -7 2 (1942). (6 ) Fisher, R . A ., A n n . Eugen., 7, 179-88 (1936). (7) Snedecor, G . W ., “ S tatistical M eth od s A pplied to E xperim ents in Agriculture and B io lo g y ” , p p . 184-7, A m es, Iow a, Col legiate P ress, 1940. Colorimetric A nalysis of Xanthone Spray Residues C. C. C A S S IL a n d J. W . H A N S E N U. S. Department of A griculture, Bureau of Entom ology and Plant Quarantine, Yakim a, Wash. represent 100, 250, and 500 micrograms of xanthone. Prepare a sta n d a rd graph b y plotting th e q u antities of xanthone in the stan d ard solution against th e logarithm s of th e corresponding photom eter readings. T h e light transm ission of 14S micrograms of xanthone read under th e conditions above in a 2.5-cm. (1-inch) cell is 50 per cent. A n a l y s i s o f S a m p l e s . A statistical analysis has shown th a t 20 to 25 apples, tak en from different p a rts of a tree, con stitute a satisfactory sam ple for residue determ ination. Place th e apples in a tared glass jar, weigh, and calculate the surface area from the weight, by the use of a previously established relationship. Add from 100 to 250 ml. of toluene, depending on th e q u a n tity of xanthone and th e size of th e apples, and shake for 5 m inutes in a m achine by th e process described by F ahey et al. (1). F ilter a portion of th e solution, and use an aliquot n o t to exceed 10 ml. of the filtrate for th e analysis as described under th e procedure for standards. R ead th e am ount of xanthone p er aliquot from the stan d ard graph. Apple plugs m ay be tre a te d in a sim ilar m anner. If th ey are used, a sm aller volum e of toluene can be used for stripping. A colorimetric method for the determination of xanthone spray residues consists in adding a measured quantity of toluene to a sample of apples or apple plugs in a glass jar and shaking for 5 minutes. The resulting solution of xanthone and apple waxes is filtered and an aliquot of the filtrate taken for analysis. The xanthone is reduced to xanthydrol b y refluxing with sodium amalgam in toluene and methanol. A fte r removal of the methanol b y a water extraction, an aliquot of the supernatant toluene solution is swirled in concentrated hydrochloric acid, effecting an equilibrium transfer of the xanthydrol to the acid layer to give a yellow color, which is measured photometrically. X A N T H O N E has been used experim entally as an insecticide against codling m oth larvae and o th er insects. T he p ur pose of th is study w as to develop a satisfactory m ethod for deter mining xanthone residues on sprayed apples, and th e following colorim etric procedure is recom mended. I t is based on a proce dure used by th e L aurel H ill L aboratory of th e G eneral Chemical Com pany for determ ining xanthone spray residues. T h e w riters are indebted to several of th e staff of this lab oratory for construc tive criticism and advice in the preparation of this paper. DISCUSSION S o lv e n ts f o r X a n th o n e . In selecting a solvent for th e re m oval of xanthone residues, consideration was given to solubility, efficacy of wax rem oval from apples, an d th e extraction of inter fering substances. Acetone, alcohols, benzene, a n d petroleum ether were n o t satisfactory because of poor solvent pow er for xanthone an d too g reat solvent power for interfering substances. A N A L y T IC A L PROCEDURE Toluene. Toluene m ay contain an im purity, probably a thiophene derivative, which upon shaking w ith con cen trated hydrochloric acid yields a slig h t yellow color in the acid layer. T his im purity can be rem oved by adding 50 ml. of concentrated sulfuric acid p er liter of toluene, allowing to stand over 24 hours, separating th e layers, and distilling th e toluene. T he first m ilky portion of the distillate is discarded. Toluene from all operations m ay be recovered and reused if treated in this m anner. W hite crystals of p-toluenesulfonic acid m ay appear in th e toluene layer during the sulfuric acid treatm en t, b u t th ey do n o t distill and do not interfere, c.p. toluene usually does not contain th is im purity. M ethanol (absolute). Sodium amalgam. C autiously melt" 9 gram s of sodium in 20 ml. of toluene in a round-bottom ed flask and add 750 gram s of m ercury, drop by drop a t first an d m ore rapidly after a few milli liters have been added. M ost of th e toluene will volatilize, b u t some should be k ep t over th e amalgam when it is transferred to an airtight bottle. H ydrochloric acid (c.p. concentrated). P r e p a r a tio n o f S ta n d a rd s . Carefully weigh 50.0 mg. of pure xanthone, transfer to a 250-ml. volum etric flask, and m ake to volume w ith toluene. K eep tig h tly stoppered to p revent loss of toluene. One m illiliter of th is solution contains 200 micro gram s of xanthone. If pure xanthone is n o t available for stan d ards, it can be prepared by distilling a crude xanthone product and recrystallizing the distilled m aterial several tim es from dioxane or other suitable solvent to a co n stan t m elting point of 174° C. M easure 2 ml. of th e stand ard solution and sufficient toluene to m ake a to ta l of 20 ml. into a 125-ml. flask fitted w ith a groundglass joint. A dd 10 ml. of m ethanol and 0.5 to 1.0 ml. of sodium amalgam , connect w ith a water-cooled condenser, and reflux for 30 m inutes. Before rem oving th e flask from the condenser, cool to prev ent loss of toluene. Add 20 ml. of w ater and shake vigor ously to rem ove th e m ethanol from th e toluene. P our into a tall tube, such as a 50-ml. N essler tube, retain in g th e am algam in the flask. Allow th e layers to separate, and p ipet 5 ml. of the tolu ene layer (containing the xanthydrol) into a 1 0 0 - to 150-ml. flask th a t contains exactly 1 0 ml. of concentrated hydrochloric acid. Develop th e color by swirling th e m ixture gently for approxi m ately 1 m inute. P our into a te s t tu b e or cell and m easure the color of th e acid layer in a photom eter. A glass color filter hav ing m aximum transm ission a t 424 millimicrons gave satisfactory results in a T y p e F Aminco photom eter. R epeat for 5- an d 10-ml. aliquots of stan d ard xanthone solu tion. T he 5/20 aliquots of toluene used for color developm ent R e a g e n ts . 10 20 30 40 SO TIME OF REFLUX - M INU TES Figure 1. Rate of Xanthone Reduction to Xanthydrol in Toluene-M ethanol M ixture T he solubility of xanthone in toluene is 1.43 gram p er 100 mL a t 30° C., w hich is far in excess of any concentration norm ally en countered in residue analysis. Since th e apple w ax appears to be com pletely dissolved, an y xanthone th a t m ay be covered w ith wax is also obtained. T h e am ount of interference introduced by shaking even m atu re waxy apples w ith toluene for 30 m inutes is negligible. On th e o th er hand, 5 m inutes’ shaking is sufficient for com plete rem oval of xanthone residues. T oluene was there fore selected as th e m ost desirable solvent for this m ethod. R e d u c tio n o f X a n th o n e . I t is best to use an aliq u o t of the residue solution containing from 0.4 to 2.0 mg. of x anthone for reduction. If th e aliq u o t contains larger quantities, u p to 50 mg., reduction will be complete, b u t fu rth er aliquoting and dilu 35 INDUSTRIAL 36 AND ENGINEERING tion after rem oval of th e m ethanol will be necessary. T he term "com plete reduction” as used here m eans th a t, under th e condi tions of th e m ethod, a m ore intense yellow color cannot be ob tained w ith a given am ount of xanthone even if th e tim e of reduc tion is doubled. R eduction of xanthone in a m ixture of 20 ml. of toluene and 1 0 ml. of m ethanol reaches a m axim um , under the reflux condition of th e m ethod, in 25 m inutes (Figure 1), as judged by color developm ent. C o lo r D e v e lo p m e n t. A fter reduction th e addition of w ater followed by vigorous shaking rem oves th e m ethanol from th e toluene layer, w hich retu rn s to its original volum e of 2 0 ml. W hen th e m ixture is transferred to a container for the separation of the tw o layers, it is convenient to w ithdraw th e am algam for subsequent recovery. T he 5-ml. aliq u o t of th e toluene layer needed for color developm ent can be tak en before all th e toluene has separated; it is n o t even necessary to filter to rem ove slight w ater tu rb id ity . If sm aller aliquots are used, sufficient pure toluene to m ake 5 ml. m u st be added before tre atm e n t w ith acid. W hen xanthydrol is treated w ith hydrochloric acid, chlorine is sub stitu ted for the hydroxyl group. T h e resulting com pound is colorless in dilute acid, b u t in th e presence of concen tra te d hydrochloric acid an intense yellow color is produced. T he intensity of yellow color is proportional to th e q u a n tity of xanthone used in the determ ination. I f th e toluene is rem oved from th e acid layer to p reven t a sh ift in th e d istribution ratio, th e solution can be diluted w ith concentrated hydrochloric acid and th e color still conforms to B eer’s law. N o decomposition of xanthydrol has been observed in toluene up to 1 2 hours after reduction, b u t low recoveries were obtained on some sam ples when th e toluene layer was allowed to stan d for a longer tim e. I t is possible th a t th e observed decomposition is due p artly to oxidation of xan thydrol to xanthone, because a re newed reduction increases th e yellow color upon subsequent acid treatm en t, b u t n o t to its original intensity. S tan d ard solutions m ade directly from xanthone and toluene are stable for a t least 60 days. Table I. Rcco' I V a rie ty J o n a th a n apples W inesap apples W inesap plugs of Known Am ounts of Xanthone A d d e d to les Sprayed with Le ad Arsenate0 W eig h t of Apples Grams X a n th o n e A dded M 0. X a n th o n e R ecovered Mg. 467 467 586 453 524 323 142 sq. cm . 10 .0 10.0 2 5 .0 2 .0 0 5 .0 0 50. Q 5 .0 0 9 .4 0 1 0 .0 2 5 .5 2 .0 0 5 .0 0 4 9 .6 4 .9 0 A v. R ecovery % 94. 100. 102. 100. 100. 99. 98. 9 9 .0 ° E a c h sam p le c o n tain ed 25 apples or 80 plugs. X a n th y d r o l D is tr ib u tio n R a tio s . In th is m ethod there are tw o distributions of xanthydrol, betw een toluene and w aterm ethanol solution and betw een toluene an d hydrochloric acid. B oth distribution ratios have been found to be co n stan t for any to tal am ount of xanthydrol up to 50 mg. for th e form er and 0.6 mg. for the latter, when the volum es are k e p t as specified in the m ethod. T he distribution ratio betw een toluene and hydro chloric acid w as n o t studied beyond 0 .6 m g., because th e in ten sity of color a t th e corresponding concentration was m ore th an sufficient for th e m ethod. Two p e r cen t of th e x an thydrol re m ains in th e w ater-m ethanol solution, and 77 p er cent of th e to ta l is transferred to the hydrochloric acid. T he concentration of th e hydrochloric acid is n o t too critical, since experience has shown no color differences in th e range of 34 to 36.5 p e r cent acid, and whereas th e use of lower stren g th acid will lead to lesser color intensities, constant results will be obtained if th e stan d ard s are tre a te d w ith the sam e acid. If conditions require th e use of volum es other th an those specified, a new standardization curve CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 2.0 100 • ALIQUOTS FROM ONE REDUCED SOLUTION o SOLUTIONS EACH OF WHICH WAS REDUCED 2 o 90 80 70 CO 60 2 CO so in O 2 < co 2 40 C O ce 1.6 I- 2 < 2 30 UJ ir i.4 h 2 LU 20 (x iu Q. 5 ML T olu en e-1 0 Ml. H C I 1.2 1.0 BLUE F IL T E R W ITH MAXIMUM TRANSMISSION AT 4 2 4 M ILLIM ICRONS 100 200 300 M IC R O G R A M S Figure 2. OF 400 500 10 XANTHONE Representative Standard Xanthone Graph m u st be established. Since distribution ratio s are involved in th e m ethod, it is im perative th a t all volum es be m easured accu rately. W hen an aliquot is tak en from th e su p e rn a ta n t toluene layer, there is some tendency for redistribution of th e x anthydrol upon standing 2 hours o r longer. T his effect is th e m ore pronounced th e larger th e concentration of xanthydrol. N o explanation can be given for th is change in distribution, b u t it is co n stan t for any co n stan t volum e ratio. If th e procedure is followed as described, good results are obtainable. If th e toluene solution is to be re tained for checking color developm ent on th e same day, it should be separated from th e w ater-m ethanol solution before a n aliquot is removed. T he d istribution of x anthydrol betw een toluene an d hydro chloric acid rapidly comes to equilibrium , b u t as a check one should m ake duplicate determ inations a t th is p o in t in th e proce dure. A fter color developm ent no change in inten sity occurs, even a fte r 24 hours, if precautions are tak en w ith respect to apple-wax concentration in th e toluene as described in th e next section. In te rfe re n c e s . Apples sprayed w ith lead arsenate alone a n d stripped for 5 m inutes in toluene gave a photom eter reading corresponding to th a t given w ith 0 .1 m icrogram of xanthone per square centim eter. Sim ilar sam ples stripped for 30 m inutes did n o t show an interference g reater th a n 0.15 microgram per square centim eter. W hen th is ty p e of interference was tested on Delici ous, Rome, an d W inesap varieties, no significant differences were found. T h e blank on apple plugs is also negligible. X anthone deposits of 2 2 m icrogram s per square centim eter dropped to 1 .6 m icrogram s a fte r w eathering for 4 weeks; therefore, if a n y de composition products are formed, th ey eith er do n o t rem ain on th e apple or do n o t cause an y detectable interference w ith the m ethod. A pple wax does n o t interfere in th e reduction of xanthone. I t also causes no interference w ith th e color developed in hydro chloric acid when th e aliquot of strip solution is 1 0 ml. or less. I t is possible to use a 15-ml. aliq u o t or even 20-ml. w ith earlyseason apples, b u t if tu rb id ity occurs in th e acid phase, th e wax concentration in toluene m u st be reduced in some way. T he yellow color developed in hydrochloric acid is stable for 24 hours or more, b u t should be read w ithin an hour, since tu rb id ity m ay develop on long standing. T his effect is m ost m arked when th e January 15, 1944 ANALYTICAL toluene is in con tact w ith th e acid layer overnight and is prob ably due to tem perature changes. Ground-glass joints are preferred for th e reflux reduction. R ubber stoppers m ay be used if th ey arc boiled in norm al alkali for 15 m inutes, th en in norm al sulfuric acid for 15 m inutes longer, and finally rinsed well w ith distilled w ater. A c c u r a c y a n d P r e c i s i o n . One stan d ard graph obtained in th is investigation is given in Figure 2. T he absorption cells used were stan d ard te s t tubes (2-cm. inside diam eter). T he line was fitted by th e m ethod of least squares. T he stan d ard error of estim ate for th e points on th is line is =*=6.7 micrograms. Aliquots can be so chosen as to perm it readings on 200 to 500 m icrograms of xanthone, th u s allowing reduction of th e percentage stan dard error to 3.3 or less. M ore accurate and precise results can be obtained if the colored solutions are read in cells w ith flat optical windows, since th e te s t tubes used in th is w ork v a ry a b o u t 0.5 per cent in light transm ission. EDITION 37 R ecovery experim ents .were run by adding known am ounts of xanthone to apples th a t had been sprayed w ith lead arsenate, and analyzing b y th e described procedure (T able I). T h e average recovery from seven sam ples w as 99.0 p er cent, w hich is n o t statistically different from complete recovery. T he completeness of rem oval of xanthone from W inesap and Rome apples (collected 6 weeks before h arvest) was also studied by subm itting sam ples to a second stripping w ith toluene. T he am o u n t of xanthone rem oved by th e second tre a tm e n t w as cal culated a fte r allowing for th e am o u n t of toluene left on th e apples from th e first stripping. Six sam ples, having from 6 to 13 mg. of xanthone per sample, tre ate d in th is m anner, showed a rem oval of 99 per cent or b e tte r w ith th e first 5-m inute stripping treatm ent. LITERATURE CITED * (1) F ahey, J. E ., C assil, C . C ., and R u sk , H . W ., J . Assoc. Official A gr. Chem., 26, 150-5 (1943). P H E N O L S T U D IE S Q ualitative Tests for Phenol and o-, m-, and p-Cresol W m . B. D E IC H M A N N Kettering Laboratory of A p p lie d Physio logy, C o llege of M edicine, University of Cincinnati, Cincinnati, O h io Q ualitative tests for phenol em ploying ferric chloride, hypochlorite, or the reagents of M e lze r, M illo n , Lie be rmann, Guareschi, and Cotton have been modified to permit differentiation between phenol and o-, m-, ar^d p-cresol. H E m anufacture and use of phenol an d cresol on a large scale have furnished an incentive for investigating th e toxicity and m etabolism of these compounds, an d these investiga tions, in tu rn , have called for a review of analytical m ethods useful in th eir detection an d estim ation. A review of q u an tita tiv e m ethods for th e estim ation of phenol in biological m aterial, in cluding a spectrophotom etric procedure for th e q u a n tita tiv e esti m ation of free, conjugated, an d to ta l phenol in tissues and fluids, has been published (2, S). In this paper q u alitativ e tests for o-, 771-, an d p-cresol w hich are modifications of well known q u alitativ e tests for phenol are described. T he hypochlorite test for o-cresol offered here has ap p aren tly n o t been recorded before. A single te st or a com bination of several of these color tests can be used very effectively for th e identification of phenol or o-, mr, or p-cresol, if th e unknow n solution contains only one of these com pounds. I f th e unknow n contains tw o or m ore of these substances, positive identification of each com pound is n o t alw ays possible; m-cresol, w hen present in m ixtures in a low con centration, is particularly a p t to escape recognition. I n analyzing for these compounds, even though each substance gives very sim ilar color reactions in high and in low concentra tions, it is best to prepare and te s t dilutions th a t approach th e ranges of sensitivity. These concentrations will furnish in addi tion some rough idea of the q u an tities present. T T he phenol used w as M erck’s reagent quality, and th e o-, m-, an d p-cresol, obtained from th e E astm an K odak Com pany, was believed to be from 96 to 98 per cent pure. T h e m elting points o f these cresols are 30-31 °, 10-11°, and 32-34° C., respectively. P h e n o l an d D e r iv a t iv e s G r o u t i n g . T he sensitivity M o d i f i c a t i o n o f M e l z e r ’ s B e n z a l d e h y d e T e s t (â) f o r D e t e c t i o n o f P h e n o l a n d o-, m - , a n d p - C r e s o l . M ix 1 ml. of th e aqueous solution to be tested w ith 2 ml. of concentrated sul furic acid (sp. gr. 1.84), and a fte r cooling under th e ta p add 2 drops of benzaldehyde. H ea t over a flame, cool, and add 10 ml. of w ater and 20 ml. of 40 per cent potassium hydroxide. T he sensitivity of th is te s t is a b o u t 1 mg. per ml. of solution. M o d ific a t io n o f G u a r e s c h i’s T e s t (4) f o r D is t in g u is h in g P h e n o l a n d p - C r e s o l f r o m o - a n d t o - C r e s o l . A dd ab o u t 0.5 gram of solid potassium hydroxide an d 3 drops of w ater to 3 ml. of a chloroform ex tract containing phenol or cresol, th en warm and observe. Straw-colored (yellow) globules will rise and th e potassium hydroxide and w ater layer will assume a yellowish tinge on warming if phenol or p-cresol is present. In th e presence of oor m-cresolj th e potassium hydroxide and th e w ater layer will assume a pinkish or rose-red color. T he sensitivity for each of these com pounds is a b o u t 4 mg. in 3 ml. of extract. F e r r ic C h lo r id e T e s t (S) f o r D e t e c t i o n o f Table I. P h en o l o- an d p- Co lo r Changes o -C h e b o l m -C re s o l p -C re so l Changes observed in 5 minutes after addition of sulfuric acid and benzaldehyde Cloudy olive Cloudy orange Cloudy yellow Milky white After heating Cloudy Cloudy reddish-brown brownish-red Cloudy Cloudy yellowish-brown brownish-green I Q U A LITA TIVE TESTS D e t e c t io n of P h en o l- IIy d ro x y used and th e m anner of preparing th e reagent. F o r these studies th e la tte r was prepared by dissolving 497 gram s of m er cury in 700 ml. of nitric acid (sp. gr. 1.42) and diluting this solution w ith 2 volum es of w ater. One milliliter of th e test solution is added to 2 ml. of M illon’s reagent. Phenol and o-cresol when present to a b o u t 1.0 mg. per ml., and 77i- and p-cresol when present to a b o u t 0.5 mg. p er m l., produce a red color alm ost im m ediately a t room tem perature. W hen reduced to ab o u t 0.05 mg. per m l., each of these com pounds produces in th e cold or on careful heating a straw-yellow color which is destroyed by fu rther heating. After cooling and addition of water and potassium hydroxide C o n t a in in g of Millon’s te s t (7) depends to some ex ten t upon th e q u an tity of mercury Blue or violet solution and prccipitate Colorless or faintly tan colored solution and precipitate 38 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING C r e s o l . Add 2 drops of a freshly prepared 10 per cent aqueous solution of ferric chloride to 5 ml. of th e te st solution. Phenol and rn-cresol produce clear bluish-purple colors, ocresol produces in about 10 m inutes a slightly cloudy urine yellow or brown solution, while p-cresol produces a cloudy blue solution. T he sensitivity for each com pound is a b o u t 10 mg. in 5 ml. M o d i f i c a t i o n o p L i e b e r m a n n ’s T e s t (5 ) f o r D e t e c t i o n o p j j - C r e s o l . T o 3 ml. of th e unknow n aqueous solution add slowly and w ith shaking 1 ml. of th e reagent (6 p er cent solution of sodium n itrite in concentrated sulfuric acid). A cloudy orange solution develops in about 6 m inutes if p-cresol is present. Phenol and m-cresol yield clear, and o-cresol very slightly cloudy brow n or yellowish-brown solutions. T he sensitivity of this te s t is about 5 m g. in 3 ml. M o d i f i c a t i o n o f C o t t o n ’s T f . s t ( 1 ) f o r D e t e c t i o n o f p C r b s o l . T o 3 ml. of an aqueous solution, add 1 ml. of concen tr a te d am m onium hydroxide (sp. gr. 0.901) an d 4 drops of the freshly prepared reagent (10 ml. of concentrated hydrochloric acid and 0.5 gram of potassium chlorate added to 40 ml. of w ater). Phenol and o- and m-cresol produce in 5 to 10 m inutes clear light blue colors; p-cresol produces a clear light straw-yellow color. T h e sensitivity is abo u t 10 mg. in 3 ml. of solution. H y p o c h lo r ite T e s t f o r D e t e c t i o n o f o -C re s o l. T o 5 ml. of the te st solution, add one drop of sodium hypochlorite solution. In th e presence of o-cresol th e solution will im m ediately tu rn a cloudy yellowish-w hite; in th e presence of phenol, and m - and pcresol, it will rem ain clear and colorless. T he sensitivity is a b out 4 mg. in 5 ml. of solution. (Excess of hypochlorite m ust be avoided because it m ay produce faint cloudiness w ith pcresol.) CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 DISCUSSION I t is reasonable to assum e th a t all reagents discussed in this p aper will also react w ith some com pounds other th a n phenol, or o-, m~, or p-cresol. T herefore one m u st m ake certain th a t the te s t solution is com paratively free from compoimds related to phenol or cresol. T h is m ay require prelim inary precipitation, ex traction, or d istillation procedures. M illon’s test, even though it m akes specific differentiation be tween phenol an d the three cresois difficult, is of value because of its sim plicity, as a prelim inary test. T h is should be followed by the modified te sts of M elzer an d G uareschi, which will identify the com pound. T h e conclusions draw n from these la tte r two tests m ay be checked b y th e hypochlorite and ferric chloride tests or b y the modified procedures of L ieberm ann and of C otton. LITERATURE CITED (1) C otton , S., Bull. soc. chim ., 21, 8 (1874). (2) D eichm ann, W m , and Schafer, L. J., Am . J . C lin. P ath ., 12, 129 (1942). (3) D eichm ann, W m ., and S cott, E . W „ I n d . E n o . C h e m ., A n a l . E d ., 11, 4 2 3 (1 9 3 9 ). (4) G uareschi, cited by H . SchifT in Correspondenzen, Ber., 5, 1055 (1872). (5) Lieberm ann, C., B er., 7, 248, 1098 (1874). (6) M elzer, H „ Z . anal. Chem., 37, 345 (1898). (7) M illon, M. E., Compt. rend., 28, 40 (1849). (8) SchifT, H „ A n n ., 1 5 9,158 (1871). Stability of Standard Solutions of Copper Perchlorate and Potassium lodate JO S E P H J. K O L B Lankenau Hospital Research Institute, Philadelphia, Penna. W H E N E V E R sodium thiosulfate is used in titra tio n work of high accuracy frequent restandardization is neces sary. In order to avoid the troublesom e and wasteful necessity of preparing for each standardization a fresh solution of a prim ary sta n d ard [iodine, potassium iodate (S), copper perchlorate (2)], a standard in the form of a solution of a prim ary substance of de pendable stability is desirable. T he work reported here deals w ith th e possibility of using potassium iodate or copper perchlo rate (5) for such a purpose. In considering the stability of such solutions it is necessary to distinguish betw een changes due to chemical instability, pre sum ably resulting in decrease of active concentration, and changes due to evaporation from th e container, which will cause increases of concentration. In th e stu d y of B erm an (I), for in stance, on th e stability of potassium iodate, it is impossible to distinguish the role of these tw o factors. However, his d a ta sug gest th a t evaporation has been an appreciable factor in bis results, and th a t, in some eases, an ap p aren t stab ility has resulted from the opposing effects of evaporation and decomposition. In a recent paper (4) on th e stab ility of sodium thiosulfate solu tions no account was taken of th e possible effect of evaporation. A graphical study of th e d a ta on stability shows th a t in th e first. 60 days there is approxim ately a 0.3 per cent increase in norm al ity . A fter th a t the values drop. Again two antagonistic tend encies, evaporation and decomposition, tend to produce a false picture of the stab ility of thiosulfate solutions. T he evaporation factor can be elim inated if, a t th e beginning of th e experiment, sam ples of the solution to be examined are p ipetted into separate flasks, an d some of these are titra te d a t once, while others are titra te d after a suitable lapse of tim e. The e x ten t of evaporation, on th e other hand, can be m easured by suitable weighings of th e vessels containing stock solutions. If th e solution is chemically stable, it is then possible to calculate the theoretical norm ality a t any tim e from th e initial norm ality and th e loss of weight th a t has occurred. APPARATUS A N D REAGENTS A 50-cc. bu ret an d one 10-cc. p ip et were carefully calibrated and were used thro u g h o u t th e experim ents. D etails of th e preparation and use of th e copper perchlorate and potassium iodate are given in (2) an d (5), respectively. EXPERIMENTAL All titra tio n s were carried o u t in duplicate. T h e a m o u n t of active substance present in solutions when th ey were fresh, an d a fter th ey h ad stood for various lengths of tim e, was alw ays de term ined by titratio n w ith thiosulfate (0.025V), new ly sta n d a rd ized ag ain st tw o freshly prepared cupric perchlorate solutions (2). Table I. Solution Cu(C10*)j K IO i D ays S tan d in g 565 565 289 454 565 565 565 289 454 Stability of 0.1 N Copper Perchlorate and Potassium lodate Solutions N o rm a lity In itia l Final® 0 .1007 0 .1007 0.0993 0.0993 0.1027 0.1027 0 .1027 0 .1007 0 .1007 0 .10 0 2 0 .1 0 0 4 0.0992 0 .0993 0 .10 2 1 0 .1013 0 .0983 0 .10 02 C o nditions T h y m o l, glass sto p p ers G lass sto p p ers C o rk sto p p ers, spores on corks G lass sto p p ers Thymol*», glass sto p p ers C ork sto p p ers, spores on corks 0 .1004 ° F in a l n o rm a lity c alcu la te d on b a sis of its in itia l volum e. & O nly one sam ple ; o th e rs a re a v erag e v a lu e fo u n d for tw o sam ples. January 15, 1944 ANALYTICAL Table II. Loss of W eig h t p e r 100 D ay s % o f weight of solution present Grams D ays EDITION 39 Stability of Solutions in Glass-Stoppered Bottles N o rm a lity C alcu la te d Found C o n ta in e r B o ttle C ap a c ity A p p ro x im a te V olum e of S olution Cc. Cc. C o p per P e rc h lo ra te 0 0-8 5 85-290 290-355 0.7 4 0 0 .6 7 9 0 .4 4 5 1.2 1 8 0 .8 9 8 0 .5 3 4 0 .1 0 0 5 0 .1 0 1 3 0 .1 0 2 5 0.1 0 3 4 G lass-stoppcrcd P y rex a b o u t 12 years old 250 155 0 .1 0 2 6 0 .1 0 3 3 0 .6 7 5 0 .4 8 8 0 .5 0 6 1 Ü Î2 0.671 0 .5 7 6 0ÜÔÔ9 0.1 0 1 9 0 .1 0 2 8 0.1 0 0 3 0 .1 0 0 9 0.1 0 2 3 0.1 0 3 4 G lass-stoppered, flint 500 165 0 ’. 0 i 8 0!021 0*.iÓÓ7 0.1 0 0 7 0.1 0 0 7 R u b b er s to p p er, P yrex 250 12a o !<348 0 .0 7 5 o ! 0994 250 145 0 .10 0 1 0 .0 9 9 3 0.0 9 9 4 0.0 9 9 7 G lass s to p p er, P y rex , sealed w ith paraffin 0*033 0 .0 8 3 500 265. B row n, glass sto p p e r, paraffined 500 195 S ta n d a rd in te rc h a n g ea b le glass sto p p e r, P yrex 250 160- 0 .10 11 0 0-85 85-290 290-455 0 0-185 0 0-373 373-1159 P o ta ssiu m Io d a te 0 0-8 5 85-453 o!o53 0 .0 9 5 0Ü 41 0 .1 5 6 o!iÓÓ7 0 .1 0 0 7 0.1 0 0 7 0 .10 11 0 .10 10 0.' 032 0.0 2 1 0.0 6 4 0 .0 3 6 o!iÓ 29 0 .1 0 3 0 0.0 5 1 0 .0 3 5 0 .0 8 3 0 .0 5 0 0 *.i 002 0 .10 0 1 0 .10 0 0 0.1 0 0 3 0.0 9 9 7 0!021 0!Ô40 0 . i 028 0.1 0 2 7 0.1 0 2 7 G lass sto p p e r an d g ro u n d -jo in t cap (" e th e r b o ttle ") 500 185. 0 .Ó22 0 . 036 0 *. i 028 0.1 0 2 7 0 .1 0 1 3 R u b b e r s to p p er 250 165. o! 130 o! i 13 0.1 0 4 0 0 .1 0 2 8 0.1 0 3 7 F lin t, glass s to p p er, tu rb id , d e p o sit of inorganic m a te ria l on w alls 1 lite r 85 0 0-368 368-768 0 0-157 157-557 0 0-238 0 0-165 0 0-855 0 .1 0 2 8 0.1 0 2 6 S olution D ay s Effect of Storage under Conditions of Minimum Evaporation Loss of W eig h t p e r 100 D a y s % of # weight of solution present Grams N o rm a lity In itia l F in a l m old a fte r several 0 .10 2 1 In the experim ents sum m arized in T able I, 10-cc. sam ples of freshly prepared cupric perchlorate and potassium iodate solu tions were pipetted into 125-cc. Erlenm eyer flasks. Some solu tions were titra te d a t once, while o th er flasks were closed w ith either glass stoppers or fresh cork stoppers and protected against du st by paper caps. These flasks were stored in th e labo rato ry in a cabinet th a t was opened frequently an d th u s provided no pro tection against possible contam ination from th e lab oratory a t mosphere. T he tem perature was 22° to 35 ° C. T he last of these solutions were titra te d a fter 19 m onths. As a possible preven tion of mold grow th, ab o u t 10 mg. of thym ol were added to some of th e flasks. Table 111. G lass s to p p er, flint glass; m onths titra te d as above. T he bottles were th en reweighed an d theabove procedure was repeated a t intervals. F rom th e d a ta given, one can readily calculate th e initial w eight of th e solutions. In some cases, portions of th e solutions were rem oved for o th er p u r poses. T he bottles were weighed before an d a fte r such rem ovals and due corrections were applied in th e calculations. In order to keep evaporation a t a m inim um th e following pro cedure was tried. A tared 250-cc. glass-stoppered b ottle contain ing ab o u t 100 cc. of copper perchlorate solution was weighed. T he bottle, placed in a d ry beaker, was stored in a desiccator o v er a portion of th e sam e solution. One y ear la te r th e b o ttle was taken from th e desiccator, wiped, and carefully weighed as be fore. D uplicate 10-cc. sam ples were th e n titra te d . A p otas sium iodate solution was trea ted in th e sam e m anner. A com parison of th e results obtained (T able I I I ) w ith those shown in Table I I shows th a t by th e use of good glass-stoppered or rubberstoppered bottles nearly th e sam e results can be attain ed as by the desiccator m ethod. C on d itio ns CONCLUSIONS C u(C lO 0» 368 0 .0 1 8 0 .0 1 9 0 .10 22 0 .1 0 1 8 KlO a 392 0 .0 0 1 8 0 .0 0 1 8 0 .1 0 0 2 0.0 9 9 9 G lass sto p p er. P y rex G lass sto p p er, flint T able I shows the results. I t appears th a t copper perchlorate solutions possess a high degree of stability, while potassium iodate solutions show a pronounced tendency to become weaker. In either case thym ol has a harm ful effect, presum ably because it is oxidized, while in th e copper perchlorate solutions, even the presence of black, sporeliko spots on th e cork stoppers was no t associated w ith any loss of titer. In the experim ents sum m arized in T able II, sam ples of freshly prepared copper perchlorate and potassium iodate solutions were titra te d w ith thiosulfate. T h e rem aining portions of th e solu tions were transferred to clean, dry, tared , glass-stoppered re ag ent bottles and weighed w ith an accuracy of ± 5 mg. A fter standing for varying periods under th e conditions described above, the bottles were carefully dusted an d a b o u t half an hour later weighed. A p air of 10-cc. sam ples were w ithdraw n and Solutions in glass-stoppered bottles m ay lose weight by evapo ration. T his loss in weight has a tendency to give some types o f solutions an appearance of stability. R esults of experim ents indicate th a t solutions of copper perchlorate are more stable than, those of potassium iodate. F o r use as perm anent standards copper perchlorate solutions should be stored in good glassstoppered or rubber-stoppered bottles (evaporation losses should be determ ined by weighing, and norm alities should be corrected accordingly). Io d ate solutions m u st be stored in glass-stoppered, bottles. Thym ol should n o t be used as a preservative for either copper perclilorate or potassium iodate solutions. ACKNOW LEDGM ENT T he a u th o r wishes to th a n k G. Toennies of this in stitu te forhis encouragem ent and suggestions. LITERATURE CITED (1) Berm an, S. M ., J . Assoc. Official A gr. Chem., 20, 590 (1937). (2) K o lb , J . J ., I n d . E x q . C h e m ., A n a l . E d ., 11, 1 97 (1 9 3 9 ). (3) K o lth o ff , I . M ., and S a n d e ll, E . B ., “ T e x tb o o k o f Q u a n tita tiv e - A n alysis", p. 593, N ew York, M acm illan Co., 1936. (4) R u e , S . O ., I n d . E n g . C h e m ., A n a l , E d ., 14, 8 0 4 (1 9 4 2 ). Semiautomatic Pressure Control in Low-Pressure, Low-Temperature Laboratory Fractionation D . R. D O U S L IN a n d W . S. W A L L S Phillips Petroleum Com pany, Research Department, Bartlesville, O k la . E necessity of using laboratory personnel m anpow er to the T Hbest advantage and th e desire continually to im prove the o ther simply by m oving th e nitrogen flask. N o other changes in th e pressure control mechanism are necessary. T h e principal features of the control device are shown in Figure 1, in relation to th e fractionating colum n. T hree es sential p a rts of the mechanism are shown in detail: th e th ro ttlin g valve in Figure 2, and th e nitrogen dispenser and nitrogen ex pander in Figure 3. q uality of fractional analysis have led to th e installation of autom atic (£) and sem iautom atic control (1, 2, 4) on fractio n at ing columns in m any laboratories. In th e past, even semi autom atic pressure control (2, 3) has entailed th e use of an elabo rate device installed a t no sm all expense. T h e pressure control devices described by B osschart (I) and Podbielniak (2) employ compressed air for dispensing liquid nitrogen to th e colum n head by m eans of electrically operated valves controlled b y electrical contacts in the column m anom eter. F ig u re JI. THROTTLING V A L V E T h e th ro ttlin g valve (Figure 2) is an extension of th e outer arm of th e column m anom eter, an d is actu a ted b y m ercury w hich rises ou t of the m anom eter and into th e valve, causing th e needle, a, to float on th e meniscus of th e m ercury column. T h e ball on to p of the needle will move in the th ro a t, 6, of th e valve w ith rise and fall of m ercury. T his m otion will restrict th e freedom of a stream of air which norm ally exhausts through th e vent, c, on th e valve an d m ust, as a result of the th ro ttlin g effect of the needle, create sufficient pressure w ithin th e nitrogen-dispensing bo ttle to cause a discharge of liquid nitrogen. T h e needle will seek an equilibrium position in th e th ro a t of th e valve, effecting a sm all b u t constant discharge of nitrogen ju s t sufficient to control th e pressure in th e column and m ain tain it w ith very slight fluctuation. T h e am ount of m ercury in th e m anom eter m ay be varied to produce any pressure plateau desired from 0 to 760 mm. T h e dim ensions of th e th ro ttlin g valve are som ew hat a rb itra ry ; b u t 7-mm. glass tubing for th e column m anom eter and lower sec tion of th e control valve in which th e needle rides was found to give satisfactory results. T h e following dim ensions are suggested: length of th ro a t section, 7.5 cm.; diam eter a t narrow est section of th ro a t, 2 to 2.5 m m .; length of needle, 9 cm. T h e th ro a t section can be draw n down to proper size from 10- or 11-mm. glass tubing; th e m ain pre cautions are to keep th e glass circular and as thick as possible. A fter a satisfactory th ro a t section has been draw n, it should be scaled to tubing of th e proper size (7 m m .). T h e ball on to p of th e needle should ju s t pass through the narrow est section of the th ro a t w ith o u t sticking, and th e bottom of th e needle m u st ride freely in th e tu b e on the m ercury meniscus. T h e m ost satisfac to ry m ethod for connecting th e th ro ttlin g valve to th e column m anom eter is shown in Figure 4. T h e three-w ay stopcock should be a t least 25 m m . below th e 760-mm. m ark on th e m eter stick to allow a length of m an om eter tu b e to ta k e care of pressure build-up when recharging th e nitrogen bottle. T h e needle in th e th ro ttlin g valve de scribed above never seats, b u t allows ex h au st air to flow through a t all tim es. T he m ovem ent of th e needle in th e tapered sec tio n varies th e size of th e orifice formed by th e thro ttlin g valve, which acts to control th e flow of exhaust air, thereby producing control of pressure w ithin the nitrogendispensing system . T h e position of th e ball on th e needle in th e lower tapered section of the th ro a t of th e valve restricts th e flow of a ir th ro u g h th e valve ju s t enough to Figure 2. Throt create sufficient pressure w ithin th e n itro tling V a lv e g e n -d is p e n s in g s y s t e m t o f o r c e t h e a. Floating needle am ount of liquid nitrogen o u t of th e b. Throat section liquid nitrogen flask needed to control c. Air exhaust d. Tungsten elec column pressures and to m ain tain liq trical contact uid reflux in th e column. As th e n itro e. Constriction in gen level in th e flask decreases, m ore tubing Semiautomatic Pressure Control D evice A . ThrottJing valve B . Liquid nitrogen dispenser C. Column condenser D . Manual control E . Electrical buzzer T his paper describes a control device developed in this labora tory from m aterials usually available, which provides a simplified m eans of sem iautom atic control for low -tem perature, low-pressure laboratory fractionating equipm ent, w ithout sacrificing excellence o f control o r ease of operation. I ts o u tstanding a ttrib u tes are sim plicity of construction and low cost. T h e device m ay be used w ith good results on either th e stan d ard low -tem perature laboratory fractionating colum n or th e Podbielniak H eli-Grid type (3); and if these tw o types o f columns are connected to th e sam e manifold, th e control m ay be shifted from one column to the 40 January 15, 1944 ANALYTICAL EDITION as th e large resistance offered to th e flow of nitrogen m akes it necessary to m ain tain an unduly large pressure in th e D ew ar flask in order to force over sufficient nitrogen. T he heating elem ent in th e liquid nitrogen dispenser is useful for reducing th e fluctuation in column pressure during the fractionation of m ethane an d ethane, since it tends to cause de livery of the.cooling agent to th e colum n head in th e form of a more nearly continuous stream of dropwise increm ents of liquid nitrogen autom atically adjusted to m eet th e column require m ents. F or separating the com ponents propane through hexane the th ro ttlin g valve usually affords satisfactory control of column pressure. T he use of th e heating elem ent in th e liquid nitrogen dispenser appears to cause very little if an y significant increase in the liquid nitrogen requirem ents for fractionating m ethane and possibly ethane. Since only a sm all portion of th e liquid nitrogen is vaporized by the h eater while fractionating m ethane, Figure 3. Liq u id N itrogen Dispenser { (right) Dewar fla»k Porcelain conduit Rubber stopper Air intake tube P. Heating element <7. Electrical lead wires (left) end N itrogen Expander Discharge tube Nitrogen expander Asbestos string packing Liquid nitrogen intake tube Spent nitrogen exhaust tube V Compressed Air pressure is required in th e flask to force th e liquid nitrogen ou t; this ex tra pressure is furnished autom atically by th e valve, since th e ball on the needle merely assum es a position fu rth er up th e th ro at, fu rth er restricting th e flow of air. W ithin reason able lim its, th e ra te of furnishing compressed a ir to th e nitrogendispensing system produces no difficulties to operation, since the needle in th e th ro ttlin g valve autom atically ad ju sts itself to a position suitable for operation a t a given ra te of a ir flow. T he rate of air flow is usually set to perm it th e ball of th e needle to operate a t a point ab o u t 1 to 1.5 cm. below th e narrow est section of th e th ro at. Since th e nitrogen expander has been designed to perm it rapid response of column pressure to th e addition of cooling agent, the th ro ttlin g valve is capable of autom atically controlling th e column p ressu re 'w ith in very narrow lim its of fluctuation. LIQUID NITROGEN DISPENSER T he nitrogen-dispensing u n it shown in detail in Figure 3 (left) is contained in a quart-size, w ide-m outhed D ew ar flask. An air intake tube, t, a nitrogen discharge tube, m , and electrical leads, k, are sealed into th e flask by m eans of a rubber stopper, h, and a porcelain conduit, g, for th e electrical lead wires. Air which has been induced to flow into th e D ew ar flask as a result of th e action of the throttling valve will force liquid nitrogen up m into contact w ith the heating elem ent, j, which being relatively ho t flash-vaporizes a sm all portion of the liquid nitrogen, and th e sudden expansion of th e vapor forcibly ejects th e liquid nitrogen from the discharge end of the tube. T he increm ents of liquid nitrogen discharged in th is m anner are of sm all size, since the flash-vaporization occurs before an y large q u an tity can find its w ay into th e upper portion of th e discharge tube. T he heating elem ent in the discharge tu b e will continue to expel nitrogen in sm all bursts, a t rapid, regular intervals, which are regulated as regards am ount of nitrogen and tim e interval by th e pressure brought to bear b y th e th rottling valve, which in turn reflects th e need of the column for cooling agent. T he heating elem ent can be m ade from 8.75 cm. (3.5 inches) of No. 26 Chromel resistance wire, sufficient to m ake a heater which extends from ju s t below th e rubber stopper to th e bend a t th e top of the discharge tube. D uring an analysis it is neces sary to v ary th e am ount of current in the heating elem ent; this can be done w ith a sm all 2-ohm, 5-am pere rh eo stat if a potential of 6 to 9 volts is being used. T h e discharge tube, m, should be m ade of 9-mm. glass tubing sealed as it enters th e rubber stoDper to capillary tubing having 2.5- to 3-mm. inside diam eter. C ap illary tubing sm aller th an 2.5 mm. cannot be used successfully, s Figure 4. Connection of Throttling V a lve to Column Manometer r. Pinch clamp ». Three-way stopcock t Throttling valve v. Valve on compressed air line y , Manual control button x. Electrical buzzer th e more uniform m anner of dispensing nitrogen to th e column, head enables b e tte r operation of th e colum n an d more efficient use of th e cooling agent, th ereby partially com pensating for the nitrogen requirem ents of th e heater. NITROGEN EXPANDER In designing th e nitrogen expander (Figure 3, rig h t) and th e nitrogen intake tube, it is im p o rtan t to keep in m ind th a t th e liquid nitrogen should be conducted from th e D ew ar flask to make con tact w ith th e distilling tube b y th e sh o rtest possible 42 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 route and should in no case pass through a difficult p a th before m aking contact. T he intake tube, p, should be a continuation of tube m in th e nitrogen flask, and should have th e sam e inside diam eter (2.5 m m .). E xpander n is m achined from a solid piece of m etal, and is supported by sm all pieces of ru b b er or felt inside th e column condenser. T his type of expander allows th e nitrogen to con tact th e distilling tu b e im mediately, and conducts any excess nitrogen aw ay from th e distilling tu b e where it m ay vaporize w ithout causing excessive cooling near the tube. T he packing, o, is asbestos strin g wound around the distilling tu b e and pressed in to place. Precautions m u st be tak en to p rev en t w ater from accum ulating in th e nitrogen ex pansion cham ber or around the distilling tube. Soon after th e th ro ttlin g valve controller is cu t in, the nitrogen b o ttle should be inspected for leaks around th e stopper an d special care taken to see th a t a sm ooth connection is m ade between th e discharge tu b e in th e nitrogen b o ttle and the tu b e to the column head. If the sam ple being analyzed contains m ethane, it m ay be de sirable to build up reflux in th e column w ith th e m anual control b u tto n , and c u t in th e th ro ttlin g valve controller a fter th e column h as become com pletely wet. An operator m u st be presen t to a d ju st th e take-off rate valve a t th e various c u t points and to record th e necessary data. T h e buzzer, z, signals th e operator when th e nitrogen b o ttle is em pty, or if for any oth er reason th e column condenser is n o t being supplied w ith sufficient nitrogen. W ith . a suitable ar rangem ent of laboratory equipm ent it is frequently possible for one o perator to operate two columns sim ultaneously. TECHNIQUE OF OPERATION ACKNOWLEDGMENTS D uring th e tim e th a t a sam ple is introduced into th e fractionate ing column, the th ro ttlin g valve controller should be cu t o u t by turning the stopcock (s, Figure 4). A fter sam pling is completed a n d the k ettle allowed to w arm up, clam p r should be released from the leveling bottle and m ay be closed again when th e de sired pressure is reached. A t som e tim e during th e period when pressure is building up, valve v should be opened, causing a small stream of air to flow through th e th ro ttlin g valve. T h e condenser head on th e colum n is next brought to proper tem perature, using the m anual control b u tto n , y, and should be a t tem perature when th e th ro ttlin g valve controller is cu t in. T he authors are indebted to T . A. M atthew s, C. F . W einaug, and D . E . S m ith of Phillips Petroleum C om pany L aboratories for assistance o r suggestions and to th e Phillips Petroleum Com p any for permission to publish this paper. LITERATURE CITED (1) (2) (3) (4) B o s s c h a r t, R . A . J ., I n d . E n g . C h e m ., A n a l . E d ., 6, 2 9 (1 9 3 4 ). P o d b ie ln ia k , W . J ., Ib id ., 5, 172 (1 9 3 3 ). I b id ., 13, 6 39 (1 9 4 1 ). R o se , A r th u r , I b id ., 8, 4 7 8 (1 9 3 6 ). Color of A queous Potassium Dichromate Solutions R. E. K IT S O N WITH M . G . M E L L O N Purdue University, Lafayette, Ind. A spectrophotometric study has been made of the color of aqueous potassium dichromate solutions, including the effect of p H and of the concentration of acid, base, and d i chromate. A l l these variables have an effect on the color of the solutions, and any recommendations of potassium dichromate solutions as permanent colorimetric standards should specify the exact nature of the solution. A Q U E O U S solutions of potassium dichrom ate a n d /o r potasI \ sium chrom ate are recom m ended as p erm anent colorimetric standards in a num ber of colorim etric m ethods involving un stable yellow colors. Exam ples are th e following procedures: silica as molybdisilicic acid, residual chlorine in w ater, carotene, an d varnish. In sp ite of these w idespread uses, little work has been done on the color of potassium dichrom ate and potassium chrom ate solutions, especially the effect on them of such variables as pH an d th e kind and am o u n t of acid or base added. H antzsch and C lark (S), N euss an d Itiem an (4), Sherrill (5), Vosburgh an d Cooper (7), and others have studied th e chrom atedichrom ate relationship from the stan d p o in t of th e ionic equilibria involved rath e r th a n th e color of th e solutions. Swank and Mellon (G) pointed o u t th e necessity of buffering potassium chro m ate solutions a t pH 9 to secure color m atches w ith molybdisilicic acid. T h e present spectrophotom etric stu d y was und ertak en to de term ine th e effect of pH , various acids an d bases, and dichrom ate concentration on the color of aqueous potassium dichrom ate solu tions. EXPERIMENTAL WORK A p p a ra tu s a n d S o lu tio n s . T ran sm ittan cy m easurem ents were m ade in 1.000-cm. cells w ith a G eneral E lectric recording spectrophotom eter, ad ju sted for a spectral band w idth of either 5 or 10 m/i. In case of colored reagents, these solutions were used in th e reference cell. Otherwise, redistilled w ater served. All p H m easurem ents were m ade w ith a glass electrode assembly. Stock solutions of potassium dichrom ate were prepared from twice recrystallized sa lt an d redistilled w ater. Tw o solutions, containing 10.00 gram s p er liter and 12.50 gram s per 100 ml., were used. A series of C lark and Lubs buffer solutions was pre pared according to th e directions of C lark (2). E f f e c t o f pH o n t h e C o l o r o f P o ta s s iu m D ic h r o m a te S o lu tio n s . T o study th e effect of p H on th e chrom ate-dichrom ate system , th é desired am ount of potassium dichrom ate solu tion was pipetted into a 50-ml. volum etric flask, and th en di luted to th e m ark w ith a buffer of th e desired pH . T h e contents were mixed and allowed to sit a few m inutes to ensure equilibrium . T he spectral transm ission curve and th e p H were th en d eter mined. In general, dichrom ate solutions a t a low p H have an orange hue, while those a t a high pH are yellow. T hese colors are com m only associated w ith th e dichrom ate and chrom ate ions, re spectively. An interm ediate range exists in which th e hue is ex trem ely sensitive to sm all changes in pH . A t low dichrom ate concentrations this in term ediate range extends from pH 5 to 7, as shown in Figure 1. A t higher concentrations, th e range shifts upw ard, being from pH 6 to 8 a t 2.0 mg. of potassium dichrom ate per ml. A t low concentrations of sa lt th e series of solutions a t various pH values has an isobestic p o in t (I) (Figure 1). W ith different concentrations of dichrom ate, th e transm ittancies of this point v ary according to B eer’s law. T h e w ave length a t th is p o in t de creased from 444 m a a t 0.2 mg. to 440 a t 1.0 m g. of dichro m ate p er ml. A t concentrations g reater th a n 1.0 m g. per ml. the absorption is too high a t these wave lengths to show th e point. E f f e c t o f A c i d s . In studying th e effect of various acids, and in all subsequent work, th e following procedure was used: January 15, 1944 ANALYTIC The dichrom ate solution was p ip etted into a 50-ml. volum etric flask, the acid or base added, an d th e solution diluted to th e m ark a t room tem perature w ith w ater. In case th e w ater could n o t be added to the concentrated acid, approxim ately th e desired am ount was added to th e flask before the acid. T h e tran sm ittancy curves were determ ined w ithin an ho u r after m aking the final volum e adjustm ents. W ith single acids two dichrom ate concentrations were used: 0.4 and 5.0 mg. per ml. T he form er was low enough to show th e relatively flat portion of the tran sm ittan cy curve near 440 m/i, a n d to observe the effect of acid upon it. T he la tte r was high enough so th a t this p a rt of th e curve did n o t appear. T he acid concentration varied from none to concentrated acid. L EDITIO N 43 where th e m inim um should be. E ven a sm all am o u nt of acid shifts th e entire curve tow ard longer wave lengths. T h en acidi ties on up to 9M have little effect on th e color; b u t betw een 9 and 12M th e color changes from orange-red to brown. Above 12il/ there is little further color change. N itric Acid. W ith a low dichrom ate concentration solutions containing nitric acid show th e first of th e tw o color changes noted w ith sulfuric acid-potassium dichrom ate solutions. T he m ini mum near 440 mp appears when th e acidity reaches 5M , and the intensity of th e minim um increases w ith increasing acidity. W ith a high dichrom ate concentration th e entire curve shifts to longer wave lengths as th e nitric acid concentration increases. T he brown color noted w ith sulfuric acid does n o t appear. Phosphoric Acid. Q ualitatively phosphoric acid has m uch the same effect on th e dichrom ate color as nitric acid, b u t q u a n tita tively it differs considerably. W ith a low dichrom ate concen tratio n th e m inim um n ear 440 m/u is definite w ith 0.3Ï1Î acid. Increasing th e acidity to l.OAf increases th e intensity greatly, b u t higher acidities cause little further change. T h e tran sm it tancy curve for high dichrom ate concentrations shifts to longer wave lengths w ith sm all am ounts of acid, but, as before, am ounts greater th a n I .Oil/ have little additional effect. Perchloric A cid, W ith a low dichrom ate concentration, this acid has little effect on th e color. T he minim um in th e trans m ittancy curves does n o t appear, b u t th e percentage tra n sm it tancy of th e horizontal portion of th e tran sm ittan cy curve in creases slightly w ith increased acid concentration. In th e pres ence of larger am ounts of potassium dichrom ate, a precipitate, presum ably potassium perchlorate, appears. Acetic Acid. D ichrom ate solutions containing acetic acid show changes sim ilar to those w ith nitric acid. T h e m agnitude of th e changes is greater th an those w ith nitric acid, although not so large as th e corresponding changes w ith sulfuric acid. Hydrochloric A d d . Although it is generally assumed th a t po tassium dichrom ate does n o t oxidize hydrochloric acid in aqueous solution, th e yellow color of solutions which contain 0.4 mg. of potassium dichrom ate per ml. and w hich are 911/ or stronger in acid disappears w ithin 5 m inutes a fte r addition of th e acid. Because of th is reaction, which proceeds a t a slower ra te in more weakly acidic solutions, hydrochloric acid solutions of po tassium dichrom ate fade and should n o t be used as p erm anent Figure 1. Effect of p H on the Color of Potassium Dichromate Solution pH on curve m g . K2C r t 0 7 p e r m l. I A q u e o u s s o lu t io n 2 . 0..8 I M Hz S O , W ith mixed acids only one concentration of dichrom ate was used: 0.4 mg. per ml. T he to ta l acid concentration did n o t ex ceed th a t likely to be encountered in general analytical practice. W ith the binary m ixtures 5 ml. of each acid per 50-ml. final volume was th e m axim um , while w ith th e te rn ary and q u atern ary mix tures th e m axim um of each acid was lim ited to 3 ml. 3 1 .6 2 4 . 7 .2 0 ■■ 5 1 0 .8 " 6 1 6 .2 ■■ - Lack of space prevents presentation or ad equate description of all the tran sm ittan cy curves. An a tte m p t is m ade in th e follow ing paragraphs to sum m arize th e ir characteristics: Sulfuric Acid. Potassium dichrom ate solutions containing sulfuric acid showr th e greatest v ariation in color of an y of the acids used. W ith a low concentration of dichrom ate, small am ounts of acid give a very definite m inim um in th e curve near 440 mp, th e wave length of th e m inim um being related to the acidity (Figure 2). L arger am ounts of acid, up to 9M , cause no great change. Between 9 and 1111/, however, th e hue of th e solu tions changes from orange to orange-red, an d th e minim um point in the curve disappears. As th e acidity is increased further, there is a shift tow ard an orange-brown hue, w ith no striking change in the curve. A high concentration of dichrom ate behaves similarly, b ut there is no m inim um in the curve a t concentrations m uch greater th an 1 mg. of dichrom ate per ml. because of complete absorption 500...520 540 560 SR0 W a v e le n g th , m jj Figure 2. Effect of Sulfuric A c id on the Color of Potassium Dichromate Solutions 44 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING standards. A solution 0.8M in acid fades ab o u t 2 per cent in 48 hours, and one 0.4A/ in acid fades to th e sam e ex ten t in a m onth. If the fading of th e solution is overlooked, hydrochloric acid affects the color in a m anner sim ilar to nitric acid. T he minim um appears a t 0.4A/ acid, and as th e acid concentration increases the m inim um is more m arked. B inary M ixtures. B inary m ixtures containing sm all am ounts of phosphoric acid and one of th e oth er acids show very definite m inim a near 440 m/i. Changes in th e concentration of th e second acid have only a sm all effect on th e color of th e solution. T he m inim um is present in th e tran sm ittan cy curve even if th e second acid is nitric or perchloric acid, neither of which, alone and a t low concentrations, causes th e m inim um to appear. M ixtures of either perchloric or nitric acid and sulfuric acid show lim ited m inim a form ation a t low, and definite m inim a a t higher, sulfuric acid concentrations. M ixtures of nitric and perchloric acid show no m inim a in the tran sm ittan cy curve. CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 1.2 m g. of potassium dichrom ate per ml. can be determ ined in solutions 1.8M in sulfuric acid or 1.5M in phosphoric acid (Figure 3). B eer’s law is valid over th e entire range in both cases. W ith 1.6M n itric acid, 1.7M acetic acid, or 0.911/ per chloric acid, 0.02 to 0.9 m g. of potassium dichrom ate per ml. can be determ ined if the m easurem ents are m ade in 1-cm. cells a t 430 m/i. B eer’s law is valid only to 0.6 mg. p er ml. for these solutions. If th e dichrom ate solution is ad ju sted to p H 2 or 9, and the tran sm ittan cy m easurem ents are m ade in 1-cm. cells a t 440 m/r th e m easurable range is 0.02 to 1.0 mg. per m l., B eer’s law being valid over th e entire range. E f f e c t o f B a s e . I n this stu d y th e sam e experim ental proce dure w as followed as w ith th e acids. A freshly prepared solu tion, 8A/ in sodium hydroxide, served as the source of the base. A fter enough base has been added to convert the dichrom ate to chrom ate, addition of an excess has little effect. Solutions 8A/ in base show a very slight greenish tin t. DISCUSSION Solutions of potassium chrom ate a n d /o r potassium dichrom ate used as perm anent colorim etric stan d ard s should be buffered to a definite pH . In th e case of th e interm ediate p H values, the buf fer should have a high capacity, since small changes in pH m ake a large change in th e color. A t either a high or low p H th is is n o t so im portant. I t is necessary to specify both th e kind of acid, or acids, an d the am ount of each when acidified dichrom ate solutions are used. If the phosphoric acid is m ore th a n 0.3AZ, sm all v ariations in th e concentration of a second, third, or fo urth acid will n o t seriously change th e color of th e solution. Solutions containing hydro chloric acid are n o t suitable for perm anent standards. A high concentration of base should be avoided, since it a ttack s glass and causes tu rb id ity . A low concentration (pH 9 or 10) gives th e sam e color, w ith m uch less a tta c k on th e container. T h e isobcstic points probably have some significance in term s of th e ionic equilibria involved. C lark (1) sta tes th a t an isobestic po in t is an intersection of all isohydric curves, an d “ consequently the probability of occurrence is low unless tw o colored com pounds and two only have some in tim ate relationship” . Such a po in t in th e chrom ate-dichrom ate transm ission curves seems to indicate th a t only tw o ions are significantly involved in the equilibrium transform ation. T hree ions have been postulated for this system , CrO» , H C rO t- , an d Cr20 7 , th e reactions in volved being Figure 3. Effect of Potassium Dichromate Concentration on the Color of Solutions in 1.5M Phosphoric A c id Ternary M ixtures. Solutions containing sm all am ounts of phosphoric acid w ith tw o oth er acids show a very definite mini m um near 440 my. in the tran sm ittan cy curve. T he intensity of the minim um is n o t m uch affected by sm all changes in th e concen tratio n of either or both of th e o th er acids. Solutions n o t containing phosphoric acid show a lim ited mini mum form ation, and the intensity of th e m inim um is affected by changes in the concentration of th e other acids. Increases in sulfuric acid concentration increase th e minim a, while increases in nitric a n d /o r perchloric acid decrease them . Quaternary M ixtures. T h e spectrophotom etric curves for all th e quaternary m ixtures tested were virtu ally th e same, and all showed a pronounced m inim um near 440 mji. E f f e c t o f D ic h ro m a te C o n c e n tr a tio n . T he range of con centration for m easurem ents of dichrom ate solutions in 1-cm. cells depends on th e am o u n t an d kind of acid used, and th e w ave length a t w hich the m easurem ents are m ade. W ith 1-cm. cells, m easured a t the wave length of m inim um transm ission, 0.02 to C rO r~ + II+ ^ H C rO r (1) 2 H C r O r ;=± C r20 7— + H 20 (2) T he isobestic p o in t would seem to indicate th a t R eaction 1 is of m ajor im portance, since it alone involves hydrogen ions. Calcu lations from th e d a ta of N euss an d R iem an (/) show th a t 88 per cent of th e dichrom ate ion in a solution containing 1 mg. of po tassium dichrom ate per ml. should react to give th e HCrO«- ion. If these d a ta, an d th e facts ab o u t isobestic points, are correct, the absorption spectra of th e HCrO<~ and C r20 7— ions should be sim ilar, since conversion of one form to th e o th er has little effect on th e over-all tran sm ittan cy . LITERATURE CITED (1) Clark, “ D eterm in ation of H ydrogen Io n s” , pp. 153, 154, B alti more, W illiam s & W ilkins C o., 1928. (2) Ib id ., pp. 193 ff. (3) H an tzsch and Clark, Z . ph ysik. Chem., 63, 367 (1908). (4) N eu ss and R iem an, J . A m . Chem. Soc., 56, 2238 (1934). (5) Sherrill, Ibid., 29, 1641 (1907). (6) S w a n k a n d M e llo n , I n d . E n g . C h e m ., A n a l . E d ., 6, 3 4 8 (1 9 3 4 ). (7) Vosburgh and Cooper, J . A m . Chem. Soc., 63, 437 (1941). b s t r a c t e d from a thesis p resented b y R . E . K itson to th e G ra d u a te School of P u rd u e U n iv e rsity in p a rtia l fulfillm ent of th e re q u ire m e n ts for th e degree of d o c to r of philosophy, F e b ru a ry , 1944. A Gravimetric Determination of Tungsten W ith A n ti-1 /S-d i-ip -m e th o xy p h e n y l)-!-h y d ro xy lam ino-3-oxim ino-4-pentene JO H N H . Y O E a n d A . LETCH ER JO N E S 1 University of V irgin ia, Charlottesville, V a . A new organic compound has been developed as a reagent for the gravimetric determination of tungsten. Its physical and chemical properties have been investigated and pro cedures are given for its use in the determination of tungsten in ores and alloys. Determinations of tungsten with the new reagent are equivalent in accuracy to the standard cinchonine method. pressly for this work, was observed to form a highly insoluble yellow precipitate w ith tu n g sta te ions (W 0 4— ) in acid solution. A detailed investigation revealed th a t th is new com pound com bines w ith th e tu n g state ion CH]0<^~ )>CH— C II2— C— C H = C H < ^ HONH ^>OCH, NOH in a definite ratio of one molecule of reag en t to one tu n g state ion and th a t th is reaction m ay be applied to th e gravim etric determ ination of tungsten. procedures for th e gravim etric determ ination of tu n g M OST sten involve separation of th e m ajor portion of th e ele m ent from solution as tungstic acid, H jW O (, by strong m ineral acid treatm en t, and recovery of th e sm all am o u n t rem aining in NATU RE O F R EA CTIO N WITH TU NGSTATE IO N solution by m eans of an organic precipitant. Cinchonine is gen erally used for this purpose. P resent governm ental restrictions T he exact mechanism b y which th e reagent combines w ith the on th e sale of cinchonine for analytical purposes and th e increas tu n g state ion to form th e insoluble complex is n o t know n with ing num ber of applications of tu n g sten an d tungsten alloys to certainty. I t is possibly a salt-form ing reactio n : industrial uses m ake th e introduction of an effective and easily obtainable reagent for tungsten p articularly desirable a t th is CH,Q<( ^>CII— C H r - C — C H = C H < ^ )>OCH, + II,WO« — tim e. T his paper describes a new organic reagent for tungsten, HONH NOH a n ti -1,5 - di - (p - m ethoxyphenyl) - 1 - hydroxylam ino - 3 - oximino-4 pentene, first synthesized in th is labo rato ry and applied to th e analysis of a v ariety of tungsten ores and alloys with highly IIO N H , HNOH satisfactory results. T he com pound m ay now be obtained from ±[WO«]=*= L aM o tte Chemical Products Co., Towson 4, Baltim ore, M d. V arious organic reagents for th e gravim etric determ ination of tun gsten have been proposed since L efort (IS) first reported in 1881 th a t quinine acetate would precipitate tu n g states from solu tion. Crem er (1) reported th e cinchonine reaction in 1895, b u t it w as n o t applied to actu a l analyses u n til a b o u t 20 years later when Low (14) developed a gravim etric procedure employing cinchonine as a p recipitant for tungsten. Jan n asch an d B ettges (8) used hydrazine hydrochloride and strong hydrochloric acid to precipitate tungsten b u t separations were n o t complete by th is m ethod. K norre (11) found benzidine hydrochloride slightly b e tte r th a n hydrazine hydrochloride b u t still n o t en tirely satisfactory. O ther investigators have proposed a v ariety of gravim etric or ganic reagents: a-naphthylam ine and cumidine (23), te tram ethyl-p-dinm inodiphenylm ethane (10, 20), 1,4-diphenylendanilodihydrotriazole (N itron) (4), quinoline (15), tan n in (16, 21), phenylhydrazine hydrochloride (2), 8-hydroxyquinoline (5, 9,1 8 ), vanillylidene-benzidine (7), and rhodam ine B (17). N one of these reagents has proved sufficiently effective to replace cin chonine as th e preferred reagent in stan d ard procedure, although its use involves certain difficulties (1, 6, 12). T he reagent belongs to the basic salinogenic group of organic compounds, m any m em bers of which combine w ith anions such as nitrates, perchlorates, sulfate, phosphates, m olybdates, v an a dates, thiocyanates, etc. (28), in acid m edium . .The “sy n ” iso m er of th e organic com pound is com pletely unreactive w ith the CH,Q<( )>CH — C II2—C— C H = € H HONH )>OCII, HON tu n g state ion. I t crystallizes in the form of colorless plates (m .p. 217° C.). P H Y SIC A L A N D C H E M IC A L PROPERTIES O F R EA G EN T T he reagent crystallizes from ethanol in th e form of sm all yel low needles which m elt a t 156-157° C. (corrected). I t is soluble in th e following organic solvents, solutions being yellow in all instances: ethanol, acetone, eth y l eth er, eth y l acetate, dioxane, acetic acid, an d benzene. T h e com pound is insoluble in w ater and petroleum eth er. Solutions of th e reagent in eth an o l are used in tun g sten analyses. T he solubility is 0.766 gram of re agent p e r 100 ml. of ethanol a t 25° C. S o l u b i l i t y o f T u n g s t e n C o m p l e x . A n experim ent was conducted to determ ine w hether or n o t th e precip itated organotungsten complex was soluble in w ater to th e e x ten t of one p a rt per million. E arly in 1931 a system atic investigation of th e reactiv ity of organic com pounds, w ith respect to color an d precipitate form a tion w ith inorganic ions, was begun in this laboratory. S tan d ard solutions of a b o u t eighty inorganic ions were prepared and tested, in b o th acid an d alkaline m edium , w ith various ty p es of organic com pounds, especially those w ith one or m ore chelating or salt-form ing groups. T he oximes, as a class, appeared to be one of th e m ost prom ising ty p es to tr y in th is search for specific an d highly sensitive reagents for inorganic ions. D uring the 1930’s several new and im p o rtan t organic analytical reagents were discover«^ in th is laboratory (19, 24-27). In 1940 an ti - 1,5 - di - (p - m ethoxyphenyl) - 1 - hydroxylam ino - 3 - oxim ino-4-pentene, one of a series of com pounds synthesized ex- One milligram of finely pulverized dried complex (dried a t 105° C. for 2 hours) was introduced into a flask containing 1 liter of w ater a t 25° C. T he w ater w as m echanically stirred for one week. A t th e end of th a t time, th e complex had n o t dissolved; hence it w as concluded th a t its solubility is less th a n 1 mg. per liter of w ater—i.e., 1 p.p.m . 1 P rese n t address, C ornell U n iversity , Ith a c a , N . Y . 45 46 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 f T he pure reagent is pale yellow in color b u t is slowly darkened by light. T his discolora tion does not affect its reactivity wit h tungstates. N o discolora tion occurs if stored in d ark bottles. R e a c t io n s w it h I n o r g a n ic I o n s T ests for reactivity with inorganic ions were m ade on porcelain spot plates by adding a drop of an ethanol solution of th e reagent to a drop of solution containing the respective ions (approxim ately 0.05 mg.) in both acid and alkaline m edium where possible. No reactions were ob served betw een th e reagent an d any of th e following ions: S t a b il it y o p R e a g e n t to L ig h t . Ag+, A l+++, A s+++, A s0 4 , B 40 7— , B a++, B e++, B i+++, Br~, CO,— , C a++, C b 0 4 , C d ++, C e++\ C l“ , Co++, C r+++, C s+, D y +++, E r +++, E u +++, F ~, F e++, G a+++, G d +++, G e + + + + (aqueous solution of GeOj), IIfO ++, H g +, H g ++, I , I n +++, K + , L a+++, L i+, M g++, M n ++, N O r , N O r , N a+, N d +++, N i++, H P 0 4“ , P b ++. P r +++, P tC l5— , R b +, R e 0 4- , R h+++, R u +++, S— , S 0 4— , S b +++, Sc+++, SeO, , S i O , ~ , Sm +++, S r++, T a 0 4 , TeO*“ , T iO ++, T h ++++, T l+++, T m +++, VO+, Y +++, Y b +++, Zn+ +, Z r+ +++ (ZrO ++). Auric, eerie, and iridic ions produce brown precipitates w ith the reagent b u t these are extrem ely rare in tun g sten ores and alloys. Ferric iron reacts to form a sm all am o u n t of brown precipitate b u t n o t enough to interfere even in th e analysis of steels contain ing tungsten. Stannous and stannic tin s produce an orange and a yellow pre cipitate, respectively, w ith the reagent. C opper reacts in alkaline solution to produce a brown precipi ta te b u t does not react a t all in acid medium. In analysis, th e re agent is alw ays used in acid solution; hence copper presents no interference. M olybdates are precipitated b u t n o t quantitativ ely . W hen m olybdenum and tungsten are present together, a sm all am o u n t of m olybdenum m ay precipitate w ith th e tungsten. T he pre cipitation of m olybdenum by the reagent is no greater th a n when cinchonine is used (see procedure for analysis of steels an d alloys; cf. analysis of N .B .S. steel 132). T he only other ions found to react w ith th e reagent are .UO,++ an d OsOs , which produce an orange an d brow n precipitate, respectively. OPTIMUM EXPERIMENTAL CONDITIONS P e r m i s s i b l e A c i d i t y . T ungsten is q u an titativ ely precipi ta te d by the reagent when th e acidity is less th a n p H 1. P artial precipitation occurs above p H 1 an d above p H 5 no precipitation occurs. T he best acidity to use is ab o u t 0.2Ar hydrochloric acid. Sulfuric and nitric acids m ay also be used, b u t in th e presence of lead or tin sulfuric acid is objectionable and nitric acid solu tions stronger th a n IN begin to a tta c k th e reagent. T e m p e r a t u r e o f S o l u t i o n . Room tem perature is preferable for effective precipitation of th e tungsten complex. P recipita tion begins im m ediately upon addition of th e reagent in cold solution, w ith th e precipitate collecting an d settling m uch more readily th a n if the solution is hot. T he reagent should therefore n o t be added to hot solutions. A m o u n t o f R e a g e n t R e q u i r e d . T he reagent combines w ith tu ngstate ions in a ratio of 1 to 1. However, when th e approxi m ate q u a n tity of tungsten is know n, it is recom m ended th a t twice th e theoretical am oun t of reagent be added to ensure com plete an d rapid precipitation. If th e tun g sten content is un known, th e am ount of reagent required m ay be judged by ob serving the color of th e precipitated complex as it forms. T i m e N e c e s s a r y f o r C o m p l e t e P r e c i p i t a t i o n . Complete precipitation is obtained when solutions are allowed to stan d a t room tem perature for 3 hours a fte r th e addition of excess reagent, w ith occasional stirring to collect th e precipitate. Allowing solutions to stan d overnight ensures com plete precipitation b u t is n o t necessary. W a s h i n g t h e P r e c i p i t a t e . T he m ost effective wash solution has been found to be a cold, dilute hydrochloric acid solution containing a small am ount of th e reagent. I t is prepared b y d i luting 20 ml. of concentrated hydrochloric acid to 1 liter and adding I ml. of a satu rated ethanol solution of th e reagent. F i n a l T r e a t m e n t o f P r e c i p i t a t e . A ttem p ts to weigh the organo-tungstate precipitate directly, after washing an d drying, indicate th a t th e m ethod is im practical. C onditions have to be tediously controlled to get consistent results. T h e difficulties arise from th e fact th a t th e reaction m u st occur in acid solution and th a t th e reagent itself precipitates when added in sm all ex cess. Unless th e reagent is added im m ediately after acidifying the solution, some tungsten m ay p recipitate as tungstic acid and be occluded in the organic precipitate, preventing a considera tion of it as a com pound of definite composition. I t is also diffi cu lt to remove precipitated reagent from th e complex w ithout a t th e sam e tim e dissolving some of th e complex. T h e complex m ay be ignited easily to tungstic oxide, W Os, in which case it m akes no difference if tungstic acid an d excess re agent are present, because tungstic acid is converted to tungstic oxide an d excess reagent is com pletely rem oved upon ignition T he precip itated complex is easily and rap id ly separated by filtration thro u g h q u a n tita tiv e ashless filter paper. W hatm an filter paper N o. 40 an d other papers of sim ilar tex tu re and grade are suitable for q u a n tita tiv e analyses w hen using th is reagent. F iltratio n is m ost rapidly accomplished if th e p recipitated com plex is allowed to settle (about 3 hours is sufficient) an d the solution filtered b y d ecantation. T here is very little tendency for th e p recipitate to clog th e pores of th e paper, th u s p erm itting thorough washing «nth a m inim um tim e consum ption. T h e washed p recipitate m ay be ignited w ith o u t difficulty. T here is no tendency for explosion, or decom position rapid enough to sweep o u t an y of th e contents of th e crucible. T he precipi ta te an d th e filter paper decompose a t a b o u t th e sam e rate. M oisture should be rem oved a t ab o u t 100 ° C. before raising the tem perature of th e crucible an d contents to ignition tem perature. T he crucible should n o t be heated above a dull red until all car bon has been b urned off. DETERMINATION OF TUNGSTEN IN SOLUTIONS, STEELS, A L L O Y S , A N D ORES Of th e various procedures investigated, a modification of th a t of H illebrand an d Lundell (6, pp. 553-5) has been found m ost satisfactory for th e analysis of tungsten ores. F or steels and tungsten alloys, m odifications of th e procedures of th e American Society for T esting M aterials (22, pp. 1011-2) are both speedy a n d accurate. D e t e r m i n a t i o n i n O r e s . T ran sfer to a 400-ml. beaker 1 gram of sam ple w hich has been ground in an agate m o rtar to 200-mesh or finer an d dried to co n stan t w eight a t 105° C. U n less th e sam ple is ground to 200-mesh or finer, a protective layer of precipitated tungstic acid m ay coat th e particles, preventing the hydrochloric and nitric acids from coming in con tact w ith all the unreacted m aterial. T h is is especially tru e w ith ferberite and w olframite, which are difficult to decompose. If sufficient hydrochloric acid is used an d the tem perature is held a t approxi m ately 75° C., th e form ation of tungstic acid on th e particles m ay be avoided. Serious error m ay be introduced by this effect if sam ples of particle size m uch larger th a n 200-mesh are used. T he m agnitude of th e error depends on th e m ineral being analyzed. Scheelite, C a W 0 4, an d hubncrite, M n W 0 4, are easily decomposed by th e hydrochloric-nitric acid treatm en t, in which case th e error is sm all; ferberite, F e W 0 4, and w olframite, (F e,M n )W 0 4, being m uch m ore difficult to decompose, require very sm all particle size. Add 5 ml. of distilled w ater an d ro tate th e beaker so as to dis trib u te th e sam ple evenly over its bottom . A dd 100 ml. of hy drochloric acid (sp. gr. 1.19), cover th e beaker w ith a w atch glass, and h eat for one hour a t a tem perature n o t exceeding 60° C. S tir occasionally to break up form ations of crusts and to facilitate co n tac t of th e acid w ith all particles of th e sam ple. Raise th e w atch glass on glass hooks a n d cautiously boil to a volume of a b o u t 50 ml. B reak up th e m aterial on th e bo tto m of th e beaker w ith a glass stirring rod. A dd 40 ml. of hydrochloric acid an d 15 m l. of nitric acid an d again boil th e solution to about 50 ml. S tir up th e caked m a tte r again, add 5 ml. of nitric acid, a n d boil to 10 or 15 ml. D ilute to 250 ml. w ith h o t w ater and h e a t ju s t below boiling for 30 m inutes. Allow to cool to room tem perature and add 25 ml. of alcoholic reagent solution (made by dissolving 0.7 gram of reagent in 100 ml. of ethanol) slowly w ith co n stan t stirring. Allow th e p recipitate to settle for about 2 hours an d te s t the su p ern a tan t liquid w ith a few drops of the reagent for complete precipitation of th e tungsten. 1 ! January IS, 1944 ANALYTIC Because of th e lim ited solubility of th e reagent in aqueous solutions, some precipitate m ay be expected to form whenever th e reagent is added. T he appearance of th e precipitate formed in th e presence of tungsten is different from th a t form ed when th e la tte r is absent. T he organic tu n g state is deep yellow-orange in color while th e precipitated reagent alone is alm ost w hite. I t is advisable for a n analyst using th e reagent for th e first tim e to add some of it to a solution of sodium or am m onium tu n g state (1 mg., of tu n g state per m l.) acidified w ith 8 or 10 volumes of 0.2JV hydrochloric acid. T he same am ount of reagent should be added to a sim ilar volum e of 0.2N acid alone. T h e striking dif ference betw een the color of th e reagent an d th a t of th e organotu n g state m ay be observed by th is simple procedure. In testing a solution for completeness of precipitation of tu n g Bten, more reagent should be added if an orange precipitate is formed. If it is w hite or pale yellow, precipitation of th e tu n g sten is complete. A fter th e precipitate has settled a t least 2 hours (or overnight if convenient) filter by decantation thro u g h an ll-c m . ashiess filter paper. W ash th e precip itate several tim es w ith reagent wash solution. T ransfer the precipitate to an ashiess filter paper an d m oder ately scrub th e beaker by m eans of a ru b b er policeman to remove, as far as possible, any precipitate adhering to th e walls of the beaker. I t is n o t necessary a t th is point to a tte m p t to remove all th e finely divided tungstic acid adhering to th e walls of the beaker, since the m ain precipitate, a fte r it is washed, is to be transferred back to th is beaker an d all th e precipitated tungsten redissolved. W ash w ith th e prepared w ash solution. R ep eat several times and set aside the combined filtrate an d washings. T e st th e fil tra te w ith a few drops of reagent solution for complete precipita tion of the tungsten. I t is rare th a t an y is found in this filtrate. T ransfer th e filter paper containing the washed precipitate to the original beaker an d add 6 ml. of concentrated am m onium hy droxide. Shred th e filter paper to a uniform pulp b y m eans of a glass stirring rod, cover the beaker, an d w arm gently for a few m inutes. S tir th e pasty m ass w ith th e rod, th en w ash down the inside of th e beaker w ith w arm dilute am m onium hydroxide (1 to 9) containing 10 gram s of am m onium chloride p er liter. W arm again and stir thoroughly. F ilte r through an ll-c m . ashiess filter paper and collect th e filtrate in a 400-ml. beaker. W ash the original beaker and residue several tim es w ith th e w arm dilute am m onium hydroxide solution; betw een washings, squeeze as m uch of th e liquid from th e fibers of th e pulp as possible. W ash th e beaker and residue w ith several sm all portions of h o t 95 per cent ethanol to dissolve any organo-tungstote th a t has n o t been decomposed by the am m onium hydroxide tre atm e n t. Follow w ith a final washing w ith the w arm d ilute am m onium hydroxide solution. K eep th e volum e of liquid as sm all as possible. R e serve th e residue of filter fiber for fu rth e r recovery of traces of tungsten. E v ap o rate th e filtrate to a volum e of a b o u t 50 m l.; ad d 20 ml. of concentrated hydrochloric acid and 10 ml. of concentrated nitric acid; cover and cautiously boil to a volum e of 10 to 15 ml. If an y organic residue is still present an d ten d s to adhere to the walls of th e beaker, it m ay be decomposed by th e addition of more hydrochloric an d nitric acids in th e sam e ratio as above. D ilute th e solution to ab o u t 250 ml. w ith w ater an d allow it to cool slowly to room tem perature. A dd th e alcoholic reagent solution until th e color of the precipitate, as it forms, indicates complete precipitation of th e tungsten. Allow th e precipitate to settle and filter through an ll-c m . ashiess filter p aper; w ash thoroughly w ith reagent w ash solution. If th e filtrate has a clear yellow tin t, precipitation is complete. I f it is colorless, m ore reagent m ust be added to complete th e precipitation. T h e w ashed pre cipitate is the m ain precipitate an d is to be ignited w ith th e very small am ounts of tungsten th a t m ay be obtained in th e procedure described in th e following paragraphs. A ny tungsten th a t m ay not have been recovered is contained in th e reserved residue of filter fiber, in com bination w ith iron or alum ina or w ith sm all am ounts of reagent th a t were n o t com pletely dissolved. T his combined tun g sten m ay be dissolved by digesting the filter paper and residue of fiber w ith w arm dilute hydrochloric acid (1 to 9). F ilte r an d w ash th e residue w ith small am ounts of h o t 0.5 per cent am m onium chloride solution and the w arm dilute am m onium hydroxide w ash solution, col lecting all in th e sam e vessel. Acidify th e filtrate w ith hydro chloric acid u n til it is approxim ately 0.2Ar an d th en slowly add 5 to 10 ml. of alcoholic reagent solution. Any precipitate L E D ITI O N 47 obtained should bo filtered an d w ashed w ith th e reag en t wash solution. R eserve th e w ashed precipitate and ignite la te r w ith th e m ain one already obtained. The residue th a t now rem ains is usually free from tungsten. To be positive, ignite it in a porcelain crucible (not a platinum crucible because tin m ig h t be present), tran sfer th e ash to a platinum crucible, and volatilize th e silicon by tre a tin g it w ith hydrofluoric an d sulfuric acids. Fuse th e rem aining residue w ith as little sodium carbonate as possible, cool, and e x tract the m elt w ith w ater. F ilte r and acidify th e filtrate w ith hydrochlo ric acid, boil to expel carbon dioxide, an d ad d dropwise some of the reagent solution to te s t for the possible presence of tu n g state ions. If th e precipitate is orange, upon th e addition of the first few drops of reagent, filter it off, w ash w ith th e reag en t wash solu tion and ignite w ith th e tw o residues already obtained. (The authors have never obtained any organo-tungstate p recipitate a t this point.) Place th e papers containing th e m ain precipitate and th e two recoveries in a weighed platinum crucible and h e a t a t a tem pera ture below a dull red u n til all th e carbon has been burned off. Cool, add a few drops of hydrofluoric acid to th e residue (enough to m oisten it com pletely), ad d a drop of sulfuric acid and evapo ra te to dryness over a w ater or sand b ath . Reignite in order to get the weight of W 0 3 free from S i0 2. T he tungstic oxide obtained a t th is point is not pure b u t m ust be examined for contam inants. T h e exam ination for contam i n ants does n o t involve any changes from th e stan d ard procedures now in use (3; 6, p. 555; 22). T he contam inants m ost a p t to be present a t th is po in t are principally iron and m olybdenum , w ith very small traces of phosphorus. T he iron is separated by fusion w ith sodium carbonate, dissolving in h o t w ater, and filtering. T ungsten and m olybdenum (if present) form soluble sodium salts. If m olybdenum is present, th e am ount of its contam ination m ay be determ ined colorim etrically (3; 22, pp. 1008-9) in th e fil trate. I t is rare th a t th e am ount of phosphorus present justifies a te st for it. T he w eights of contam inants found are su b tracted as oxides from th e w eight of im pure tungstic oxide and th e cor rected weight is used to calculate the percentage of tungstic oxide or tungsten in th e sample. D e t e r m i n a t i o n i n A l l o y s a n d M e t a l s . T re a t 1 gram of the finely divided m etallic sam ple w ith 5 ml. of hydrofluoric acid in a large covered p latinum crucible or dish. A fter th e initial effervescence has ceased, add nitric acid dropwise un til th e m etal has dissolved. A dd 15 ml. of sulfuric acid (1 to 1), transfer the vessel to a sand b ath , and h e a t cautiously until dense fum es of sulfur trioxide are evolved freely. Perchloric acid m ay be sub stitu ted for sulfuric acid if desired. In this case, add 15 ml. of perchloric acid (60 per cent) a fter th e hydrofluoric-nitric acid tre atm e n t an d h ea t cautiously to dense fumes of perchloric acid. Cool, dilute, and tran sfer in th e sam e m anner as when sulfuric acid is used. T h e use of perchloric acid shortens slightly th e tim e necessary for th is p a rt of th e analysis, b u t otherwise offers no particu lar advantage. Allow to cool and tran sfer th e co n ten ts to a 400-ml. beaker by washing th e p latinum vessel w ith a fine stream of w ater. W ipe th e vessel w ith a sm all piece of ashiess filter paper and tran sfer it to th e beaker. R inse th e vessel w ith a little w arm am m onium hydroxide (1 to 1), a little w ater, th en a little h o t hydrochloric acid (1 to 1). R ep eat th e treatm en ts with am m onium hydroxide, w ater, and hydrochloric acid, adding all rinsings to th e 400-ml. beaker. D ilute th e contents of th e beaker w ith w ater to a b o u t 150 ml. Add 10 ml. of hydrochloric acid (sp. gr. 1.19), cover w ith a w atch glass supported on glass hooks, and boil cautiously for a t least 5 m inutes. Rem ove th e source of h e a t an d dilute th e contents to a b o u t 350 ml. w ith w ater. Allow to cool and add slowly, w ith co n stan t stirring, 15 to 20 ml. of alcoholic reagent solution (0.7 gram per 100 ml. of 95 per cent ethanol). Allow th e p recipitate to settle for a b o u t 2 hours and te s t th e su p e rn a ta n t liquid for complete precipitation of th e tungsten. If an orange precipitate forms upon the addition of m ore reagent, precipita tion is incom plete. If th e precip itate is alm ost w hite, separation of tungsten is complete. W hen the p recipitate has com pletely settled, filter by d ecanta tion through an ll-c m . ashiess paper. W ash th e p recipitate several tim es w ith reagent wash solution, ignite th e p aper and residue, in th e platinum vessel in w hich th e sam ple was tre ate d originally, a t a tem perature below a dull red h e a t u n til all of th e carbon is consumed. A dd a few drops of nitric acid an d evapo ra te to dryness on a w ater or sand b ath. Ig n ite to co n stan t w eight (preferably in an electric muffle furnace) a t a tem p eratu re n o t exceeding 750° C. T his is th e w eight of im pure tungstic oxide. Add a b o u t 5 gram s of sodium carbonate and carefully h e at until a clear m elt is obtained. R o ta te th e fused m ass in th e vessel until it solidifies around th e wall of th e container. W hen cool, dissolve th e m elt in ho t w ater, filter through an 11-em. ashiess paper, and wash thoroughly w ith hot w ater. Place the filter in 48 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING th e crucible and ignite again. R epeat th e sodium carbonate fu sion on the small residue, using a proportionately sm aller am ount of carbonate th an in th e first fusion. Cool and dissolve in th e same m anner as before. F ilter and w ash thoroughly to rem ove all traces of sodium carbonate. Ig n ite in th e same platinum ves sel, cool, and weigh. S u b tra c t th e w eight of this oxide residue from th a t of the original im pure tungstic oxide. Calculate the percentage of tungsten from the corrected w eight of tungstic oxide. If m olybdenum is present, th e am o u n t of its contam ination of th e tungsten precipitate can be determ ined in th e sodium car bonate extracts. T his is best done colorim etricallv (3; 22, pp. 1008-9). A N A LY SIS OF STANDARD TUNGSTATE SOLUTIONS A stan d ard tu n g state solution was prepared from c .p . tungstic acid (HjWO<, 99.84 per cent pure) by fusion w ith sodium hy droxide in a silver crucible. T he fusion m ass was dissolved in w ater and diluted to th e m ark in a volum etric flask. M easured volumes of this solution were tak en and acidified to 0.2N w ith hydrochloric acid and the tungsten w as precipitated by th e addi tion of an ethanol solution of th e new reagent. In order to com pare the tw o reagents, the tu n g sten was also precipitated by cin chonine from a sim ilar series of solutions. T he precipitated com plexes were filtered off through q u an titativ e paper and ignited in platinum crucibles to tungstic oxide (Table I). APPLICATIO N OF PROCEDURES N atio n al B ureau of S tan d ards sam ples Nos. 50a, 132, and 75 were used to stu d y th e appli cability of the procedure to th e determ ination of tungsten in steels an d alloys (Table II ). One-gram sam ples were used and th e tungsten was precipitated and separated according to th e procedure given for th e analysis of tun g sten alloys and m etals. A n a l y s i s o f O r e s . Samples of scheelite and ferberite (ob tained through the courtesy of G. E. F . Lundell, N ational B ureau of S tandards, W ashington, D . C.), an d w olfram ite (supplied by th e C allite T ungsten C orporation, U nion C ity, N . J.) were analyzed by the procedure outlined for th e determ ination of tungsten in ores (Table I I I ) . One-gram sam ples were used. A n a ly s is o f S te e ls a n d A llo y s . DISCUSSION OF RESULTS OF A N A LY SE S T he results obtained in th e analyses of th e solutions, steels, alloys, and ores show th a t anti-1,5-di-(p-m ethoxyphenyl)-lhydroxylamino-3-oximino-4-pentene m ay be applied to th e gravi- Table 1. Standard Tungsten Solutions Sam ple WO» P re se n t M g. 1 2 9 .1 1 8 .5 1 8 .0 1 8 .0 3 4 Table II. Sam ple 1 2 3 4 5 WO» F o u n d b y C inchonine M 0. 9 .1 1 8 .5 1 7 .9 18.1 Steels and A llo y s M ate rial N .B .S . ch ro m c-tu n g sten -v an ad iu m steel N o . 50a N .B .S . m o ly b d cn u m -tu n g sten steel N o. 132 W P re se n t % 1 8 .2 5 ° 6 .2 9 ° 6 7 8 9 10 WO» F o u n d b y N ew R ea g e n t M o. 9 .1 1 8 .5 18 .0 18.1 N .B .S . ferro -tu n g aten N o. 75 7 5 .2 ° W F o u n d D ifference % % 18.35 + 0 .10 18.21 -0 .0 4 18.27 + 0 .02 6 .5 8 6 .6 5 6 .7 3 6 .3 4 6 .3 4 7 5 .3 6 75 .1 1 + 0 .2 9 6 + 0 .3 6 6 + 0 .4 4 6 + 0 .0 5 c + 0 .0 5 « + 0 .2 - 0 .1 “ N a tio n a l B u re au of S ta n d a rd s certificate value. S N .B .S . N o. 132 co n tain s 7 % (approx.) m o lybdenum . I n sam ples 4, 5, an d 6 , no correction was m ade on ig n ited tu n g s tic oxide for m olybdic oxide as a c o n ta m in an t. e I n sam ples 7 an d 8 , m o ly b d en u m co n ta m in atin g oxide was d eterm ined colorim etrically a n d co rrectio n s applied. H ig h resu lts of sam ples 4, 5, a n d 6 are ev id en tly d u e to presence of m olybdic oxide. CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 m etric determ ination of tun g sten in these m aterials. T he varia tion of percentage values betw een individual sam ples is well w ithin th e range of v ariation encountered b y th e use of oth er ac ceptable gravim etric m ethods. W ith th e N atio n al B ureau of S tandards sam ples, th e values found b y th is m ethod are w ithin th e range of v ariation of values reported by th e various analysts using o th er m ethods. T h e sm all variations in percentage found b y th is m ethod are believed to be due to experim ental technique ra th e r th a n an y inconsistency in th e behavior of th e new reagent. In th e analysis of N .B.S. steel 132, w hich contains approxi m ately equal am ounts of tun g sten and m olybdenum (7 per cent m olybdenum an d 6 per cent tungsten) it was necessary to d eter m ine th e am ount of m olybdenum contam inating th e tungsten p recip itate and correct for it. Table III. O res 1 2 Scheelite W Oj P rese n t % 5 9 .6 ° 3 4 5 F e rb e rite 66.0« 6 6 .0 8 6 6 .2 5 65 .9 7 + 0 .1 + 0 .3 6 W olfram ite 6 9 .3 9 t 6 9 .4 0 69 .2 3 + 0 .0 1 -0 .1 6 Sam ple M ate rial 7 WO» F ound % 59 .5 3 5 9 .7 0 D ifference % - 0 .1 + 0 .1 0 .0 « T e n ta tiv e values supplied b y G . E . F . L undell. Sam ples w ere d ried for 18 hours a t 105° C. before being analyzed b y D r. L u n d ell in 1918. T h e y w ere d ried u n d e r sam e conditions for analysis w ith new tu n g ste n reagent, a fte r each was th o ro u g h ly mixed. &V alue supplied b y C allite T u n g ste n C o rp o ra tio n on basis of air-dried sam ple of a com m ercial w olfram ite ore. LITERATURE CITED (1) Cremer, F ., Eng. M in in g J ., 59, 345 (1895). (2) D otreppe, G ., B ull. soc. chim. Belg., 38, 385 (1929). (3) G rim aldi, F . S., and W ells, R . C ., I n d . E n g . C hem ., A n a l . E d ., 15, 315 (1943). (4) G utbier, A., and W eise, G . L., Z. anal. Chem. 53, 426 (1914). (5) H alberstadt, S., Ibid., 92, 86 (1933). (6) H illebrand, W . F., and Lundell, G . E. F ., "Applied Inorganic A n alysis” , p. 552, N ew Y ork, John W iley & Sons, 1929. (7) Ilovork a, V ., Collection Czechoslov. Chem. Com m un., 10, 518 (1938). (8) Jannasch, P ., and B ettges, W ., B er. 37, 2219 (1904). (9) Jilek, A ., and Ryädnek, A ., Collection Czechoslov. Chem. Commun., 5, 136 (1933). (10) K afka, E., Z. anal. Chem., 52, 601 (1913). (11) Knorre, G. v., B cr., 38, 783, 789, 2512 (1905). (12) Lam bie, D . A ., A n alyst, 64, 481 (1939). (13) Lefort, G ., Compt. rend., 92, 1461 (1881). (14) Low’, A. H ., Eng. M in in g J ., 106, 27 (1918). (15) M ellet, R ., H d v. Chim . A cta, 6, 656, (1923). (16) M oser, L., and B laustein, W ., M onatsh., 52, 351 (1929). (17) O ats, J. T ., Eng. M in in g J ., 144, N o . 4, 72 (1943). (18) Otero, E., and M ontequi, R ., Anales, soc. espafl. f is . qulm ., 33, 132 (1935). (19) O vcrholser, L. G ., and Y oe, J. H ., I n d . E n g . Chem ., A n a l . E d ., 15, 310 (1943). (20) Papafil, M ., and Cernatesoo, R ., A n n . S ei. Univ. J assy, 16, 526 (1931). (21) Schoeller, W . R „ and Jahn, C „ A n alyst, 52, 504 (1927). (22) S cott, W . W ., "Standard M ethods of C hem ical A n alysis” , 5th ed., edited by N . II. Furm an, V ol. I, pp. 1007-9, N ew York, D . Van N ostrand Co., 1939. (23) T schilikin, M „ B er., 42, 1302 (1909). (24) Y oe, J. H „ A m . Chem. Soc., 54, 4139 (1932). (25) Y oe, J. H „ and H all, R . T „ Ibid., 59, 872 (1937). (26) Y oe, J. H ., and Overholser, L. G ., I n d . E n g . Chem ., A n a l . E d ., 15, 73 (1943). (27) Y oe, J. H ., and O verholser, L . G ., J . A m . Chem. Soc., 61, 2058 (1939). (28) Y oe, J. H ., and Sarver, L . A ., “ Organic A n alytical R eagen ts” , p. 158, N ew Y ork, John W iley & Sons, 1941. from a d isse rta tio n p re sen te d b y A . L e tc h e r Jones to th e G ra d u a te F a c u lty of th e U n iv e rsity of V irginia in p a rtia l fulfillm en t of th e re q u ire m e n ts for th e degree of d o cto r of philosophy, M ay , 1943. A b s tra c te d > Dichromate Determination of Iron, Using the Silver Reductor J . L . H E N R Y A N D R. W . G E L B A C H , State Co llege of Washington, Pullman, Wash. a t a rate of a b o u t 30 ml. p er m inute. T he reductor was w ashed w ith 150 ml. of 1 m olar hydrochloric acid added in sm all portions. T o th e reduced solution 5 ml. of 85% phosphoric acid and 5 to 6 drops of 0.25% diphenylam ine sulfonic acid were added, an d the solution was titra te d w ith potassium dichrom ate. T he results, shown in T able I, deviated from those of th e W alden m ethod by only 0.06% error. Sim ilar analyses were m ade by introducing in th e first series 25-ml. portions of 0.01 m olar potassium dichrom ate, in th e second 0.1 molar m anganese chloride, and in th e th ird 0.1 m olar titanium sulfate. C ontrols were run on each ion by passing th e solution through th e reductor in th e absence of iron. In each case one drop of 0.1 norm al potassium dichrom ate gave a d istin ct end point. E m ethod of W alden, H am m ett, and E dm onds (4) for th e T Hdeterm ination of iron using th e silver reductor and titra tin g w ith eerie sulfate, although highly satisfactory, is expensive be cause of the relatively high cost of th e eerie sulfate and its very high equivalent w eight. In th e titra tio n large q u an tities of sul furic acid are required. T h e dichrom ate m ethod as presented in this paper overcomes these objections and seems to retain th e more desirable features. In the analysis of ores and alloys of iron th e common im purities which m ay interfere w ith th e reduction and subsequent titra tio n are chromium, manganese, molybdenum , titan iu m , an d vana dium . M olybdenum m ay be separated from iron by precipitating iron as the hydrous oxide. In the silver reductor, chrom ium is n o t reduced below the triv alen t sta te , while m anganese and tita nium are n o t reduced a t all. V anadium is reduced to th e vanadyl ion which is n o t oxidized b y either cerate or dichrom ate ions. Table I. Solution A dded MU I t has been shown th a t reliable results can be obtained in the presence of chrom ium , manganese, or tita n iu m w ith acidities ranging betw een 0.5 and 1.5 m olar. Checks were obtained w ith titra tio n acidities as low as 0.1 m olar and as high as 2 m olar, b u t a t th e extremes of concentration th e end points were n o t sharp. T he results shown in T able I indicate th a t these ions do n o t in ter fere w ith th e analysis. In the presence of high concentrations of vanadium an indis tin c t end p o in t was obtained, th e color change being from ligh t green to gray. T itra tio n s were m ade in the presence of a wide range of concentrations of vanadyl ion; u p to concentrations of 100 mg. of vanadium per 200 ml. of titra tin g volum e a v ery sharp end p o in t was obtained. T h e deep violet color wras n o t shown as in the absence of vanadium b u t th ere was; a d istin c t color change from light green to deep blue. T h e results of these runs checked well w ith th e accepted value for iron in th e sta n d ard ferric chloride solution. Effect of A d d e d Impurities (V olum e of F eC li. 25 ml.) N o. of D e tn 8. Fe Found Gram F ro m previous sta n d a rd iz a tio n 0 N one 25 O.OlJVf K jC rjO r 25 0 . 1 3 f M n C li 25 O .lA f TiCSOi)* 5 O .litfN a V O i 10 O .lilfN a V O . 15 0 A M N aV O i 20 0 . lJlf N aV O j 40 1 0 m l. of each 0 6 5 10 2 2 3 2 2 0.1 7 5 5 0.1 7 5 0 0.1 7 5 7 0.1 7 6 0 0 .1 7 5 6 0 .1 7 5 5 0 .1 7 5 4 0.1 7 5 4 0 .1 7 5 3 0 .1 7 5 4 A verage D e v iatio n P .p . 1000 ‘o .6 - 1.1 2.8 0 .6 0 0 .6 0 .6 1.1 0 .6 • F ro m th e s ta n d a rd m eth o d of W ald en , H a m m e tt, a n d E d m o n d s. T$ro samples obtained from th e B ureau of S tan d ard s were analyzed: iron ore, B. of S. N o. 27, and ferrovanadium alloy, B. of S. N o. 61. T h e sam ples were dissolved according to recom m ended procedures accom panying th e samples. T he rem oval of m olybdenum from th e alloy was accomplished by tw ice precipi tatin g th e hydrated ferric oxide from am m oniacal solution. In each instance th e acidity was adjusted to 1 m olar w ith hydro chloric acid and reduced as before. R esults of th e analyses are shown in T able II. T he oxidation potential in I N hydronium -ion concentration of the system , VO< -V O ++, is given as 1.2 volts (1), and th a t of diphenylam ine sulfonic acid is 0.83 vo lt (8), which according to W alden, H am m ett, and E dm onds (8) is sufficiently below th e v anadate-vanadyl potential to give precise results. Adj usting the a cidity to approxim ately IN and adding 5 ml. of 85% phosphoric acid, one obtains a condition favorable to the titra tio n of ferrous ion w ith potassium dichrom ate even in th e presence of vanadium . Table II. M ATERIALS B . of S. S am ple S tandard solutions of eerie am m onium sulfate and potassium dichrom ate were prepared in th e usual m anner and standardized against pure iron wire. T h ey were also checked against a gravim etrically standardized solution of ferric chloride, using stannous chloride reduction. A solution of ferric chloride standardized gravim etrically was used in studying the behavior of th e dichrom ate-diphenylam ine sulfonic acid titratio n in th e presence of th e ions of chromium, m anganese, vanadium , and titanium . T he effect of im purities was studied b y adding definite q u an ti ties of 0.01 m olar potassium dichrom ate, 0.1 m olar manganese chloride, 0.1 m olar sodium vanadate, an d 0.1 m olar titan iu m sulfate. T he la tte r was prepared by fusing 4 gram s of titan iu m dioxide w ith 80 gram s of potassium hydrogen sulfate, dissolving in 55 ml. of concentrated sulfuric acid, and diluting th e resulting solution to 500 ml. T he silver reductor was prepared in th e m anner described by W alden, H am m ett, and Edm onds (4). Iro n ore 27 F e rro v an a d iu m a llo y 61 Determination of Iron N o . of D e tn s . 4 2 Fe Found % 6 9 .3 0 52 .8 3 F e , B . of S. C ertificate % 69 .2 6 5 2 .8 A verage D e viation P .p . 1000 0 .6 SUMM ARY P otassium dichrom ate, using diphenylam ine sulfonic acid as indicator, is an oxidizing agent for th e d eterm ination of iron by th e W alden silver red u cto r m ethod. M anganese, chromium, and tita n iu m do n o t interfere. V anadium does n o t interfere in concentrations of 100 mg. or less in 200 ml. of titra tin g solution. A m ore economical m ethod results from th e use of only IN hydrochloric acid instead of th e higher concentrations of sulfuric acid required in th e eerie sulfate m ethod. T h e stab ility , purity, low equivalent weight, and com paratively low cost of potassium dichrom ate render it a very desirable oxidizing ag en t in this con nection. METHOD LITERATURE CITED Analyses were m ade w ith 25-ml. portions of th e stan d ard ferric chloride solution by th e m ethod of W alden, H am m ett, and E dm onds (4), titra tin g w ith eerie am m onium sulfate. Sim ilar analyses were then m ade by titra tin g w ith potassium dichrom ate. A 25-ml. sam ple of standard ferric chloride solution was pipet ted, the acidity was adjusted to 1 m olar w ith hydrochloric acid, and the final volume of 50 ml. w as passed through th e reductor (1) K olthoff and Sandell, “ T extb ook of Q u an titative Inorganic A n alysis” , p. 483, N ow York, M acm illan C o., 1943. (2) I b id ., p. 493. (3) W alden, H am m ett, and Edm onds, J . A m . Chem. Soc., 56, 59 (1934). (4) Ib id ., p. 350. 49 Precise Measurement of Volum e in Titrimetric A n alysis W I L L I A M M . T H O R N T O N , JR., Lo yo la Co llege , Baltimore, M d. A review of precise measurement of volume in titrimetric analysis is presented. Detailed descriptions of the burets and special techniques used by the author are given. Rep resentative standardizations indicate the reliability to be e x pected under the prescribed conditions. expansiveness is a m a tte r of some im portance; hence its fu rther stu d y would seem to be justified. THERM AL EXPAN SIO N Thiessen and his collaborators, an d also C happuis, have determ ined th e density of w ater (“ ordinary w ater-substance” ) a t various tem peratures w ith g reat exactness. From th eir d a ta th e expansivity m ay be calcu lated. Accordingly, C ircular 19 of th e B ureau of S tandards (5) enables one to correct th e ob served volume to w hat it would be a t 20° C — the stan d ard tem perature for volum etric analysis th roughout th e U nited S tates (24). T h e small num bers th a t are to be added or subtracted have been com puted on the assum ption th a t the glass forming th e m easuring utensils has a coef ~1 ficient of cubical expansion of 0.000025 per de T gree Centigrade. (C ertain borosilicate glasses, -\S 47, such as Pyrex, exhibit therm al expansions m uch sm aller th an the foregoing.) These cor rections apply n o t only to w ater b u t also, practically speaking, to sufficiently dilute aque ous solutions. F urtherm ore, a supplem entary table (5, below T able 38) gives the percentage increase in th e corrections for w ater to be applied when stan d ard solutions of four common acids and bases—nam ely, nitric and sulfuric acids and sodium and potassium hydroxides—are under consideration. T his increase is ab o u t 5 per cent for th e before-named reagents when of O.IjV concentration. In like m anner, it is b u t 3 per cent for 0.1 Ar hydrochloric acid (44)—an alm ost negligible increm ent. Y et th e higher th e n o r m ality of th e solution th e greater m u st be the augm entation of th e tem perature corrections for pure w ater. As early as 1869, G erlach (13) studied th e ex pansion of aqueous solutions of acids and salts; and in 1877 C asam ajor (6), utilizing M atthiesson’s d a ta for w ater, a ttem p ted to correct the volume of his stan d ard solution for changes of tem perature. Some 5 years later, Schulze (39) determ ined the ra te of expansion for a good m any -• of th e b e tte r known voluis metric solutions, and these apparently reliable values have been used to a con siderable extent. Schloesser (30, 31) and several other authorities (7 ,9 ,1 0 , 20, 25, 88) have contrib uted to the subject in one w ay or another. F inally, O saka (22) has made available his exten sive investigations. A S ID E from the choice of a suitable chemical reaction, or / \ th e resultant of a series of successive reactions, on which to base a dependable titrim etric process, one is confronted w ith th e responsibility of perform ing th e physical m easurem ents w ith sufficient nicety. M ore specifically, if th e highest accuracy is to be attained, th e following points m u st be given serious con sideration: (1) influence of tem perature change, (2) position of the meniscus, 1.3) drainage o r afterflow, (4) errors of graduation, (5) evaporation, and (6) po in t of complete reaction. E xcept for the last two, these sources of u n certain ty can be removed by weighing, instead of m easuring by volume, the standard solutions. F o r this purpose, various forms of “ w eight” o r “weighing burets” have been invented; and a few investi gators (I, 2, 15) have seen fit to tak e account of th e solution of known concentration by weighing th e reaction vessel both before an d after the titration. If the loss of w ater (or oth er solvent) from stan d ard solutions during long periods of storage be left o u t of account, it is safe to assume th a t the evaporation taking place w ithin the ,time required to effect a volum etric determ ination is of no signifi cance (19). On the contrary, rendering a decision as to the equivalence point looms up as an unquestionably difficult ob jective in this kind of analysis, an d one in which th e weight buret, as compared w ith the volum e buret, offers no advantage. If the volume burets are properly designed, and used w ith certain precautions, a m uch higher degree of accuracy m ay be realized in dealing w ith a num ber of th e well known volum etric solutions th an is commonly supposed. T he very fine w ork of Ponndorf (26) m ay be cited in support of th e above contention, and this constitutes by no m eans the sum to tal of the evidence (cf. 1 1 , 1 4 , 31, 48). A dm ittedly, when m any titratio n s have to be m ade, it is expedient to feed th e evaluated solution from a large reservoir directly into the buret. ¡Moreover, in th e case of solutions th a t are sensitive to th e oxygen of th e air and have to be kept under a nearly co n stan t pressure of an indifferent gas (4, 17), the transfer to a short buret for weighing would probably lead to a lowering of the tite r (28). W eighing the titra tio n flask is not alw ays feasible: in some experim ents th e reaction m ixture m ust be heated; it is often desirable to bubble an inactive gas (carbon dioxide, for example) through th e te s t solution (43); it is sometimes necessary to introduce an indicator during the la tte r stages of the procedure. However, Lee (18) has developed an ingenious weighing buret, wherein a known solution of titanous sulfate m ay be obtained by shaking acidulated titan ic sulfate w ith zinc amalgam . B u t such a device, owing to th e high density of th e am algam (about 4 p er cent zinc, presum ably), would seem to bo unduly heavy, besides being restricted to the p reparation of only a sm all q u a n tity of th e reducing agent a t a time. T he chief lim itation to m easurem ent b y volume in precise analysis is the lack of experim entally established d a ta regarding th e therm al expansion of num erous very useful solutions. This 1 In th is connection, it m ay be desirable to call a tten tio n to a point th a t is a p t to be overlooked. W hen a n auxiliary re agent is added to a titri m etric solution, even though it does n o t enter into th e stoichiom etric re lations, it m u st needs alter th e therm al expansion of the liquid. M any such cases m ight be cited, b u t a 50 < & > Figure 1 January IS, 1944 ANALYTICAL few will suffice. A ddition of potassium iodide increases the solubility of iodine, acidification of am m onium sulfato-cerate prevents hydrolytic decomposition of th e cerium compound, and so on. In all candor, there seems to be a d earth of inform ation concerning th e expansivity of th e m ore complex volum etric solutions. Besides dilatation or contraction, certain other physical properties of an aqueous solution— namely, density, surface tension, and viscosity (37)— undergo appreciable change when th e concentration w ith respect to a dissolved substance is m ark edly increased. As these properties influence delivery, the h abitual assum ption th a t th e volum e m easured a t a given tem perature is equal to th a t of pure w ater m ay n o t be fully w ar ran ted in the case of the complex solutions discussed above. BURETS T he gratifying results obtained by Getz and the w riter (4 2 ) in standardizing 0.1 N barium hydroxide (measured from an ordinary buret) against benzoic acid and p-nitrobenzoic acid, respectively, led to the expectation th a t, w ith a special instru m en t of com paratively simple construction, it m ight be possible to a tta in a very high degree of precision in certain titrim etric analyses. Two such burets (Figure 1) were procured. T hey were m ade by E im er and Amend, of New Y ork C ity, in accordance with definite specifications. E ach instru m en t consists essentially of a middle wider portion, graduated in intervals of 0.2 m l., and two narrow er portions, one above and one below, both m arked in intervals of 0.05 ml. T he to ta l capacity is 50 ml., and the entire graduated length is approxim ately 70 cm. E ach stopcock, which is som ew hat larger th an usual, is composed of a blown (and therefore hollow) plug and a neatly fitting shell. T he former tu rn s in the la tte r w ith the u tm o st sm oothness. T his lowfriction bearing and the long handle (more th a n 5 cm.) perm it th e operator to release fractions of drops when nearing th e end point. These stopcocks do n o t leak a t all. T he following statem ents and recom m endations regarding th is ty p e of b u ret are held to be self-evident. No m a tte r w hat m ay be the m agnitude of the sam ple, a reading will be obtained in any titratio n , provided the required volum e does n o t exceed 50 m l., for the entire interval is g raduated—even th e shoulders. If, however, the level of the liquid stands betw een th e 3- and the 45-ml. m arks, the determ ination should be taken as ten tativ e only. B u t, w ith this d atu m in hand, it is a simple problem to calculate by m eans of a proportion w h at increase in th e weight of the sam ple will give rise to a reading somewhere betw een the 45- and th e 50-ml. graduations, where, on grounds of probability, th e best observations are to oe had. (The linear value corre sponding to 1 ml. is ab o u t 34 m m . in th e narrow er portions of the tube.) In order to measure volum es som ew hat less th a n 45 m l., a 25-ml. N orm ax b u ret was provided. T his in strum ent is fashioned from a straig h t tube, th e sm allest division is 0.1 m l., an d the distance representing 1 ml. is 16.3 mm. To m ake th e burets ready for use, a uniform , thin layer of a suitable lubricant is spread betw een th e plug and th e shell of th e stopcock. W ith th e plug in position B t, Figure 1, a small am ount of carbon tetrachloride is poured into th e buret. T he key is then turned through an angle of 90°, B ,t and th e issuing liquid is caught in a sm all beaker. T h e je t being m om entarily closed by tire index finger, th e sam e portion of the tetrachloride is again introduced into the b u ret a t its to p opening; b u t on no account should the key bo tu rn ed back to position B . a t this juncture, for fear th a t a furrow will be cu t in th e film of lubricant by th e solvent. These operations are repeated un til th e small tubes have been washed free from visible greasy m a tte r; w here upon the buret is dried thoroughly b y aspiration. T he well known “cleaning m ixture” (concentrated sulfuric acid to which powdered potassium dichrom ate has. been added in abundance) is then applied, th e preceding instructions as to the two positions of the stopcock key (more particularly, th e plug capillary) being adhered to in an equally conscientious m anner. In calibrating the burets, th e gravim etric m ethod of Peffer and M ulligan (24) was followed in a general way. However, g reat care was taken to discharge th e w ater very slowly—not faster than by rapid dropping from th e tip, even during th e initial stages of the delivery— and th e settings and rem oval of hanging drops were m ade w ith all necessary pains. Experience has shown th a t very uniform volumes of pure w ater m ay be obtained by slow delivery from a scrupulously clean EDITION 51 buret. T his observation is in su b stan tial agreem ent w ith th e words of Osborne and Veazey (28): “ B y lim iting th e rate o f outflow th e residue and th e afterflow m ay bo m ade negligibly sm all.” The results obtained in calibrating th e three burets are given in T able I. Judging from duplicate determ inations, it is reason able to hope th a t, in th e case of the special b u rets (E im er and Amend 12 and 13, respectively), m easurem ents will agree to w ithin 0.005 ml., and w ith th e 25-ml. b u ret (N orm ax 830), to w ithin 0.01 ml. Tabic 1. In te rv a l M l. Calibration o f Burets (V olum es corrected to 20° C.) D elivery M l. B ou n d ed M l. V a lu e 13. an d A. B u re t N o. 12 O- 3 0-25 0-45 0 -4 7 .5 0-5 0 2.9 9 6 2.995 25 .0 0 4 5 .086 45.086 4 7 .606 4 7 .608 5 0 .080 50.082 2 .9 9 5 ° 2 5 .0 0 b 4 5 .0 8 5 ° 4 7 .6 0 5 ° 5 0 .0 8 0 ° E . an d A. B u re t No. 13 0 - 2 .5 0-25 0-4 5 0 -4 7 .5 0-5 0 2.5 1 7 2.5 1 4 24 .8 4 4 5 .0 6 8 4 5 .068 4 7 .579 47.580 50.068 5 0 .067 2 .5 1 5 ° 2 4 .8 4 & 4 5 .0 7 0 ° 4 7 .5 8 0 ° 5 0 .0 7 0 ° N orm ax B u re t N o. 830 0- 5 0 -10 0 -15 0-20 0 -25 4 .9 9 2 4.994 9 .9 9 5 9.9 9 4 14.998 14.996 19.999 19.999 2 4 .997 25.006 4 .9 9 * 9 .9 9 * 15.00* 20.00* 25.00* ° M ean valu e ro u n d e d off to n e arest 0.005 ml. * M ean valu e ro u n d e d off to n e arest 0 .0 1 ml. STA N D A RD IZA TIO N OF SOLUTIONS B y way of forming a fairly satisfactory estim ate as to the p re cision of the physical m easurem ents in really nice volum etric analysis, wherein the titra tio n s are made w ith volume burets, three fam iliar titrim etric solutions, of O .lA strength, were standardized in accordance w ith supposedly accurate m ethods. T he solutions were: (1) potassium perm anganate, (2) sodium tetrab o rate, or borax, and (3) sodium hydroxide. In th e first set of experim ents, O.IA solutions of potassium perm anganate were evaluated against th e certified sodium oxalate of th e N atio n al B ureau of S tan d ard s (Standard Sam ple 40c), th e procedure of Fow ler and B rig h t (12) being followed in all its m inutiae. T h e solutions were prepared by dissolving high-grade crystals of potassium perm anganate in th e requisite q u an tity of distilled w ater, aging for more th a n a m onth, and filtering very slowly through glass frit of fine tex tu re under th e influence of mild suction. T he clear solution was introduced into th e b u re t b y m eans o f the “ lift” (Figure 2), an ap p aratu s modeled a fte r a sim ilar con trivance b y Osborne an d Veazey (23). T h e suction being tu rn ed on and properly regulated b y obvious m anipulations of the stopcocks, S an d T , an y desired q u a n tity of th e liquid m ay be pulled u p from th e storage b o ttle into a large pipet, P , held th ere a t will, and finally allowed to en ter th e b u ret. T ransferring in this m anner loaves th e neck of th e b o ttle clean—a condition to be wished for in th e case of a perm anganate solution. T he tem perature of th e solution in th e bu ret was taken by inserting a slender therm om eter w ith enclosed scale, ju s t before setting th e meniscus upon th e 0-ml. g rad u atio n ; and again a t the end of th e titratio n , by running th e rem aining liquid in to a 52 INDUSTRIAL Table II. Solution No. I ENGINEERING Potassium Permanganate against Sodium O xalate D a te J u n e 25 J u n e 26 J u n e 27 J u ly 8 J u ly 9 NaaCiOi Gram KM nO* ML N o rm a lity 0.3 1 1 0 .3 1 2 0 .3 1 3 0 .3 1 0 0.3 1 1 4 5 .3 2 5 4 5 .4 3 5 4 5 .5 7 0 4 5 .2 2 5 4 5 .3 2 0 M ean 0 .1 0 2 6 0 0 .1 0255 0 .1 0257 0 .1 0259 0 .1 0 2 5 8 0 .1 0 2 5 8 M ean 0 .0 9967 0 .0 9966 0 .0 9967 0 .0 9966 0 .0 9966 M ean 0 .0 9940 0 .0 9939 0 .0 9940 M ea n 0 .0 9947 0.09951 0 .0 9 9 4 9 55 15 15 85 45 II M ay 24 M ay 24 A ug. 5 A ug. 5 0 .3 1 6 0 .3 1 5 0 .3 1 6 0 .3 1 6 65 60 85 60 4 7 .4 2 0 4 7 .2 7 0 4 7 .4 5 0 4 7 .4 1 5 III A ug; 16 A ug. 19 0 .3 1 7 05 0 .3 1 7 85 4 7 .6 0 0 47.7 2 5 IV AND J a n . 18 J a n . 20 0 .3 1 7 05 0 .3 1 7 90 4 7 .5 7 0 4 7 .6 7 5 A Vol. 16, No. 1 A slight lack of uniform ity in th e results w as apparent, owing, presum ably, to a n end p o in t th a t is som ew hat difficult to judge; and, because of this u n certain ty , th e tests w ith borax are not tab u lated in th e present report. N evertheless, as th e average deviation of a determ ination was less th a n 3 p arts per 10,000, th is p a rt of th e w ork m ay still be regarded as acceptable. I n th e th ird set of experim ents, a 0.11V solution of sodium hydroxide was prepared, reasonably free from carbonate, by the m ethod of Cowles (5); it was protected against atm ospheric carbon dioxide in th e usual m anner. A second basic solution, in all respects sim ilar to th e first, was also em ployed. T h e sodium hydroxide was standardized against 0.2N hydrochloric acid, which, in its tu rn , had been obtained by ap propriately diluting constant-boiling acid. F o r alkaline Solution I (see T able I I I), a reference color was established b y adding 1 drop of m ethyl red (0.2 per cent alcoholic solution) to 100 ml. of w ater. F o r Solution II, 25 ml. of 0.2N sodium chloride were diluted to 100 m l., and th e before-nam ed q u a n tity of th e indicator was introduced. T h e la tte r m ixture is theoretically correct, b u t it differs very little from th e form er in tin t. Tw enty-five m illiliters of th e 0.2Ar hydrochloric acid were m easured from th e small b u ret (N orm ax 830), 25 ml. of w ater an d a single drop of th e m ethyl red were added, and th e titratio n was perform ed w ith th e 0.11V sodium hydroxide (in b u re t 12), th e stan d ard color being m atched as well as possible. T h e results of th is last series of experim ents, w herein all the solutions were m easured by volume, are given in T able II I. Table III. Y CHEMISTRY Solution No. Sodium H yd ro xid e against H yd ro ch lo ric A c id D a te 0.20066 N HC1 M l. N aO H ML N o rm a lity I J u ly 19 J u ly 19 2 4 .9 5 24 .9 4 4 7 .525 4 7 .5 0 0 M ean 0.10534 0 .10536 0.10535 II O ct. 13 O ct. 13 O ct. 14 24 .9 8 24 .9 8 24 .9 8 4 7 .165 4 7 .145 47.145 M ea n 0.10628 0.10632 0.10632 0.10631 CONCLUSIONS sm all test tube. T he m ean of the tw o values was arbitrarily accepted, and th e volum e was ad ju sted on th e assum ption th a t the therm al expansion is th e sam e as th a t of p u re w ater {22). E xcellent observations of th e meniscus were m ade by utilizing a device sim ilar to the one proposed by W hite (46), despite the purple color of the solution. I h e tin y excess of perm anganate unavoidably added was estim ated by m atching the pink color of th e te st solution in th e usual way. B u t it is doubtless m ore accurate to arrive a t the correction iodom ctrically, as suggested by B ray (5). T he results obtained w ith potassium perm anganate are set forth in T able II. In the second set of experim ents, th e prim ary stan d ard was constant-boiling hydrochloric acid (41), and from th is a 0.1 N acid was obtained. A solution of sodium tetrab o rate, likewise O.IAT, was prepared from recrystallized borax (16). F o r m aking the standardizations, the borax solution was weighed in a stop pered flask and was then titra te d w ith the hydrochloric acid (in b u ret 12), m ethyl red serving as indicator. B arring such rem arkably accurate results as those a ttain ed in iodom etry by W ashburn (45), who used a w eight b u re t of the R ipper ty p e (27), th e experim ental d a ta reported herein compare favorably w ith m any to be found in th e scientific literature, which were obtained by weighing, an d n o t b y m easuring the volume of, th e stan d ard solution. T he delivery of a liquid from a graduated tu b e is a t best a som ewhat empirical operation, and, naturally, th e best m easure m ents m ay be expected when th e physical properties of the solution under consideration are n ear to those of th e liquid (usually w ater) employed in calibrating th e instrum ent. M ore especially, th e therm al expansion of th e titra n t should bo known, a t least approxim ately. These and m any oth er points have been discussed and elucidated by such prom inent m etrologists as Schloesscr (29-37), Osborne an d Veazey (23), and S to tt (40), to whose writings th e interested reader is referred for fu rth er in form ation and advice. LITERATURE CITED (1) A shley, S. E . Q., and H u lett, G. A ., J . A m . Chem. Soc., 56, 1275 (1934). (2) Bezzcnberger, F . K ., Ibid., 39, 1321 (1917). (3) B ray, W . C„ Ib id ., 32, 1204 (1910). (4) Brennecke, E ., " N ew er M eth od s of V olum etric A n alysis” , p. 131, N ew York, D . V an N ostran d C o., 1938. (5) Bur. Standards, C irc. 19, T ab le 38 (1924). (6) Casaraajor, P ., Chem. N ew s, 35, 96, 130, 160, 170 (1877); 38, 137 (1879). (7) C ouvee, W . J., Chem. W eekblad, 23, 550 (1926). (8) Cowles, H . W ., Jr., J . A m . Chem. Soc., 30, 1192 (1908). (9) D ebrun, C „ A n n . fa ls., 7, 407 (1914). (10) D ealin g, H . C ., J. I n d . E n q . C h e m ., 8, 451 (1916). (11) D uranton, B ., A n n . chim. anal. chim. a p p l., 20, 257 (1938). January 15, 1944 ANALYTICAL (12) F ow ler, R . M ., and B right, H . A ., J . Research N a tl. B u r. Stan d ards, 15, 493 (1935). (13) Gerlach, G . T ., Z . anal. Chem., 8, 245 (1S69). (14) G ol’tz, R „ J . Gen. Chem. (.U .S .S.R .), 5, 779 (1935). (15) H eath , W . P ., U . S. P a ten t 1,358,950 (N o v . 16, 1920). (16) H urley, F . H ., Jr., I n d . E n g . C h e m ., A n a l . E d ., 8, 220 (1936); 9, 237 (1937). (17) K necht, E ., and H ibbert, E ., “ N ew R ed u ction M eth od s in V olum etric A n alysis” , 2nd ed., p. 62, N e w York, Longm ans, G reen & Co., 1925. (18) Lee, K . W ., J . Chem. Soc. Ja p a n , 53, 25 (1932). (19) M ellon, M . G ., P roc. In d ia n a A cad. S ei., 32, 159 (1922). (20) M eurice, R ., A n n . chim . anal. chim . a p p l., 21,202 (1939). (21) M ika, J ., Z . anal. Chem., 96, 401 (1934). (22) O saka, Y ., J . Tokyo Chem. Soc., 32, 450 (1911); 40, 424 (1919). (23) Osborne, N . S., and V eazey, B . H ., B u r. Standards B ull. 4, 553 (1908). (24) Peffer, E . L., and M ulligan, G . C ., N a tl. Bur. Standards, Circ. 434 (1941). (25) P ellet, H ., A n n . chim. anal., 20, 97 (1915). (26) Ponndorf, W ., Z . anal. Chem., 84, 289 (1931); 85, 1 (1931). (27) Ripper, M ., Chem .-Ztg., 16, 794 (1892). (28) R osem an, R ., and T hornton, W . M ., Jr., J . A m . Chem. Soc., 57, 328, 619 (1935). (29) Schloesser, W ., Chem .-Ztg., 28, 4 (1904). EDITION (30) (31) (32) (33) (34) (35) (36) (37) (38) (39) (40) (41) (42) (43) (44) (45) (46) (47) (48) 53 Ibid., 29, 509 (1905). Ib id ., 33, 1105 (1909). Schloesser, W ., Z . anal. Chem., 46, 392 (1907). Schloesser, W ., Z . angew. Chem., 16, 953, 977, 1004, 1061 (1903). Ib id ., 17, 1608 (1904). Ib id ., 21, 833 (1908). Schloesser, W ., Z . Chem. A p p a ra t., 3, 353 (1908). Schloesser, W ., and G rim m , C., Chem .-Ztg., 30, 1071 (1906). Schoorl, N „ Chem. W eekblad, 23, 581 (1926). Schulze, A., Z. anal. Chem., 21, 167 (1882). S to tt, V ., "V olum etric G lassw are” , L ondon, H . F . and G . W itherby, 1928. T hornton, W . M ., Jr., and Christ, C. L ., I n d . E n g . C hem ., A n a l . E d ., 9, 339 (1937). T hornton, IV. M ., Jr., and G etz, D oroth y, A m . J . S ci., 9, 176 (1925). T hornton, W . M ., Jr., and lV ood, A . E ., I n d . E n g . C h e m ., 19, 150 (1927). T readw ell-H all, “A n alytical C h em istry” , 8th ed., V ol. II, p. 479, N ow Y ork, John W iley & SonB, 1935. W ashburn, E. W ., J . A m . Chem. Soc., 30, 31 (1908). W h ite, E. P., I n d . E n g . C hem ., A n a l . E d ., 10, 668 (1938). W ichers, E., F in n , A. N ., and C labaugh, W. S., Ib id ., 13, 419 (1941). Zotier, V ., B u ll. sci. ph arm acol, 24, 298 (1917); 25, 274, 357 (1918). Ethyl b is-2/4-Dinitrophenylacetate/ a New p H Indicator D eterm in ation o f Sa p o n ific a tio n E q u iv a le n ts in D a rk -C o lo r e d O ils E. A . F E H N E L a n d E. D . A M S T U T Z Wm. H . Chandler Chem ical Laboratory, Lehigh University, Bethlehem, Penna. A new acid-base indicator, ethylbis-2,4-dinitrophenylacetate, has been studied and its preparation described. The p H range over which the change from colorless to deep blue occurs is found to be from 7.5 to 9.1 (p K ca. 8.3), making the indicator suitable for most titrations which are ordinarily performed with phenolphthalein. The indicator gives an accurate end point in amber-colored solutions where the phenolphthalein end point is not visible, and it is therefore recommended for use in the determination of acid numbers and saponification equivalents of dark-colored oils. T H E course of a n investigation on th e preparation and INproperties of su b stitu ted phenylm alonic esters, th e com pound identified by R ich ter (6) as ethylbis-2,4-dinitrophenylacetate was obtained, an d th e opportu n ity w as tak e n to study suited to th e titratio n of orange- an d red-colored solutions in which th e phenolphthalein end p o in t is n o t visible. Because of the frequency w ith w hich dark-colored oils are encountered in organic analysis an d because of th e inadequacy of present-day m ethods of perform ing titra tio n s w ith these products (1-6), d a ta were obtained to determ ine th e applicability of this indicator for such work. I t was found th a t satisfactory results are o btain able even w ith extrem ely dark-colored oils an d th a t th e ac curacy of th e m ethod approaches th a t of ordinary phenolphtha lein titrations. PREPARATION A N D PROPERTIES N 02 its indicator properties. R ich ter noted th e color change of this com pound from colorless in acid to intense blue in base and ac cordingly suggested its possible application as a n acid-base indicator, b u t he reported no fu rth er studies along this line. T he au th o rs’ results show n o t only th a t th e com pound m ay serve as a satisfactory su b stitu te for phenolphthalein in th e titra tio n of m ost weak acids w ith strong bases, b u t also th a t it is specially T he indicator is n o t difficult to prepare and, while th e yield is n o t good, enough of th e com pound m ay be obtained from 0.5 mole of dinitrochlorobenzene to serve for thousands of titratio ns. T h e following procedure furnished 19.0 gram s (18.1 p er cent of theoretical) of recrystallized m aterial sufficiently pure for use as an indicator. One-half gram -atom (11.5 gram s) of sodium was dissolved in 200 ml. of absolute alcohol in a 1-liter three-necked flask fitted with a reflux condenser, m otor stirrer, and dropping funnel. T he solution was cooled and 0.25 mole of diethyl m alonate wras added dropwisc, w ith stirring, over a 30-m inute period. Stirring was continued for an o th er 10 m inutes and a h o t solution of 0.5 mole of 2,4-dinitrochlorobenzene in a b o u t 200 ml. of absolute alcohol was then added over a 30-m inute period. T h e deep red reaction 54 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING m ixture was refluxed, w ith stirring, for 4 hours and allowed to sta n d overnight. E nough w ater was th e n added to th e resulting ■olive-brown solution to bring the volum e up to a b o u t 1200 ml., a fte r which the_ solution was acidified w ith a little concentrated sulfuric acid, stirred for 20 m inutes, th en allowed to stan d for 30 m inutes. T h e w ater layer was decanted and th e residual ta r w ashed twice w ith w ater and finally w ith successive 200-ml. por tions of alcohol until a gran ular black m ass was obtained. By repeated washing w ith h o t alcohol an orange solid was finally o btained, 'which, after recrystallization from benzene, gave pale yellow' crystals m elting a t 150-153.5° C. (uncorreeted). (A sm all am ount of a second compound wfith indicator proper ties can be isolated from th e alcohol washings; it appears to be th e m onophenylated ester, ethyl-2,4-dinitrophenylm alonatc, which would be expected as an interm ediate in the form ation of th e diphenylated ester. A fter recrystallization from alcohol this com pound m elted a t 48° C. and dissolved in d ilute base to give a deep red color. T h e change from colorless to red was found to occur over a pH range of ca. 7.2 to 9.0, b u t th e com pound is n o t recommended as a su b stitu te for phenolphthalein because th e change is less distinct.) Table I. CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 Saponification Equivalents Determined for Colored O ils Oil P ropyl benzoate P ro p y l be n zo a te P ro p y l benzoate E th y l-3 -c a rb e th o x y -2 -fu ra n ac e ta te E th y l-3 -c a rb e th o x y -2 -fu ra n ac e ta te Oil A Oil A Oil A (electrom etric) Oil B Oil B A pproxi m ate C olor Saponification E q u iv a le n t D en sity , O bserved U n C alcu *£ colored C olored la te d it 164 164 164 113 113 ... 165 167 166 165 166 164 113 115 256 254 256 276 270 1.8 5 1.85 1.8 5 1.85 1.85 1 .5 5 1.55 1.55 6 0 .3 6 0 .3 these conditions, saponification equivalents were determ ined for sam ples of pure propyl benzoate and ethyl-3-carbethoxy-2furanacetate b o th before and a fte r th e addition of an artificial coloring m aterial. F or th is purpose th e addition of a few m illiliters of a highly colored n eu tral caram el solution prepared from pure cane sugar was found to be satisfactory. A bout 0.3 gram of th e carefully distilled ester was weighed into a 125-ml. Erlenm eyer flask an d th e m ixture was saponified w ith 15.00 ml. of a sta n d a rd alcoholic sodium hydroxide solution ac cording to th e procedure of Shriner and Fuson (7). T h e saponi fication m ixture was titra te d alm ost to n eu trality w ith stan d ard acid, 5 drops of th e indicator solution were added,_ and th e end point w'as determ ined b y adding an excess of acid and backtitratin g w ith stan d ard alkali to th e first blue tinge. Several m illiliters of aqueous caram el were th en added to th e alkaline solution an d th e end p o in t w as redeterm ined in the dark green m ixture b y adding acid un til the am ber caram el color ju s t re turned. In th e dark-colored solutions the end point w'as ap proached from th e basic side, n o t from th e acid side as in th e case of th e uncolored solutions. Figure 1. Indicator Range» in Titration of Potassium A c id Phthalate with Sodium H yd ro x id e T h e exact range over which the color change occurs was d eter m ined b y titratio n of a buffered hydrochloric acid solution w ith sodium hydroxide, using th e glass electrode to m easure pH . A bout 5 drops of a satu rate d solution of th e indicator in 50-50 acetone-ethyl alcohol were added to each 100 ml. of solution to be titra te d . A t pH 7.5 the first blue tinge appeared in th e solu tion, an d a t pH 9.1 the change to deep blue was complete. (The indicator has been successfully used in th e au th o rs' analytical laboratories by stu d en ts who, b y reason of deficiencies in color vision, do n o t easily recognize th e phenolphthalein end point.) T he pK of th e indicator is therefore ab o u t 8.3. Figure 1 shows the indicator range given by ethylbis-2,4-dinitrophenyla cetate com pared w'ith th a t given by phenolphthalein in the titra tio n of potassium acid p h th ala te w ith sodium hydroxide. T h e sam e reversible color change was observed to occur in anhydrous solvents such as absolute alcohol, d ry ether, and dry benzene. TITRATION O F DARK-COLORED OILS Since the basic color of cthylbis-2,4-dinitrophenylacetate, in stead of being m asked in amber-colored solutions as is the case wfith phenolphthalein, becomes m ore pronounced as a result of th e com plem entary spectral relations, th e end po in t is easily visible even in titratio n s involving dark-colored oils. In order to check the accuracy of the end point determ ined under In T able I th e saponification equivalents th u s determ ined for uncolored propyl benzoate and for artificially colored propyl benzoate an d ethyl-3-carbethoxy-2-furanacetate are com pared w ith th e tru e values calculated from th e m olecular -weights of th e esters. T h e agreem ent betw een th e calculated an d the observed values Is sufficiently good to prove th e usefulness of th e procedure as an analytical m ethod. Two heat-bodied linseed oils, one of which (oil B, T able I) was alm ost opaque w hen viewed by daylight in thicknesses greater th an 5 cm., were studied in order to determ ine the reproducibility of th e results under actu a l working conditions. Oil A was also subjected to eloctrom etric titratio n , th u s affording an additional chock on the accuracy of th e results. T h e following procedure is recom m ended as a working m ethod. A sam ple of 0.2 to 0.4 gram of th e oil was saponified as before, and a fte r reducing th e alkalinity of th e m ixture b y titra tin g al m o st to n eu trality w ith 0.25A hydrochloric acid, 5 drops of sa tu ra te d solution of th e indicator were added. M ore acid was then run in un til th e d ark green color of th e indicator ju s t dis appeared. Two m ore determ inations of th e end point were th en carried o u t on th e sam e sam ple b y adding a few m illiliters of sta n d a rd sodium hydroxide solution an d b ack -titratin g w ith acid. T h e results of th e triplicate determ ination were th en averaged and th e saponification equivalent was calculated. T h e electrom etric titra tio n on a saponified sam ple of oil A was perform ed in the usual m anner, using a B eckm an p H m eter and a glass elec trode. As can be seen by reference to T able I, th e values for oil A obtained by m eans of th e relatively simple indicator m ethod agree w ith th e value obtained from th e m ore elaborate electrom etric m ethod, and even th e v ery high color density of oil B does not seriously interfere w ith th e precision of th e determ ination. T h e approxim ate density of th e am ber color of b o th th e n atu rally an d th e artificially colored oils is recorded in th e last column of T ab le I w ith reference to 0.017.1/ potassium dichrom ate solution arb itrarily assigned a value of unity. The ANALYTICAL January 15, 1944 lig ht absorption was m easured by comparison of th e various oils w ith th e stan d ard on a K lett-Sum m erson photoelectric colorim eter w ithout a filter. W ith th e in stru m en t ad justed to give a scale reading, B , of zero for th e reference stan d ard , th e ratio of th e lig ht absorbed by the oil, i„ to th a t absorbed by th e stan d ard , t., w as calculated from the equation or l o g ^ = 0.002/E Ik 4%- —, antilog 0.002/E h T h u s oil* B has a light-absorbing power approxim ately 60 tim es th a t of 0.017/1/ potassium dichrom ate solution. EDITION 55 ACKNOW LEDGM ENT T he au th o rs are indebted to E arl J . Serfass for m any helpful suggestions concerning th e analytical procedures. LITERATURE CITED (1) Am . Soc. T estin g M aterials, Standards, P art II I, pp. 954, 958 (1942). (2) M cllh in ey, J. Am. Chem. Soc., 16, 408 (1894). (3) N ational T echnical Laboratories, pH Bull. BIO. (4) Pom eranz, Seifensieder-Ztg., 45, 578 (1918); Chem. Zentr., 90, II, 647 (1919). (5) Pschorr, Pfaff, and Berndt, Z. angew. Chem., 34, 334 (1921). (6) R ichter, Ber., 21, 2470 (1888). (7) Shriner and F uson, “S ystem atic Id en tification of Organic Com p ou n ds” , 2nd ed., Procedure B , p. 118, N ew Y ork, John W iley & Sons, 1940. Pycnometer for Volatile Liquids Control of Diffusion as an A id in Precision Pycnometry M . R. L IP K IN , J . A . D A V I S O N 1, W . T. H A R V E Y , a n d S. S. K U R T Z , J r . Sun O i l Com pany, Marcus H o o k and N orw ood, Penna. This paper reports the design of a pycnometer which is especially well suited for the determination of density on 5 ml. of volatile liquid with an accuracy of =*=0.0001 gram per ml. T H E R publication in th e field of density determ inations FUmRight seem unnecessary in view of th e large num ber of de vices which have already been described. However, m ost of these instrum ents were designed for a special purpose and a simple pycnom eter for general use in hydrocarbon analysis, and particularly for obtaining precise densities on m aterials as vola tile as pentane, has n o t previously been described. M any general references (I, 9, 16, 19, 90, 24, 29) are available on the determ ination of density, an d Irv in g {16) gives a general discussion of th e m ethod of floating equilibrium . U nusual m eth ods include m easuring th e frequency of acoustic vibratio n {17) which is dependent on the den sity of th e surrounding m edium. E specially interesting are th e balanced column m ethods {4, 7 ,1 1 , 13) w hich elim inate th e use of a n an alytical balance, and which m erit fu rth er investigation. T h e m ore conventional pycnom eters, such as th e p ip et types {8, 10, 33) and th e Sprengel-Ostwald ty p e w ith its modifications {6, 19, 20, 23, 27), often involve some kind of closure or cap to prevent rapid vaporization of volatile m aterials. T hese caps are in p a rt successful, b u t are n o t entirely satisfacto ry w ith m aterials as volatile as pentane and ether. In 1884 P erkin {22) recognized th e ad vantage of having both m enisci rem ote from th e ends of th e pycnom eter arm s, so th a t vaporization would be som ew hat hindered. T h is principle is in volved in the design of several flask-type pycnom eters {2, 3, SO, 31) and m any capillary-arm pycnom eters {6, 12, 21, 22, 25, 26). However, th e control of diffusion b y th e use of an unfilled capil lary arm has n o t been generally recognized and has never, as far as th e authors are aware, been discussed on a q u a n tita tiv e basis. P arker and P ark e r {21) also used th e principle of siphoning to fill th eir pycnom eter. Siphoning has th e definite advantage over filling by a suction technique th a t it reduces th e loss of th e more volatile com ponents of gasoline. B oth upper side arm s of th e U -tube are calibrated in scale divi sions from 0 to 8.0 w ith ten interm ediate scale divisions between each m ajor scale division. E ach m ajor scale division equals 10 mm. T h e capillary tu b e should have a 0.6- to 1.0-mm. bore and should n o t be over 6 mm. in outside diam eter. T he pyc nom eter is sim ilar to those of Shedlovsky and Brown {26) and R obertson {25), which feature two calibrated stem s an d 25-ml. capacity. T h e present pycnom eter, however, is of m uch sm aller capacity and is easily handled on an analytical balance. I t is constructed w ith a bulb in only one side arm , which allows the ycnom eter to be filled easily an d avoids loss of volatile products y th e slow ra te of diffusion through unfilled capillary arm s. PyCNOMETER T he pycnom eter which has been developed (Figure 1) has been in use in these laboratories for a b o u t 4 years. I t is of Pyrex and consists of a 0.3-, 1-, 3-, or 5-ml. bulb blown in one side arm of a capillary U -tube. A bout 2 cm. of th e upper end of th e other side arm are b en t over to form a hook for filling th e pycnom eter by capillary action and for hanging th e pycnom eter in th e balance._ T his hook is a self-filling device, previously described b y H ennion {14). T h e liquid is first draw n in to th e pycnom eter by capillary action and th e pycnom eter th en fills by siphoning. 1 P re se n t ad d ress, U . S. R u b b er C o m p an y , P assaic, N . J. Figure 1. Pycnometer Capillary bore 0.6 to 1.0 mm., outside diameter 6 mm. maximum, material Pyrex, total weight not to exceed 30 grams 56 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING T he d a ta showing the restraining effect of diffusion thro u g h a capillary on ra te of evaporation, sum m arized in Figure 2, were obtained using a prelim inary design in which both arm s of the pycnom eter were straight. R ecent tests w ith th e pycnom eter having one arm b en t are sim ilar. T o ta l length referred to is th e sum of the unfilled capillary in b o th arm s of th e pycnom eter an d the rate of evaporation is th e to ta l rate from b o th arm s of the pycnom eter in m illiliters per m inute. T he rates given in Figure 2 are based upon d a ta obtained during Ju ly and A ugust in a hot, d rafty laboratory. T herefore these rates are probably m axi m um since heat an d drafts on th e exposed ends of th e pycnom e ter both increase vaporization. Howrever, these rates are suffi ciently accurate to establish th e length of th e unfilled capillary necessary to avoid volatilization. U nder m ore favorable condi tions th e evaporation rates are som ew hat lower th a n shown in Figure 2. I t is clear from Figure 2 th a t if to ta l length of unfilled capillary is over 1 0 cm., the rate of diffusion is so low th a t th e vapor loss from th e pycnom eter becomes negligible. T he specification for these pycnom eters is 0.6- to 1.0-mm. inside capillary diam eter. Since th e d a ta were obtained on a pycnom eter of 1 .0 -mm. capillary, the evaporation losses will n ot be greater th an indicated in Figure 2 . CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 dried by suction. T h e final rinse should be w ith good clean ben zene. Acetone is n o t recom m ended because it frequently con tains nonvolatile residue. If th e outside of the pycnom eter is d irty or oily, it is rinsed w ith benzene and dried b y gently wiping w ith cheese cloth or o th er suitable m aterial. [Static charge in troduced by wiping th e pycnom eter w ith a dry cloth is a p t to cause errors in weighing, especially in cold d ry w eather. Before hanging pycnom eter on wire hook in th e balance, observe w hether ycnom eter exerts a ttrac tio n for the wire hook by touching the ook w ith th e pycnom eter and gently draw ing it aw ay. S tatic charge can usually be nullified by touching th e side of th e pycnom cter lightly w ith one’s fingers. If th is procedure will not rem ove th e static charge, th e h um idity of th e balance room should be increased u n til the difficulty disappears (about 60 per cent relative h um idity).] T h e w eight is th e n obtained w ithin =±=0 .0 0 0 1 gram on a good analytical balance, a fter allowing the pycnom eter to come to balance case tem perature. CALIBRATIO N OF PYCNOMETER T h e pycnom eter calibration is based on the density of w ater an d is checked w ith a pure hydrocarbon such as benzene. [Ben zene m ay be easily purified Dy th e following procedure: Place 5 gallons of commercial c.p. benzene in a can surrounded w ith 5 cm. (2 inches) of felt, and place th e can in a cold room a t a b o u t —30° C. ( —22° F .), or if this is n o t available, in a box chilled w ith dry ice. Allow the benzene to freeze w ithout ag itatio n until only about 1000 cc. of benzene rem ain uncrystallized. P our off the im pure benzene, m elt the crystallized benzene and recrystallize. E ach crystallization should tak e 3 to 5 days. F iv e or six such slow crystallizations will usually give benzene having a freezing p o in t of 5.51° C. {SI), and density and refractive index agreeing w ith th e b est literatu re values.] T he volume a t 20° C. of w ater free from a ir (boiled and cooled w ithout agitation shortly before use) is obtained near th e top, b ot tom, and middle of the scales of the pycnom eter. T h e volum e a t 20° C. is calculated by dividing th e w eight of w ater by 0.99823. A calibration curve is draw n, plottin g th e sum of th e scale divisions on both arm s as th e abscissa and th e volum e in m illiliters as the ordinate. All points m u st fall on th e sam e stra ig h t line, w hich is the calibration curve for th e pycnom eter. N o correction is m ade for air buoyancy in th e w ater calibration. In stead, a correction, C, given b y E q u atio n 1, is added to th e observed value of the density to tak e care of all buoyancy errors in which D 0 = density in air. T his correction C = 0 .0 0 1 2 X (1 - D 0) (1) is based on the use of an average value of 0 .0 0 1 2 gram per ml. for th e density of air {29), and is applicable to all types of weights, provided th a t w eights of the sam e density are used in b o th the calibration an d the density determ inations. T h e use of a sealed counterpoise has n o t been recommended, since th e to tal volume of th e 5-ml. pycnom eter is only ab o u t 15 ml. and a variation in a ir den sity of =±=0.00005 gram per ml. will give a change in buoyancy of only 0.00075 gram . Since a b o u t 4 gram s of liquid are weighed, this buoyancy v ariation corresponds to about =*=0.00015 in the density of the sample. T his value is probably extreme. F o r m ore accurate work, especially w ith pyc nom eters of larger size, a sealed counterpoise can be used to com pensate accurately for buoyancy of th e a ir on th e pycnom eter it self. T h e buoyancy effect can then be corrected using an accu ra te value for th e density of air, w hich is dependent on th e tem p eratu re and hum idity. Check points on th e w’a te r calibration arc obtained w ith ben zene. T o obtain volumes, th e w eights of benzene are divided by 0.8788. T he density of benzene in vacuum a t 20° C. determ ined by use of this calibration curve and E q u atio n 1 should be 0.87893, which checks th e values of 0.87890 of T im m erm ans and M artin {28) and 0.87895 of W ojeiechowski (32). DETERMINATION O F PRECISION DENSITIES A. P u r e C o m p o u n d s a n d M i x t u r e s o p M e d iu m a n d L o w V o la tility . T h e pycnom eter is cleaned w ith benzene and T O T A L LEN G TH U N F ILLE D C A P IL L A R Y . Figure 2. Evaporation Rates T he pycnom eter is filled in an uprig h t position b y placing the hooked tip in a vial containing the liquid un til th e liquid level reaches scale m ark 4 on th e bulb side. L iquid level m u st be on th e scale when th e pycnom eter contents are a t 2 0 ° C. (6 8 ° F.). In h o t w eather (100° F .), th e contraction to 6 8 ° F . on a 3-ml. pycnom eter of sm all bore is approxim ately 10 cm. If room tem perature is below 6 8 ° F . or th e sam ple is m uch below th a t tem perature, due allowance should be m ade in th e filling level. T he level of liquid in the vial m ust be very near th e top. Pentan e will fill a 3-ml. pycnom eter in less th an a m inute. More viscous sam ples wall fill m ore slowly. T h is pycnom eter is not recom mended for sam ples more viscous th a n gas oil of 50 seconds Saybolt viscosity a t 100° F . (about 7.4 centistokes). T h e pycnom eter is rem oved from the sam ple bottle, and th e hook which had been im m ersed in th e sam ple is cleaned w ith a cloth m oistened w ith benzene and wiped dry. T h e w eight is then obtained w ithin =*=0 .0 0 0 1 gram . T he pycnom eter is placed for 10 to 15 m inutes in a vertical position in a glass ja r th erm o sta t held a t 20.00° =*= 0.05° C. and allowed to reach th a t tem perature. A variatio n of 0.05° C. is equivalent to approxim ately 0.00004 gram ml. per ml. for gaso January 15, 1944 ANALYTICAL line hydrocarbon. A m ore général expression for the tem pera tu re coefficient of density of hydrocarbons m ay be obtained from the correlation of Lipkin and K u rtz {18). T h e m eniscus levels are read on b o th arm s of th e in stru m en t w ithin one half of the sm allest scale u n it w ith o u t rem oving the pycnom eter from the bath . To avoid undue volatilization losses, th e elapsed tim e betw een weighing and reading th e meniscus levels should n o t be over 15 m inutes. T h e volum e in milliliters corresponding to the sum of the readings is read from th e cali b ration curve: „ w eight of sam ple D ensity in air = -r —2— 3 ¡—1— observed volum e (2 ) E q uation 1 gives the corrections to be added to th e determ ined d ensity to tak e care of air buoyancy and to o b tain density in vacuum . B. H i g h l y V o l a t i l e M i x t u r e s . T his procedure is to be used on highly volatile m ixtures because it prevents or reduces change in the compositions of th e sam ple b y th e selective vola tilization of th e lower boiling com ponents while the pycnom eter is being filled an d while it a tta in s balance tem perature. T h e sam ple is cooled to ice tem perature, charged to th e pyc nom eter, and th e pycnom eter and contents are allowed to come to tem perature, 20° C. T he volum e is read, th e in stru m en t re moved from th e b ath , th e outside cleaned and dried, and th e pycnom eter plus sam ple weighed. T he sam ple is th en flushed from th e pycnom eter w ith benzene, and the pycnom eter is dried, an d weighed em pty. E ith er procedure m ay be used on pure com pounds of high volatility, since selective loss of one com ponent is n o t involved. Procedure A is more convenient for sam ples w hich are n o t ex trem ely volatile. In b o th procedures there is a tim e in terv al betw een th e meas urem ent of w eight and the m easurem ent of volum e. If volatili zation occurs betw een these m easurem ents in th e case of proce dure A a high density will result, since w eight is m easured first. In th e case of procedure B, since volum e is m easured first, low densities will result from such vaporization. Such losses are negligible except in the m easurem ent of very volatile m aterials such as isopentane in pycnom eters of sm all volum e such as 0.3 ml. If vaporization losses are suspected, th e density should be determ ined by both procedures and averaged. Table I. Deviations in Density O bserved Using Pycnometers of Different Sizes“ O p erato r M ate rial E x am in ed d 2 0 /4 1 1 2 2 Iso p e n tan e 0 .6 1 9 7 Av. 1 1 2 2 E th y l e th e r 0 .7 1 4 0 Av. 1 1 2 2 1 1 2 2 1 1 2 3 00-400° F . 0 .7 9 7 5 n a p h th a 0.32-M I. Pycnom e te r 1.2-M I. Pycnom e te r 3-M I. Pycnom e te r 5-M I. Pycnom e te r + 0 .0 0 1 9 + 0 .0 0 11 + 0 .0 0 8 4 + 0 .0 0 4 0 + 0 .0 0 1 4 + 0 .0 0 10 + 0 .0 0 2 5 + 0 .0 0 11 + 0 .0 0 0 6 ± 0 .0 0 0 0 + 0 .0 0 0 5 + 0.0 0 01 - + 0 .0 0 3 8 + 0 .0 0 1 5 + 0 .0 0 0 3 - 0.0 0 01 + 0.0 0 2 4 + 0.0022 + 0 .0 0 4 4 + 0 .0 0 0 6 + + + + 0 .0 0 0 2 0 .0001 - 0 .0 0 0 2 ± 0 .0 0 0 0 + 0.0004 - 0 .0 0 01 - 0 .0 0 0 5 - 0 .0 0 01 ± 0 .0 0 0 0 + 0 .0 0 0 0 + 0 .0 0 2 4 + 0 .0 0 0 5 - 0 .0 0 0 2 - 0.0 0 01 —0 .0 0 0 3 - 0 .0 0 0 5 -0 .0 0 0 3 -0 .0 0 0 7 -0 .0 0 0 6 - 0 .0 0 01 - 0 .0 0 0 2 - 0 .0 0 0 3 ± 0 .0 0 0 0 + 0.0 0 01 - 0 .0 0 01 - 0 .0 0 0 3 - 0 .0 0 0 2 +CLÓÓ04 - 0 .0 0 0 4 0 .0 0 0 6 0 .0 0 1 3 0.0 0 01 0 .0 0 01 0 .0 0 0 2 0 .0 0 01 A v. - 0 .0 0 0 4 - 0 .0 0 0 5 - 0 .0 0 01 - 0 .0 0 0 2 (50% iso 0 .7 1 2 8 p en tan e) 50% 3 0 0 400 F . n a p h th a • Av. - 0 .0 0 1 5 - 0.0022 - 0 .0 0 6 9 + 0 .0 0 1 9 + + + + + + + 0 .0 0 0 2 0 .0 0 0 2 0 .0 0 0 2 0.0 0 0 3 ± 0 .0 0 0 0 - 0 .0 0 01 + 0 .0 0 0 4 ± 0 .0 0 0 0 -0 .0 0 3 1 + 0 .0 0 0 7 + 0 .0 0 0 2 + 0 .0 0 01 G as oil 50 sec. S ayb o lt at 100° F . Av. 0 .8 3 0 4 0 .0 0 0 5 0.0 0 0 3 0 .0 0 0 9 0 .0 0 12 -0 .0 0 3 2 -0 .0 0 2 8 -0 .0 0 1 4 + 0 .0 0 01 - 0 .0 0 0 5 -0 .0 0 0 8 -0 .0 0 0 5 - 0.0 0 10 ± 0 .0 0 0 0 - 0 .0 0 0 2 - 0.0001 -0 .0 0 0 3 + 0.0 0 01 + 0 .0 0 01 ± 0 .0 0 0 0 -0 .0 0 0 3 -0 .0 0 1 9 -0 .0 0 0 7 - 0 .0 0 0 2 - 0.0 0 01 ° O b tained using pro ced u re A a n d e arly design of p y c n o m e ter w ith b o th arm s s tra ig h t. Sim ilar d a ta o b ta in e d w ith b e n t-a rm p y cn o m eter check these d a ta . E a rlie r te sts a re given, Bince th e y a re m ore com plete th a n re c e n t te sts. EDITION 57 PRECISION T ests of th e precision of th e pycnom eter using procedure A are shown in T able I. (R esults obtained w ith procedure B are of comparable accuracy.) Two operators determ ined the densities of isopentane, eth y l ether, a n ap h th a, a m ixture of isopentane and a n ap h th a, and a gas oil. E ach operator m ade duplicate determ inations. T h e d a ta showed th a t, w ith th e 3- or 5-ml. pycnom eter, precision does n o t depend on th e operator, and th a t the 5-ml. size is precise to ±0.0001, th e 3-ml. to ±0.0002, th e 1-ml. to ±0.001, and th e 0.3-ml. to ± 0.002 gram p er ml. over the entire viscosity and volatility range betw een p en tan e and light gas oil. T he sources of th e larger errors in determ ining densities w ith the sm aller pycnom eters are shown in T able I I . T h e effect of th e various possible errors on th e final determ ination of th e den sity is given. W ith th e 1-ml. an d th e 0.3-ml. pycnom eters, errors in the scale readings and weighings are im p o rtan t. E rrors due to tem perature control an d air buoyancy are th e sam e w ith all size pycnom eters, as indicated in th e table. T h e 3- and 5-ml. pycnom eters are recom m ended for routine use. Table II. Errors in Determined Densities of Ethyl Ether Due to Errors of Observation Volume of Pycnom eterB “ M l. 1° C. E rro r in T e m p e ra tu re O ./m l. 0.5 M g. E r ro r in W eighing a ./m l. 0.5 m m . E r ro r in Scale R eading O ./m l. 0 .2 5 1 3 5 0.0011 0.0011 0.0011 0 .0011 0 .0 0 2 0 0 .0 0 0 5 0 .0 0 0 2 0.0001 0.0011 0.0003 0.0001 0.0001 “ C ap illary d ia m e te r 1.0 m m . ACCURACY T h e d a ta in colum n 3, T able I, on the density of th e m aterials were obtained by a skilled o perator w ith th e 5-ml. pycnom eter, and are believed to be accurate w ithin ±0.0001 gram p er ml. If this is true, th e d a ta in T able I con stitu te a te s t of accuracy as well as of precision. As a fu rth er te s t of absolute accuracy of the au th o rs’ m ethod, th e density of a carefully purified sam ple of benzene was determ ined on a pycnom eter calibrated w ith w ater. T he density a t 20° C. was found to be 0.87895. T his result checks th e literatu re value of T im m erm ans {28) of 0.87895 cor rected from 15° C. an d th e value of 0.87891 determ ined by W ojciechowski {82) corrected from 25°, using th e tem perature co efficient of density values determ ined by Tim m erm ans. SPEED E ach determ ination requires 10 to 15 m inutes of th e operator’s time, and an elapsed tim e of 20 to 30 m inutes. W ith a dam ped balance, 10 m inutes of o perator’s tim e per sam ple is sufficient. ACKNOW LEDGMENT T he au th o rs wish to acknowledge the cooperation of Ace Glass, Inc., Vineland, N . J., in connection w ith th e developm ent of this pycnom eter. T h ey also wish to acknowledge th e assistance of I. W . M ills w ith prelim inary work on this pycnom eter and C. C. M artin, A. E . W ikingsson, G. H . H ansel, and C. W. D ittric h in obtaining statistical d ata. LITERATURE CITED B earce, H . W ., Proc. A m . Soc. Testing M aterials, 19, 412 (1919). Bousfield, W . R., J . Chem. Soc., 93, 679 (1908). B u svold, B „ Chem.-Ztg. 49, 276 (1925). Ciochina, J., Z . anal. Chem., 107, 108 (1936). D avis, P . B ., and P ratt, L. W ., J . A m . Chem. Soc., 37, 1199, (1915). (6) F reund, Ida, Z . ph ysik. Chem., 66. 569 (1909). (7) Frivold, O. E „ P h ys. Z „ 39, 529 (1920). (8) Furter, M „ H d v. Chim . Acta, 21, 1666 (1938). (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) 58 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING (9) Geiger, H ., and Scheel, K ., “ H andbuch der P h y sik ” , V ol. 2, p. 160, Berlin, Julius Springer, 1926. (10) G osko-M ulhoim R uhr, Z . Untersuch. N ähr. Genussm., 24, 245 (1 9 1 2 ). (11) (12) (13) (14) (15) H are, J . In st. Brewing, 40, 92 (1934). H artley, H ., and B arrett, W . H ., J . Chcm. Soc., 99, 1072 (1911). H eard, L ., J . Chem. Education, 7, 1910 (1930). H ennion, G . F ., I n d . E n g . C h e m ., A n a l . E d ., 9, 479 (1937). H ouben, J., “ M eth od en der organischen C hem ie” , V ol. 1, p. 891, Leipzig, G . T h iem e, 1925. (16) Irving, H ., Science Progress, 31, 654 (1 9 3 7 ). (17) K alahno, A ., B er. deut. p h ysik. Ges., 16, 8 1 -9 2 (1914). (18) Lipkin, M . R ., and K urtz, S. S., Jr., I n d . E n o . C hem ., A n a l . E d ., 13, 291 (1 9 4 1 ). (19) O stwald, W ., J . prakt. Chem.., 16, 396 (1877). (20) O stwald, W ., Luther, R ., and D rucker, C., “H an d - und H ilfs buch zu . A usführung physiko-chem ischer M essungen” , pp. 2 3 4 -7 , Leipzig, A kadem ische V erlagsgesellschaft, 1931. (21) Parker, H . C ., and Parker, E . W ., J . P h ys. Chem., 29, 130 (1925). CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 (22) Perkin, W . H ., J . Chem. Soc., 4 5 , 1, 4 4 3 -5 (1884). (23) R eidel, R ., Z . ph ysik. Chem., 56, 245 (1906). (24) R eilly, J., and R ae, W . N ., “ P hysical C hem ical M eth od s” , N ew Y ork, D. V an N ostrand C o., 1939. (25) R obertson, G . R ., I n d . E n o . Chem ., A n a l . E d . , 11 , 464 (1939). (26) S h edlovsky, T ., and B row n, A . S., J . A m . Chem. Soc., 56, 1066 (1934). (27) Sprengel, H ., Pogg. A n n ., 150, 459 (1873). (28) Tim m erm ans, J., and M artin, F ., J . chim. p h ys., 23, 747 (1926). (29) Ward, A . L ., K urtz, S. S., Jr., and Fulweiler, W . H ., in “S cien ce of P etroleu m ” , ed. b y D u n stan , N ash, B rooks, and T iza r d , V ol. II, p . 1137, N ew York, Oxford U n iversity P ress, 1938. (30) W ashburn, E . W ., and Sm ith, E . R ., B u r. Standards J . R e search, 12, 305 (1934). (31) W ostberg, J., Tek. Fören. Finland Förh., 58, 314 (1938). (32) W ojciechow ski, M ., J . Research N a tl. B u r. S tandards, 19, 347 (1937). (33) Y uster, S. T ., and R eyerson , L . H ., I n d . E n g . C hem ., A n a l E d ., 8, 61 (1936). Apparatus for Measuring the G as Permeability of Film Materials of Low Permeability A. CO RN W ELL SH U M A N Central Laboratories, General Foods Corp., H o b o ke n , N . J. Apparatus is described (or measuring the gas permeability of film materials having permeabilities as low as 0.001 cc. (at standard temperature and pressure) per 1 0 0 square inches per 24 hours. The low range for previously reported methods (water vapor permeability and balloon fabric perm eability) is about 1 0 0 cc. per 1 0 0 square inches per 2 4 hours. The apparatus combines sim plicity of design, sim plicity of manipulation, and high sensitivity in a unit which can be fabricated in most machine shops. The measurements are made under conditions of one atmosphere pressure differential. relatively im perm eable to oxygen. P erhaps a process of solution of gas in th e film on one side, diffusion through th e film, and evaporation from th e film on th e oth er side takes place in some cases. E packaging of some foods, drugs, chemicals, etc., requires T Hflexible films and paper coatings of very low perm eability to fixed gases, particularly oxygen. T h e need for film having a perm eability of not m ore th a n 0.25 cc. per 645 sq. cm. (100 square inches) per 24 hours has been pointed o u t by E ld er (S). T his figure is entirely o u t of th e range usually m easured for balloon fabrics (5), w here perm eabilities range from 100 cc. p er 100 square inches per hour an d up. T he custom ary m easurem ents o f w ater vapor perm eability (1, 2, 4) of packaging films are also in a relatively high range— for example, a “good” w ater vapor barrier will have a perm eability figure of 0.1 gram or 125 cc. p er 100 square inches per 24 hours. T he ap p a ra tu s described in th is p aper is designed for m easurem ents in th e range 0.001 to 1000 cc. per 100 square inches per 24 hours, and prim arily for th e m eas urem ent of the fixed gases, although w ith some modification it m ight be also used for w ater v ap o r perm eabilities. T he purpose o f this publication is to m ake available to others th e m eans which th e au th o r has developed for testing packaging films of very low perm eability. T he m echanism of gas transm ission through solids has n o t been explained thoroughly. Oswin discusses th is briefly (4). If the gas passed through sm all pores or openings in th e solid, th e situation would be a relatively simple one; th e perm eability of a film to various gases could be predicted from th e know n laws of gas flow through orifices. However, such is n o t th e case. I t is known th a t polyvinyl alcohol film is perm eable to w ater vapor b u t n o t to oxygen, and Pliofilm is perm eable to carbon dioxide b u t Figure 1. Diagram of Apparatus January 15, 1944 ANALYTICAL T he m echanism of gas transm ission through film determ ines to some extent the conditions u n d er which a film should be tested. Tw o factors are involved: th e difference in to ta l pressure on th e tw o sides of th e film and the difference in p a rtial pressure of th e gas being tested on th e tw o sides of th e film. I f perm eability is due to gas flow through orifices in th e film, th e difference in to ta l pressure is of prim ary im portance and th e difference in p artial pressure is of secondary im portance. If th e perm eability is due to solubility of th e gas in th e film, th e difference in to ta l pressure is of no im portance, b u t the difference in p a rtia l pressures is im p o rtan t. In th e ap p aratu s described in th is article, th e te s t is m ade under th e conditions of atm ospheric pressure of th e gas being tested on one side of the film and zero pressure of all gases on the o th er side. T he apparatus, shown in Figures 1 and 2, combines simplicity of design, sim plicity of m anipulation, an d high sensitivity in a u n it which can be fabricated in m ost m achine shops. Essentially th e m ethod involves m easuring changes in pressure inside a sm all evacuated space due to gas passing into th a t space through the film sam ple being tested. EDITION 59 stopper w ith a glass tu b e is inserted into each of these holes. T he space betw een E and F is th en flushed o u t w ith gas to be m easured by passing th e gas in one opening an d o u t th e other. I t has been shown th a t th e m oisture conten t of fixed gases m ark edly affects th eir ra te of transm ission thro u g h some film m ate rials (4). T his factor m ay be controlled by conditioning th e gas to be tested before it is passed thro u g h th e apparatus. CONSTRUCTION OF APPARATUS T he m anom eter, M , is held in place by th e n u t, N , to w hich it is sealed w ith Cenco Plicene cem ent or other sealing compounds of good adhesive properties an d low vapor pressure. T h e hole through the n u t is bored nearly th e same diam eter as th e glass tube, thereby minim izing the am o u n t of cem ent necessary for this seal. T he n u t is screwed up against th e th in ru b b er w asher, W, and the entire jo in t is coated w ith shellac to ensure a vacuum tig h t seal. M anom eter M serves th e d ual purpose of recording th e pres sure change and of evacuating th e space inside th e apparatus. F o r evacuation, the entire ap p aratu s is tipped so th a t th e m er cury runs over into th e reservoir, R ; th en th e a p p aratu s is evacu a ted through tu b e B w ith stopcock S in th e open position. A fter evacuation, S is closed and th e a p p aratu s is tip p ed again so th a t th e m ercury runs from R into M . In case air leaks through S during a test, th e m ercury in th a t arm of th e m anom eter will be depressed, th u s serving as an indicator of leakage a t th is point w ithout spoiling th e test. T h e center arm of M is m ade of cap illary tubing of ab o u t 1.5-mm. internal diam eter for th e purpose of reducing the volum e of gas space inside th e a p p aratu s and thereby increasing its sensitivity. T he rest of th e m anom eter m ay be m ade of tubing of any convenient size. T h e scale used in m easuring the height of th e m ercury is n o t shown. A piece of m illim eter cross-section p aper held behind th e m anom eter serves very well for th e purpose. T he upper p a rt of th e hole in th e center of th e disk, K , is covered w ith a sm all m etal disk, D, which has four sm all holes ab out 1 m m . in diam eter for passing gas in to th e m anom eter system . T he top surface of th e sm all disk is flush w ith th e top surface of th e large disk, If, presenting a continuous sm ooth sur face for m ounting th e film, F. T he drying agent absorbs all m oisture w hich passes through F, th u s elim inating this gas as a source of error in gas transm ission m easurem ent. D ehydrite (anhydrous m agnesium perchlorate) diluted w ith a sm all q u an tity of Indicating D rierite (anhydrous calcium sulfate) serves adm irably. A screen fraction passing 14mesh and retained on 40-mesh has been found to be a convenient size. In general, an y drying agent w hich will reduce th e w ater vapor pressure inside th e app aratu s to less th a n 0.5 mm . of m er cury will serve. A sm all plug of co tto n over th e to p of th e m an om eter tube will prevent particles of th e drying agent from falling into th e m anom eter. MOUNTING SAMPLES T he film sam ple, F, is m ounted on th e ap p aratu s as showrn in th e diagram . A piece of filter paper, P , is placed betw een the film and K to provide a porous medium for gas leaking through the film to trav el to th e openings in D an d pass thro u g h th e drying agent into M . T he p a rt of F overlapping P and in d irect contact w ith K is sealed to th e disk by m eans of a th in film of heavy stop cock grease having a low vap o r pressure. T his area of th e film is held in place by th e rubber gasket, C. D isk E has tw o sm all holes diam etrically opposite one another and near the inside circumference of th e m etal ring, 0 . W hen m easuring air transm ission, these openings are left open so th a t th e space betw een E and F is filled w ith air. W hen it is desired to measure the gas transm ission for any o th er gas, a sm all rubber Courtesy "M o d e rn P a cka g in g " Figure 2. Apparatus In m ounting m ulti-ply film having one or more plies of a porous m aterial— for example, a film lam inated betw een twro pieces of paper—it is p ractically impossible to o btain a v acuum -tight seal using stopcock grease betw een th e p ap er surface of th e sample and K . In m ounting such films, use h a s been m ade of a plas ticized ta r as shown in Figure 3. An edge coating extending a b o u t 0.6 cm. (0.25 inch) from th e circum ference is applied to both sides of th e disk of film to be tested b y dipping in th e p lasti cized ta r (Figure 3). T h e tar-co ated disk of m aterial is m ounted directly on K w ith o u t th e use of stopcock grease. W hen cap G is screwed into place, th e plasticized to r is spread o u t by th e com pressive forces and m akes a vacuum seal betw een F an d K . Carbowax 1500 is a suitable plasticizer for th e ta r when used a t th e level of a b o u t 5 per cent. CA LCU LA TIO N S Gas. transm ission m easurem ents are conveniently recorded as cubic centim eters of gas a t stan d ard conditions of tem perature and pressure tran sm itted per 100 square inches of surface p e r 24 hours. Such a figure is given b y th e following expression: _P_ v v 273 100 24 760 * X T X A A hours w’here P = th e absolute pressure inside th e ap p a ra tu s as m eas ured on th e m anom eter in m illim eters V = to ta l volum e of th e inside of th e ap p a ra tu s in cubic centim eters T = tem p eratu re in degrees absolute A — surface area of te s t sam ple (area of filter p ap er P in square inches) hours = tim e of te st The value of V m ay be calculated w ith sufficient accuracy (w ithin 5 per cent) from th e known dim ensions of th e apparatus, m aking a correction for th e volume of th e drying agent used. 60 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING I t is equal to the sum of the volume of th e holes in D , th e volum e of th e circular opening containing th e drying ag en t m inus th e volume of the drying agent, an d th e volum e of th e capillary bore of the center stem of th e m anom eter down to th e m ercury level in this stem . T h e volum e of th e pore space in P am ounts to ab out 0.05 cc. and the volum e change due to a m ercury level change of 20 mm . in th e center stem of th e m anom eter am ounts to ab o u t 0.04 cc. These errors in volum e are neglected. CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 urem ents w ith th is ap p aratu s are accurate to w ithin 15 per cent. T he tem p eratu re, tim e, and m anom eter reading m ay be d eter m ined w ithin a few p er cent. T h e principal factors affecting the accuracy are th e volum e of th e a p p aratu s and th e area of th e test sam ple. I t is estim ated th a t these are easily determ ined in the m anner described w ithin 10 p er cent accuracy. T he precision or reproducibility of m easurem ents on duplicate sam ples of the same m aterial is generally a b o u t 10 per cent. EXAM PLES T he following examples will serve to typify th e d a ta w hich may be obtained w ith this a p p a ra tu s: F or the ap p aratu s diagram m ed in Figure 1, th e value of V is a b o u t 2 cc., and th e value of A is 23 sq. cm. (5 square inches). A t a tem perature of 30° C., T = 303° absolute. S u b stitu tin g these values in th e above equation, we get th e following working equation: 1. Air transm ission for an im perm eable sam ple (a sam ple of lam inated glassine a t 60 to 80 per cent relative hum idity). In a period of 36 hours, no change was observed in th e m a n ometer. Assum ing th a t a m inim um change of 0.5 mm . can be detected on th e m anom eter, th e ra te of change of th e m anom eter was n o t greater th a n 0.5/36 or 0.0139 mm . per hour. T he gas transm ission was, therefore, n o t g reater th a n 0.0139 X 1.14, or 0.016 cc. p er 100 square inches per 24 hours. 2. Air transm ission for an im perm eable sam ple containing a volatile plasticizer (a polyvinyl alcohol coating a t low hum idity). T he m anom eter changes during th e indicated tim e intervals were as follows: T im e In te rv a l H ours M an o m e te r C hange Mm. R a te of C hange M m ./h o u r 0-1 1-2 2 1 .5 2 2.0 3 .5 0 .5 0 .5 8 0 .0 1 7 2 -4 4-1 0 10-40 P /h o u rs X 1.14 = cc. of gas a t stan d ard conditions of tem p era tu re and pressure tra n s m itte d /100 square inches/24 hours • T o ta l 1.5 1.0 9 .5 SENSITIVITY, ACCURACY, A N D PRECISION T he actual tim e required for a te s t w ith th is a p p aratu s varies w ith the perm eability of th e film being tested and th e lim its w ithin which it is desired to determ ine th e gas transm ission rate. F o r example, it m ight bo desired to know w hether a film sam ple has a transm ission rate greater or less th a n 0.25 cc. per 100 square inches per 24 hours. Using th e above equation and constants for the ap p aratu s herein described, th is transm ission ra te will produce a pressure change in th e m anom eter of 0.5 m m . in ab o u t 2.5 hours: 0.5-mm. change is easily read on th e m anom eter; therefore, the failure of the m anom eter to change 0.5 m m . in 2.5 hours’ tim e is sufficient evidence th a t th e gas transm ission ra te is less th a n 0.25 cc. per 100 square inches per 24 hours. Should the tim e of the te st be extended five tim es as long, to 12.5 hours, th e failure of the m anom eter to cliange 0.5 m m . is sufficient evidence th a t th e gas transm ission ra te is less th a n 0.05 (0.25/5) cc. per 100 square inches per 24 hours. F u rth er extending th e tim e of th e te s t th u s fu rth er reduces th e figure Tor th e m axim um tra n s mission ra te of th e sam ple. W ith films of liigh perm eability, th e m ercury in th e m anom eter will drop several m illim eters in a n h o u r’s tim e. W ith such films, therefore, the te s t need n o t be extended m ore th a n a few hours. Occasionally film sam ples contain m aterial, such as plasticizers, which have appreciable vapor pressures. Such m aterials will vaporize into the ap p aratu s an d depress th e m ercury in th e m an om eter. T his m ay bo m istaken for gas transm ission through the film, b u t m ay be distinguished from gas transm ission b y th e fact th a t th e pressure will reach a co n stan t value, th e ra te of change of pressure decreasing as this value is approached. I t is th e re fore necessary to m ake readings of th e m anom eter a t intervals during the te s t and calculate th e ra te of m anom eter change for each interval. I f th e ra te of change is constant, it is due to gas transm ission through th e film, b u t if it is a decreasing ra te of change, th e change is due a t least p a rtly to vaporization of some volatile m aterial from th e film. T he required accuracy is n o t very g reat for m easurem ents of perm eability of film packaging m aterials where values m ight vary a millionfold am ong various m aterials and a thousandfold am ong various sam ples of the sam e m aterial. I t is estim ated th a t m eas I t is evident from th e above d a ta th a t a m aterial having a vapor pressure of a b o u t 9.5 m m . is ev aporating from th e sam ple and th a t equilibrium is nearly established a fter 10 hours. T he rate of change of th e m anom eter during th e last 30 hours of th e te st was 0.017 mm. per hour. Therefore, th e gas transm ission ra te for th e sam ple was n o t m ore th a n 0.017 X 1.14 or 0.019 cc. per 100 square inches per 24 hours. 3. Air transm ission for a perm eable sam ple (a th in coating of polyvinyl alcohol). T he m anom eter changes during th e indicated tim e intervals were as follows: T im e In te rv a l H ours 0-1 1-2 10-18 1 .5 1 .5 3 .0 9 .5 1 1 .5 18 2 7 .0 2 -4 1-10 T o ta l M an o m e te r C hange Mm. R a te of C hange M m ./h o u r 1 .5 1 .5 1 .5 1.58 1 .4 5 A v. 1 .5 T h e c o n sta n c y o f th e ra te o f ch a n g e figu res in d ic a te s t h a t th is sa m p le is p erm ea b le t o air. T h e r a te o f g a s tra n sm issio n is 1.5 X 1.14, or 1.71 cc. p er 100 sq u are in c h e s p er 2 4 h ou rs. LITERATURE CITED (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) A non., M odern Packaging, 1 6 ,7 8 -8 2 ,1 0 0 (1942). Carson, F . T ., N a tl. B ur. Standards. M isc. P u bl. M 127 (1937). Elder, L . W ., M odern Packaging, 16, 6 9-71 (1943). Oswin, C . R ., J . Soc. Chem. In d ., 62, 4 5 -8 (1943). Sager, T . P ., J . Research N a ll. B u r. Standards, 25, 309 -1 3 (1940). B ecause of critical shortages, th e A m e r i c a n C h e m i c a l has been forced to cu t its use of paper to an abso lu te m inimum . I t will no longer be possible to p rin t the custom ary num ber of extra copies to supply dem ands for volumes an d sets in subsequent years. Therefore, it is suggested th a t subscribers who do n o t bind their journals save current issues for later sale. S o c ie ty Design of Large-Size Laboratory Extraction G lass Apparatus R A Y M O N D JO N N A R D Warner Institute for Therapeutic Research, 113 West Eighteenth St., N ew York, N . Y . A S IM P L E large-capacity extraction a p p aratu s has been described by Smallwood (2). T he frequent need for extraction ap p ara tu s of larger capacity th a n th e conventional Soxhlet extractors for research as well as for sm all pilot production justifies a description of th e im proved all-glass ap p aratu s which has been in satisfactory operation in th is laboratory for a num ber of m onths. tem perature was alw ays lower th a n 39.3° C., th e difference being probably accounted for by th e presence of noncondensable gas in th e vapor phase, w hich is difficult to avoid in ap p a ra tu s of relatively large size. D espite th e length of th e v ap o r line, th e a p p aratu s appears well suited for use w ith mixed or diluted solvents. Some determ inations of th e approxim ate h ea t balance have been m ade an d one typical resu lt is reported in T able II. T he a p p a r a t u s is shown in Figure 1, after rem oval of the insulation. I t is de signed for operation a t either ordinary or re duced pressures and is equipped to p erm it the collection of all engi neering d a ta required for pilot work. I t is m a d e of s t a n d a r d Pyrex p arts w ith Ace spherical joints, size 35/25. T he boiler is a three-neck 12-liter flask i n s t a l l e d i n a Glas-Col h eate r p ro vided w ith proper in p u t control (rheostat . and a m m e t e r ) a n d pyrom eter. T he ex tra c to r has a to tal capacity of 8 liters. In order to o btain a sufficient speed of ex tractio n the h o t sol v e n t vapor is fed a t the top of th e 600-mm. Allihn condenser, in stead of th e bottom , as in th e conventional Soxhlet. E xperim ent has shown th a t flood ing occurs w ith the conventional design a t a distillation ra te of 3 liters per hour a t ordi n ary pressure and 1.5 Figure 1 liters per hour a t 74.1 mm . h g . ( 2 7 - i n c h ) vacuum in the pres ence of alcohol vapor, w ith a condensing area of 640 sq. cm. cooled w ith brine, whereas th e present design perm its an extrac tion of 5.5 liters per hour a t ordinary pressure and over 4 liters per hour in vacuum w ith a condensing area of only 350 sq. cm. W hen used under vacuum , excessive evaporation of the solvent in the extractor is prevented by a oack-condenscr inserted in the vacuum line (350-sq. cm. Allihn Pyrex vertical condenser) a t the level of th e side connection of the 8-liter bell ja r form ing the extractor. Inasm uch as the sudden em ptying of the large extractor into th e h o t boiler could be dangerous, particularly w ith v ery volatile solvents, th e retu rn U -tube is provided w ith a glass stopcock which perm its either controlled periodical or continuous circula tion of the solvent. A sam pling o u tlet is provided a t th e bo tto m of the extractor. T h e condensers can be cooled w ith eith er w ater or brine, and th e piping circuit includes th e necessary valves and m easuring devices for determ ination of the h e at balance. Table I. H ead B oiler T em T em p e ra tu re p e ra tu re ° C. ° C. 32 36 29 35 Performance of Apparatus E x tra c t T em p e ra tu re ° C. A bsolute P ressu re M m . Hij O ver head M ole % B o tto m Mole % 27 26 109 7 3 .0 6 2 .8 2 3 .5 2 3 .5 10 0 P la te N o .° 1 .4 1.1 ° O ver-all th e o re tic al p la te n u m b e r. A lthough a c e rta in reflux ta k e s place from th e to p of th e v a p o r line dow nw ard, no liquid is ever carried b ack to th e still p o t w hen th e lic a t in p u t is c orrectly a d ju ste d . T h e re fo re th e phases in equilibrium considered for th e calculation of th e "o v e r-a ll th e o re tic al p la te n u m b e r” w ere th e s till p o t liquid com position an d th e d is tilla te com posi tion, respectively. N o flow m e a su re m e n t is involved in th is c alculation. H ow ever, th e ra te of distilla tio n can be d e te rm in e d b y m easuring th e tim e req u ired to fill th e e x tra c to r w hose cap a c ity is know n; th is op eratio n re q uires s h u ttin g off th e stopcock on th e re tu rn U -tube for only a s h o rt tim e. T he d a ta reported show th e excellent perform ance of the ap p aratu s. T hey dem onstrate th e possibility of obtaining a rate of extraction m uch faster th a n h ith erto reported w ith large all glass lab oratory ap p aratu s, while a t th e sam e tim e m aintaining a satisfactory an d economical h e a t balance so th a t th e extraction can be carried o u t under conditions m ore closely resembling those of p la n t operation. Table II. H eat Balance H e a t In p u t from D istilla te H e a t O u tp u t (to B rine) A. H e a t of condensation K a te of d istilla tio n , ml. p er m in., 80 D istilla te , sp. g r., 0.840 E th a n o l, m ole % , 62.8 W a te r, m ole % , 37.3 Sp. h e a t of eth an o l, 204.26 Sp. h e a t of w a ter, 579.3 A *= 23,103.96 calories p e r m in. K a te of b rin e flow, lite rs p e r m in., 5.6 B rin e , sp. g r„ 1.20 B rin e , sp. h e a t, 0.7 I n p u t te m p e ra tu re , ° C ., 8.0 T e m p e ra tu re increase, 0 C., 8.1 W eight, gal. of w a ter, lb ., 8.33 H e a t o u tp u t, 81.4 B .t.u . or 20,462.4 calories p e r m in. B . H e a t of of cooling of distillate T e m p e ra tu re decrease, ° C., 2 9 -2 6 ° » 3° Sp. h e a t of 62.8 m ole % of e th a n o l a t 23° C .f calories p e r gram , 72.0 B «■ 145.15 calories p e r m in. T o ta l h e a t in p u t, 23,249.11 calories p e r m in. Balance®, 2787 calories p e r m in. or 11.9% ° “ B alance” rep resen ts sum m ed effect of h e a t losses from th e s till p o t and th e v a p o r line, th e th e rm o m e te rs, v arious experim ental u n c erta in tie s, an d som e sim plifying assu m p tio n s m ad e in calculation of th e q u a n titie s involved. LITERATURE CITED (1) Beebe, A . H ., Coulter, K . E ., L in d s a y , R . A ., a n d Baker, E . M .# I n d . E n g . C h e m ., 3 4 , 1501 (1 9 4 2 ). (2 ) S m a llw o o d , E ., I n d . E n g . C h e m ., A n a l E d ., 14, 9 03 (1 9 4 2 ). T able I indicates th e perform ance of th e a p p aratu s in two different experim ents. T he volatility involved in calculating th e over-all theoretical p late num ber has been calculated from th e recen t d a ta of Beebe an d co-workers (f): F o r Xf = 24.10 an d x<> = 56.75 th e overhead r e s e n t e d before th e D ivision of In d u s tria l an d E n g in ee rin g C h em istry a t th e 105th M eetin g of th e A m e r i c a n C h e m i c a l S o c i e t y , D e tro it, M ich. P 61 A Continuous Liquid-Liquid Extractor IR W IN A . P E A R L The Institute of Paper Chemistry, A p p le to n , W is. T L Y Kieselbach (I) introduced a new principle into R EthC Ee Nfield of liquid-liquid extractors for use w ith m ixtures stan d ard -tap er jo in t was used for th e connection to th e boiling flask, C. T ubing of a t least 10-mm. outside diam eter should be used for th e glass p a rt of the trap , D; otherwise, th e passage of very slowly breaking emulsions is impeded. T he tra p its e lf was m ade of a sh o rt length of fairly thick-walled neoprene tubing. T he inner tube, E , was m ade by sealing a piece of 8-mm. outside diam eter glass tubing to a stock gas inlet adapter. T he length of th e tu b e depended upon th e size of th e flask containing th e m aterial to be ex tracted. If a num ber of gas inlet ad ap ters are no t available, a 10/30 stan d a rd jo in t m ay be sealed to th e stock ad ap ter and a num ber of 8-mm. tubes w ith stan d ard 10/30 joints of lengths to fit various flasks or bottles m ay be used. which tend to emulsify. H is extractor, using a ir agitation and a settling cham ber for the separation of an y emulsion formed, m ade possible the rapid extraction of solutions form erly tak in g as long as several weeks. However, K ieselbach's ex tracto r has a num ber of disadvantages, chief am ong w hich are th e facts th a t a separate ex tractor is necessary for each desired volum e of solution to be ex tracted an d th a t very stable emulsions do n o t separate in th e narrow settling cham ber. T he app aratu s herein described was an a tte m p t to increase the u tility of K ieselbach’s extracto r for use w ith strongly emulsifying sulfite waste liquor reaction m ixtures varying in volume from 250 cc. to several gallons. T he e x tracto r u n it is actu ally an ad ap te r to be used w ith sta n d ard -tap er glass bottles or flasks. I t is m ade from readily available stock glassware and requires a m inim um of glass blowing. T h e completion of th e extraction is usually determ ined by th e change in color tak in g place in th e settling cham ber. However, in th e case of extractions of colorless substances, sam ples of th e solvent layer in th e settling basin m ay be tak en periodically by lowering th e solvent solution interface (by w ithdraw ing a little solution through th e gas inlet tube, E ) an d th e appropriate use of several screw clam ps on th e ru b b er trap . (R ichard Kieselbach, a fte r reviewing th e paper, suggested th a t th e settling cham ber m ight be provided w ith a tu b u latu re, close to th e point which used to be the neck of th e Erlenm eyer flask, w hich would perm it sam pling w ithout interru p tio n of the operation of th e ex tracto r. T his should prove a valuable modification of th e present ap p a ra tu s when dealing w ith colorless solutions.) A glass T in th e ru b b er tra p m ay be used if a num ber of such solutions are to be encountered. W hen th e extraction is com plete, th e solvent in th e settling basin m ay be draw n oS in the m anner described above. These advantages m ake th e rubber tra p preferable to th e all-glass U -trap. In addition, th e glass blowing is greatly simplified. An Erlenm eyer flask was used for th e settling cham ber because m any fairly stable emulsions did n o t break in th e sm all-diam eter settling basin of th e earlier ap p aratu s. T h e shape of th e E rlenm eyer flask is adm irably suited for th is purpose because th e slopes of its base an d sides (when in th e position shown in Figure 1) facilitate rapid separation of the tw o liquid phases. F urtherm ore, th is design is relatively com p act. F o r m axim um applicability, th e seals a t b o th ends of the E rlenm eyer flask should be a t th e sam e level. T he size of the flask depends upon th e n atu re of the solutions encountered. F o r fast-breaking emulsions a 250-cc. flask m ay be used, thereby holding up less solvent in th e settling cham ber. I f a large mixing cham ber is used w ith a correspondingly increased a ir stream , a larger settling cham ber should be used. T he specifications of the entire ap p a ratu s are flexible. W hen extracting m aterials su b ject to oxidation by a ir a stream of in e rt gas should be used for agitation. Furtherm ore, w hen ex tractin g g as-saturated solutions (such as bicarbonate o r bisulfite solutions), carbon dioxide or sulfur dioxide, respectively, m ay be used advantageously as th e ag itatin g gas. In extractions of large volumes of solutions w ith corresponding increases in tim e, th e loss of solvent due to ex trainm ent in th e exit gases m ay become appreciable, and more solvent m ay have to be added to th e boiling flask. In th is case advantage m ay be tak e n of a two-necked boiling flask. A long efficient reflux condenser should alw ays be used. An active carbon tra p is useful for recovering larger am ounts of solvents. A large ap p aratu s, using sem iball joints, for use w ith 22-, 50-, and 72-liter flasks was fabricated according to specifications by th e Scientific Glass A pparatus Co., Bloomfield, N . J. Figure 1 T he operation of the complete ex tracto r assem bly draw n to scale in Figure 1 is identical to K ieselbach’s. T h e ex tracto r u n it was used successfully for extracting solutions contained in vessels ranging from 250-cc. flasks to 12-liter bottles. T he mixing cham ber, A , was m ade by sealing together two stan d ard -tap er glass joints. T h e upper jo in t in this case was 24/40, although any size com patible w ith o th er equipm ent is sa t isfactory. T he lower joint was 29/42; because of the possibility of constriction, a sm aller stan d ard -tap er jo in t should n o t be used. B oth stan d ard joints were connected to 28-mm. outside diam eter tubing. A 500-cc. Erlenm eyer flask served as th e settling cham ber, B , and was connected to th e mixing cham ber b y a short piece (30 mm.) of 25-mm. outside diam eter tubing. A 24/40 LITERATURE CITED (1) 62 K ie s e lb a c h , R ., I n d . E n g . C h e m ., A n a l . E d ., 15, 2 23 (1 9 4 3 ). Determination of Small Am ounts of Acrylonitrile in A ir G . W . PETERSEN a n d H . H . R A D K E Industrial H y g ie n e Laboratory, The B. F. G oodrich Com pany, A k ro n , O h io E recent w idespread use of acrylonitrile in th e m anu T Hfacture of one type of synthetic ru b b er has m ade it im pera Table I. Concentrations tive th a t a qu an titativ e m ethod for its determ ination in air be developed. T he toxicity experim ents conducted b y th e U. S. Public H ealth Service (1) indicate th a t th e m axim um allowable lim it for acrylonitrile is in th e neighborhood of 20 p.p.m . Con sequently, an analytical m ethod m u st be accurate to a t least th a t concentration. As far as is known no analytical m ethod has y et been reported. T he Raleigh-Jeans gas interferom eter has been used for concentrations above 90 p.p.m . Below this figure the results are questionable (2). In addition, th e gas in ter ferom eter is not very satisfactory for field use where m ixtures of vapors are likely to be encountered. T heoretical S am pling C o n cen tratio n R a te T im e P .p .m . L ./m x n . M in . 0 .4 0 .4 0 .4 0 .4 0 .4 400 200 100 50 25 20 35 75 150 180 .------Mg. —Y ie ld - 6 .5 4 5.51 394 189 9 7 .9 5 0 .6 3 0 .0 P .p .m . 6 .12 6 .2 9 4 .5 0 9 8 .5 9 4 .6 9 7 .9 101.2 120.0 w ater, and the excess sulfuric acid is titra te d w ith 0.0LY sodium hydroxide, using m ethyl red as th e indicator. T he concentration of acrylonitrile is calculated as follows: METHOD P.p.m . = (25.00A1'a - T he m ethod developed in th is laboratory depends upon a modified K jeldahl reaction in which th e absorbing solution containing th e acrylonitrile is m ade strongly alkaline w ith sodium hydroxide and then oxidized w ith hydrogen peroxide. Upon refiuxing, the acrylonitrile is converted q u an titativ ely to am m onia, which is distilled j, over and collected in a stan d ard acid solution. The am ount of am m onia evolved is determ ined by titratio n of th e excess acid. T he acrylo nitrile vapors are absorbed in cold concentrated sulfuric acid contained in- a suitable absorption trap. T his m ethod is lim ited by th e fact th a t there can be present in t h e c o n t a m i n a t e d a ir no nitrogen-bearing compounds oth er th a n acrylonitrile. when N a Vb Vs Nb C = = = = — N BV B) X ^ X C norm ality of I I 2SOi ml. of N aO H used in titra tio n volum e of air sampled, liters norm ality of N aO H used in titratio n 22,400 corrected to sam pling pressure and t emperature DISCUSSION T he analysis is based upon Radziszewski’s reaction (3). mechanism is as follows: T he O H 20 2 N aO H /• R C N — > R — C—H N 2— > N H S + R — C A \ A PROCEDURE S a m p lin g . T w o absorp tion trap s (Figure 1) are filled to a d epth of about 2.5 cm. (1 inch) w ith glass beads, and 2 ml. of concentrated sul furic acid are added to each trap . T he tra p s are con Figure 1. A bsorption Trap nected in series and p u t in A . Glass outlet tube a water-ice b ath. T he air B . One-hole rubber stopper sample is draw n through a t C. 0.25-Inch test tube a m aximum rate of 0.4 liter D. Glass beads E. Glass inlet tube per m inute. T he ra te of sam pling is accurately m eas ured by m eans of a ro tam eter. T he volume of air sam pled should be such th a t the to ta l sam ple consists of approxim ately 6 mg. of acrylonitrile. T he sam ple is th en washed into th e reflux flask (Figure 2), and 0.2 gram of copper acetate is added as an inhibitor to p revent polym erization. A n a l y s i s . Tw enty-five milliliters of 0.0251V sulfuric acid are p ipetted into th e titratio n beaker an d diluted w ith distilled w ater un til the bubbler is a t least 1.25 cm. (0.5 inch) below th e surface. T he reflux flask containing th e sample is p u t into place and th e system is completely closed. T he acid sam ple is m ade alkaline by adding 50 ml. of 50 per cent sodium hydroxide to th e closed system by m eans of the separatory funnel. T h e residual sodium hydroxide in th e reflux condenser is w ashed down w ith 10 ml. of distilled w ater, and 20 ml. of 30 per cent hydrogen peroxide are then added slowly from th e separatory funnel. W hen the addition is completed, th e sam ple is refluxed gently for 30 m inutes. A t the end of th e reflux tim e, th e w ater is drained from th e reflux condenser and approxim ately one half of th e sam ple is distilled over. T he second condenser is then w ashed down w ith distilled Figure 2. Apparatus for D e termination of A crylo n itrile A . 200-cc. balloon flaslc B. Ground-glass joint C . Reflux condenser D . Separatory funnel E. No. 2 condenser F . Sintered-slass bubbler 63 O Na T he use of hydrogen peroxide reduces th e re flux tim e from 4 hours to 0.5 hour, and also drives th e reaction to completion. Low yields due to polym erization of th e acrylonitrile are prevented by th e addi tion of copper acetate as an inhibitor, and by lim itation of th e size of th e sample. A sam ple containing approxi m ately 6 mg. of acrylo nitrile proved to be m ost satisfactory because it is dilute enough to p re v e n t polym erization and y e t large enough to give a n accu rate analysis. T h e maxim um sam pling ra te of 0.4 liter per m inute is very critical for th e typ e of absorp tion equipm ent de scribed in th is article. A higher ra te will re su lt in loss of sample. 64 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING T able I contains the results of th e analyses of known concen tratio n s of acrylonitrile vapors, prepared in a gas cham ber of 1000 liters’ capacity by the introduction of m easured am ounts of liquid acrylonitrile. T he various concentrations were chosen to indicate the accuracy of the m ethod over a wide range. Over the entire range of concentrations th e only variable is th e tim e of sam pling. T he large relative error in th e analysis of the 25 p.p.m . sam ples is misleading, since th e actu a l error is only 5 p.p.m . T he principal reason for th e error in the results of the low concentrations is th e difficulty of m easuring th e exceedingly small am ounts of liquid acrylonitrile required in m aking up these concentrations in the 1000-liter gas cham ber available. CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 ACKNOWLEDGMENTS T he authors gratefully acknowledge th e cooperation of V. M igrdichian of th e A m erican C yanam id C om pany for his suggestions as to th e sam pling m edium, and of IV. P. T yler, T. R . Steadm an, and J. C. M cCool of th e B. F. G oodrich Com pany in th e developm ent of th e analysis. LITERATURE CITED (1) D u d ley, N . C ., and N eal, P . A ., J . In d . H yg. Toxicol., 24, 2 7 -3 6 (1942). (2) P roceedings, Conference on H ealth H azards in R ubber Industry, M ay 29, 1942. (3) R adziszow ski, B er., 18, 335 (1SS5). Spectrophotometric Determination of Iodine Liberated in the Oxidation of Carbon M onoxide by Iodine Pentoxide B E R N A R D S M A L L E R a n d J O H N F. H A L L , J r . A e ro M e d ical Laboratory, A rm y A ir Forces, W right Field, Dayton, O h io A spectrophotometric method for measuring the Iodine liberated in the oxidation of carbon monoxide b y iodine pentoxide Is described. The Iodine concentration was measured at 3 50 millimicrons against a water blank, using a Coleman photoelectric spectrophotometer. Results in terms of carbon m onoxide were calculated b y the use of a for mula derived from the calibration curve and the chemical reactions Involved. The method Is sensitive, convenient (requiring the preparation of only one reagent, 1 per cent potassium iod ide), and reliable for concentrations of carbon m onoxide as low as 0 .0 0 5 to 0.001 per cent. The range of ap plicability is 0.001 to approximately 0.2 per cent. Interfering substances (gasoline vapor, water, etc.) are effectively removed b y the use of chromic acid, silica gel, and phosphorus pentoxide as the absorbing or "scouring" agents. A s described, the method has an accuracy of ± 1 0 per cent In the range 0.001 to 0 .0 1 0 per cent carbon monoxide. For analyses of carbon monoxide concentrations above 0 .0 1 0 per cent and within the limits of usefulness of the apparatus (0 .2 per cent) the accuracy of the method is Increased to ± 3 to 5 per cent. O N E of the stan d ard m ethods and probably th e m ost widely used q u an titativ e procedure a t present available for th e de term ination of sm all am ounts of carbon monoxide in a ir is th e iodine pentoxide m ethod. N um erous w orkers, including Edell (J), Sendroy (S), and V andaveer and Gregg (4, 5) have suggested m odifications or have added im provem ents to th e m ethod as originally introduced by de la H arfe an d R everdin (2). I n these m ethods th e gas sam ple is usually first passed through chrom ic acid to rem ove volatile hydrocarbons, th en through po tassium hydroxide and phosphorus pentoxide to rem ove w ater vapor, and finally over d ry solid iodine pentoxide a t 150° to 160 0 C. to produce q u an titativ ely th e volatile products carbon dioxide an d iodine. T hese are absorbed or collected in barium hydrox ide in case carbon dioxide is m easured, or in potassium iodide in case th e iodine is to be determ ined. Iodom etric m easurem ent by titratio n w ith sodium thiosulfatc, using starch as th e indicator, has been generally adopted as the m ethod of choice. However, the necessity for frequent determ inations in this laboratory of low (0.005 to 0.001 p er cent) carbon monoxide concentrations disclosed several difficulties and disadvantages w hich m ade desirable some oth er m eans of m easuring th e iodine liberated. T h e following m ay be m entioned specifically: (1) the very dilute (0.001A0 sodium thiosulfate solutions used, because of a slow ra te of decom position, require periodic checks upon th eir concentration; (2) slight o v ertitratio n of th e end point is a p o ten tial source of error; an d (3) duplicate titratio n s on th e same sam ple are som etim es impossible. APPARATUS A N D REAGENTS Iodine pentoxide ap p aratu s. Colem an photoelectric spectro photom eter, M odel 10S. One per cent potassium iodide solution (M erck’s c.p. g ranular potassium iodide is satisfactory). Pipets, 10.0, 1.0, and 0.2 cc. METHODS A N D PROCEDURE T h e above-m entioned difficulties could be elim inated, it was found, by th e use of a spectrophotom etric m ethod of m easuring th e iodine concentration. F o r this purpose a Coleman double m onochrom ator photoelectric spectrophotom eter (M odel 10S) having a range of 350 to 1000 millim icrons was used. D eter m inations of th e spectral transm ittance of iodine in 1 per cent potassium iodide, the calibration curve relating concentrations to logarithm of th e percentage tran sm it tance, as well as all m eas urem ents of iodine concen tratio n in blanks and un know n sam ples were per formed w ith th is instrum ent. The spectrophotom etric m ethod . of m easuring the a m ount of iodine in a 1 per c e n t potassium iodide solu tion requires no chemical reaction of th e iodine b u t is dependent only upon the absorption of lig h t b y the iodine in solution. F o r th e range of iodine concentra tions used th is absorption has been observed to follow B eer’s law, in th a t th e rela tionship between the logarithm of th e percentage tran sm ittan ce and th e con- January 15, 1944 ANALYTIC L EDITI O N 65 Blank analyses are carried o u t by filling calibrated containers w ith nitrogen (commercial), passing the gas through the ap p ara tus, and flushing exactly as w ith unknow n sam ples. F rom the am ount of iodine m easured th e equivalent carbon monoxide is then calculated. B lank analyses are always perform ed prior to th e analysis of unknow n sam ples and the blank value in term s of percentage carbon monoxide is always su b tracte d from the un known value to o btain the tru e or “ corrected” carbon monoxide percentage concentration. T he only reagent required for an analysis is the 1 per cent potassium iodide solution. T his should be prepared from a pure grade of potassium iodide (since im pure preparations readily liberate appreciable iodine) and should be renewed about once a week. T he solution should bo stored in a dark glass bottle. RESULTS j 350 45 0 550 1------ 1------1------ 650 75 0 WAVE LENGTH-MILLIMICRONS Figure 2. Spectral Transmission Curve of Iodine (5 X 10 -» N ) In 1 percent potassium Iodide solution as determined with Coleman photoelectric spectrophotometer (Model 10S) using a 5-mm. slit. Cuvettes were circular tubes of 16.5-mm. diameter and comparison tube was a blank solution (10 cc.) of 1 per cent potassium iodide centration of absorbing m aterial (iodine in 1 per cent potassium iodide) is linear and th e calibration curve is a stra ig h t line. T his m ay be expressed as: In Figure 2 the spectral tran sm ittan ce curve of iodine (5 X 10~W ) in 1 per cent iodide solution is presented. M aximum absorption of light b y iodine (5 X 10~SAT) in 1 p er cent po tas sium iodide solution occurs in th e region of th e ultraviolet. However, a t 350 millim icrons (th e lower lim it of th e Colem an in strum ent) th e absorption is sufficiently g reat (90 per cent) to pro vide a m eans of m easurem ent th a t is as sensitive an d accurate as th e routine sodium thiosulfate titra tio n m ethod. B oth th e ti tratio n m ethod an d th a t described here have been em ployed in this lab oratory for determ ining carbon monoxide in air samples. However, th e au th o rs have found th e titra tio n m ethod less satis factory for concentrations of carbon monoxide below 0.005 per cent. Below this value th e titra tio n m ethod was less convenient and more tim e-consum ing th a n th e spectrophotom etric. T h e relationship betw een th e concentration of iodine over a wide concentration range and th e logarithm of percentage trans m ittan ce is linear. T h e value of th e calibration constant, K ', which expresses this relationship betw een concentration in equiv alents per liter an d logarithm of percentage transm ittance, is 5.1 X 1 0 "‘. C oncentration = K ' X —^ r ° wherc To equals the intensity of incident light, T equals the in ten sity of tran sm itted light (after passing through sam ple), and K ' equals the calibration co n stan t expressing the relationship betw een concentration of iodine in 1 per cent potassium iodide solution and th e logarithm of the percentage tran sm ittan ce. Ab sorption of light by iodine (5 X 10“ bV) in 1 per cent potassium iodide increases as the wave length of light used decreases into th e ultraviolet. As a result of this observation all m easurem ents were m ade a t 350 millimicrons, th e point of g reatest absorption of th e w ave-length range available w ith th is ty p e spectrophotom eter. G as sam ples are collected in calibrated m etallic containers of approxim ately 1600- to 1700-cc. (STP) capacity; sm aller 200to 250-cc. (STP) glass tonom eters m ay be used for sam pling p ur poses, b u t give less satisfactory results. T he sam ples are then passed through th e iodine pentoxide ap p aratu s by displacem ent w ith w ater, th is m ethod being preferable from the stan d p o in t of safety, ease of adjustm ent, and convenience to th e suction m ethod usually employed. I t was experim entally observed th a t th e displacem ent of the 1600- to 1700-cc. sam ple in 60 m inutes fol lowed by a 30-m inute flushing w ith nitrogen gas a t th e same ra te of flow gave m ost accurate results. However, size of sam ple, its concentration, and degree of accuracy dem anded are all factors which m ay m odify the tim e necessary to complete an analysis. F o r the collection of the liberated iodine th e original Gomberg tu be used routinely w ith th e iodine pentoxide ap p aratu s was re placed by an absorption tub e designed and adap ted by J. W. H eim of this laboratory for the present m ethod of analysis (Figure 1). T he iodine passes through the collecting tube, which extends alm ost to the bottom of the absorption vessel, and bubbles o u t through the sintered-glass filter a t its end. T h e am ount of iodide solution used (10 cc.) is sufficient, of course, to keep th e filter well below the liquid level. T his tube has m arked advantages over th e Gomberg type, in th a t its w ide-m outhed ground-glass stopper perm its ready access to the iodide solution for sam pling a t the com pletion of an analysis; it is easily washed ou t or cleansed; an d q u an titativ e results obtained w ith its use have proved it an efficient type of absorption vessel. 0 10 co <2 1 < 8 cc Y- Z Id o z < X o O T IM E -H O U R S Figure 3. Changes in Percentage Transmission of Iodine in 1 Per Cent Potassium Iodide as a Function of Time T he change in th e percentage light transm ission of iodine in 1 p er cen t potassium iodide solution as a function of tim e is illus tra te d in Figure 3 and th e q u an titativ e effects of such changes are presented in T able I. D ilutions of 1 to 50 showed changes equivalent to only a 6 p er cent decrease in th e percentage of car bon monoxide after one hour. If spectrophotom etric readings are m ade w ithin 5 to 10 m inutes following th e com pletion of the sam ple run, th e error due to any change in lig h t transm ission m ay be considered negligible. B lank analyses using nitrogen gas (commercial) an d performed as previously described gave fairly consistent values, th e average being eq uivalent to a carbon monoxide concentration of 0.0004 per cent. T hese results are sum m arized in T ab le II. INDUSTRIAL Tabic I. AND ENGINEERING Effect of Changes in Percentage Transmission of Iodine in 1 Per Cent Potassium Iodide Solution with Time Original^ C o n ce n tratio n D ilu tio n CO % 1 :1 0 1 :2 0 1 :5 0 0.0 1 3 7 0 .0 1 3 6 0 .0 1 1 6 1 H our 5 H o u rs 23 H o u rs CO C h an g e CO C h an g e CO C h ange % % % % % % 0 .0 1 2 0 - 1 2 . 4 0 .0 1 0 9 - 2 0 . 4 0 .0 1 0 3 - 2 4 . 8 0.0120 -1 1 .8 0 .0 1 1 2 - 1 7 . 6 0 .0 1 0 7 - 2 1 . 4 0 .0 1 0 9 - 6 .0 0 .0 0 9 1 - 2 1 . 6 0 .0 0 8 5 - 2 6 . 8 Table II. Blank A n alyse s Sam ple V olum e Cc. 1 2 /5 /4 2 1 2 /5 /4 2 1 2 /8 /4 2 1 2 /1 2 /4 2 1 2 /1 2 /4 2 1 2 /1 2 /4 2 1 2 /1 9 /4 2 1 /2 /4 3 1 /6 /4 3 1660 1610 1630 1590 1600 1580 1640 1630 1650 0 .0 0 5 0 4 /1 2 /4 2 4 /1 2 /4 2 4 /1 2 /4 2 4 /1 2 /4 2 4 /1 1 /4 2 K ' X (0.056 X 1000) X 100 X 10 X (2 - log % T) cc. of sam ple (STP) where K ' is 5.1 X 10- t and 10 ml. of 1% potassium iodide are used. Of m 0 .0 0 0 5 0.0 0 0 4 0.0 0 0 3 0 .0 0 0 5 0.0 0 0 4 F inally Carbon M o no xide (C om p ariso n of B u re a u of S ta n d a rd s a n d W rig h t F ie ld A nalyses) D a te pn /0 0 .0 0 0 2 0 .0 0 0 2 A n opportunity to check th e accuracy and sensitivity of this m ethod was offered when known sta n d a rd sam ples of carbon m on oxide m ixtures prepared an d analyzed b y th e N atio n al B ureau of S tandards, W ashington, D . C., were sen t to W right Field for check analyses. T he com parative results are presented in T able I I I . In general, values w ith th e spcctrophotom etric m ethod varied from 4 to IS per cen t below those reported b y th e B ureau of S tandards, w ith results averaging 10 to 11 per cent lower. While the m ethod is capable of detecting concentrations as low as 0.001 per cent, th e lim it of accuracy is approxim ately 5 to 10 per cent for concentrations below 0.010 per cent. B u re au of S ta n d a rd s A nalyses % 0 .0 0 7 6 th e chemical reactions involved 1.0 ml. of O.OOliV iodine is equivalent to 0.056 ml. of carbon monoxide m eas 0° an d 760 m m . Tlie volum e of carbon monoxide a t 0° mm. is th en calculated as follows: M po 5.1 X 1 0 -6 X (0.056 X 1000) X 1000 X (2 - log % T) /0 “ cc. of sam ple (STP) CO (as Io d in e E % 0.0 0 0 3 0 .0 0 0 7 A v. 0 .0 0 0 4 M D « ( ¿ 0 0.0001 Table III. W rig h t Field A nalyses % 0 .0 0 7 0 0 .0 0 0 5 0 .0 0 6 8 0 .0 0 6 9 0.0 0 4 1 0 .0 0 4 8 Vol. 16, No. 1 substituting, [N itro g en (C om m ercial) G as Sam ples] D a te F rom solution ured a t and 760 CHEMISTRY T he analysis of sam ples whose concentration is below 0.010 per cen t requires consideration of several factors. As previously m entioned, ra te of sam ple flow should be sufficiently slow to en sure com plete oxidation of all carbon monoxide b y th e iodine pentoxide. F o r concentrations of 0.010 p er cen t an d below to ta l sam pling periods of 80 to 90 m inutes gave satisfactory results. Sample volum e is another factor to be given consideration when accurate results are desired. C om parative results of analyses of a stan d ard carbon monoxide m ixture when using sm all and large sam pling volum es are shown in T able IV . A ccuracy and dependability of analysis are obviously increased when larger volumes are used, particularly w hen th e concentration of carbon monoxide is below 0.010 per cent. T he photoelectric colorim eter used w ith a filter w hich tran sm its the greater portion of its lig h t as nearly as possible w ithin th e re gion of th e maxim um absorption of iodine in 1 p er cen t potassium iodide solution—i.e., ab o u t 350 millimicrons— can be used if the spectrophotom eter is n o t available. A calibration curve m ust be determ ined and th e sen sitiv ity of th e photoelectric colori m etric procedure is som ew hat less th a n th a t obtained w ith th e spectrophotom eter. % CO = X dilution used T he value 2.86 is term ed K in the final equation below and is determ ined as indicated from bo th th e calibration curve and the q u an tita tiv e relationship betw een th e concentration of carbon m onoxide an d iodine released in the oxidation reaction. The final general equation is then: % CO = K X (2 ~ X dilution cc. of sam ple (STP) As an exam ple of th e use of the above equation in calculating results, th e following analytical d a ta are presented: A 10-ec. portion of th e 1 per cent potassium iodide was used to collect th e iodine liberated when a gas sam ple of 2360 cc. (STP) was passed through th e apparatus. A 1 to 100 dilu tio n of the iodine collected in the 10-cc. portion of th e 1 per cent potassium iodide solution was m ade and when m easured (a t 350 m illim i crons) w ith th e spectrophotom eter against a 10-cc. 1 p er cent po tassium iodide blank set a t 100 per cent lig h t transm ission, gave a percentage lig h t transm ission of 44.5. T h e calculation, b y sub stitu tio n of th e above da ta , is illustrated as follows: D ifference % - 7 .9 -1 4 .5 -1 0 .5 - 9 .1 A v. - 1 0 . 5 -1 8 .0 - 4 .0 A v. —1 1 .0 = 5.1 X 10-s X 56,000 X (2 - log % T ) cc. of sam ple (STP) %CO = Table IV . 2.86 X (0.352) X 100 = 0.043 2360 Standard Carbon M o no xide M ixture [C om parison of A nalyses U sing Sm all a n d L arge Sam ple Volum es of S ta n d a rd CO (0.012 p e r c en t)] D a te G as V olum e Cc. 1 0 /2 3 /4 2 1 0 /2 3 /4 2 1 0 /2 3 /4 2 1 0 /2 4 /4 2 1 0 /24/42 1 0 /2 4 /4 2 1 0 /2 4 /4 2 264 204 264 270 270 270 270 1 0 /2 6 /4 2 1 0 /2 6 /4 2 1 0 /2 6 /4 2 1 0 /2 7 /4 2 1 0 /2 7 /4 2 1 0 /2 7 /4 2 1 0 /3 0 /4 2 1 0 /3 1 /4 2 1 1 /1 3 /4 2 1660 1660 1660 1660 1660 1660 16001060 1645 CO F o u n d % 0 .0 11 0.009 0.0 1 3 0 .0 0 6 0 .0 10 0 .0 0 6 0 .0 1 5 A v. 0 .0 1 0 0.0 1 3 0 .0 10 0 .0 11 0 .0 12 0 .0 11 D e v iatio n % + 0 .0 0 1 - 0 .0 0 1 + 0.0 0 3 -0 .0 0 4 0.000 -0 .0 0 4 + 0 .0 0 5 M D - ( a .) 0 .0020 + 0 .0 0 2 - 0 .0 0 1 0.000 + 0 .0 0 1 0.000 0 .0 1 3 + 0 .002 0 .0 11 0 .0 11 0 .0 12 0.000 0.000 + 0.0 0 1 A v. 0.011 MD - ( * ) 0 .0 0 0 8 LITERATURE CITED (1) E d ell, G . M ., I n d . E n o . C h e m ., 20 , 275 (1928). (2) H arfe, C. de la, and R everdin, F ., Chem .-Ztg. 1 2 , 1726 (1888). (3) Sendroy, J., in Peter3 and V an Slyke, “Q u an titative Clinical C hem istry, V ol. II, M eth od s” , B altim ore, W illiam s & W ilkins Co., 1932. (4) V andaveer, F . E ., Gas, 18, 24 (1942). (5) V andaveer, F . E ., and G regg, R . C ., I n d . E n o . C h e m ., A n a l . E d ., 1, 129 (1 9 2 9 ). » Yeast M icrobiological Methods for Determination of Vitamins Pan to th e n ic A c i d L A W R E N C E A T K IN , W I L L I A M L . W IL L IA M S , A L F R E D S. S C H U L T Z , a n d C H A R L E S N . F R E Y The Fleischmann Laboratories, Standard Brands Incorporated, N ew Yo rk 51 , N . Y . The yeast growth method for determination of pyridoxine is modified for the determination of pantothenic acid. The basal medium contains ammonium sulfate as a nitrogen source and in addition sufficient asparagine to prevent interference due to 0-alanine. Extracts of substances to be assayed are prepared b y aqueous extraction under pressure (1 5 pounds for 15 minutes) at p H 5.6 to 5 .7, by E y east microbiological m ethod recently described for the T Hdeterm ination of pyridoxine (0) can, w ith certain modifica tions, be used to determ ine pan to th en ic acid. T h e y east grow th factor activ ity of pantothenic acid was know n before its need in anim al n u tritio n w as established (72). T h a t th e y east m ethod was n o t further developed as an assay m ethod-by the discoverers of pantothenic acid was due in p a rt to th e interference of 13alanine (S). 0-Alanine is a stru ctu ra l p a rt of th e vitam in mole cule b u t is itself w ithout vitam in activ ity for higher anim als, al though under certain conditions it can replace pantothenic acid as a yeast grow th factor. T h e inclusion of asparagine in th e y east grow th m edium tends to reduce th e effect of 0-alanine (73), b u t ap p aren tly it was not realized th a t th e presence of sufficient asparagine fu rth er reduces th e interference to an insignificant level. A sparagine does not, however, affect th e activ ity of p an tothenic acid under th e conditions employed. T he assay m ethod described here has been used b y th e authors for some tim e and m ay possess certain advantages over th e micro biological m ethod of Pennington, Snell, an d W illiams (3). T he m ethod is rapid, 16 to 18 hours being allowed for y east grow th, an d it is especially adapted for turb id im etric m easurem ent of th e y east grow th w ith a photoelectric colorim eter. Furtherm ore, it offers an opportunity for checking assay results w ith a different ty p e of microorganism . APPARATUS ^ T he apparatus em ployed has previously been described (7, 2). T h e utility of the E velyn photoelectric colorim eter was also studied. Using the te st tubes usually supplied w ith th e E velyn and the 660 (red) filter, th e absorption curves were found to be essentially the sam e as w ith th e L um etron instru m en t. SOLUTIONS One lite r contains 200 gram s of gram s of m onopotassium phos p hate, 1.7 gram s of potassium chloride, 0.5 gram of m agnesium sulfate (M gS0(.7H 20 ) , 0.5 gram of calcium chloride (CaCl2.2H 20 ) , 0.01 gram of m anganese sulfate, an d 0.01 gram of ferric chloride. P o ta s s iu m C i t r a t e B u f f e r . One liter contains 100 gram s of potassium citrate (K SC«HS0 7 .H 20 ) an d 20 gram s of citric acid (H 3C ,H 50 7.H 20 ). S u g a r a n d S a lts S o lu tio n . c .p . dextrose (anhydrous), 2.2 T h i a m i n e S o l u t i o n , 10 m i c r o g r a m s p e r m l. P y r i d o x i n e S o l u t i o n , 1 0 m i c r o g r a m s p e r m l. I n o s i t o l S o l u t i o n , 1 m g . p e r m l. B io tin S o lu tio n . S. M . A. Corp. biotin concentrate N o. 5000, diluted so th a t it contains approxim ately 0.8 m icrogram of biotin per ml. On one occasion th is m aterial was found to con ta in appreciable am ounts of p an to th en ate and as a consequence a high blank, 15 to 20 per cent absorption, w as obtained. T he p antothenate was readily destroyed by alkaline h eat tre a tm en t and th e blank or zero value retu rn ed to th e previous value (less th a n 10 per cent). P ure biotin was also tried when it recently enzyme digestion at the same p H , or by enzym e digestion followed b y aqueous extraction (1 5 pounds for 15 minutes). The choice of extraction method depends upon the sub stance, since some have pantothenate in a bound form whereas others do not. The results of assays of a number of representative substances compare favorably with results obtained b y other methods. became available and th e results indicate th a t it m ay be sub stitu te d for th e crude concentrate. A m m o n iu m S u l f a t e S o l u t i o n , 150 mg. p er ml. A sp a ra g in e S o lu tio n . One hundred m illiliters contain 3 gram s of (-asparagine. H eatin g to 100° C. is necessary to dis solve th e asparagine. T he solutions are sterilized by heating in flowing steam for 30 m inutes on th ree consecutive days, an d m ay th en be stored a t room tem perature u n til used. T h e pyridoxine solution is care fully p ro tected from light. P a n t o t h e n a t e S t a n d a r d S o l u t i o n . d-Calcium p an to th e n a te (synthetic) is used as a p rim ary stan d ard . A freshly dis solved solution containing 1 mg. p er ml. is k e p t in th e refrigerator and used as a working stan d a rd for n o t m ore th a n 2 to 3 weeks. Im m ediately before use a portion of th e w orking sta n d a rd is di lu ted w ith distilled w ater, to contain 0.1 m icrogram (100 millimicrograms) p er ml. YEAST INOCULUM Fleischm ann culture 4228, a strain of Saccharomyces carlsbergensis, is grown on m alt agar slants (Difco) for 24 hours a t 30° and th en m ay be sto red in th e refrigerator for n o t m ore th an one m onth. T h e day before an assay run, a fresh tran sfer is made an d incubated a t 30°. Y east is tran sferred from th is sla n t to a tube of sterile saline u n til th e lig h t absorption indicates th a t th e concentration is 3 mg. p er ml. T h e calibration (50 p er cent ab sorption w ith th e au th o rs’ instrum ent) is based on a known sus pension of m oist b aker’s y east. T he absolute q u a n tity of yeast in th e inoculum is n o t critical an d hence th is approxim ation is satisfactory. A 10-ml. aliquot of th is suspension is added to 90 ml. of sterile saline contained in an Erlenm eyer flask. T he final suspension contains 0.3 mg. of m oist y e ast p er ml. and is ready for use. PREPARATION OF SAM PLES FOR A S S A Y K u h n an d W endt (7) have reported th a t p an to th e n a te (filtrate factor) m ay occur as p a rt of a nondialyzable complex of high m olecular weight. T h e p an to th en ate con ten t of tissues an d yeast, as m easured b y microbiological m ethods, is increased by autolysis or enzyme digestion and th e increase appears to be due to a decom position of th e complex. P a n to th e n a te is a relatively u nstable com pound, being readily hydrolyzed by e ith er acid or base. C onsequently it is desirable to prepare ex tracts for assay b y th e m ildest an d m ost direct m eans. I n general, th ere are three extraction m ethods available: 1. Enzym e digestion by clarase or o th er suitable enzyme preparations. A utolysis (self-digestion) m ay be considered a form of enzym e digestion b u t is inapplicable to m ost substances and u n certain w ith some tissues. 2. W ate r extraction a t high tem p eratu re (autoclave) and a t th e m ost stable p H range. 3 . Enzym e digestion followed by w ater extraction a t high tem p eratu re. 68 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING Table 1. CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 Typ ical Protocol T o each tu b e a re added 5 m l. of b a sa l p a n to th e n ic a cid -fre e m edium plus in gredients noted below . A fte r th e 10-m inute h e a t tre a tm e n t 1 ml. of y e a st suspension (0.3 m g. of m o ist y e ast) is a d d ed to each. T h e tu b e s a re th e n shaken a t 30° for 16 hours, th e tu rb id ity is m easured, an d th e tu b e s a re re tu rn e d to th e in c u b a to r fo r 2 h o u rs a n d m easu red again. 16 H ours 18 H ours No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 I I jO ML ML err /O 4 .0 3 .5 3 .0 2 .5 0 6 2.0 1.0 0 3 10 11 2 1 0 12 3 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 --------------- A dded-------------------------- . A bsorption 2 1 0 3 2 1 0 3 2 1 0 0 .5 o 50 M y of calcium p a n to th e n a te 0 o 100 Sam e 1 1 .5 o 150 Sam e o 200 Sam e 2 o 300 Sam e 3 o 400 Sam e 4 1 2 o 0 .0 2 5 m l. w hole urinc*> 3 4 1 2 o 0 . 1 m g. y e a s t e x tra c t ( d r y )c 3 4 1 2 M y /tu b e P a n to th e n a te y /o - or y /m l. 21 P a n to th e n a te % M y /tu b e P a n to th e n a te y/g- or y /m l. A verage y /m l. or y/g. 7 21 16 29 4 1 .5 4 8 .5 5 9 .5 6 6 .5 31 48 5 4 .5 A bsorption 37 48 55 66 73 70 130 195 250 57 2.8 2.6 2.6 2 .5 2 8 .5 3 6 .5 5 5 .5 0 1 .5 72 130 203 250 2 2 .5 40 53 57 55 112 165 212 550 560 550 530 550 17.5 3 1 .5 4 3 .0 5 0 .5 165 215 570 550 550 538 110 2 .9 2.0 2.8 2 .7 2 .5 o 0.5 m g. d ry 200-B yeast«* 2 2 .5 4 1 .5 56 63 75 155 265 355 150 155 177 173 29 4 8 .5 6 1 .5 6 7 .5 75 155 250 317 150 155 166 159 163 o 10 m g. w h e at-h ard w in te r N o. 2 e 2 5 .5 4 1 .5 5 4 .5 6 2 .5 87 157 250 350 8 .7 7 .9 8 .3 3 2 .5 4 9 .5 60 6 7 .5 160 235 320 86 8.6 8.0 8 .3 3 4 1 2 P a n to th e n a te 3 4 8.8 7 .8 8.0 u £ alcium p a n to th e n a te , p re p a re d fro m 1 m g. p e r m l. of re frig e ra te d solution. & N o tre a tm e n t, p reserv ed a t p H 5.6 for 24 ho u rs, 10 m l. d ilu te d to 400 ml. j J jg e s tc d w ith clarasc for 2 d ay s a t 45° C ., 100 m g. d ilu te d to 1 lite r. « D igested w ith c larase for 2 d ay s a t 45° C., 100 mg. d ilu te d to 200 m l., solution centrifuged u n til clear. • W a te r ex tra c tio n , au to clav cd 15 m in u tes a t 16 p ounds p ressu re, 1 g ra m dilu ted to 100 ml. an am ount containing only 10 to 20 microgram s: hence 100 mg. are weighed o u t a n d after digestion a g reater dilution is made. T he solutions are centrifuged, if necessary, to o btain a clear ex tra c t. W a t e r E x t r a c t i o n ( H i g h T e m p e r a t u r e ) . Some cereals do n o t ap p ear to require enzyme digestion (9, 10)— e.g., w heat and w heat products—and for these w ater extraction m ay be used. Suspend an am ount of sample estim ated to contain 5 to 10 micro gram s of p an to th en ate—e.g., 1 gram of w heat—in 80 ml. of water, add 1 ml. of buffer, and a d ju st th e pH to 5.6 to 5.7, using dilute sodium hydroxide or sulfuric acid. H eat th e suspensions in an autoclave a t 7 kg. (15 pounds) for 15 m inutes, cool, and dilute to 100 ml. T his treatm en t does n o t always yield a clear extract even a fter centrifuging. A sh o rt incubation a t 45° for 15 m inutes a fte r th e addition of a knife point of clarase will usually produce flocculation and a clear su p ern atan t fluid. E n z y m e D i g e s t i o n F o l l o w e d b y W a t e r E x t r a c t i o n . Pro ceed exactly as in th e simple enzyme digestion b u t rinse th e con ten ts of th e te s t tube into a flask w ith 60 ml. of w ater, check the p H and adju st, if necessary, to 5.6 to 5.7, and th e n h e at a t 15 pounds for 15 m inutes. Cool and dilute as usual. METHOD MILLIMICROGRAMS- PANTOTHENATE Figure 1. A. 16 hours Reference Curve B. 18 hours T he th ird m ethod has been found necessary w ith certain m ate rials—e.g., fresh green peas—because of th e presence of a sub stance inhibitory to yeast grow th which, however, is inactivated by a short treatm en t in th e autoclave. E n zy m e D ig e s tio n . Insoluble substances should be pow dered or dispersed in w ater w ith a W aring Blendor or its equiva lent. W eigh or m easure a portion of th e unknow n estim ated to contain 10 to 20 m icrogram s of p a n to th en ate into a 40-ml. te st tu b e graduated a t 10 and 20 ml. A dd 1.0 ml. of th e buffer and sufficient w ater to m ake th e volume to 10 ml. H e a t in flowing steam for 5 m inutes, cool, and add a weighed am ount of clarase roughly equal to th e dry w eight of th e sam ple. Dissolve by gentle shaking and a fter adju stin g th e volum e to 20 ml. ad d 0.5 ml. of benzene. C ork securely an d incubate a t 45° for 2 days or 37.5° for 3 days. M ake th e volum e to 200 ml. w ith w ater. W ith m aterials of high potency it is n o t convenient to weigh out F ive milliliters of basal pantothenate-free medium plus a solu tion of th e unknow n o r an aliquot of th e p an to th en ate standard solution are placed in a series of te st tubes together w ith sufficient w ater to m ake th e volum e in each tu b e 9 ml. T h e tubes are plugged w ith cotton, steam ed for 10 m inutes, cooled, and inocu lated w ith 1 ml. each of th e yeast inoculum. T h e tubes are then shaken a t 30° C. and th e y east grow th is estim ated a t 16 and 18 hours by turbidim etric m easurem ents m ade directly on th e tubes w ith th e photoelectric colorim eter. E ach assay run includes a series of tubes which are used to construct th e reference curve. T his series is m ade w ith th e following levels: 0, 5 0 ,100,150, 200, 300, an d 400 millimicrograms p er tube. F or assay runs contain ing more th a n 25 tubes two reference series are included, one a t th e beginning and one a t the end of the run, and th e results of the tw o are averaged to construct th e reference curve. T he basal m edium for 20 assay tubes is prepared by mixing the stock solutions in th e following proportions: sugar and salts solution, 50 m l.; potassium citrate buffer, 10 m l.; inositol solu tion, 5 m l.; amm onium sulfate solution, 5 m l.; thiam ine solution, 5 m l.; pyridoxine solution, 5 m l.; biotin solution, 5 m l.; aspara gine solution, 12.5 m l.; an d w ater to 100 ml. I t is n o t essential to prepare this m edium fresh for each run. Larger batches m ay be prepared and stored a t a tem p erature a few degrees below 0° for as long as 3 m onths w ith no observed ill effects upon th e assay run. ANALYTICAL January 15, 1944 T h e protocol of a typical assay ru n in w hich representative m aterials were assayed is shown in T able I and th e reference curve is given in Figure 1. In practice th is curve is plo tted on ordinary graph paper and values for th e unknow n are obtained by interpolation. T he estim ated potency is an average of the value a t each assay level and a t bo th 16 an d 18 hours. T he aver age deviation from th e m ean is a b o u t 4 per cent. If m ore th an tw o of th e eight values obtained for each assay deviate from the m ean by more th a n 10 per cent, th e assay is usually repeated. R esults are reported as p a n to th en ate co n ten t an d are based on d-calcium p an to th en ate as th e prim ary stan d ard w ith o u t con version to th e equivalent w eight of free acid. T here seems to be good precedent for this in the use of thiam ine hydrochloride and pyridoxine hydrochloride equivalents w ith o u t conversion to th e equivalent w eight of free base. Table II. Determination of Pantothenate in Presence of Its H y d ro ly tic Products C om position of M ix tu re C om pletely h ydrolyzed calcium C alcium p a n to th e n a te p a n to th e n a te M g. M g. 0 1.0 0 .2 5 0 .5 0 0 .7 0 0 .8 0 0 .9 0 0 .9 5 1.00 0 .7 5 0 .5 0 0 .3 0 0 .20 0 .10 0 .0 5 0 .0 0 A ssay C alcium p a n to th e n a te (by assay) Mg. R eco v ery of a d d ca calcium p a n to th e n a te % 1.0 2 102 0 .7 0 . 0 .5 0 0 .2 9 0 .1 9 10 0 0 .10 100 110 0 .0 5 5 < 0 .0 1 93 97 95 RESULTS P a n t o t h e n a t e E s t i m a t i o n in t h e P r e s e n c e o f /3 -A la n in e . Since /3-alanine is a p o tential interfering substance in this assay it is desirable to determ ine the lim its of the interference. T here is no evidence th a t /3-alanine occurs as such in n atu re except as a degradation product of pan to th en ate. C onsequently, th e in fluence of /3-alanine on the assay w as studied by analyzing a se ries of m ixtures representing p an to th en ate in various stages of hydrolysis. A solution of com pletely hydrolyzed p an to th en ate was pre pared by heating 10 mg. of th e calcium salt dissolved in 10 ml. of 12V and 42V sodium hydroxide, respectively, a t 15 pounds pres sure for 2 hours and th en cooling and neutralizing. T h e panto th en ate rem aining was determ ined after adding a known am ount of pantothenate to the solution. T he assay showed 1.5 per cent of the p an to th en ate left in the 12V tre a te d solution and less th an 1 per cent in the 42V treated solution. In order to determ ine the am ount of /3-alanine produced b y th e hydrolysis the basal m edium was modified b y th e omission of asparagine, th e inclusion of Z-leucine, and th e su bstitution of pure biotin for the crude w hich contains /3-alanine. A reference series of grow th tests w ith increasing am ounts of /3-alanine then supplied d a ta for a reference curve, which was used to determ ine the /3-alanine content of th e hydrolyzates. T heoretically each 100 parts of calcium p an to th en ate should yield 37.3 of /3-alanine. T he 12V solution assayed 32.5 p arts or 87 per cent and the 42V solution 30.25 parts or 81 per cent. A pparently a portion of th e /3-alanine is destroyed in th e course of th e hydrolysis. Assuming th a t th e 42V solution represented “ com pletely” hy drolyzed pantothenate, the experim ent described in T able I I was made. T he hydrolyzate was mixed in various proportions w ith freshly dissolved p an to th en ate and th e m ixtures were assayed as unknowns. T he results show th a t little interference from 23alanine is to be expected u n til 95 p er cent or more of th e p an to th en ate has been destroyed. T he ease w ith which the present m ethod m ay be converted to a m ethod for /3-alanine determ ination suggests th a t it m ay be use ful in determ ining the nature of th e loss of p an to th en ate activ ity in th e processing of vitam in concentrates. I n f l u e n c e o f pH o n t h e S t a b i l i t y o f P a n t o t h e n a t e . Since pan to th en ate is readily hydrolyzed by either acid or alkali, it is desirable to establish th e p H range of m axim um stability, so th a t extracts for assay m ay be m ade w ith a m inim um of loss. EDITION 69 Solutions of p an to th en ate were heated a t 7 kg. (15 pounds) pressure for 15 m inutes and a t 9 kg. (20 pounds) for 1 hour. T h e heating a t 20 pounds was used to accentuate th e destruction; th e m ilder heating is used in th e assay. T he solutions contained in 1 liter: 1 mg. of calcium pantothenate, 10 ml. of potassium citrate buffer, and enough citric acid to a d ju st the p H to 5.0. Potassium hydroxide (30 per cent) was added to a d ju st th e pH to various levels an d aliquots of th e solution were rem oved a t each level. A fter heating and cooling, th e solutions were diluted to correspond to a concentration of 100 millimicrograms p er ml. and assayed by th e usual procedure. As can be seen from Figure 2, the m ost stable region is between p H 5.5 and 6.0. In practice th e p H is ad justed to betw een 5.6 and 5.7 in th e extraction procedures. A lthough a suspension of whole w heat had a p H of 6.4, extraction w ith o u t lowering th e pH showed no significant loss. R elatively large q u antities of organic m a tte r m ay have a protective action on p an to th en ate. I t is de sirable, however, to a d ju st th e p H to th e m ost stable range in routine analysis, unless investigation shows it to be unnecessary. Clarification of aqueous ex tracts of starch y substances by the short clarase m ethod proceeds best a t p H 5.6 to 5.7. E n z y m a tic D ig e s tio n . E arly p an to th en ate assays of certain substances by the microbiological m ethods did n o t agree w ith chick assays (9). T h e discrepancy is now believed to be due to th e existence of a bound form of p anto th en ate available to the chick b u t n o t to th e microorganism . D igestion w ith various en zyme preparations liberates th e bound pan to th en ate an d tends to bring th e assay results by th e tw o m ethods into som ewhat b etter agreem ent. W aism an and Elvehjem (22) found pancreatin satisfactory, Cheldelin el al. (3) prefer takadiastase, whereas Strong, Feeney, and E arle (9) recom mend clarase. T he au th o rs have com pared clarase w ith a few other preparations and find it satisfactory an d furtherm ore relatively low in color and in p an to th en ate content. T he p roduct is labeled “ D iastase, Vera, highly concentrated ‘C larase’ ” , and m ay be obtained from Eim er and Amend, New Y ork. T he p an to th en ate content of this preparation varies betw een 2 and 4 m icrogram s per gram . W hen clarase tre a tm e n t is used, th e results of th e assay m u st be cor rected for th e p an to th en ate content of th e enzyme. pH Figure 2. Influence of p H on Stability on Pantothenate A. 15 pounds for 15 minutes B. 20 pounds for 1 hour T h e enzyme is active in th e p H range of m axim um stab ility of p an to th en ate. M axim um liberation of bound p a n to th en ate was obtained by digestion for 3 days a t 37° C. or 2 days a t 45° C. H igher tem peratures did n o t ap p ear to offer an y advantage. I t is essential to m ain tain an excess of benzene or toluene in the digestion m ixture during incubation. INDUSTRIAL 70 Table III. AND Y e ast e x tra c t D ried y e a st U rine C alcium p a n to th e n a te Table IV . O riginal P a n to th e n a te C o n te n t t / (7509 509 104 3 .2 7 /m l. 1 mg. R esidual P a n to th e n a te 7/(7- 2 .5 5 .0 10.0 0 . 0 0 7 /m l. 1 0 . 0 7 /m g . D estru ctio n % 9 9 .5 9 9 .0 9 4 .0 98 .4 99 Recovery of Pantothenate T o tal Added F ound R ecovered 7/(7- 7/(7- 7/(7- 7/(7- R ecovery % 8 .3 8 .3 8.0 8.0 17.4 10.4 9 .1 8.1 110 101 Y east e x tra c t 550 550 500 500 1053 1 0 S0 503 530 101 10G D rie d y e a st 104 104 200 200 371 357 207 193 104 97 Av. 103.0 Pantothenate Content of V arious Substances D escription P a n to th e n a te D eterm ined W ater C larase e x tra c tio n (autoclave) digestion C ereais W hole w heat A W hole w heat B W hite flour (p a te n t) W hole w h eat b read (air-dry) W hite b read (air-dry) Y ellow corn C itru s fru its G ra p e fru it (fresh) O ranges (fresh) C larase A B C M eats P ork muscle (fresh) P ork liver (fresh) B eef m uscle (fresh) B eef liv e r (fresh) Liver c o n ce n trate No. 20 (dry) 7/(7- 7/(7. 8 .9 8 .3 4 .0 8 .9 3 .8 4 .2 8 .4 2 .7 1.9 3 .7 6 3.3 6 1.9 4 .0 3 .3 T he relative ease w ith which p antothenate activity is destroyed by hydrolysis suggests an added te st of the specificity of th e assay m ethod. Q u antitative destruction of the pantothen ate activ ity by alkaline hydrolysis would indicate th e absence of an alkali-stable, nonspecific grow th factor in the preparation under stu d y . Sim ilarly, acid hydroly sis would indicate th e absence of an acid-stable factor. Y east extract (100 mg.) and d ry y east (100 mg.) were subjected to clarase digestion and then 10iV sodium hydroxide was added to m ake the final concentration IN . Urine and calcium panto th en ate were prepared in sim ilar fashion b u t w ithout digestion. All were heated a t 20 pounds for 2 hours, cooled an d neutralized, and then assayed for pantoth en ate after superim posing a known q u an tity of p an to th en ate on th e test. T he results are shown in T able I I I . I t is ap p aren t th a t essentially all th e activ ity is destroyed by alkaline hydrolysis. Sim ilar results were obtained by acid hydrolysis. R e c o v e ry o f A dded P a n to th e n a te . T he recovery of p anto th en ate which has been added to th e unknow n is a necessary test of the specificity of an assay m ethod of th is sort. T able IV gives th e results obtained w ith w heat, y east extract, and dried yeast, when th e p an to th en ate w as added a t th e beginning of th e extrac tion. T he calculated recovery is based upon th e added p an to th en ate and the average recovery of 103.6 p er cent is considered satisfactory, since each estim ate is based upon two assays. A s s a y o p M i s c e l l a n e o u s S u b s t a n c e s . T able V gives the results of assays on a num ber of representative m aterials. These assays are in essential agreem ent w ith those appearing in the literature if allowance is m ade for th e fa c t th a t m any early micro biological assays were m ade w ith o u t enzymic digestion. W heat and w heat derivatives appear to give m axim um values w ith simple aqueous extraction, b u t yellow corn requires enzymic digestion. I t would th u s app ear difficult to generalize a b o u t the best ex tractio n m ethod for cereals. C itrus fruits contain some of th e bound p an to th en ate. M eats, anim al tissues and extracts, and y east products have a high pro portion of bound p an to th en ate and m u st alw ays be subjected to enzymic digestion. M ilk an d urine do n o t ap p ear to contain any significant proportion of bound p an to th en ate. Enzym e diges tion of fresh w-hole m ilk does n o t yield results as high as aqueous extraction. T here are indications th a t fresh m ilk m ay have an inhibitory substance w hich is destroyed by heat. M ost fresh vegetables contain bound pan to th en ate. F resh green peas con tain a substance w hich is m arkedly inhibitory to y east growth b u t which appears to be completely destroyed w hen th e autoclave m ethod of extraction is em ployed. Simple enzymic digestion is therefore inadequate and th e authors follow th e enzyme treatm en t w ith autoclaving, when assaying fresh vegetables and fruits. M ilk P asteurized A P a steu riz ed B D ried skim milk M ilk (w hey)c 3 .9 9 .3 8 .5 6 0 .0 8.2 5 9 .0 472 7 / ml. or y /y . H y d ro ly s is o p P a n to th e n a te . Vol. 16, No. 1 CHEMISTRY Table V . A lk a lin e H yd ro lysis of Pantothenate Sam ple W h ea t ENGINEERING 3 .2 3 .3 . 4 3 .0 3 .2 7 /m l. or y /y . 1.8.’ 2*4 6 4 0 .0 P a n to th e n a te L ite ra tu re V alue y /o 1 2 ( 4 ). 1 2 . 8 ( 10 ) 8 .3 (9), 1 1 .2 “ (S) 3 .5 (4), 5 .7 (10) 8 .S (4) 6 .9 (4) 9 .0 (9) 2 .9 (4) 3 .4 (4) 4 .7 , 5 .8 (4) 50 (11) 10 «?), 9 , 8 “ (5) 70 (4). 0 1 .5 (9) 7 /m l. or 7 / y. 4 .0 (9) ' 44, 47 (9) y /d a y 7 /d a y 7 /d a y U rine, norm al 24-hour excretion** 3000-5000 (9) 3410 3250 S u b je c t A 4400 S u b je c t A 4400 S u b je c t B V egetables (frefch) 4 .5 6 3 .7 (4) 2 .0 T o m ato es 2 .5 6 2 .1 C abbage 1.8 (4) 1.06 1.3 B eets 1 .1 U) 3 .1 6 2 .3 2 .5 (4) C arro ts 3 .9 6 G reen peas 3 .8 (4> 3 .8 2 .5 6 2 .1 3 .2 (4) P o ta to e s Y east 100 22*. 80* (9) B rew ers’ (dry) 104 "¿8 200-B (dry) 240 * ’({?),’ 260 * (5) 319 500 Y e a s t e x tra c t (dry) 48 A utoclaved (dry) “ C hick assay. b C larase digestion followed b y auto clav in g w ith w ater. c C asein co ag u lated w ith m in eral acid an d s u p e rn a ta n t fluid n e u tra lised an d a u to c lav e d for assay. 4 p H of u rin e a d ju sted and assayed w ith o u t fu rth e r tre a tm e n t. * N o enzym ic digestion. T h e specificity of th e present m ethod is supported by a num ber of observations: T h e values estim ated a t th e various testing levels and a t 16 an d 18 hours show no significant drift, recovery of added p an to th e n ate is v irtu ally q u an titativ e, th e poten tial in ter ference of /S-alanine has been elim inated, th e p an to th en ate ac tiv ity of extracts prepared for assay m ay be destroyed by alkaline or acid hydrolysis, and the results obtained are in su bstantial agreem ent w ith reported values obtained b y tests w hich employ o th er microorganism s, and also in a lim ited num ber of cases w ith th e results of th e chick assay m ethod. In order to o b tain a m easure of th e reproducibility of the m ethod, a carefully refrigerated sam ple of dried y east was as sayed te n tim es over a period of 3 m onths. T h e complete assay including clarase digestion was perform ed each tim e. T h e mean of th e ten assays was 166.3 m icrogram s of p a n to th en ate p er gram w ith an average deviation of 3.2 p er cent and a sta n d a rd devia tion of 3.8 per cent. SUMMARY A y east microbiological m ethod for th e determ ination of pan to th en a te is described. Specificity of response to p an to th en ate in th e presence of /3-alanine is obtained by th e inclusion of a rela tively large proportion of asparagine in th e m edium in addition to am m onium sulfate. T he y e ast is grown in te s t tu b es which are shaken a t 30° C. for 16 to 18 hours. Y east grow th is estim ated w ith th e aid of a photoelectric colorim eter. M ethods of ex trac tio n of th e vitam in have been studied an d recovery experim ents are described. E x tra c ts of substances to be assayed are prepared by aqueous extraction under pressure (16 pounds for 15 m inutes) ANALYTICAL January 15, 1944 a t pH 5.6 to 5.7, by enzym e digestion a t th e same pH , o r by en zym e digestion followed by aqueous extraction (15 pounds for 15 m inutes). (5) (6) (7) (8) LITERATURE CITED (9) (1) A tkin, L ., Schultz, A. S., and Frey, C. N ., Arch. Biochem., 1, 9 (1942). (2) A tkin, L., Schultz, A . S., "Williams, W . L ., and F rey, C . N ., I n d . E n g . C h e m ., 1 5 , 141 (1 9 4 3 ). (3) C heldelin, V . H ., Eppright, M . A ., Snell, E . E ., and Guirard, B . M „ U niv. Texas P ubl. 4 2 3 7 ,1 5 (1942). (4) C heldelin, V . H „ and W illiam s, R . J., Ib id .. 4237, 105 (1942). 71 EDITION (10) (11) (12) (13) Jukes, T . H ., J . B iol. Chem., 117, 11 (1937). Jukes, T . H „ and L epk ovsk y, S., Ib id ., 114, 117 (1936). K uhn, R ., and W endt, G ., B er., 71, 780 (1938). Pennington, D „ Snell, E . E ., and W illiam s, R . J., J . B iol. Chem., 135, 213 (1940). Strong, F . M ., F een ey, R . E ., and Earle, A nn., I n d . E n g . C h e m ., A n a l . E n ., 13, 566 (1941). T cply, L . J., Strong, F . M ., and E lvehjem , C. A ., J . N u trition , 24, 167 (1942). W aism an, H . A ., and E lveh jem , C . A ., “ V itam in C on ten t of M eat" , M inneapolis, M in n ., Burgess P ublishing C o., 1941. W illiam s, R . J., L ym an, C. M ., G oodyear, G . H ., T ruesdail, J. H ., and H olad ay, D ., J . A m . Chem. Soc., 55, 2912 (1933). W illiam s, R . J., and R ohrm an, E ., Ib id ., 58, 695 (1936). Polarographic Determination of Copper, Lead, and Cadmium in High-Purity Z in c A llo y s R. C. H A W K I N G S a n d H . G . T H O D E M cM aster University, Ham ilton, O ntario, Canada A study has been made on the application of the polaro graphic method of analysis in determining trace elements (down to 1 X 1 0 " ‘ per cent) found In zinc-base die casting alloys. Trace amounts of lead, cadmium, and tin cause intergranular corrosion which results in a serious weakening of the allo y. A polarographic procedure has been de veloped for the direct determination of copper, cadmium, and lead in these alloys. The samples are dissolved in hydrochloric and nitric acids, evaporated to near dryness, redissolved, treated with hydroxylam ine hydrochloride, and finally diluted to volume. The solution is then electrolyzed cathodically over a range of approxim ately 0.8 L L U R G IS T S have found in recent years th a t traces M EofT Alead, cadm ium , and tin in zinc-base die-casting alloys tend to cause intergranular corrosion which results in a serious w eakening of th e alloy. F o r th is reason, specifications for the m anufacture of these alloys are very rigid, often requiring th a t lead shall n o t exceed 0.003 per cent, cadm ium 0.003 p er cent, and tin 0.001 per cent. T he purpose of th is investigation was to de velop a system of analysis for zinc die-casting alloys of the M azak ty p e in w hich th e polarograph could be used w ith a d v an tage to determ ine trace am ounts down to 10 per cent w ith high precision and accuracy. T he determ ination of trace quan tities b y w et m ethods of analysis is exceedingly difficult. I t is usually necessary to use large sam ples (100 gram s or m ore), an d to m ake repeated tim econsum ing separations. T h e polarographic m ethod, on the o th er hand, is particularly suited to trace am ounts, th e very n ature of which greatly reduces th e necessity for m aking separa tions, an d w hich com pares very favorably w ith th e spectrochemical m ethod w ith respect to th e lim its of determ ination possible. A polarographic determ ination, where applicable, is considerably cheaper th a n a spectrochem ical determ ination, and can often be carried out m ore rapidly. H eyrovsky (/,) in a review of th e applications of polarograpby noted th a t it is possible to determ ine lead and cadm ium in zinc, a n d gave curves for a 0.5-gram sam ple in 5 ml. of hydrochloric acid, in w hich th e concentration of lead is 0.0050 per cent and cadm ium is 0.0037 per cent. T erui {11) determ ined lead and cadm ium to th e nearest 1 X 10“ * p er cent by dissolving 8 grams of zinc in 70 ml. of 5N hydrochloric acid w ith a few drops of ni tric acid and evaporating to 50 ml. Ensslin (3) reported a po larographic m ethod for lead an d cadm ium in pure zinc, in which th e zinc w as dissolved in n itric acid and th e resulting solution com bined w ith different base solutions. T h e lead an d cadm ium were determ ined separately; th e lead w ith an accuracy of 20 per volt to obtain waves for copper, lead, and cadmium. Using an 8-gram sample in 50 ml. of solution, these elements can be determined with a precision of * 1 X 10~* per cent of the sample weight. National Bureau of Standards zinc samples have been analyzed using the above procedure and the results found to agree very well with the certificate value. Samples of high-purity zinc and zinc alloys have been analyzed without difficulty. Nineteen elements have been considered from the standpoint of possible interference. The results indicate that trace amounts of copper, cadmium, and lead can be determined polarographically with high precision and accuracy. cent of th e to ta l am ount present, from 3 X 10 "3 to 5 X 10 "1 per cent on w h at would correspond to a 100-gram sample in 1 liter of solution. ICrossin (8) applied th e polarograph to th e analysis of copper- an d alum inum -bearing zinc alloys for lead, an d bism uth by m eans of precipitation w ith sodium sulfide. Seith an d Esche (9) determ ined lead, cadmium, bism uth, thallium , an d tin in zinc by th e polarographic m ethod. The lead, cadm ium , and bism uth were determ ined sim ultaneously by treatin g a 5-gram sample w ith hydrochloric acid and diluting to 25 ml. before elec trolysis a t 28° C. T h e thallium and tin were determ ined by difference from th e sum of cadmium and thallium and lead and tin, respectively. R esults are reported to th e nearest 1 X 10“ 3 per cent except for tin, w hich is lim ited to 1.5 X 10-3 per cent. H ohn (5) in a review of polarographic m ethods of analysis o u t lined a m ethod for copper, lead, an d cadm ium in zinc, b u t m ade no m ention of its accuracy or precision. In th e work reviewed above, only one p aper deals with th e de term ination of im purities in zinc alloys, an d th is involves an ob jectionable sulfide separation w ith its a tte n d a n t errors. T he present investigation was u n dertaken in an effort to develop a m ethod for th e direct determ ination of copper, lead, an d cadmium in high-purity zinc-base die-casting alloys of th e M azak ty p e w ith special em phasis on accuracy and precision in th e region of 10 p er cent of th e sam ple weight. APPARATUS A N D REAGENTS T he prelim inary studies were m ade w ith a Leeds & N o rth rup Electro-C hem ograph, and th e w ork w as concluded w ith a H ey rovsky polarograph M odel X I (E. H . Sargent a n d Co.). The same capillary w as used thro u g h o u t th e investigation. The capillary constant in 2.5.V zinc chloride w as found to be 1.37 m g.*/3 sec.- 1 / 3 when h = 36.5 cm., t = 3 .3 seconds, and tem pera tu re = 25 ± 0.5° C. W hen th e curves showed irregularities traceable to fluctuations in th e drop tim e, th e capillary was cleaned w ith concentrated nitric acid as directed b y K olthoff and Lingane (7). T he pressure on th e dropping electrode was m ain tained b y using th e Leeds & N o rth ru p electrode assem bly in con- 72 junction w ith a large flask to serve as a pres sure regulator. T his kept the pressure constant to w ithin ± 0 .5 mm. of m ercury over periods of not less th an 45 m inutes. An ordinary electrolysis cell w ith an internal anode was used throughout these experiments. T he step heights were m easured by th e slope intercept m ethod—i.e., straight lines were draw n along the principal slopes of the curve and th e v er tical distances between the points of intersec tion of the extensions of these lines were m eas ured w ith a m illim eter scale (/) (see Figure 1). All work was carried o u t a t 25 =*= 0.5° C. M ost commercial reagents contain traces of various elem ents, and it was found necessary to check the p u rity of the reagents used under th e conditions existing in th e procedure out lined below. I t was n o t possible to procure zinc m etal of such pu rity th a t no steps were obtained under the operating conditions. (The word “step ” is intended to describe th e increase in current caused by the discharge of an ion, 7.) Typical Polarogram and M ethod of M easuring W ave Heights A sample of zinc was m ade uniform by reducing the sam ple to shavings and mixing. A portion of this sample was analyzed polarographically, using the procedure outlined, w ith o u t addi tion of m etal ions. T his gave th e residual cu rren t for the en suing determ inations. C o n c e n t r a t e d H y d r o c h l o r i c A c i d (sp. gr. 1.19). One hundred m illiliters of concentrated hydrochloric acid were evap orated alm ost to dryness in a 125-ml. Pyrex beaker. An 8-gram sam ple of zinc was then added to this residual liquid and the whole carried through the procedure for analysis. A fter sub tracting the residual current duo to the zinc, it was found th a t for the 32 ml. of hydrochloric acid required, a correction of 5 X 10-5 per cent of cadm ium and 5 X 10-6 per cent for copper would have to be applied. No trace of lead was found. C o n c e n t r a t e d N i t r i c A c i d (sp. gr. 1.42). One hundred milliliters of concentrated nitric acid were treated in a m anner sim ilar to th a t used for the hydrochloric acid. No traces of copper or lead were found, b u t cadmium corresponding to 0.00015 per cent in an 8-gram zinc sam ple was detected. In a s m uch as th e am ounts of nitric acid used were seldom in excess of 10 m l., th is am ount of cadm ium was considered negligible for the present purpose. H y d r o x y l a m i n e H y d r o c h l o r i d e (2Ar). T en m illiliters of 2iV hydroxylam ine hydrochloride were evaporated alm ost to dryness and treated as was th e hydrochloric acid. No traces of copper, lead, or cadm ium w ere found. G e l a t i n S o l u t i o n (0.2 per cent aqueous). One gram of gelatin was ashed in a porcelain crucible and th e residue taken up in a few milliliters of concentrated hydrochloric acid. The contents of th e crucible were then added to a zinc sam ple as for hydrochloric acid. C opper corresponding to 3 X 10“ 4 per cent and cadmium to 1 X 10“ 4 per cent in an 8-gram zinc sample were found. Since only 2.5 ml. of th e 0.2 per cent solution are used in an analysis, these im purities were considered negligible. D is tille d W a te r. F ive hundred m illiliters of w ater were evaporated to dryness and tre ated as for hydrochloric acid. N o detectable am ounts of copper, lead, or cadm ium were found. To 8 gram s of turnings in a 125-ml. Pyrex beaker add slowly 25 ml. of concentrated hydrochloric acid. A fter th e first violent reaction has subsided, add cautiously a few milliliters of concen tra te d nitric acid, and warm to effect solution. W hen solution is complete, add sufficient nitric acid to m ake the volum e of added nitric acid 5 ml. E v ap o rate on a h o t sand b a th until salts begin to crystallize out, an d th e m ixture boils like thick sirup. If desired, th e evaporation m ay be hastened som ewhat by careful heating on a wire gauze. Allow the m ixture to cool for a short time, or un til solid. W ash down w ith distilled w ater until a b o u t 10 ml. of w ater have been added. Add 7 ml. of concentrated hydrochloric acid and h eat on a sand b a th until any hydrolyzed alum inum is redissolved. T his may require 10 to 15 m inutes. T ransfer to a 50-ml. volum etric flask w ith the m inim um of distilled w ater. Add 2.5 ml. of 0.2 per cent gelatin solution an d 0.1 ml. of 2 N hydroxylam ine hydrochloride. Shake and h eat un til th e solution becomes colorless. If neces sary, add a second portion of hydroxylam ine hydrochloride. (Occasionally a solution m ay rem ain colored in spite of a large excess of hydroxylam ine. If th e excess corresponds to 100 to 200 tim es th e am o u n t of iron present, th is color can usually be ig nored.) D ilute w ith freshly boiled distilled w ater, cool, and di lute of volume. Bubble w ith nitrogen in th e electrolysis cell for 15 to 20 m inutes to rem ove dissolved oxygen, and eleetrolyze from —0.04 volt to th e discharge potential of th e supporting electrolyte (approxim ately —0.8 volt) using a bridge poten tial of 1 volt. T h e sensitivity should be ad justed to give th e largest pos sible steps in the curves. Using the procedure described below, it was found th a t the over-all effect of im purities in the reagents am ounts to copper 0.00005 per cent, lead 0.00000 per cent, and cadm ium 0.00005 per cent. These am ounts m ay be neglected for m ost purposes. T he stan d ard solutions of copper, lead, and cadm ium , required for th e calibration of th e capillary were prepared by diluting stock solutions. S t a n d a r d S tock S o l u t i o n f o r C o p p e r . A 0 .2 3 / solution of cupric n itrate was prepared by dissolving 12.714 gram s of electrolytic copper in dilute nitric acid a n d diluting to 1 liter. T his solution was analyzed by slow deposition, and found to be 0.1982 =*= 0.00023/ (average of four determ inations). S t a n d a r d S t o c k S o l u t i o n f o r C a d m iu m . A 0 .2 3 / solution of cadm ium n itrate was prepared by dissolving 22.496 gram s of c.P. cadm ium in dilute nitric acid an d diluting 1 liter. T his solu tion was analyzed by electrical deposition and found to be 0.1996 ± 0.00043/ (average of three determ inations). S ta n d a r d S to c k S o lu tio n f o r L e a d . A 0.23/ solution of lead n itrate was prepared by dissolving 41.458 gram s of c .P : lead in dilute nitric acid and diluting to 1 liter. T his solution was analyzed by th e lead acid m ethod and found to be 0.1981 ± 0.00023/ (average of four determ inations). PROCEDURE T he ferric iron is readily reduced to the ferrous sta te by tre a t ing th e warm hydrochloric acid solution w ith hydroxylam ine (2). In th is state, th e iron will n o t interfere w ith th e determ ination of th e copper, lead, an d cadm ium . S trubl {10) also m ade use of this reagent in th e analysis of zinc blende which was high in iron. T he tim e required for a determ ination of copper, lead, and cadm ium in a zinc-base alloy using th e above procedure is about 3 hours. However, a large num ber of sam ples m ay be run a t the sam e tim e, as only 10 m inutes are required for a polarogram after th e sam ple is prepared. I f copper is present in th e alloy in excess of 0.1 p er cent, it is advisable to rem ove th e copper by electrodeposition from nitric acid solution as follows: T o 8 gram s of zinc in a tail-form 250-ml. beaker, add 50 ml. of w ater and th en add 23 ml. of nitric acid in sm all portions. W hen all th e acid has been added, boil to complete solution, dilute to 100 ml. (or sufficient volum e to cover th e electrodes), and electrolyze a t 4 am peres an d 3 to 4 volts for 1 hour, w ith a ro tatin g gauze anode and a gauze cathode. A t the end of this tim e, wash down the cover glass and beaker and continue for a n o th er 5 January 15, 1944 ANALYTICAL m inutes. Carefully rem ove th e electrodes, while washing w ith a heavy stream of w ater. U nder no circum stances should the circuit be broken before th e electrode is completely free of acid. Rinse th e e le c tro d e several tim es in 95 per cent alcohol, shake free of excess alcohol, and d ry by revolving rapidly over a B un sen flame after igniting the film of alcohol. Weigh as pure copper. Replace the anode, which m ay have lead oxide deposited, in th e electrolyte and h eat the whole to boiling. T hen wash the electrode and remove it and boil th e solution down to incipient crystallization. Add hydrochloric acid and carry o u t the proce dure as for zinc w hich is low in copper. Care m u st be taken to remove all excess nitric acid. T o do this, an extra evaporation w ith 10 ml. of hydrochloric acid is recommended before addition of the 7 ml. of hydrochloric acid and 10 m l. of w ater to redissolve th e hydrolyzed alum inum . T his modification increases th e to ta l tim e required for an analysis, b u t when a large n um ber of sam ples are to be run, this increase is considerably lessened. T h e results obtained for the copper by this m ethod are usually slightly high (0.03 per cent high for 3 per cent copper). N o traces of cadm ium or zinc were found in th e deposit when th e deposit h ad been redissolved and deposited, and th e electrolyte examined polarographically. Table I. E lem e n t Cu Pb Cd Calibration Constants for Copper, Le ad , and Cadmium Leeds & N o rth ru p 2 A verage % / micro % / m icro % / micro ampere ampere ampere 1 0 .0 1 8 1 5 0 .0 2905 0.018G9 0 .0 1864 0 .0 3009 0 .0 1873 0.0184 0 .0 2 9 6 0.0 1 8 7 S a rg e n t 2 A verage % /m ic ro % /m icro % / micro ampere ampere ampere 1 0 .0 2040 0.03334 0 .0 1 8 7 5 0 .0 2 0 7 8 0 .0 3413 0 .0 1 8 8 8 0 .0 2 0 6 0 .0 3 3 8 0.0 1 8 8 RESULTS A N D DISCUSSION T he capillary was calibrated by m aking additions of copper, lead, and cadm ium from th e diluted stock solutions. T h e cali b ratio n was carried out over a concentration range of 1 0 ~ W to 3 X 10 ~*M on both the Leeds & N o rth ru p and the Sargent polarographs. T he step heights were obtained by difference from the residual current of th e zinc used as a supporting electro lyte, and those produced by th e zinc plus added ions. In the lower concentration range (1 X 10"5 to 5 X 10-6ilf), th is residual cu rrent am ounted to from te n to tw en ty tim es th e increase in current due to the added ions, and, accordingly a large error was introduced. T his error was m ore significant when using th e Leeds & N o rth ru p instrum en t th a n when em ploying th e Sargent a p p aratu s. T h e fact th a t th e la tte r has over twice th e m axi m um sensitivity of the form er would account in p a rt for this dif ference in th e results. T h e calibration constants for tw o successive calibrations using tw o different zinc sam ples as a supporting electrolyte are given in T able I. T he factors were obtained in term s of per cent p er microam pere for each m etal for the sake of convenience in calculating th e values from the step heights. T he basis for th e calculation is an 8-gram sample in 50 ml. of solution. In order to determ ine the precision of th e m ethod, and to dis cover the g reatest source of erro r in th e polarographic proce dure, five' series of determ inations were carried out, using the S argent instrum ent (Table II). 1. Precision of repeated determ inations on th e sam e cell. 2. Precision of repeated determ inations on different aliquots of the same solution. 3. Precision of repeated determ inations on different sam ples of th e sam e alloy. 4 and 5. Precision of repeated m easurem ents of th e sam e curve by different individuals and by the sam e individual. These results indicate th a t th e mean deviation of m easurem ent in all cases is approxim ately one half of the to tal m ean deviation of th e procedure. T he deviation is n o t significant, however, in th a t it barely affects th e fourth place of decimals. T he over-all EDITION 73 Table II. Precision of Polarographie Procedure C opper S cries“ A verage D e v iatio n & % % 1 O.OOI81 0 .00006 2 O.OOI81 0.00003 3 0.0018s 0.00011 4 O.OOlOt 0.00003 5 0 .0 0 1 0 2 0.00003 L ead A verage Deviation*» % % 0.00579 0.00008 0 .0 0 5 8 t 0.00003 0.0056o 0 .00008 0.0017! 0.00004 O.OOI67 0.00005 C adm ium A verage D eviation^ % % 0 . 0005« 0 .00004 O.OOO62 0 .00005 O.OOO62 0 .00005 0.00002 0.0009s 0.0009a 0.00003 ° E a c h of series 1, 2, and 3, is resu lt of seven d e te rm in a tio n s. In series 3, each d e te rm in a tio n w as m ade in du p lic a te. Series 4 is re su lt of d u p lic a te m easurem ents by nine d ifferen t individuals. Series 5 is re s u lt of te n m easure m ents of sam e curve. &A verage dev iatio n from a rith m e tic a l m ean. precision would indicate th a t it is possible to determ ine copper, lead, and cadm ium to w ithin 1 X 10-< per cent for th e range of concentrations encountered in high-purity alloys of th e M azak type. A t th e tim e this investigation was carried out, it was im pos sible to procure a N ational B ureau of S tandards zinc die-casting alloy of th e ty p e desired (M azak 3). In lieu of this, an analysis was m ade on an alloy high in copper. Analyses are also pre sented for several stan d ard zinc spelters (Table II I). I t has been found, as a result of th e analysis of a large num ber of commercially analyzed zinc sam ples, th a t the polarographic results are usually high. N o explanation is available for this phenom enon. T he calibrations have been checked an d re checked repeatedly in th e a u th o rs’ labo rato ry by different m eth ods. T here is a possibility th a t because of th e sm all am ount of handling, the polarographic results represent a closer approxim a tion to th e tru e value th a n analyses which are the result of m any successive m anipulations. T he degree of precision of th e polaro graphic procedure is high, as illustrated, and th e deviations from o th er analyses do n o t show signs of a constant error. T his is evidenced by exam ination of th e above results for th e B ureau of S tan d ard s sam ples. Table III. A ccu ra cy of M ethod (S arg en t in stru m e n t) C o p p er L ead % N a tio n a l B u re au of S ta n d a rd s. E x p erim en tal Precision C ertificate v a lu e 2 .8 3 “ ± 0 .0 1 2 .8 2 N a tio n a l B u re au of S ta n d a rd s. E x p e rim en ta l P recision C ertificate v a lu e 0 .0007 ± 0 .0 0 0 1 0 .0 0 0 5 N a tio n a l B u re au of S ta n d a rd s. E x p e rim en ta l Precision C ertificate valu e 0 .0 0 0 4 ± 0 .0 0 0 1 0.0004 % C adm ium % Sam ple 94 0 .0318 ± 0 .0 0 0 2 0.031 0.0025- =*=0.0001 0.0 0 4 S am ple 109 0.0025 ± 0 .0 0 0 1 0.0020 0.001 9 *=0.0001 0.001 8 S am ple 108 0.0505 ± 0 .0 0 0 2 0 .0 4 7 0.096 0 *=0.0007 0.0 9 2 “ B y electrodeposition. INTERFERING ELEMENTS T here are some nineteen elem ents w hich m ay be found in zinc, eith er as im purities, or as alloying elem ents: Cu, P b, Cd, N i, Co, M n, Ag, As, H g, T l, Bi, Sb, Al, Fe, Ge, Ga, In , Mg, and Sn. (“ In terference” is intended to describe th e prelim inary or alm ost co incidental discharge of some undesired ion which either results in a m asking of th e step desired or m akes impossible th e record ing of the desired ion a t m axim um sensitivity.) E xperim ents w ith 0.05 p er cent each of nickel, cobalt, m anga nese, silver, arsenic, m ercury, and indium show th a t th ere is no detectable effect on the steps for copper, lead, and cadm ium within ±0.0001 p er cent. M agnesium was tried up to 0.5 p e r cent an d no interference was detected. T his is to be expected, since th e discharge p o ten tial of m agnesium is well above th a t of 74 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING zinc. Copper up to 0.1 per cent has been determ ined polarographically w ithout reducing th e sam ple size while retaining a high degree of precision for lead an d cadm ium . R esults of th e electrodeposition of copper in conjunction w ith th e polarographic determ ination of lead and cadm ium indicate th a t there is no loss of lead an d cadmium during this operation an d th a t less th an 0.01 per cent of th e copper rem ains after deposition. B ism uth was found to give a step which precedes th a t of copper and for this reason interferes w ith th e ensuing determ ination of copper, lead, and cadmium when present in excessive am ounts. I t is not close enough, however, to m ask th e copper step. T he factor for bism uth was found to be approxim ately 0.024 per cent per A. for an 8-gram zinc sam ple in 50 ml. A ntim ony a t 0.05 p er cent gives a poorly defined step w hich interferes w ith th e steps for copper, lead, and cadm ium ; however, a t 0.01 p e r cent and less, no interference w as found. T h u s antim ony concentrations of 0.01 per cent can be tolerated. T h e n atu re of th e interference would seem to indicate a sm all diffusion coefficient for Sb+++++ in this particular m edium . T hallium gives a well-defined wave which comes between lead and cadm ium in 2.5 zinc chloride. F or trace am ounts of copper, lead, an d cadmium, only 0.002 per cent of thallium can be present. T his corresponds to th e findings of Seith and Esche (9) w ith regard to th e lim it of detec tion of thallium in zinc. G erm anium was n o t tested for in te r ference, because of th e extrem e volatility of its chloride. Gallium was not tested because of th e difficulty in obtaining a salt of th is m etal. N o interference is to be expected from gallium because of its high discharge potential. Stannic tin when present in am ounts greater th a n 0.0015 per cen t will rive a m easurable increase in th e step height for lead. Occasionally, am ounts greater th a n th is m ay be tolerated due to volatilization of stannic chloride, b u t such am ounts of tin are n o t volatilized appreciably by this p articu lar procedure. Kalovsek (5) indicates th a t the electroreauction of stannic tin is n o t re versible except in hydrochloric acid solutions of high concentra tion (above 0.1 A7), where, however, th e reduction process a p pears inhibited. T his would explain w hy such a large am ount of stannic tin would cause no interference. These results confirm those of Seith and Esche for th e lim it of detection of tin in zinc. Aluminum up to 6 per cent has been found to be w ith o u t d etec t able effect on the height of th e steps for copper, lead, and cad mium. H igher concentrations of alum inum m ight have an effect only in so far as they affected th e concentration of the supporting electrolyte. Iron, a fter reduction w ith hydroxylam ine hydro chloride is w ithout significant effect in th e determ ination of copper, lead, and cadm ium a t 2.5 per cent. I t is necessary, of course, to ad ju st the am ount of hydroxylam ine hydrochloride used in accordance w ith the iron content for satisfactory results. CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 A stu d y of the polarographic determ ination of trace quantities of tin , alum inum , and m agnesium in high-purity zinc alloys is in progress. CONCLUSION T race am ounts of copper, lead, and cadm ium can be rapidly de term ined by th e polarographic m ethod in high-purity zinc and zinc die-casting alloys w ith a high degree of precision. Such a m ethod should prove of value in industrial laboratories where tim e is a t a prem ium . In an effort to m ake possible a complete polarographic analysis of high-purity zinc and zinc die-casting alloys, procedures are being developed for th e determ ination of other elem ents present. ACKNOWLEDGMENTS T h e authors wish to th a n k th e D ep artm en t of Physics, U ni v ersity of T oronto, for th e use of its Leeds & N o rth ru p E lectroChem ograph. T hanks are due also to D . H . Sim pson for his valuable assistance in th e prelim inary investigations, and to F. E. Beamish, U niversity of T oronto, who kindly provided a sam ple of indium chloride. LITERATURE CITED (1) Borcherdt, G . T., M eloche, V. W ., and A dkins, H., J . A m . Chem. Soc., 59, 2171 (1937). (2) Bray, W . C., Sim pson, M. E ., and M acK enzie, A. A., Ibid., 41, 1366 (1919). (3) E nsslin, F ., M elall u. E rz, 37, 1 71-2 (1940). (4) H eyrovskjb J., Chim ie an d In du strie, Special N o ., 1933, 20 4 -1 0 . (5) H ohn, H ., Ch.em.-Ztg., 62, 7 7 -8 1 (1938). (6) K alovsek , M., Collection Czechoslov. Chem. Com mun., 11, 5 9 3 613 (1937). (7) K olthoff, I. M., and Lingane, J. J., "Polarography” , p. 243, N ew Y ork, Interscienco P ublishers, 1941. (8) K rossin, E ., MetaU u. E rz., 38, 1 0-12 (1941). (9) S eith, W ., and E sche, W ., Z. M elallkunde, 33, 8 1 -3 (1941). (10) Strubl, R ., Collection Czechoslov. Chem. Commun., 10, 466 (1938). (11) Terui, Y ., B u ll. In st. P h ys. Chem. Res. ( Tokyo), 17, 6 4 4 -8 (1938). r e s e n t e d before th e D ivision of A n a ly tic al and M loro C h em istry a t th e 105th M eeting of th e A m e r i c a n C h e m i c a l S o c i e t y , D e tro it, M ich. P Determination of Pectin in Biological Materials M odification of Pentose-Furfural M ethod E D W IN F. B R Y A N T , G R A N T H . P A L M E R , A N D G L E N N H . J O S E P H California Fruit Grower» Exchange, Research Department, Corona, Calif. Pectin is converted to a pentose which produces the furfural with which this method is concerned. Data are presented to show the normal levels of furfural-yielding substances in various organs and fluids from rabbits. The analytical pro cedures described make it possible to recover 95 to 100 per cent of pectin which has been added to animal tissues and fluids. N T w artim e conditions, w hich have increased in ter P RestE SinEpectin sols for intravenous use in treatin g shock, have m ade it necessary to devise a sem im icrom ethod for th e d eter m ination of pectin in biological m aterials. Pectinum N . F. V II which is suitable for intravenous use is es sentially a pure polygalacturonic acid ester. W hen such a pectin is refluxed a t elevated tem p eratu res w ith 12.5 per cent hydro chloric acid the polygalacturonic anhydride u n its are decarboxylated, producing a mole of carbon dioxide for each carboxyl, and forming furfural from th e newly formed pentose. A ccurate qu an titativ e procedures based upon th e determ ination of th e carbon dioxide evolved an d upon the furfural produced have been developed during th e forty years w hich have elapsed since the general reactions were first described by Tollens (5). T he m ethods which have been developed for q u an titativ e esti m ations of furfural are sensitive to extrem ely sm all am ounts and adaptable to colorim etric procedures. T h e carbon dioxide m eth ods are useful only when relatively large am ounts of m aterial are available; hence for purposes of determ ining pectin in biological system s th e furfural scheme is preferred. F u rfu ral m ethods and th eir applications to pectin analyses were discussed by Browne and Zerban in 1941 (2). Y oungburg (7) in 1927 described a particu lar ad ap ta tio n of furfural estim a tion useful for biological m aterials. B ry an t, Palm er, an d Joseph (4) used a modification of Y oungburg’s m ethod in these labora tories early in 1941 for an exam ination of th e liver and other organs of th e rab b it. T h e Y oungburg scheme involved steam distillation from 85 per cent phosphoric acid an d colorim etric determ ination of furfural in the distillate b y th e furfural-aniline acetate reaction. D etails for the use of the Y oungburg m ethod, January 15, 1944 ANALYTIC L E DI TIO N 75 sta n d a rd (1.00 ml. equivalent to 0.01 mg. of furfural) should be made fresh the day of use. Freshly distilled aniline, free from furfural. T e st b y adding 0.25 ml. to 2.0 ml. of glacial acetic acid. If a pink color develops w ithin one m inute, furfural is present. G lacial acetic acid, 85 per cent orthophosphoric acid, 10 per cent by w eight solution of sodium tu n g sta te (NasW OiYHjO), 0.5Ar sulfuric acid, and isopropyl or eth y l alcohol, a t least 95 per cent. PREPARATION OF SAM PLES M e th o d . T he u tility of th is m ethod in determ ining th e fate of injected pectin depends upon having a n accu rate figure for th e furfural equivalent p er m illiliter o f the p ectin sol being used in th e anim al experim ents. Each lo t of Exchange P ectinum N . F . V II will have a definite value for the furfural equivalent, usually varying from 190 to 215 mg. of furfural p er gram of pectin. These furfural values, obtained by the m ethod described below, have been checked by using th e sta n d a rd gravim etric phloroglucin m ethod (6). T he values by the two m ethods agree alm ost perfectly. Animal work w ith pectin usually involves 1.0 to 2.0 per cent sols w hich have been sterilized by autoclaving and filtered to sparkling brilliance. S tandardization analyses on such sols should be run on sam ples prepared as follows: 5.0 ml. of 1.0 to 2.0 per c e n t pectin sol, diluted to 200.0 ml. w ith distilled w ater; 2.0 ml. of this d ilu ted sol should be used for each analysis. U rin e . N orm al urine from rab b its usually contains so little furfural-yielding m aterial th a t 4.0-ml. sam ples are required for a n analysis. W hen pectin has been injected into an anim al, i t is necessary to use only a 2.0-ml. sam ple of urine to g et good re sults, while pectin is being excreted. P ip et duplicate sam ples of urine into 25 X 150 ml. Pyrex te s t tubes an d add 10 volumes of a t least 95 per cent alcohol. A fter stan d in g for an hour or two centrifuge the tubes an d pour off the su p e rn ata n t liquor. Place th e tubes containing the residue in a drying oven a t 100° C. an d d ry for ab o u t 30 m inutes, or until no odor of alcohol can be detected. T hese tubes containing th e dried residue m ay th en be covered an d stored until ready for analysis. U rin e a n d A d d ed P e c tin , a s C o n t r o l o n M e th o d . P rep are a check solution by diluting 5.0 ml. of a 1.0 to 2.0 per cent pectin solution w ith urine u p to 200.0 ml. in a volum etric flask, and tre a t 2.0-ml. sam ples w ith alcohol as described above. B lo o d . P repare a Folin-W u blood filtrate b y th e following m ethod: W eigh 2.0 ml. of oxalated blood (10 mg. of potassium oxalate per 5 ml. of blood) accurately in a 30-ml. centrifuge tube. Add to this b y p ip et 13.0 ml. of distilled w ater, 2.0 ml. of 10 per cen t sodium tu n g state solution, and 3.0 ml. of 0.5IV sulfuric acid. M ix th e contents of th e tubes well, allow the samples to stand 15 m inutes, then centrifuge a t ab o u t 1000 r.p.m . for 30 m inutes. Rem ove th e clear centrifugate and save for analyses, using 2.0 ml. for each sample, as described below. A n i m a l T i s s u e s . A nalyses m ay be m ade upon th e organs im m ediately a fter th e y have been rem oved from the anim al and weighed, or th e m aterial m ay be frozen w ith d ry ice and stored for la te r use. In either case it is necessary to m acerate th e organ (or a portion of it in cases of large organs) in a m ortar. T ransfer as m uch as possible from th e m o rtar (n o t to exceed 10 gram s of the larger organs), into a tared beaker and th en ad d a b o u t 10 tim es as m uch distilled w ater as th e w eight of th e organ used. S tir th is weighed m ixture thoroughly an d transfer to a mixer such as the W aring B lendor where it is reduced to a homogeneous slurry. P ip et a volum e of this slurry equivalent to a b o u t 0.3 to 0.5 gram of th e original organ into a 30-ml. centrifuge tube, and weigh. A dd distilled w ater to bring th e volume to 15.0 ml., then add 2.0 ml. of 10 p er cent sodium tu n g state solution and 3.0 ml. of 0.51V sulfuric acid, mixing th e contents of th e tube by careful swirling after th e addition of each reagent. M ix th e con tents of th e tubes well and allow the sam ples to sta n d 15 m inutes. T hen centrifuge a t ab o u t 1000 r.p.m . for 30 m inutes. Remove the clear centrifugate an d save for analyses, using 2.0 ml. for each distillation. P e c tin S o ls f o r C h e c k o n particularly th e step involving trichloroacetic acid tre a tm e n t of sam ples, were given by Andersch an d Gibson (1). M odifications of the Y oungburg m ethod previously published failed to allow reasonable recovery of pectin w hich had been added to urine, and also failed to provide sam ples from blood an d tissue m aterials w hich could be distilled w ith o u t excessive foaming. T h e m ethod described here provides for an alcohol tre a tm en t of urine sam ples w hich perm its complete recovery of pectin added to urine. I t su b stitu tes sodium tu n g sta te for trichloroacetic acid an d centrifuging for filtration, in preparing o th er sam ples, and continues w ith th e regular Y oungburg distillation. F oam ing is elim inated and recoveries from control sam ples are excellent. T h e technique for the determ ination of furfural in th e distillate by a photoelectric colorim eter is described. T h e procedures given below are the result of several hundred analyses of ra b b it blood, urine, an d organs, and of m any m ixtures of pectin w ith these ani m al m aterials. APPARATUS T he distillation apparatus shown in Figure 1 is composed of a steam generator, A , m ade from a large eth er can w ith burner underneath regulated by screw clam p for control of steam flow into B , the distillation unit, a Pyrex 25 X 150 mm . te s t tube, w ith therm om eter covering th e range 0° to 200° C .: C, tin cylinder shield for m icrobum er; and D, a w ater-cooled condenser, 250mm . jacket, w ith inside tube preferably 6 to 7 mm . in diam eter and tu rn ed down a t end for delivery into E . a 50-ml. g raduated cylinder. An ordinary steam generator m ade from glass m ay be used instead of th e m etal one described. A num ber of the Pyrex 25 X 150 mm. te s t tubes should be available because urine sam ples are prepared in them and then m ay be stored until tim e is available for distillation. I t is con venient to have 2.0-, 3.0-, 4.0-, and 5.0-ml. volum etric pipets, as well as M ohr pipets, 1.0-ml. size graduated in 0.10 divisions. A centrifuge a t least as large as th e In tern atio n al N o. 1 and several 30-ml. centrifuge tubes are required. A photoelectric colorim eter is recom mended. T he F isher Electropnotom eter w ith a blue filter (N o. 425B) and th e K lett-Sum m erson photoelectric colorim eter w ith a green filter (No. 54) have been used successfully w ith this m ethod. REAGENTS METHOD Freshly - prepared furfural, vacuum -distilled a t a pressure of 20 to 30 mm. Standard furfural stock solution prepared from th e freshly dis tilled furfural; 1.000 gram is diluted to 500 ml. w ith distilled w ater. T his stock solution m ay be k ep t for several weeks in a refrigerator. S tandard dilute solution of furfural for calibration of photo electric colorim eter or as a com parison solution w ith th e D uboscq-type colorim eter. T his solution is m ade by diluting 5.0 ml. of th e stock to 1000 ml. w ith distilled w ater. T his dilute T he sample for analysis should be in a 25 X 150 mm . Pyrex te s t tube, prepared as discussed under “ P reparation of Sam ples” . Add to th e sam ple in the te s t tu b e 5.0 ml. of 85 per cen t phos phoric acid and connect w ith th e condenser and th e steam gen erator. L ight the m icroburner and raise th e tem perature rapidly to 170° to 175° C. T he tem perature should be m aintained a t this po in t and never allowed to go higher during the 20- to 30m inute distillation period. Collect 40 ml. of distillate in th e 50-ml. g raduated cylinder used as a receiver, and an additional 10 ml. of distillate in a te s t tu b e INDUSTRIAL 76 AND ENGINEERING previously m arked a t the 10-mi. level. T e st this last distillate for th e presence of furfural as follows: Mix 2.0 ml. of th e distil late, 0.25 ml. of aniline, and 2.0 ml. of glacial acetic acid in a test tube. If no color develops in one m inute, stop the distillation and discard th e final 10 ml. of distillate. If color does ap p ear in the te s t sam ple, distill an additional 10 ml. and te s t a portion for fur fural as above described. W hen analyzing blood or urine of un tre a te d anim als, 30 ml. of d istillate are usually sufficient to con ta in all th e furfural. Table I. Recovery of Pectin A d d e d to Rabbit Urine M ate rial A nalyzed 2.0 ml. of 1.75% p ectin sol B-9221 48.0 m l. of u rin e + 2.0 ml. of p ectin sol B-9221 48.0 m l. of u rin e 4- 2.0 ml. of distilled w a ter D ifference, d u e to a d d ed pectin R ecovery of ad d ed p ectin , % Tabic II. F u rfu ra l F o u n d Y oun g b u rg P rese n t m eth o d m eth od M g. Mg. 7 .0 8 11 .4 6 7 .3 3 4 .1 3 5 8 .3 7 .0 8 9 .2 2 2 .0 8 7 .1 4 100.9 Furfural Equivalent of 1 .0 0 Gram of Pectinum N . F. V II (S am ple 444-H -3. CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 I t is desirable to know th e actual pectin concentration of th e pec tin sol used or else th e furfural equivalent per gram of th e pectin used to m ake th e sol. T he typical examples of these d a ta shown in T ables I I and I I I illustrate th e ranges for these values as well as show th e precision and accuracy of the m ethod. T h e d a ta in T able I I I show th a t 100 ml. of solution B-9221 would be equivalent to 355 mg. of furfural; hence th e solution m ust be 355/201 or 1.76 p er cent pectin. P ectin sol B-9221, when analyzed by a modified Lefevre-Tollens m ethod (described by B ry an t and Joseph, 3), showed 0.2315 gram of galacturonic acid p er 15.0-ml. sample. Pectin 444-H-3 had previously been found by th e sam e m ethod to contain 87.6 per cent of galacturonic acid; hence th e 15.0-ml. sample of B-9221 contained 100 (0.2315)/15.0 X 0.876 o r 1.76 p er cent of pectin. T he exten t to which furfural-producing substances occur in ra b b it organs is indicated in T able IV, along w ith an alytical values showing how th e present m ethod elim inates interference from th e various anim al m aterials an d perm its practically com plete recovery of any added pectin. A nalyses m ade on w a ter solu tio n c o n tain in g 750 m g. of p e ctin p e r liter) O p erato r F u rfu ra l F o u n d M g J g ra m 444-H -3 201 E .F .B . G .H .P . G .H .P . G .H .P . A verage v a lu e used 198 205 200 201 Combine and mix 20.0 ml. of th e original 40-ml. distillate and 5.0 ml. of each 10-ml. distillate showing a positive te st for fur fural, Place 5.0 ml. of this m ixture (or 5.0 ml. of the original 40-ml. distillate when the furfural test in th e next 10 ml. was negative) in a tube and mix w ith 0.5 ml. of aniline an d 4.5 ml. of glacial acetic acid, carefully m easured w ith a pipet. Set this m ixture aside in the d ark a t 20° to 25° C. for exactly 15 m inutes, a t which tim e the color in ten sity is determ ined w ith a photoelectric colorimeter. T h is 15-minute period has been deter mined experim entally as giving th e m ost exact value. T he col orim eter should be calibrated by using th e stan d ard dilute fur fural solution described above, spacing sam ples over the range from 0.001 to 0.050 mg. of furfural per 10 ml. of solution contain ing 0.5 ml. of aniline, 4.5 ml. of glacial acetic acid, and th e diluted stan d ard furfural solution. W hen using the D uboscq type of in stru m en t a stan d ard for colorim etric comparison m u st be prepared for eacli sample. T his is done by mixing 2.0 ml. of th e dilute stan d ard furfural solution m ade tiia t day, w ith 3.0 ml. of distilled w ater, 0.5 ml. of aniline, a n d 4.5 ml. of glacial acetic acid. T h e tube containing this mix tu re and also th e one w ith the unknow n are se t aside in th e dark for exactly 15 m inutes, for color developm ent. T he unknown a n d the stan d ard should have a b o u t th e sam e color intensity. If they do not, the solutions should be rem ade, reducing the volum e of either the unknow n or stan d ard , adjusting th e to tal volum es w ith distilled w ater to keep them th e sam e as outlined above. DISCUSSION A n illustration of the accuracy of th e present m ethod com p ared w ith th a t of the original Y oungburg scheme, in the case of ra b b it urine, is given by T able I. I t was found th a t urea added to pectin sols decreased th e re covery of pectin by th e Y oungburg procedure. M any analyses, a s illustrated by T able I, show th a t even though th e alcohol pre c ip itatio n scheme does rem ove some of th e natu rally occurring aldehyde-producing substances of urine, it also removes th e urea a n d thereby allows complete recovery of th e added pectin. The increase in furfural due to added pectin in urine (hum an as well as rab b it), using th e alcohol precipitation m ethod, has alw ays been found equivalent to th e furfural obtained from th e pectin w hen analyzed alone. W hen th is m ethod is used to follow pectin excretion from ani m als to which pectin sol transfusions have been given, i t is neces sa ry to know th e furfural equivalent for th e pectin sol used and th e norm al furfural values for th e organs or fluids being examined. Table 111. Furfural Equivalent of 1 .0 0 M l. of A u to clav e d 1.75 Per Cent Isotonic Pectin Sol (Sol B-9221 m ade from P e c tin 444-H -3. A nalyses m ade on d ilu tio n of 5.0 m l. of B-9221 to 200 m l. to ta l) O p erato r D a te G .H .J. G .H .P . E .F .B . G .H .J. E .F .B . G .H .J. E .F .B . A verage value Table IV . F u rfu ra l M g ./m l. B-9221 Sept. 11, 1942 Sept. 14, 1942 O ct. 5, 1942 O ct. 7, 1942 M ay 27, 1943 Ju ly 21, 1943 J u ly 21, 1943 3 .5 9 3 .4 6 3 .5 4 3 .5 7 3 .5 8 3 .5 4 3 .5 6 3 .5 5 Furfural O b tained from Rabbit Tissues and Recovery of Pectin A d d e d to These Tissues (1.00 ml. of p e ctin sol B-9221 a dded is eq u iv a len t to 3.55 m g. of fu rfu ra l, T a b le II I) M a te ria l Blood B ile B one H e a rt K idney L iv e r“ Spleen Sam ple W eight Grams 1.903 1.539 0 .3 2 0 0 .3 2 0 0 .5 0 0 0 .5 0 0 0 .3 3 0 0 .3 3 0 0.5 3 5 0 .5 3 5 0.4 9 2 0 .4 9 6 0.3 2 0 0 .3 2 0 F u rfu ra l O btained T issue plus 1.0 m l. of p e ctin sol B-9221 M g. O riginal tissue sam ple M g. F u rfu ra l D u e to A dded P e c tin M g. R ecovery of A dded P e c tin % 101.7 0 .2 3 3 .8 0 3 .6 1 3 .7 1 3 .4 2 9 6 .3 3 .6 2 3 .5 2 9 9 .2 3 .6 2 3 .4 8 9 8 .0 3 .7 4 3 .5 2 9 9 .2 5 .6 0 3 .6 5 102.8 3 .6 2 3 .4 8 9 8 .0 0 .2 9 0 .1 0 0 .1 4 0 .2 2 1 .9 5 0 .1 4 ° B e tte r resu lts a re ob tain ed w hen sam ple w eight of liv e r is a b o u t 0.2 to 0.3 gram . LITERATURE CITED (1) Andersch, M arie, and G ibson, R . B ., J . P harm acol., 52, 390-407 (1934). (2) B row ne, C. A ., and Zerban, F . W ., “P hysical and C hem ical M eth ods of Sugar A n alysis” , 3rd od., pp. 914-18, N ew Y ork, John W iley & Sons, 1941. (3) B ryant, E . F ., and Joseph, G . H ., paper presented before the D ivision of Agricultural and F ood C hem istry at th e D alla s M eetin g of the A m erican C hemical S ociety , 1938. (4) B ryant, E . F ., Palm er, G. H ., and Joseph, G. H ., P roc. Soc. E x p tl. B iol. M ed., 49, 2 7 9 -8 2 (1942). (5) L efevre, K . U., and T ollens, B ., B cr., 40, 4 5 1 3 -2 3 (1907). (6) Norris, F . W ., and R esell, C . E ., Biochem. J ., 29, 1590-6 (1935); also A ngell, S tan ley, Norris, F . W ., and R esoh, C ., Ib id . 30, 2 1 4 6 -5 4 (1936). (7) Y oungburg, G . E „ J . B iol. Chem., 73, 5 99-606 (1927). P h e s e n te d of th e before th e D ivision of B iological C h em istry a t th e 105th M eeting D e tro it, M ich. A m e k ic a n C h e m ic a l S o c ie ty , January 15, 1944 ANALYTICAL 15 EDITION M ETALLURGICAL PRODUCTS A N A LYZED SPEEDILY A N D ACCURATELY Slomin High Sp e e d Electrolytic A n a lyze rs T h e rap id a cc ep ta n ce o f this in str u m e n t fo r m e ta llu r g ic a l an alysis is o u tsta n d in g en d orsem en t o f its p ro v en a b ility and con sisten t re lia b ility . O v er 80 0 Slom in A n a ly zer s are n o w in u se in m e ta llu r g ic a l lab oratories. E lectrod e d esign , c u r r e n t efficien cy and im p ro v ed p roced u res re d u ce d ep osition tim e fo r m e r ly req u ired b y oth er system s as m u ch as 25 to 4 0 % . U n d er th ese h ig h speed co n d ition s h a rd , sm o o th , b r ig h t and clo sely g rain ed deposits th a t firm ly adhere to th e electrod es are p ro d u ced , th u s a ssu rin g good r e p r o d u c ib ility o f re su lts. U sers rep ort an a c c u r a c y o f 0.01 to 0.04% fo r r o u tin e d eterm in a tio n s. E ach m od el is p o rta b le and en closed in a -welded steel case finished in acid resista n t baked w h ite en am el. T h e b rushless m otor is v a p o r tig h t and is th e re fo r e u n a ffe cted by co rro siv e fu m es, B o th m odels h a v e an e le c tr ic a lly h e a te d , rh eos ta t co n tro lled b eak er p la tfo r m fo r a d ju stin g so lu tio n tem p era tu res, an d v o ltm e te r s an d a m m eters so th a t d eta iled stu d ies ca n be m ade, E ach p o sitio n o f th e t w o p la ce a n a ly ze r is a co m p lete c ir c u it th a t op erates in d e p e n d en tly o f th e o th er. C o n seq u en tly th is u n it ca n be u sed fo r th e sim u lta n eo u s d eterm in a tio n o f tw o sam p le s h a v in g w id e ly d iv e r g e n t ch a ra c teristics, N o a ccesso ry g en era to rs o r rh eo sta ts are req u ired — a ll m odels are se lf-c o n ta in e d , p o rta b le and op erate fro m sta n d a rd e lec tr ic c ir c u its. A la b o ra to ry m a n u a l o f h ig h speed e lec t r o ly tic m ethod s o f an alysis w r itte n b y G . W . Slom in is su pp lied w it h each a n a ly zer. In d iv id u a l copies are a v a ila b le at .5 0 each. • S -2 9 4 6 0 S lom in E le c tr o ly t ic A n a ly zer. O n e p o s itio n , 5 A m p e r e M o d el, w ith H e a tin g P la t e . For op eration from 115 v o lt, 60 cy cle circu its. Each $ 1 7 0 .0 0 • S -2 9 4 6 2 D itlo . B u t for op eration from 23 0 v o lts, 60 cy cle circu its.E a ch $ 1 7 5 .0 0 • S -2 9 4 6 5 S lom in E le c tr o ly t ic A n a ly zer, T w o p o s itio n s , 5 A m p e r e M o d el, w ith H e a tin g P la t e . For op eration from 115 v o lt, 60 c y c le circu its. Each $ 3 1 0 .0 0 • S -2 9 4 6 7 D itto . B u t fo r op eration from 23 0 v o lts, 60 cy c le circu its. Each $ 3 2 0 .0 0 High Speed Electrodes for Use with Slomin Electrolytic Analyzers • S -2 9 6 3 2 C o r r u g a t e d P latin u m A n o d e (P a t. p e n d in g ). P rice su b ject to m a rk et. • S-29& 72 C o r r u g a t e d P latin u m C a t h o d e (P a t. p e n d in g ). P rice su b ject to m ark et. Lite ra tu re on Request E. H. SARGENT & CO., 155-165 E. Superior St., Chicago 11, III. M ichigan D ivision: 1959 East Jefferson, Detroit 7, Michigan 16 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 5 7 In d ic a t o r s fo r D e t e r m in in g H y d r o g e n - I onC o n c e n t r a t i o n E astm an O rganic Chem icals include 57 indicators covering the entire pH range. Careful laboratory tests assure the dependability and uniformity of these compounds. In addition, each indicator of the sulfonphthalein type is tested spectrophotometrically to make certain that it exhibits maximum color change and sensitivity. A table giving the solvents employed and the concentrations in which these Eastman indicators are generally used, as well as a chart showing their pH ranges and color changes, will be supplied free upon request. . .. Eastman Kodak Company, C h e m ic a l S a le s D iv is io n , Rochester, N. Y . ER The r e ar e mor e fhan 3 4 0 0 ' CO DAK. M odem E F F IC IE N C Y COUPLED W ITH 50 Y E A R S O F Q U A L I T Y E DIAL OF A ß h ja b sw jd siA . MOISTURE TESTER The[M OISTUR£ TESTER does away with the old, laborious method of determinins mois ture content. O n e instrument takes the place of the oven, the balance and the desicca tor. Moisture content can be determined w hile samples are in the oven. W h e re v e r m o istu re c o n te n t Is a a c to r— in th e la b o r a to r y o r In th e p la n t — th e r e th e M O IS T U R E TESTER w ill m ake Its p la c e . • TEN TESTS A T ONCE • SENSITIVE TO .002s • READINGS TO ,05% W R IT S FOR F U L L IN FO RM ATIO N SCHAAR & COMPANY Complete Laboratory Equipment 754 WEST LEXINGTON ST., CHICAGO INDUSTRIAL LA B O R A TO R Y TABLE 6610 For hall a century Peterson engineers Lave constantly studied the requirem ents of laboratory workers an d the various techniques w hich em anate from the classroom on into commercial practice. Every bit of Peterson laboratory furniture is designed with full cognizance of m odem improvements necessary to the current technique . . . plus the fact that it is backed by the reputation for quality w hich stems back through half a century. W RITE FOR PE T E R SO N 'S CATALOG, G RATIS OF COURSE LEONARD PETERSON & CO., Inc. 1222-34 F U L L E R T O N AVE. C H IC A G O , U. S . A. ANALYTICAL January 15, 1944 17 EDITION m a The mos t i mp o r t a n t bot tl e of c h e m i c a l s in the world. . Jo You It s the next bottle of reagent chemicals you take from your laboratory shelf, for upon the quality, purity and uniformity of the product it contains may depend the outcome of your careful analyses . .. perhaps the success or fail ure of vital research that “can’t wait!’ B &A recognizes your need for dependable chemicals. That’s why all B&A Reagents are produced only under the strictest manufacturing standards. Into every B&A product—whether it is a reagent you use every day or one you need infrequently—goes the same careful attention to minute details and constant laboratory con trol that assure you chemicals of unusually high uniformity and purity. When you reach for a bottle of B&A Reagent Chemicals you reach for the best. Be sure to specify Baker and Adamson Reagents! S E T T I N G THE PACE IN T* B a k e r C H E M I C A L PURITY SINCE 1882 7Ï A d a m s o n D iv is io n o f G E N E R A L C H E M IC A L C O M P A N Y ,4 0 R e cto r S t . , N e w Y o r k 6 , N . Y . C .'R A c û / s T echn ical S e n k te O ffices: A t l a n t a • B a ltim o re • B o s to n • B rid g e p o rt ( C o n n .) * B u ffa lo • C h a r lo tte ( N . C .) C h ic a g o • C le v e la n d • D enver • D e tr o it * H o u s to n • K a n s a s C ity • M ilw a u k e e • M in n e a p o lis N ew Y o rk • P h ila d e lp h ia • P i tts b u r g h • P ro v id e n c e ( R . I . ) • S t. L o u is • U tic a ( N . Y .) P a cific C oast T ech n ical S e rv ic e O ffic e s : S a n F ra n c is c o • L o s Angeles P a cific N o rth w est T ech n ical S ervice O ffic e s : W e n a tc h e e ( W a s h .) • Y a k im a ( W a s h .) In C a n a d a : T h e N ic h o ls C h e m ic a l C o m p a n y , L im ite d • M o n tr e a l • T o r o n to • V a n c o u v e r 18 INDUSTRIAL AND Liters Micron Liters Micron CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. For its capacity—The Speediest Pump at a n y Pressure PUMPING SPEED 14.9 1 24.2 1 ENGINEERING Per Minute at at 304 R.P.M. Per Minute at at 528 R.P.M. W elch DUO-SEAL VACUUM PU M P Greater free-air capacity and higher ultimate vacuum assure fastest pumping at all pressures. In addition to superior performance it is QUIET RUNNING No drumming in the ears even where banks of them are pumping. G UARANTEED V A C U UM .35 M icro n — .00005 m m H g . FREE A IR C A PA C ITY 3 3 .4 L iters P e r M in u te O PTIM U M O PERATING SPEE D 3 00 R ev olutions P e r M in. • OIL REQUIRED 6 5 0 m l D uo*Seal O il • ELECTRONICS No. 140S-H • FREEZING • DRYING D U O -SEA L V A C U U M PUM P, M otor D riven. V acu u m .05 m ic ro n — f re e a ir c a p a c ity of 33.4 lite rs p e r m in u te ................................................... $140.00 W ith la r g e r m otor g iv in g 57 lite rs fre e a ir c a p a c ity p e r m in u te a n d v a c u u m of 0.1 m i c r o n .. . .$ 1 5 5 .0 0 T H IS BOOKLET E X PL A IN S ALL. “ O rd er to d a y for p ro m p t d e liv e ry . W. M. Welch ESstacb lish i eedn1880 tific C o m pan y 1518 Sedgwick Street Chicago, Illinois, U.S.A. W rite for it to d a y . C on ta in s fu ll d e ta ils a n d d ia g r a m s o n W e lc h P u m p s . LaMOTTE OUTFIT FOR DETERMINATION OF VITAMIN A CHEM ICAL AND SCIENTIFIC PO RCELA IN W ARE djaiic equipment OF A L L M O D E R N TESTING LABORATORIES E V A P O R A T IK C D IS U A Goleiade Product fijj ^ W e x ld m id e A a n te The im portance oi grading fish oils and similar m aterials according to the vitamin A content has dem anded a simple means of determ ining vitamin A. This LaMotte outfit employing the method of Dr. B. E. O ser provides a reliable chem ical procedure to m eet this need. The unit comes complete with color standard special com parator, reagents and full instructions. Price $35.00 f.o.b. Towson-4, Baltimore, Md. L a M D T T E C H E M I C A L P M D J C T S CO. D ept. F. Tow son-4 B A L T IM O R E , M D . » T a C oors P o r c e l a in C o m p a n y B e W 8 ^ . GOLDEN, COLORA DO . ^*masaJM January 15, 1944 ANALYTICAL EDITION 19 It’s UfOt a Fancy Furnace — But It’s Built to Do the Job T H IS H o s k in s Furnace, T y p e FD, is an o ld stan d -b y to m o st la b o ra to ries. F or a lm o st 3 0 years, it has b een b u ild in g that rep u tation by its g o o d p erform an ce. C h em ists lik e its relatively c o o l surface tem perature. T h e y lik e the g o o d -siz e d w o r k sh elf and th e ea sily o p erated s lid in g d o o r. A ls o , repairs are s o easy to m ake b eca u se every th in g is s o easy to g et at. F in ally, th e C h ro m el u n its are s o d u ra b le that w h e n th ey at la st w ea r o u t, it o n ly re m in d s you o f h o w very lo n g they h ave lasted . O p erates on 45/s'' of Insulation means efficient operation, and a cooler laboratory lin e v o lta g e. F ull sto ry in C atalog5 8 , fro m you r d ea le r o r ou rselves. H o s k in s M an u factu rin g C om pany, D e tr o it 8 , M ich ig a n . Sturdy Long-Lasting Chromel Elements— EASY TO APPLY H O S K IN S PR O D U CTS E L E C T R IC H EA T T R E A T IN G FU R N A C E S • • H E A T IN G ELEM ENT A L L O Y S • • TH ER M O C O U P LE A N D LEAD WIRE • • PYROMETERS • • WELDING WIRE • • HEAT RESISTANT CASTINGS • • ENAMELING FIXTURES SPARK PLUG ELECTRODE WIRE • • -SPECIAL A LLO YS OF N ICKEL • • PROTECTION TUBES INDUSTRIAL 20 AND ENGINEERING Vol. 16, No. 1 CHEMISTRY NO W . . . FASTER D ELIVERIES O N K l e B u rre ll T em p . TYPE K F U R N A C E t t . . . . P h o to m e te rs K U tt-£ u * tu n e sU & ri P h o to e le c tr ic Q laM . C e ll Golo>U*net*si For the varied needs of industrial, clinical and agricultural laboratories. Complete and self contained — no accessory equip m en t necessary. Fused cells for readings on solu tion depths of 2.S, 10, 20, and 40 m m . Selective ligh t filters available. fio * up ta m p a ta tW c a i to 2550°F This furnace accommodates laboratory crucibles and dishes of various sizes and may be used for heating articles which can be laid directly on the hearth plate. • 1 U K b it fy lu o sU m e i& i • Heating chamber measures 4" wide x 4" high x 9” deep. Throat is 41/ 2" deep. • Floor is a removable, refractory plate with moulded sides to prevent spillage from reaching isulation. • Heating elements give long life and can be replaced in a few minutes without cooling furnace. • Overall outside dimensions without table are 26" wide x 30” high x 24" deep. No. Î0 T 1 . Designed for the rapid and accurate d e t e r m i n a t i o n of thiam in , riboflavin, and other substances which fluoresce in solu tion. The sensitivity and sta b ility are su ch th a t it has been found particu larly u seful in d eterm ining very sm all am oun ts of these substances. To further increase its adaptability a separate circuit and scale is provided for colorim etric determ inations. For complete information on all standard models of box, muffle, combustion-tube and pit types, write for Burrell Catalog F-241. LITERATURE SE N T U PO N REQUEST B u r r ell TECHNICAL SU PPLY C O M P A N Y K 1 9 3 6 - 4 2 Fifth A v e n u e 179 E A S T 8 7 T H S T R E E T Pittsburgh (1 9), Pa. le tt M anufacturing Co. NEW YORK, N.T. ANALYTICAL January 15, 1944 EDITION M A K ER Platinum Laboratory Ware T e s t e d b y U se \ Tests of any piece of apparatus under conditions that simulate those under which it jT \ will have to operate are valuable, hut notli\ ing can equal workaday use really to show gA the quality of a piece of equipment. Baker Laboratory W are is under the conV tinual trial of test by use, because we em ploy it freely all the time in our own \ laboratories. In this way we discovered S' how the steins of stationary type electrodes I \tended to break at their juncture with the i cylinder and corrected the fault by reinfbrcing the joint there. Among our other improvements are design >. v 'y changes like our reinforced rim crucibles / CSl ar>d 'dishes, the Baker Low Form Crucible / and Our platinum -rhodium alloy, now so, widely, used for laboratory ware. SPECIAL APPABATUS — When you are ■«B>y in need of special apparatus, o u r plant is the logical place to have it produced. We are the largest refiners and worker^ of s Mjjpfr platinum , gold and silver in the world.; Our experience covers a period of m ore than seventy-five years and our research staff is always ready to work with you. BAK ER & CO S M E L T E R S , R E F I N E R S A N D W O R K E R S O F P L A T IN U M . G O L D A ND S I L V E R 113 A s t o r S t ., N e w a r k . 5 , N . «V. SA IV I 'l I A N C I S t 'O 21 22 INDUSTRIAL AND E N G I N E E R I N G ¡ " . C H E MI S T R Y Vol. 16, No. 1 : liaae auailahle i&me ICAL MICROSCOPES N ew a n d R e c o n d itio n e d H eating stages P olarizers and analyzers A lso FLUORESCENT U T I L I T Y LI GHT This fluorescent Utility Light is an efficient, flexible, attrac tively designed lighting unit for laboratory or office use. BIOLOGICAL and M etallurgical M icroscopes Photom icrographic Cameras types o f m icroscope lenses, new and used The reflector housing is of Bakelite molded in one piece—-overall length 18 inches. The ballast is built into and concealed inside the housing. A manually-operated switch with separate stopand-start buttons assures dependable operation and fluorescent lamp efficiency. Light output is boosted by an aluminized metal reflector inside the housing. A universal ball-joint on the mounting hub per mits adjustment of the lamp to any angle. The unit is completely adjustable and, when separated from the support base, may be used atop a balance. 10303—F luorescent U tility L ight. As illus trated, with 8" diameter stand and 15" support rod and clamp. For 110 volts, 60 cycle, W e are experienced and successful in the design and manufacture of high temperature furnaces particu larly for research laboratories requiring a range from 2 0 0 0 ° to 3 0 0 0 ° F. In this field we have served some of A m e ric a ’s leading Chem ical and Industrial plants. If your furnace requirements are unusual, our d e signs as w ell as our quotations w ill interest you. A d d re ss Harper. H L -7 6 1 0 -F High Temperature Electric Laboratory Furnace $15.75 Write fo r d e sc rip tiv e b u lletin W ILL CORPORATION R O C H E S T E R , N. Y. Office and Warehouses W ill C o r p o r a t io n , 596 B r o a d w a y , N ew Y o r k C i t y B u f f a lo A p p a r a t u s C o r p ., B u f f a lo , N . Y . HARPER ELECTRI C FURNACE ANALYTICAL January 15, 1944 EDITION 23 ''Spectrophotelom eter" A typ ical assembly of the "Spectrophotelom eter“ and accessories for work in the visible wave lengths. fyecduneA. oJ, £tcceile*ice. • E A S E O F O P E R A T IO N • ACCURACY AND R E P R O D U C I B IL IT Y O F M E A S U R E M E N T S • F A C IL IT Y B R A T IO N • 9 9 9 FO R C H E C K IN G T h e Cenco-Sheard “Spectrophotelom eter” is unsurpassable for accurate and economical spectral transm ission m easurem ents in research or control. M ore th a n a hundred o f these in stru m ents are being used daily in educational and industrial labo C A L I R A P I D IT Y IN M A K I N G R E A D I N G S ‘ ratories. F o r work in th e visible range o f 380 to 700 milli microns, th e 1 cm. cell u n it, com plete w ith light source and all necessary accessories, m ay be purchased for $572.90. The 5 cm cell unit, covering th e sam e range, com plete w ith ac N E G L IG IB L E S T R A Y L IG H T EFFECT cessories, sells for $577.90. I f th e range 325 to 750 millimicrons is desired, th e addition of a special high am perage light source A D A P T A B IL IT Y FO R V A R IO U S S I Z E S A N D K IN D S O F A B S O R P T IO N C E L L S and suitable transform er, rheostats, and other accessories is necessary. T he 1 cm u n it and accessories covering th is range to ta l $720.25. T he 5 cm u n it and accessories for th is range N O M I N A L B A N D W ID T H S F R O M 2l/2 T O 2 0 mu. to ta l $725.25. T he I cm outfits are equipped to handle 1/ t inch te st tubes. W rite for o th er detailed inform ation. CENTRAL SCIENTIFIC COMPANY S C IE N T IFIC IN S T R U M E N T S ffN (() LABORATORY A PPA R A TU S RbSrtpLr otf. NEW Y O R K TO RO NTO CHICAGO BO STO N S A N F R A N C IS C O INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING CHEMISTRY Vol. 16, No. 1 GLASS ABSORPTION CELLS oj p,He Q uality, ■ ■ ■ made. Ly K . I c t t Optical Flat Wa l l s . M a n y stock sizes are available. Special s i z e s m a d e to order. Fused in an elec tric furnace with cem ent t hat is acid, alkali and solvent resistant. Sole manufacturer in the United States of fused Electrophoresis Cells ■ Makers of complete Electrophoresis Apparatus Klett Manufacturing Co. 177 ea st 87TH str e e t, new York, n. y. I t ’s VERSATILE! IT’S NEW! R E C O R D IN G Viscosimeter PERM AN EN T I Records — available only with the Recording Vis|cosimeter ] C H AN G ES • Mills, washers and calenders in a range of sizes for laboratory work in natural and synthetic rubber and plastics. Heavily constructed and precision built. For full details write NATIONAL RUBBER MACHINERY CO. in viscosity can now be ] studied easily j ADAPTABLE I to many m a t e r i a l s . In j many industries V A R IA T IO N in speed, paddles, springs I easily accomplished SCHAAR For paints, pigments, varnishes, printing inks, adhesives, oils, greases, chocolate, ice cream, starches, and other viscous ma terials, from approxim ately 1 poise up. Write for information. H a v e y o u r e c e iv e d y o u r co p y of C A T A L O G 43, P a r t O n e? & COMPANY Complete Laboratory Equipment G e n e r a l O ffic e s : A k r o n , O hio 754 WEST LEXINGTON ST., CHICAGO January 15, 1944 A N A L YTI C A L E D I TI O N 25 LU M ETR O N N EW American Chemical Society Monographs PHOTOELECTRIC COLORIMETER VEGETABLE FATS AND OILS t The Chem istry, Production and U tilizatio n of V e g e ta b le Fats and O ils for E d ib le , M e d icin a l and Technical Purposes Secon d Edition by George S. Jamieson Revised and re -w ritte n to include n ew in fo rm atio n from S o u th A m erica th is m o n o g rap h is packed w ith v ita l d etails on th e sources o f these p roducts, th e ir ch aracteristics, com p o sitio n , p ro p erties and uses; com m ercial and la b o ra to ry processes fo r th e p rep aratio n and e x tra c tio n o f fats and oils from oleag in o u s seeds, clarification, b leach in g , d eo d o rizatio n , h y d ro g en atio n , refining and o th e r treatm en ts in special cases are discussed. G rad in g is described. M e th o d s are given for sam p lin g , fo r ex am in atio n o f seeds, o ils, fats, press cake and m eals as w ell as tests for e v a lu a tio n purposes and for the detectio n o f a d u lte ra n ts . . . all ex h au stiv ely docum ented. ;o S Pages U -71 A highly sensitive instrument covering an un usually wide field of application. • • • • A b rid g e d spectrophotometry with 14 monochromatic filters, trichromatic filters. G reat variety of sample holders, microcells, test tubes, absorption cells up to 150 mm light path. Line-operated, highest reproducibility and stability due to use of balanced circuit, no batteries or voltage stabilizers required. A p p lic a b le (with accessories) to faint turbidities, fluores cence, ultraviolet absorption, reflection of opaque liquids, powders, pastes, solids. W rite for new 15-page bulletin on L U M E T R O N Mod. 402-E. TUNGSTEN PHOTOVOLT CORPORATION Its H isto ry, G e o lo g y , O re -D re ssin g, M etallu rgy, Chem istry, A n a ly s is , A p p lic a tio n s , and Econom ics 95 M a d iso n A v e . 4 BOOK by K . C. L i and Chung Y u W ang T h e increasing im p o rtance o f tu n g sten in the m etallurgical and electronic in d u stries h as evoked a need for a com pre hensive tre a tm e n t o f its g eology, processing and uses, w h ich th is b o o k ex p ertly m eets. W ritten by tw o o u tsta n d in g au th o ritie s in th e field, it presents detailed discussions o f the occurrence, co m p o sitio n and p re p a ra tio n o f tu n g sten ores in all p a rts o f th e w o rld . Includes th ree strik in g co lo r rep ro d uctio n s o f tu n g sten allo y s, m aps and o th e r illu stra tio n s. A valu ab le reference w o rk for a ll those concerned w ith the uses o r pro p erties o f th is im p o rta n t m etal, ¡ i ; Pages Illu s tra ted $7.00 BIOCHEMISTRY OF THE FATTY ACIDS AND THEIR COMPOUNDS THE LIPIDS by W . R. Bloor A m uch-needed stu d y o f th e fats — the o rganic com pounds so closely associated in th e hum an body w ith carb o h y d rates and p ro tein s — o f g re a te st value to physicians, n u tritio n is ts , o rg an ic chem ists, b io ch em ists, and to th o se in th e food and iharm aceutical fields. Discusses th e p a rt played by fats and ¡{fids in d ig estio n and n u tritio n , and th e re la tio n o f fa tty acid m etabolism to such p e rtin e n t subjects as v itam in s, en zym es, th e rep ro d u c tiv e cycle, em bolism , anaem ia, cancer, diab etes, sy p h ilis, a rth ritis , and o th e rs. }$y Pages Illustrated { NEW YORK CITY YOU WILL FIND HELPFUL Ju st w rite for it I 11 tills booklet th e '. pH , chlorine, and phosphate con trol problems o f 34 IN D I V ID U A L IN D U S T R IE S are discussed and brief solutions are given . . . 84 pages o f in form ation you will find helpful in m aintenance of precise process control. IT IS YOURS FO R T H E A SK IN G . TAYLOR COM PARATORS offer m any advantages for pH , chlorine, and phosphate control in practically every in dustry. M olded o f durable plastic, th ey will la st a lifetime. A ccuracy o f determ ina tion is assured a t all tim es because T aylor Liquid Color S tandards C A R R Y A N U N L IM IT E D G U A R A N T E E A G A IN ST F A D IN G . E xtrem ely easy to use — p erm it quickest m ethod o f determ ination. T h eir cost is insignifi c a n t com pared to the savings they m ake possible. $6.00 S e e y o u r d e a le r or utrite d ir e c t. Senel for our N ew 1944 Book Catalog " L e t’s Look It U p " REINHOLD PUBLISHING CORPORATION 3 3 0 W . 4 2n d Street N e w Y o rk 1 8 , N . Y. \ W. A. TAYLOR co? 7 3 0 2 Y O R K RD. • BALTIM ORE-4, MD. 26 INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING Vol. 16, No. CHEMISTRY %T I ' - Xfe' /* I spe \ . o CSV-'": ' V.r.: •' uD,W ■ X ß T hese things fight ! They fight 24 hours a day! Striking hard blows at the enemy by c o n sta n tly giving o u r so ld ie rs d e ad lier weapons, faster planes, b etter arm or. The few sym bols and words above are a small p art o f technology, th at know how o f produc tion which has become as im portant as logistics or strategy. These are the weapons C o l e m a n i n s t r u m e n t s a r e so Id b y o f m odern men, the realists o f research and industry, always seeking the practical, newer, b etter way o f doing their work. W e offer these weapons in their m ost efficient form, proper im plem ents for m en who have no m ore roots in the past th an are useful to roll back the future — and win a war l e a d i n g d e a l e r s in l a b o r a t o r y s u p p l i e s pH E L E C T R O M E T E R S P H O TO FL UO RO M E TE R S SPECTROPHOTOMETERS C O L E M A N E L E C T R I C C O . • M A Y W O O D , ILL. • NEW Y O R K , N. Y.